UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C.  20549

FORM 10-K

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE

SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934


For the fiscal year ended January 30, 2009


Commission file number: 001-11421


DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION
( Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter )


TENNESSEE
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)

61-0502302
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

 

100 MISSION RIDGE
GOODLETTSVILLE, TN  37072
(Address of principal executive offices, zip code)

 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:   (615) 855-4000

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: None

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:   None


Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  Yes [  ]   No [X]


Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act.  Yes [   ] No [X]


Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes [X] No [    ]


Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. [X]





Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.


Large accelerated filer [  ]

Accelerated filer [  ]


Non-accelerated filer [X]

Smaller reporting company [  ]


Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  Yes [  ]  No [X]


The aggregate fair market value of the registrant’s common stock outstanding and held by non-affiliates as of August 1, 2008 was $3,230,750, all of which was owned by employees of the registrant and not traded on a public market. For this purpose, directors, executive officers and greater than 10% record shareholders are considered the affiliates of the registrant.


The registrant had 556,227,947 shares of common stock outstanding on March 17, 2009.





INTRODUCTION


General


This report contains references to years 2009, 2008, 2007, 2006, 2005 and 2004, which represent fiscal years ending or ended January 29, 2010, January 30, 2009, February 1, 2008, February 2, 2007, February 3, 2006 and January 28, 2005, respectively.  All of the discussion and analysis in this report should be read with, and is qualified in its entirety by, the Consolidated Financial Statements and related notes.


Forward Looking Statements


“Forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the federal securities laws are included throughout this report, particularly under the headings “Business” and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” among others. You can identify these statements because they are not solely statements of historical fact or they use words such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “believe,” “anticipate,” “project,” “plan,” “expect,” “estimate,” “objective,” “forecast,” “goal,” “intend,” “will likely result,” or “will continue” and similar expressions that concern our strategy, plans or intentions. For example, all statements relating to our estimated and projected earnings, costs, expenditures, cash flows and financial results, our plans and objectives for future operations, growth or initiatives, or the expected outcome or impact of pending or threatened litigation are forward-looking statements.


All forward-looking statements are subject to risks and uncertainties that may change at any time, so our actual results may differ materially from those that we expected. We derive many of these statements from our operating budgets and forecasts, which are based on many detailed assumptions that we believe are reasonable. However, it is very difficult to predict the impact of known factors, and we cannot anticipate all factors that could affect our actual results. Important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from the expectations expressed in our forward-looking statements are disclosed under “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A and elsewhere in this document (including, without limitation, in conjunction with the forward-looking statements themselves and under the heading “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates”). All written and oral forward-looking statements we make in the future are expressly qualified in their entirety by these cautionary statements as well as other cautionary statements that we make from time to time in our other SEC filings and public communications. You should evaluate all of our forward-looking statements in the context of these risks and uncertainties.


The forward-looking statements included in this report are made only as of the date hereof. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statement as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as otherwise required by law.




1



PART I


ITEM 1.

BUSINESS


General


We are the largest discount retailer in the United States by number of stores, with 8,414 stores located in 35 states, primarily in the southern, southwestern, midwestern and eastern United States, as of February 27, 2009.  We serve a broad customer base and offer a focused assortment of everyday items, including basic consumable merchandise and other home, apparel and seasonal products.  A majority of our products are priced at $10 or less and approximately 25% of our products are priced at $1 or less.


We offer a compelling value proposition for our customers based on convenient store locations, easy in and out shopping and quality name brand and private brand merchandise at highly competitive everyday low prices. We believe our combination of value and convenience distinguishes us from other discount, convenience and drugstore retailers, who typically focus on either value or convenience. Our business model is focused on strong and sustainable sales growth, attractive margins, and limited maintenance capital expenditure and working capital needs, which, in combination, result in significant cash flow from operations (before interest).


We were founded in 1939 as J.L. Turner and Son, Wholesale.  We opened our first dollar store in 1955, when we were incorporated as a Kentucky corporation under the name J.L. Turner & Son, Inc.  We changed our name to Dollar General Corporation in 1968 and reincorporated as a Tennessee corporation in 1998.  In 2007, we entered into a merger transaction with an entity controlled by investment funds affiliated with Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., L.P. (“KKR” or “Sponsor”), as discussed in more detail under “Our 2007 Merger” below.


We have increased our total number of stores from 6,700 on January 30, 2004, to 8,362 on January 30, 2009, a 4.5% compounded annual growth rate (“CAGR”).  Over the same period, we grew our net sales from $6.9 billion to $10.5 billion (8.8% CAGR), driven by growth in number of stores as well as same store sales growth. We slowed new store growth in 2007 and 2008 and closed approximately 400 stores in 2007 to improve our profitability and to enable us to focus on improving the performance of existing stores. In 2008, we opened 207 new stores, closed 39 stores, and relocated or remodeled 404 existing stores. Net sales in 2008 were driven primarily by a same-store sales increase of 9.0%. See our Consolidated Financial Statements for net sales and net income (loss) for each of our last three fiscal years and total assets for each of our last two fiscal years. We intend to accelerate our new store growth in 2009 with plans to open approximately 450 new stores and to remodel or relocate approximately 400 stores.


Our 2007 Merger


On July 6, 2007, we completed a merger (the “Merger”), and, as a result,  we are a subsidiary of Buck Holdings, L.P. (“Parent”), a Delaware limited partnership controlled by investment funds affiliated with KKR. KKR, GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P. and affiliated funds (affiliates of Goldman, Sachs & Co.), Citi Private Equity, Wellington Management



2



Company, LLP, CPP Investment Board (USRE II) Inc., and other equity co-investors (collectively, the “Investors”) indirectly own a substantial portion of our capital stock through their investment in Parent.


As a result of the Merger, our outstanding common stock is now owned by Parent and certain members of management. Our common stock is not registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and is not traded on a national securities exchange.


We entered into the following debt financings in conjunction with the Merger:


·

We entered into a credit agreement and related security and other agreements consisting of a $2.3 billion senior secured term loan facility, which matures on July 6, 2014 (the “Term Loan Facility”).


·

We entered into a credit agreement and related security and other agreements consisting of a senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility of up to $1.125 billion (of which $432.3 million was drawn at closing and $132.3 million was paid down on the same day), subject to borrowing base availability, which matures July 6, 2013 (the “ABL Facility” and, with the Term Loan Facility, the “Credit Facilities”).


·

We issued $1.175 billion aggregate principal amount of 10.625% senior notes due 2015, which mature on July 15, 2015, and $725 million aggregate principal amount of 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated toggle notes due 2017, which mature on July 15, 2017. We repurchased $25.0 million and $44.1 million of the senior subordinated toggle notes in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2007 and in the fourth quarter of fiscal 2008, respectively.  


Accounting periods before and after the Merger are referred to as the Predecessor and Successor, respectively.


Overall Business Strategy


Our mission is “Serving Others.” To carry out this mission, we have developed a business strategy of providing our customers with a focused assortment of everyday low priced merchandise in a convenient, small-store format.


Our Customers .  In general, we locate our stores and base our merchandise selection on the needs of households seeking value and convenience, with an emphasis on rural and small markets. However, much of our merchandise, intended to serve the basic consumable, household, apparel and seasonal needs of these targeted customers, also appeals to a much broader and higher income customer base.  


Our Stores . The traditional Dollar General® store has, on average, approximately 7,000 square feet of selling space and generally serves customers who live within three miles of the store.  Of our 8,414 stores operating as of February 27, 2009, more than 60% serve communities



3



with populations of 20,000 or less.  We believe that our target customers prefer the convenience of a small, neighborhood store with a focused merchandise assortment at value prices.


Our Merchandise .  Our merchandising strategy combines a low-cost operating structure with a focused assortment of products, consisting of quality basic consumable, household, apparel and seasonal merchandise at competitive everyday low prices. Our strategic combination of name brands, quality private brand products and other great value brands allows us to offer our customers a compelling value proposition. We believe our merchandising strategy and focused assortment generate frequent repeat customer purchases and encourage customers to shop at our stores for their everyday household needs.  


Our Prices.   We distribute quality, consumable merchandise at everyday low prices.  Our strategy of maintaining a low-cost operating structure and a focused assortment of merchandise allows us to offer quality merchandise at competitive prices.  As part of this strategy, we emphasize even-dollar prices on many of our items.  In the typical Dollar General store, the majority of the products are priced at $10 or less, with approximately 25% of the products priced at $1 or less.  


Our Cost Controls . We aggressively manage our overhead cost structure and generally seek to locate stores in neighborhoods where rental and operating costs are relatively low.  Our stores typically have low fixed costs, including lean staffing. In recent years, we implemented “EZstore TM ”, our proprietary process designed to improve inventory flow from our distribution centers, or DCs, to consumers. The EZstore process has allowed us to reallocate store labor hours to more customer-focused activities, improving the work content in our stores.


We also attempt to control operating costs by implementing new technology when feasible. In recent years we have improved our store labor scheduling,  store replenishment, and our supply chain and warehousing systems. We are in the process of expanding our technological capabilities by installing store computers throughout the chain. This initiative is expected to improve store communications and execution and reduce costs.


Strategic Initiatives Project Alpha.   In 2007, we executed strategic initiatives launched in the fourth quarter of 2006 aimed at improving our merchandising and real estate strategies, which we refer to collectively as “Project Alpha.” Project Alpha was based upon a comprehensive analysis of the performance of each of our stores and the impact of our inventory management model on our ability to effectively serve our customers.


The execution of this merchandising initiative has moved us away from our traditional inventory packaway model, where unsold seasonal, apparel and home products inventory items were stored on-site and returned to the sales floor until the items were eventually sold, damaged or discarded.  In connection with this initiative, in fiscal 2007 we began taking end-of-season markdowns on current-year non-replenishable merchandise. With limited and planned exceptions, we eliminated, through end-of-season and other markdowns, our seasonal, home products and basic clothing packaway merchandise and out of season current year merchandise by the end of fiscal 2007. In addition to allowing us to carry newer, fresher merchandise, particularly in our seasonal, apparel and home categories, we believe this strategy change has



4



enhanced the appearance of our stores and has positively impacted customer satisfaction as well as our store employees’ ability to manage stores.


Project Alpha also encompassed significant improvements to our real estate practices. We have integrated the functions of site selection, lease renewals, relocations, remodels and store closings and have defined and are implementing rigorous analytical processes for decision-making in those areas. As a first step in our initiative to revitalize our store base, we performed a comprehensive real estate review resulting in the identification of approximately 400 underperforming stores, all of which we closed by mid-2007. These closings were in addition to stores that are typically closed in the normal course of business, which over the last 10 years constituted approximately 1% to 2% of our store base per year. In 2008, our store closings were more in line with historic levels, as we closed 39 stores.  As part of Project Alpha, we moderated our new store growth rate beginning in 2007 to enable us to focus on improving the performance of existing stores, including increasing the number of store remodels and relocations in order to improve productivity and enhance the shopping experience for our customers. We intend to accelerate our new store growth in 2009 by opening approximately 450 new stores and remodeling or relocating approximately 400 stores.


As a result of opening new stores and remodeling existing stores, as of February 27, 2009, approximately 1,600 stores are operating in our racetrack format, which is designed with improved merchandise adjacencies and wider, more open aisles to enhance the overall guest shopping experience. We plan to continue to review and refine all of our existing store layouts, including the racetrack format, as well as test new layouts to further drive sales growth and margin enhancements through improved merchandising.


Our Industry


We compete in the deep discount segment of the U.S. retail industry. Our competitors include traditional “dollar stores,” as well as other retailers offering discounted convenience items. The “dollar store” sector differentiates itself from other forms of retailing in the deep discount segment by offering consistently low prices in a convenient, small-store format. Unlike other formats that have suffered with the rise of Wal-Mart and other discount supercenters, the “dollar store” sector has grown despite the presence of the discount supercenters.  We believe it is our substantial convenience advantage, at prices comparable to those of supercenters, that allows Dollar General to compete so effectively.

 

We believe that there is considerable room for growth in the “dollar store” sector. According to data from Nielsen Homescan Panel (“Nielsen”), “dollar stores” have been able to increase their penetration across all income brackets in recent years, climbing from 45% in 1997 to 64% in 2008. Though traditional “dollar stores” have high customer penetration, according to Nielsen the sector as a whole accounts for only approximately 1.5% of retail spending, which we believe leaves ample room for growth. Our merchandising initiatives are aimed at increasing our stores’ share of customer spending.


See “Our Competitive Strengths” and “Competition” below for additional information regarding our competitive situation.



5



Our Competitive Strengths


Market Leader in an Attractive Sector with a Growing Customer Base.   We are the largest discount retailer in the U.S. by number of stores, with 8,414 stores in 35 states as of February 27, 2009.  We are the largest player in the U.S. small box deep discount segment based on sales.  We believe we are well positioned to further increase our market share as we continue to execute our business strategy and implement our operational initiatives.  Our target customers are those seeking value and convenience. According to Nielsen, recent trip consolidation has caused decreased total outlet trips per shopper by approximately 2.5%.  At the same time the “dollar store” channel grew trips per shopper by approximately 2.5%, faster than any other retail channel and the only channel other than warehouse clubs that increased trips per shopper.

Consistent Sales Growth and Strong Cash Flow Generation. For 19 consecutive years, we have experienced positive annual same store sales growth.  Approximately two-thirds of our net sales come from the sale of consumable products, which are less susceptible to economic pressures (such as increased fuel costs and unemployment), with the remaining one-third comprised mainly of seasonal, basic clothing and home products which are subject to little trend or fashion risk.  We have a low cost operating model with attractive operating margins, low capital expenditures and low working capital needs, resulting in generation of significant cash flow from operations (before interest).


Differentiated Value Proposition. Our ability to deliver highly competitive everyday low prices in a convenient location and shopping format provides our customers with a compelling shopping experience and distinguishes us from other discount retailers, as well as from convenience and drugstore retailers.


Compelling Unit Economics.   The traditional Dollar General store size, design and location requires an initial investment for fixtures, equipment, signage and inventory of approximately $230,000. The low initial investment and maintenance capital expenditures, when combined with strong average unit volumes, provide for a quick recovery of store start-up costs.  The ability of our successful stores to generate strong cash flows with minimal investment often results in a short payback period.  


Efficient Supply Chain.   We believe our distribution network is an integral component of our efforts to reduce transportation expenses and effectively support our growth.  In recent years, we have made significant investments in technological improvements and upgrades which have increased our efficiency and capacity to support our merchandising and operations initiatives and new store growth.


Experienced Management Team.   In January 2008, we hired Richard Dreiling, who has 39 years of retail experience, to serve as our Chief Executive Officer.  Over the past several years we strengthened our management team with the hiring of David Beré, our President and Chief Strategy Officer, and Todd Vasos, our Executive Vice President, Division President and Chief Merchandising Officer. We also replaced a majority of our senior merchandising and real estate teams.




6



Seasonality


Our business is seasonal to a certain extent.  Generally, our highest sales volume occurs in the fourth quarter, which includes the Christmas selling season, and the lowest occurs in the first quarter.  In addition, our quarterly results can be affected by the timing of new store openings and store closings, the amount of sales contributed by new and existing stores, as well as the timing of certain holidays. We purchase substantial amounts of inventory in the third quarter and incur higher shipping costs and higher payroll costs in anticipation of the increased sales activity during the fourth quarter.  In addition, we carry merchandise during our fourth quarter that we do not carry during the rest of the year, such as gift sets, holiday decorations, certain baking items, and a broader assortment of toys and candy.


The following table reflects the seasonality of net sales, gross profit, and net income (loss) by quarter for each of the quarters of the current fiscal year as well as each of the quarters of the two most recent fiscal years. All of the quarters reflected below are comprised of 13 weeks (see note (a) regarding results for the second quarter of 2007).


(in millions)

1 st
Quarter

2 nd
Quarter

3 rd
Quarter

4 th
Quarter

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended January 30, 2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

2,403.5 

$

2,609.4 

$

2,598.9 

$

2,845.8 

Gross profit

 

693.1 

 

758.0 

 

772.3 

 

837.7 

Net income (loss)

 

5.9 

 

27.7 

 

(7.3)

 

81.9 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended February 1, 2008(a)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

2,275.3 

 

(a)

 

2,312.8 

 

2,559.6 

Gross profit (b)

 

633.1 

 

(a)

 

646.8 

 

740.4 

Net income (loss) (b)

 

34.9 

 

(a)

 

(33.0)

 

55.4 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended February 2, 2007

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

 

2,151.4 

 

2,251.1 

 

2,213.4 

 

2,554.0 

Gross profit (b)

 

584.3 

 

611.5 

 

526.4 

 

646.0 

Net income (loss) (b)

 

47.7 

 

45.5 

 

(5.3)

 

50.1 


(a)

The Merger was completed during the second quarter of 2007. Net sales, Gross profit, and Net (loss) were $1,648.5, $438.5 and $(42.9), respectively, for the Predecessor period from May 5, 2007 to July 6, 2007, and were $699.1, $184.7 and $(27.2), respectively, for the Successor period from March 6, 2007 to August 3, 2007. For comparison purposes, these Successor results include the results of operations for Buck Acquisition Corp. for the period prior to the Merger from March 6, 2007 (its formation) through July 6, 2007 (reflecting the change in fair value of interest rate swaps).

(b)

Results for the 3 rd and 4 th quarters of 2006 and all of 2007 reflect the impact of certain strategic real estate and inventory management initiatives as discussed above in “Overall Business Strategy.”


Merchandise


We separate our merchandise into the following four categories for reporting purposes: highly consumable, seasonal, home products, and basic clothing. Highly consumable consists of packaged food, candy, snacks and refrigerated products, health and beauty aids, home cleaning supplies and pet supplies; seasonal consists of seasonal and holiday-related items, toys, stationery and hardware; home products consists of housewares and domestics; and basic



7



clothing consists of casual everyday apparel. The percentage of net sales of each of our four categories of merchandise for the period indicated below was as follows:


 

2008

 

2007

 

2006

Highly consumable

69.3

%

 

66.5

%

 

65.7

%

Seasonal

14.6

%

 

15.9

%

 

16.4

%

Home products

8.2

%

 

9.2

%

 

10.0

%

Basic clothing

7.9

%

 

8.4

%

 

7.9

%


Our home products and seasonal categories typically account for the highest gross profit margin, and the highly consumable category typically accounts for the lowest gross profit margin.  


We currently maintain approximately 7,300 core stock-keeping units, or SKUs, per store and an additional 3,200 non-core SKUs that get rotated in and out of the store over the course of a year.


We purchase our merchandise from a wide variety of suppliers. Approximately 10% of our purchases in 2008 were from The Procter & Gamble Company.  Our next largest supplier accounted for approximately 6% of our purchases in 2008.  We directly imported approximately 10% of our purchases at cost (14% at retail) in 2008.


The Dollar General Store


The average Dollar General store has approximately 7,000 square feet of selling space and is typically operated by a manager, an assistant manager and two or more sales clerks. Approximately 53% are in freestanding buildings, 45% of our stores are located in strip shopping centers and 2% are in downtown buildings. We attempt to locate primarily in small towns or in neighborhoods of more densely populated areas where occupancy expenses are relatively low.


We generally have not encountered difficulty locating suitable store sites in the past, and although management does not currently anticipate experiencing material difficulty in finding future suitable locations, the current conditions in the real estate and financing markets could make this process more difficult than in recent years.




8



Our recent store growth is summarized in the following table:


Year

Stores at
Beginning
of Year

Stores
Opened

Stores
Closed (a)

Net
Store
Increase/(Decrease)

Stores at
End of Year

2006

7,929

537

237

300 

8,229

2007

8,229

365

400

(35)

8,194

2008

8,194

207

39

168 

8,362


(a) Includes 128 stores and 275 stores closed in 2006 and 2007, respectively as a result of certain strategic initiatives.


Employees


As of February 27, 2009, we employed approximately 72,500 full-time and part-time employees, including divisional and regional managers, district managers, store managers, and DC and administrative personnel.  Management believes our relationship with our employees is generally good, and we currently are not a party to any collective bargaining agreements.


Competition


We operate in the discount retail merchandise business, which is highly competitive with respect to price, store location, merchandise quality, assortment and presentation, in-stock consistency, and customer service.  We compete with discount stores and with many other retailers, including mass merchandise, grocery, drug, convenience, variety and other specialty stores. These other retail companies operate stores in many of the areas where we operate, and many of them engage in extensive advertising and marketing efforts. Our direct competitors in the dollar store retail category include Family Dollar, Dollar Tree, Fred’s, 99 Cents Only and various local, independent operators. Competitors from other retail categories include Wal-Mart, Walgreens, CVS, Rite Aid, Target and Costco, among others. Certain of our competitors have greater financial, distribution, marketing and other resources than we do.


The dollar store category differentiates itself from other forms of retailing by offering consistently low prices in a convenient, small-store format. We believe that our prices are competitive due in part to our low cost operating structure and the relatively limited assortment of products offered. Historically, we have minimized labor by offering fewer price points and a reliance on simple merchandise presentation. We maintain strong purchasing power due to our leadership position in the dollar store retail category and our focused assortment of merchandise.


Trademarks


We own marks that are registered with the United States Patent and Trademark Office, including the trademarks Dollar General®, Dollar General Market®, Clover Valley®, DG®, DG Guarantee® and the Dollar General price point designs, along with variations and formatives of these trademarks as well as certain other trademarks. We attempt to obtain registration of our trademarks whenever practicable and to pursue vigorously any infringement of those marks.  Our trademark registrations have various expiration dates; however, assuming that the trademark registrations are properly renewed, they have a perpetual duration.



9



Available Information


Our Web site address is www.dollargeneral.com. We make available through this address, without charge, our annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed or furnished to the SEC.


ITEM 1A.

RISK FACTORS


Investing in our securities involves a degree of risk. Persons buying our securities should carefully consider the risks described below and the other information contained in this report and other filings that we make from time to time with the SEC, including our consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Any of the following risks could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations. In addition, the risks described below are not the only risks we face. Our business, financial condition or results of operations could also be adversely affected by additional factors that apply to all companies generally, as well as other risks that are not currently known to us or that we currently view to be immaterial. In any such case, the trading price of our securities could decline or we may not be able to make payments of principal and interest on our outstanding notes, and you may lose all or part of your original investment. While we attempt to mitigate known risks to the extent we believe to be practicable and reasonable, we can provide no assurance, and we make no representation, that our mitigation efforts will be successful.


The fact that we have substantial debt could adversely affect our ability to raise additional capital to fund our operations, limit our ability to react to changes in the economy or our industry, expose us to interest rate risk to the extent of our variable rate debt and prevent us from meeting our obligations under our outstanding debt securities.  


We have substantial debt which could have important consequences, including:


·

increasing difficulty in making payments on our outstanding debt;


·

increasing our vulnerability to general economic and industry conditions;


·

requiring a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to be dedicated to the payment of principal and interest on our indebtedness, therefore reducing our ability to use our cash flow to fund our operations, capital expenditures and future business opportunities;


·

exposing us to the risk of interest rate fluctuations as certain of our borrowings bear interest based on market interest rates;


·

limiting our ability to obtain additional financing for working capital, capital expenditures, debt service requirements, acquisitions and general corporate or other purposes; and



10



·

limiting our ability to adjust to changing market conditions and placing us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors who are less highly leveraged.

In addition, the borrowings under our Credit Facilities bear interest at variable rates and other debt we incur also could be variable-rate debt.  If market interest rates increase, variable-rate debt will create higher debt service requirements, which could adversely affect our cash flow.  While we have and may in the future enter into agreements limiting our exposure to higher interest rates, any such agreements may not offer complete protection from this risk.  We and our subsidiaries may be able to incur substantial additional indebtedness in the future, subject to the restrictions contained in our Credit Facilities and the indentures governing our debt securities.  If new indebtedness is added to our current debt levels, the related risks that we now face could intensify.

Our debt agreements contain restrictions that limit our flexibility in operating our business.  

Our Credit Facilities and the indentures governing our debt securities contain various covenants that limit our ability to engage in specified types of transactions.  These covenants limit our and our restricted subsidiaries’ ability to, among other things:

·

incur additional indebtedness, issue disqualified stock or issue certain preferred stock;


·

pay dividends and make certain distributions, investments and other restricted payments;


·

create certain liens or encumbrances;


·

sell assets;


·

enter into transactions with our affiliates;


·

limit the ability of restricted subsidiaries to make payments to us;


·

merge, consolidate, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets; and


·

designate our subsidiaries as unrestricted subsidiaries.


A breach of any of these covenants could result in a default under the agreement governing such indebtedness.  Upon our failure to maintain compliance with these covenants, the lenders could elect to declare all amounts outstanding thereunder to be immediately due and payable and terminate all commitments to extend further credit thereunder.  If the lenders under such indebtedness accelerate the repayment of borrowings, we cannot assure you that we will have sufficient assets to repay those borrowings, as well as our other indebtedness, including our outstanding debt securities.  We have pledged a significant portion of our assets as collateral under our Credit Facilities.  If we were unable to repay those amounts, the lenders under our



11



Credit Facilities could proceed against the collateral granted to them to secure that indebtedness. Additional borrowings under the ABL Facility will, if excess availability under that facility is less than a certain amount, be subject to the satisfaction of a specified financial ratio.  Our ability to meet this financial ratio can be affected by events beyond our control, and we cannot assure you that we will meet this ratio and other covenants.  


General economic factors may adversely affect our financial performance and other aspects of our business.


A further slowdown in the economy or other economic conditions affecting disposable consumer income, such as unemployment levels, inflation, business conditions, fuel and other energy costs, consumer debt levels, lack of available credit, interest rates, tax rates and changes in tax laws, may adversely affect our business by reducing overall consumer spending or by causing customers to shift their spending to products other than those sold by us or to products sold by us that are less profitable than other product choices, all of which could result in lower net sales, decreases in inventory turnover, greater markdowns on inventory, and a reduction in profitability due to lower margins.  Many of those factors, as well as commodity rates, transportation costs, costs of labor, insurance and healthcare, foreign exchange rate fluctuations, lease costs, changes in other laws and regulations and other economic factors, also affect our cost of sales and our selling, general and administrative expenses, and we have no control or limited ability to control such factors .


In addition, many of the factors discussed above, along with current global economic conditions and uncertainties, the potential impact of the current recession, the potential for additional failures or realignments of financial institutions, and the related impact on available credit may affect us and our suppliers and other business partners, landlords, and customers in an adverse manner including, but not limited to, reducing access to liquid funds or credit (including through the loss of one or more financial institutions that are a part of our revolving credit facility), increasing the cost of credit, limiting our ability to manage interest rate risk, increasing the risk of bankruptcy of our suppliers, landlords or counterparties to or other financial institutions involved in our credit facilities and our derivative and other contracts, increasing the cost of goods to us, and other impacts which we are unable to fully anticipate. See also our disclosures under Part II, Item 7A. “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” below.


Our plans depend significantly on initiatives designed to improve the efficiencies, costs and effectiveness of our operations, and failure to achieve or sustain these plans could affect our performance adversely.


We have had, and expect to continue to have, initiatives (such as those relating to marketing, merchandising, promotions, sourcing, shrink, private brand, store operations and real estate) in various stages of testing, evaluation, and implementation, upon which we expect to rely to improve our results of operations and financial condition. These initiatives are inherently risky and uncertain, even when tested successfully, in their application to our business in general. It is possible that successful testing can result partially from resources and attention that cannot be duplicated in broader implementation. Testing and general implementation also can be affected



12



by other risk factors described herein that reduce the results expected. Successful systemwide implementation relies on consistency of training, stability of workforce, ease of execution, and the absence of offsetting factors that can influence results adversely. Failure to achieve successful implementation of our initiatives or the cost of these initiatives exceeding management’s estimates could adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition.


Risks associated with the domestic and foreign suppliers from whom our products are sourced could adversely affect our financial performance.


The products we sell are sourced from a wide variety of domestic and international suppliers. Approximately 10% of our purchases in 2008 were from The Procter & Gamble Company. Our next largest supplier accounted for approximately 6% of our purchases in 2008. We directly imported approximately 10% of our purchases at cost in 2008, but many of our domestic vendors directly import their products or components of their products. Political and economic instability in the countries in which foreign suppliers are located, the financial instability of suppliers, suppliers’ failure to meet our supplier standards, labor problems experienced by our suppliers, the availability of raw materials to suppliers, merchandise quality or safety issues, currency exchange rates, transport availability and cost, inflation, and other factors relating to the suppliers and the countries in which they are located or from which they import are beyond our control. In addition, the United States’ foreign trade policies, tariffs and other impositions on imported goods, trade sanctions imposed on certain countries, the limitation on the importation of certain types of goods or of goods containing certain materials from other countries and other factors relating to foreign trade are beyond our control. Disruptions due to labor stoppages, strikes or slowdowns, or other disruptions, involving our vendors or the transportation and handling industries also may negatively affect our ability to receive merchandise and thus may negatively affect sales. These and other factors affecting our suppliers and our access to products could adversely affect our financial performance.


All of our vendors must comply with applicable product safety laws, and we are dependent on them to ensure that the products we buy comply with all safety standards.  Our ability to obtain indemnification from foreign suppliers may be hindered by the manufacturers’ lack of understanding of U.S. product liability or other laws, which may make it more likely that we be required to respond to claims or complaints from customers as if we were the manufacturer of the products.


As we increase our imports of merchandise from foreign vendors, the risks associated with foreign imports will increase.


We are subject to governmental regulations, procedures and requirements. A significant change in, or noncompliance with, these regulations could have a material adverse effect on our financial performance.


Our business is subject to numerous federal, state and local laws and regulations.  New laws or regulations or changes in existing laws and regulations, particularly those governing the sale of products, may require extensive system and operating changes that may be difficult to implement and could increase our cost of doing business. In addition, such changes or new laws



13



may require the write off and disposal of existing product inventory, resulting in significant adverse financial impact to the Company.  Untimely compliance or noncompliance with applicable regulations or untimely or incomplete execution of a required product recall can result in the imposition of penalties, including loss of licenses or significant fines or monetary penalties, in addition to reputational damage.


Litigation may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.


Our business is subject to the risk of litigation by employees, consumers, suppliers, competitors, shareholders, government agencies, or others through private actions, class actions, administrative proceedings, regulatory actions or other litigation. The number of employment-related class actions filed each year has continued to increase, and recent changes in Federal law may cause claims to rise even more.  The outcome of litigation, particularly class action lawsuits, regulatory actions and intellectual property claims, is difficult to assess or quantify. Plaintiffs in these types of lawsuits may seek recovery of very large or indeterminate amounts, and the magnitude of the potential loss relating to these lawsuits may remain unknown for substantial periods of time. In addition, certain of these lawsuits, if decided adversely to us or settled by us, may result in liability material to our financial statements as a whole or may negatively affect our operating results if changes to our business operation are required. The cost to defend future litigation may be significant. There also may be adverse publicity associated with litigation that could negatively affect customer perception of our business, regardless of whether the allegations are valid or whether we are ultimately found liable. As a result, litigation may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. See the disclosure under the heading “Legal Proceedings” in Note 8 to the Consolidated Financial Statements herein for further details regarding certain of these pending matters.


Failure to attract and retain qualified employees while controlling labor costs, as well as other labor issues, could adversely affect our financial performance.


Our future growth and performance depends on our ability to attract, retain and motivate qualified employees, many of whom are in positions with historically high rates of turnover. Our ability to meet our labor needs, while controlling our labor costs, is subject to many external factors, including the competition for and availability of qualified personnel in a given market, unemployment levels within those markets, prevailing wage rates, minimum wage laws, health and other insurance costs and changes in employment and labor legislation (including changes in the process for our employees to join a union) or other workplace regulation (including changes in entitlement programs such as health insurance and paid leave programs). To the extent a significant portion of our employee base unionizes, or attempts to unionize, our labor costs could increase. Our ability to pass along labor costs is constrained.


Also, our stores are decentralized and are managed through a network of geographically dispersed management personnel. Our inability to effectively and efficiently operate our stores, including the ability to control losses resulting from inventory and cash shrinkage, may negatively affect our sales and/or operating margins.




14



We are dependent upon the smooth functioning of our distribution network, the capacity of our distribution centers, and the timely receipt of inventory.


We rely upon the ability to replenish depleted inventory through deliveries to our distribution centers from vendors and from the distribution centers to our stores by various means of transportation, including shipments by sea and truck. Labor shortages in the transportation industry could negatively affect transportation costs. In addition, long-term disruptions to the national and international transportation infrastructure that lead to delays or interruptions of service would adversely affect our business.


Our planned future growth will be impeded, which would adversely affect sales, if we cannot open new stores on schedule or if we close a number of stores materially in excess of anticipated levels.


Our growth is dependent on both increases in sales in existing stores and the ability to open profitable new stores. Our ability to timely open new stores and to expand into additional market areas depends in part on the following factors: the availability of attractive store locations; the absence of occupancy delays; the ability to negotiate favorable lease terms; the ability to hire and train new personnel, especially store managers; the ability to identify customer demand in different geographic areas; general economic conditions; and the availability of sufficient funds for expansion. In addition, many of these factors affect our ability to successfully relocate stores. Many of these factors are beyond our control. In addition, our substantial debt, particularly combined with the recent tightening of the credit markets, has made it more difficult for our real estate developers to obtain loans for our build-to-suit stores and to locate investors for those properties after they have been developed. If this trend continues, it could materially adversely impact our ability to open build-to-suit stores in desirable locations.


Delays or failures in opening new stores, or achieving lower than expected sales in new stores, or drawing a greater than expected proportion of sales in new stores from existing stores, could materially adversely affect our growth. In addition, we may not anticipate all of the challenges imposed by the expansion of our operations and, as a result, may not meet our targets for opening new stores, remodeling or relocating stores or expanding profitably.


Some of our new stores may be located in areas where we have little or no meaningful experience. Those markets may have different competitive conditions, market conditions, consumer tastes and discretionary spending patterns than our existing markets, which may cause our new stores to be less successful than stores in our existing markets.


Some of our new stores will be located in areas where we have existing units. Although we have experience in these markets, increasing the number of locations in these markets may result in inadvertent over-saturation of markets and temporarily or permanently divert customers and sales from our existing stores, thereby adversely affecting our overall financial performance.




15



Because our business is seasonal to a certain extent, with the highest volume of net sales during the fourth quarter, adverse events during the fourth quarter could materially affect our financial statements as a whole.

We generally recognize our highest volume of net sales during the Christmas selling season, which occurs in the fourth quarter of our fiscal year. In anticipation of this holiday, we purchase substantial amounts of seasonal inventory and hire many temporary employees. A seasonal merchandise inventory imbalance could result if our net sales during the Christmas selling season were to fall below either seasonal norms or expectations. If our fourth quarter results were substantially below expectations, our financial performance and operating results could be adversely affected by unanticipated markdowns, especially in seasonal merchandise. Lower than anticipated sales in the Christmas selling season would also negatively affect our ability to absorb the increased seasonal labor costs.


We face intense competition that could limit our growth opportunities and adversely impact our financial performance.


The retail business is highly competitive. We operate in the discount retail merchandise business, which is competitive with respect to price, store location, merchandise quality, assortment and presentation, in-stock consistency, and customer service. This competitive environment subjects us to the risk of adverse impact to our financial performance because of the lower prices, and thus the lower margins, required to maintain our competitive position. Also, companies operating in the discount retail merchandise sector (due to customer demographics and other factors) may have limited ability to increase prices in response to increased costs (including, but not limited to, vendor price increases). This limitation may adversely affect our margins and financial performance. We compete for customers, employees, store sites, products and services and in other important aspects of our business with many other local, regional and national retailers. We compete with retailers operating discount, mass merchandise, grocery, drug, convenience, variety and other specialty stores. Certain of our competitors have greater financial, distribution, marketing and other resources than we do. These other competitors compete in a variety of ways, including aggressive promotional activities, merchandise selection and availability, services offered to customers, location, store hours, in-store amenities and price. If we fail to respond effectively to competitive pressures and changes in the retail markets, it could adversely affect our financial performance. See “Business—Our Industry, —Competitive Strengths, and —Competition” for additional discussion of our competitive situation.


Competition for customers has intensified in recent years as larger competitors have moved into, or increased their presence in, our geographic markets. We remain vulnerable to the marketing power and high level of consumer recognition of these larger competitors and to the risk that these competitors or others could venture into the “dollar store” industry in a significant way. Generally, we expect an increase in competition.




16



Natural disasters, unusually adverse weather conditions, pandemic outbreaks, boycotts and geo-political events could adversely affect our financial performance.


The occurrence of one or more natural disasters, such as hurricanes and earthquakes, unusually adverse weather conditions, pandemic outbreaks, boycotts and geo-political events, such as civil unrest in countries in which our suppliers are located and acts of terrorism, or similar disruptions could adversely affect our operations and financial performance. These events could result in physical damage to one or more of our properties, increases in fuel (or other energy) prices or a fuel shortage, the temporary or permanent closure of one or more of our stores or distribution centers, delays in opening new stores, the temporary lack of an adequate work force in a market, the temporary or long-term disruption in the supply of products from some local and overseas suppliers, the temporary disruption in the transport of goods from overseas, delay in the delivery of goods to our distribution centers or stores, the temporary reduction in the availability of products in our stores and disruption to our information systems. These events also can have indirect consequences such as increases in the costs of insurance following a destructive hurricane season. These factors could otherwise disrupt and adversely affect our operations and financial performance.


The efficient operation of our business is heavily dependent upon our information systems.


We depend on a variety of information technology systems for the efficient functioning of our business. Such systems are subject to damage or interruption from power outages, computer and telecommunications failures, computer viruses, security breaches, and natural disasters.  Damage or interruption to our computer systems may require a significant investment to fix or replace them, and we may suffer interruptions in our operations in the interim. Any material interruptions may have a material adverse effect on our business or results of operations.


We also rely heavily on our information technology staff. If we cannot meet our staffing needs in this area, we may not be able to fulfill our technology initiatives while continuing to provide maintenance on existing systems.  We rely on certain software vendors to maintain and periodically upgrade many of these systems so that they can continue to support our business. The software programs supporting many of our systems were licensed to us by independent software developers. The inability of these developers or us to continue to maintain and upgrade these information systems and software programs would disrupt or reduce the efficiency of our operations if we were unable to convert to alternate systems in an efficient and timely manner. In addition, costs and potential problems and interruptions associated with the implementation of new or upgraded systems and technology or with maintenance or adequate support of existing systems could also disrupt or reduce the efficiency of our operations.




17



Our current insurance program may expose us to unexpected costs and negatively affect our financial performance.


Our insurance coverage reflects deductibles, self-insured retentions, limits of liability and similar provisions that we believe are prudent based on the dispersion of our operations. However, there are types of losses we may incur but against which we cannot be insured or which we believe are not economically reasonable to insure, such as losses due to acts of war, employee and certain other crime and some natural disasters. If we incur these losses and they are material, our business could suffer. Certain material events may result in sizable losses for the insurance industry and adversely impact the availability of adequate insurance coverage or result in excessive premium increases. To offset negative insurance market trends, we may elect to self-insure, accept higher deductibles or reduce the amount of coverage in response to these market changes. In addition, we self-insure a significant portion of expected losses under our workers’ compensation, automobile liability, general liability and group health insurance programs. Unanticipated changes in any applicable actuarial assumptions and management estimates underlying our recorded liabilities for these losses, including expected increases in medical and indemnity costs, could result in materially different amounts of expense than expected under these programs, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Although we continue to maintain property insurance for catastrophic events, we are effectively self-insured for losses up to the amount of our deductibles. If we experience a greater number of these losses than we anticipate, our financial performance could be adversely affected.


The Investors control us and may have conflicts of interest with us now or in the future.  


The Investors indirectly own, through their investment in Parent, a substantial portion of our common stock.  As a result, the Investors have control over our decisions to enter into any corporate transaction and the ability to prevent any transaction that requires shareholder approval regardless of whether others believe that the transaction is in our best interests.  For example, the Investors could cause us to make acquisitions that increase the amount of indebtedness that is secured or that is senior to our outstanding notes or to sell assets, which may impair our ability to make payments under our outstanding notes.


The Investors are also in the business of making investments in companies and may from time to time acquire and hold interests in businesses that compete directly or indirectly with us. The Investors may also pursue acquisition opportunities that are complementary to our business and, as a result, those acquisition opportunities may not be available to us.  So long as the Investors, or other funds controlled by or associated with the Investors, continue to indirectly own a significant amount of our outstanding common stock, even if such amount is less than 50%, the Investors will continue to be able to strongly influence or effectively control our decisions.




18



ITEM 2.

PROPERTIES

 

As of February 27, 2009, we operated 8,414 retail stores located in 35 states as follows:


State

Number of Stores

 

State

Number of Stores

Alabama

465

 

 

Nebraska

80

 

Arizona

52

 

 

New Jersey

22

 

Arkansas

227

 

 

New Mexico

42

 

Colorado

21

 

 

New York

232

 

Delaware

23

 

 

North Carolina

487

 

Florida

424

 

 

Ohio

473

 

Georgia

476

 

 

Oklahoma

276

 

Illinois

307

 

 

Pennsylvania

399

 

Indiana

318

 

 

South Carolina

333

 

Iowa

171

 

 

South Dakota

12

 

Kansas

145

 

 

Tennessee

419

 

Kentucky

309

 

 

Texas

983

 

Louisiana

332

 

 

Utah

9

 

Maryland

57

 

 

Vermont

4

 

Michigan

237

 

 

Virginia

248

 

Minnesota

16

 

 

West Virginia

153

 

Mississippi

266

 

 

Wisconsin

85

 

Missouri

311

 

 

 

 

 

Most of our stores are located in leased premises.  Individual store leases vary as to their terms, rental provisions and expiration dates.  The majority of our leases are relatively low-cost, short-term leases (usually with current terms of three to five years) often with multiple renewal options. We also have stores subject to build-to-suit arrangements with landlords, which typically carry a primary lease term of 10 years with multiple renewal options. In recent years, an increasing percentage of our new stores have been subject to build-to-suit arrangements. In 2008, approximately 85% of our new stores were build-to-suit arrangements.


As of February 27, 2009, we operated nine distribution centers, as described in the following table:


Location

Year
Opened

Approximate Square
Footage

 

Approximate Number of Stores Served

Scottsville, KY

1959

720,000

 

 

930

 

Ardmore, OK

1994

1,310,000

 

 

1,236

 

South Boston, VA

1997

1,250,000

 

 

806

 

Indianola, MS

1998

820,000

 

 

833

 

Fulton, MO

1999

1,150,000

 

 

1,099

 

Alachua, FL

2000

980,000

 

 

777

 

Zanesville, OH

2001

1,170,000

 

 

1,145

 

Jonesville, SC

2005

1,120,000

 

 

759

 

Marion, IN

2006

1,110,000

 

 

829

 


We lease the distribution centers located in Oklahoma, Mississippi and Missouri and own the other six distribution centers. Approximately 7.25 acres of the land on which our Kentucky distribution center is located is subject to a ground lease. We lease additional temporary warehouse space as necessary to support our distribution needs.



19



Our executive offices are located in approximately 302,000 square feet of leased space in Goodlettsville, Tennessee.


ITEM 3.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS


The information contained in Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements under the heading “Legal proceedings” contained in Part II, Item 8 of this report is incorporated herein by this reference.


ITEM 4.

SUBMISSION OF MATTERS TO A VOTE OF SECURITY HOLDERS


No matters were submitted to a vote of shareholders during the fourth quarter of 2008.


PART II


ITEM 5.

MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES


Our outstanding common stock is privately held, and there is no established public trading market for our common stock. There were approximately 188 shareholders of record of our common stock as of March 17, 2009.


Our Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend in the amount of $0.05 per share payable on or before April 19, 2007 to common shareholders of record on April 5, 2007. Our Board of Directors did not declare a dividend thereafter.  See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” for a description of the restrictions on our ability to pay dividends.



20



ITEM 6.

SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA


The following table sets forth selected consolidated financial information of Dollar General Corporation as of the dates and for the periods indicated.  The selected historical statement of operations data and statement of cash flows data for the fiscal years or periods, as applicable, ended January 30, 2009, February 1, 2008, July 6, 2007 and February 2, 2007, and balance sheet data as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 have been derived from our historical audited consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report. The selected historical statement of operations data and statement of cash flows data for the fiscal years ended February 3, 2006 and January 28, 2005 and balance sheet data as of February 2, 2007, February 3, 2006 and January 28, 2005 presented in this table have been derived from audited consolidated financial statements not included in this report.


On July 6, 2007, we completed a merger (the “Merger”) and, as a result, we are a subsidiary of a Delaware limited partnership controlled by investment funds affiliated with Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., L.P. As a result of the Merger of the Company and Buck Acquisition Corp. (“Buck”), the related purchase accounting adjustments, and a new basis of accounting beginning on July 7, 2007, the 2007 financial reporting periods presented below include the Predecessor period of the Company reflecting 22 weeks of operating results from February 3, 2007 to July 6, 2007 and 30 weeks of operating results for the Successor period, reflecting the Merger from July 7, 2007 to February 1, 2008.  Buck’s results of operations for the period from March 6, 2007 to July 6, 2007 (prior to the Merger on July 6, 2007) are also included in the consolidated financial statements for the 2007 Successor period described above, as a result of certain derivative financial instruments entered into by Buck prior to the Merger. Other than these financial instruments, Buck had no assets, liabilities, or operations prior to the Merger. The fiscal years presented from 2004 to 2006 reflect the Predecessor.


Due to the significance of the Merger and related transactions that occurred in 2007, the 2008 and 2007 Successor financial information is not comparable to that of the Predecessor periods presented in the accompanying table.


The information set forth below should be read in conjunction with, and is qualified by reference to, the Consolidated Financial Statements and related notes included in Part II, Item 8 of this report and the Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations included in Part II, Item 7 of this report.



21






 

Successor

Predecessor

Year Ended

 

 

 

Year Ended

(Amounts in millions, excluding number of stores, selling square feet, and net sales per square foot)

 

January 30,
2009

 

  March 6,   2007
through
February 1,
2008(1)(2)

 

February 3,
2007
through
   July 6,   
2007(2)

 

February 2,
2007(2)

 

February 3,
2006(3)

 

January 28,
2005

Statement of Operations Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

10,457.7 

$

5,571.5 

$

3,923.8 

$

9,169.8 

$

8,582.2 

$

7,660.9 

Cost of goods sold

 

7,396.6 

 

3,999.6 

 

2,852.2 

 

6,801.6 

 

6,117.4 

 

5,397.7 

Gross profit

 

3,061.1 

 

1,571.9 

 

1,071.6 

 

2,368.2 

 

2,464.8 

 

2,263.2 

Selling, general and
administrative

 

2,448.6 

 

1,324.5 

 

960.9 

 

2,119.9 

 

1,903.0 

 

1,706.2 

Litigation settlement and related costs, net

 

32.0 

 

 

 

 

 

Transaction and related costs

 

 

1.2 

 

101.4 

 

 

 

Operating profit

 

580.5 

 

246.1 

 

9.2 

 

248.3 

 

561.9 

 

557.0 

Interest income

 

(3.1)

 

(3.8)

 

(5.0)

 

(7.0)

 

(9.0)

 

(6.6)

Interest expense

 

391.9 

 

252.9 

 

10.3 

 

34.9 

 

26.2 

 

28.8 

Other (income) expense

 

(2.8)

 

3.6 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

194.4 

 

(6.6)

 

4.0 

 

220.4 

 

544.6 

 

534.8 

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

86.2 

 

(1.8)

 

12.0 

 

82.4 

 

194.5 

 

190.6 

Net income (loss)

$

108.2 

$

(4.8)

$

(8.0)

$

137.9 

$

350.2 

$

344.2 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Statement of Cash Flows Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating activities

$

575.2 

$

239.6 

$

201.9 

$

405.4 

$

555.5 

$

391.5 

Investing activities

 

(152.6)

 

(6,848.4)

 

(66.9)

 

(282.0)

 

(264.4)

 

(259.2)

Financing activities

 

(144.8)

 

6,709.0 

 

25.3 

 

(134.7)

 

(323.3)

 

(245.4)

Total capital expenditures

 

(205.5)

 

(83.6)

 

(56.2)

 

(261.5)

 

(284.1)

 

(288.3)

Other Financial and Operating Data:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Same store sales growth (4)

 

9.0%

 

1.9%

 

2.6%

 

3.3%

 

2.2%

 

3.2%

Same store sales (4)

$

10,118.5 

$

5,264.2 

$

3,656.6 

$

8,327.2 

$

7,555.8 

$

6,589.0 

Number of stores included in same store sales calculation

 

8,153 

 

7,735 

 

7,655 

 

7,627 

 

7,186 

 

5,932 

Number of stores (at period end)

 

8,362 

 

8,194 

 

8,205 

 

8,229 

 

7,929 

 

7,320 

Selling square feet (in thousands at period end)

 

58,803 

 

57,376 

 

57,379 

 

57,299 

 

54,753 

 

50,015 

Net sales per square foot (5)

$

179.7 

$

165.4 

$

163.9 

$

162.6 

$

159.8 

$

159.6 

Highly consumable sales

 

69.3%

 

66.4%

 

66.7%

 

65.7%

 

65.3%

 

63.0%

Seasonal sales

 

14.6%

 

16.3%

 

15.4%

 

16.4%

 

15.7%

 

16.5%

Home product sales

 

8.2%

 

9.1%

 

9.2%

 

10.0%

 

10.6%

 

11.5%

Basic clothing sales

 

7.9%

 

8.2%

 

8.7%

 

7.9%

 

8.4%

 

9.0%

Rent expense

$

389.6 

$

214.5 

$

150.2 

$

343.9 

$

312.3 

$

268.8 

Balance Sheet Data (at period end):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents and short-term investments

$

378.0 

$

119.8 

 

 

$

219.2 

$

209.5 

$

275.8 

Total assets

 

8,889.2 

 

8,656.4 

 

 

 

3,040.5 

 

2,980.3 

 

2,841.0 

Total debt

 

4,137.1 

 

4,282.0 

 

 

 

270.0 

 

278.7 

 

271.3 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

2,831.7 

 

2,703.9 

 

 

 

1,745.7 

 

1,720.8 

 

1,684.5 


(1)

Includes the results of Buck for the period prior to the Merger with and into Dollar General Corporation from March 6, 2007 (its formation) through July 6, 2007 and the post-Merger results of Dollar General Corporation for the period from July 7, 2007 through February 1, 2008.

(2)

Includes the effects of certain strategic merchandising and real estate initiatives that resulted in the closing of approximately 460 stores and changes in the Company’s inventory management model which resulted in greater inventory markdowns than in previous years.

(3)

The fiscal year ended February 3, 2006 was comprised of 53 weeks.

(4)

For fiscal periods ending after January 28, 2005, same-store sales have been calculated based upon stores that were open at least 13 full fiscal months and remained open at the end of the reporting period. For fiscal periods ending on or before January 28, 2005, same-store sales include stores that were open both at the end of the reporting period and at the beginning of the preceding fiscal year. The Company excludes the sales in the 53rd week of a 53-week year from the same-store sales calculation.

(5)

Net sales per square foot was calculated based on total sales for the preceding 12 months as of the ending date of the reporting period divided by the average selling square footage during the period, including the end of the fiscal year, the beginning of the fiscal year, and the end of each of the Company’s three interim fiscal quarters. For the period from February 3, 2007 through July 6, 2007, average selling square footage was calculated using the average of square footage as of July 6, 2007 and as of the end of each of the four preceding quarters.  For the fiscal year ended February 3, 2006, net sales per square foot was calculated based on 52 weeks’ sales.     



22



ITEM 7.

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS


General


Accounting Periods .  The following text contains references to years 2009, 2008, 2007, and 2006, which represent fiscal years ending or ended January 29, 2010, January 30, 2009, February 1, 2008, and February 2, 2007, respectively. Our fiscal year ends on the Friday closest to January 31. Fiscal years 2008 and 2006 were 52-week accounting periods  As discussed below, we completed a merger transaction on July 6, 2007, and therefore the 2007 presentation includes the 22-week Predecessor period of Dollar General Corporation through July 6, 2007, reflecting the historical basis of accounting prior to the Merger, and a 30-week Successor period, reflecting the impact of the business combination and associated purchase price allocation of the merger of Dollar General Corporation and Buck Acquisition Corp. (“Buck”), from July 7, 2007 to February 1, 2008.  Buck was formed on March 6, 2007, and its results of operations prior to the Merger, related solely to interest rate swaps entered into in anticipation of the Merger, are included in the 2007 Successor results of operations. Transactions relating to or resulting from the Merger are discussed separately. This discussion and analysis should be read with, and is qualified in its entirety by, the Consolidated Financial Statements and the notes thereto. It also should be read in conjunction with the Forward-Looking Statements/Risk Factors disclosures set forth in the Introduction and in Item 1A of this report.

Purpose of Discussion . We intend for this discussion to provide the reader with information that will assist in understanding our company and the critical economic factors that affect our company. In addition, it should help the reader understand our financial statements, the changes in certain key items in those financial statements from year to year, the primary factors that accounted for those changes, as well as how certain accounting principles affect our financial statements.


Our 2007 Merger


On July 6, 2007, we completed a merger (the “Merger”) and, as a result, we are a subsidiary of Buck Holdings, L.P. (“Parent”), a Delaware limited partnership controlled by investment funds affiliated with Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., L.P. (“KKR” or “Sponsor”). KKR, GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P. and affiliated funds (affiliates of Goldman, Sachs & Co.), Citi Private Equity, Wellington Management Company, LLP, CPP Investment Board (USRE II) Inc., and other equity co-investors (collectively, the “Investors”) indirectly own a substantial portion of our capital stock through their investment in Parent.

The Merger consideration was funded through the use of our available cash, cash equity contributions from the Investors, equity contributions of certain members of our management and the debt financings discussed below. Our outstanding common stock is now owned by Parent and certain members of management. Our common stock is no longer registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) and is no longer traded on a national securities exchange.




23



We entered into the following debt financings in conjunction with the Merger:

·

A credit agreement and related security and other agreements consisting of a $2.3 billion senior secured term loan facility, which matures on July 6, 2014 (the “Term Loan Facility”).


·

A credit agreement and related security and other agreements consisting of a senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility of up to $1.125 billion subject to borrowing base availability, which matures July 6, 2013 (the “ABL Facility” and, with the Term Loan Facility, the “Credit Facilities”).


·

$1.175 billion aggregate principal amount of 10.625% senior notes due 2015, which mature on July 15, 2015, and $725 million aggregate principal amount of 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated toggle notes due 2017, which mature on July 15, 2017. We have repurchased $69.1 million of the senior subordinated toggle notes since the Merger.


Executive Overview


We are the largest discount retailer in the United States by number of stores, with approximately 8,400 stores located in 35 states, primarily in the southern, southwestern, midwestern and eastern United States. We serve a broad customer base and offer a focused assortment of everyday items, including basic consumable merchandise and other home, apparel and seasonal products. A majority of our products are priced at $10 or less, and approximately 25% of our products are priced at $1 or less. We seek to offer a compelling value proposition for our customers based on convenient store locations, easy in and out shopping and quality merchandise in a friendly shopping environment at highly competitive prices. We believe our combination of value and convenience distinguishes us from other discount, convenience and drugstore retailers, who typically focus on either value or convenience.


The nature of our business is seasonal to a certain extent. Primarily because of sales of holiday-related merchandise, sales in our fourth quarter (November, December and January) have historically been higher than sales achieved in each of the first three quarters of the fiscal year. Expenses and, to a greater extent, operating income vary by quarter. Results of a period shorter than a full year may not be indicative of results expected for the entire year. Furthermore, the seasonal nature of our business may affect comparisons between periods. It is important for you to read our more detailed discussion of financial and operating results below under “Results of Operations.” Basis points or “bps” amounts referred to below are equal to 0.01 percent as a percentage of sales.


The customers we serve are value-conscious, and Dollar General has always been intently focused on helping our customers make the most of their spending dollars. In 2008, consumers faced severe economic challenges, including high gasoline and fuel costs, rising food costs, increased unemployment, and the downturn in the housing and credit markets.  We believe that we benefited to some extent from the impact of consumers searching for good values on their basic purchases.



24



At the beginning of 2008, we defined four operating priorities as follows: 1) drive productive sales growth, 2) increase our gross margins, 3) leverage process improvements and information technology to reduce costs, and 4) strengthen and expand Dollar General's culture of serving others. These continue to be our principal operating priorities in 2009.  Coupled with the changes we made to our operations during the year in connection with these priorities, which are discussed in more detail below, we achieved the following financial highlights in fiscal 2008:


·

Total sales in fiscal 2008 were $10.5 billion, a 10.1% increase from 2007. Sales in same-stores increased 9.0% and were driven by increases in customer traffic and average transaction amount. Average sales per square foot for all stores in 2008 were approximately $180, up from $165 in 2007. Sales increases of highly consumable products outpaced our more discretionary categories, likely the result of both our merchandising initiatives, which were more focused on consumables, and the negative effect of the economy on consumer discretionary spending.


·

Gross profit, as a percentage of sales, was 29.3% in 2008. During the year, we made progress in reducing our inventory shrinkage and improving the efficiencies of our distribution and transportation processes as well as leveraging fixed distribution costs. Improvements in our pricing systems and processes also permitted us to make more timely price changes to compensate for unavoidable cost increases, and for the year, markdowns declined.

 

·

SG&A, as a percentage of sales, for fiscal 2008 was 23.4%. This compares to 23.8% in the 2007 Successor period and 24.5% in the 2007 Predecessor period. Our increased sales levels favorably impacted SG&A, as a percentage of sales, in addition to a reduction in workers’ compensation expense, resulting from safety initiatives implemented over the last several years, and reduced advertising expense. The 2007 Predecessor period included SG&A of $45.0 million, or 115 basis points, related to closing underperforming stores.


·

We recorded litigation expense of $32 million to reflect the settlement and related expenses, net of insurance proceeds, of a class action lawsuit filed as a result of the Merger in 2007. We determined that the settlement was in our best interests to avoid costly and time consuming litigation.

 

·

Interest expense of $391.9 million in 2008 relates primarily to interest on debt incurred to finance the Merger. We repaid all borrowings under our revolving credit facility in the first quarter of 2008 and incurred no additional borrowings during the year. In January 2009, we further reduced our total long-term obligations by repurchasing $44.1 million of senior subordinated notes.


·

For fiscal 2008, we reported net income of $108.2 million. This compares to a net loss of $4.8 million in the 2007 Successor period and a net loss of $8.0 million in the 2007 Predecessor period, each of which included significant costs related to the Merger and other strategic initiatives as more fully described in the discussion below of 2008 vs 2007.



25



·

We generated $575.2 million of cash from operating activities, a portion of which we used to invest in our stores and to reduce long-term obligations. At year end, our cash balance of $378 million included $310 million invested in money market funds. Because of uncertainties in the current financial markets, we believe maintaining excess liquidity is prudent.


·

During 2008, we opened 207 new stores, remodeled or relocated 404 stores, and closed 39 stores, resulting in a store count of 8,362 on January 30, 2009. In addition, we are pleased with the progress we made during the year in our efforts to better utilize existing square footage and to improve the appearance of our stores.

 

Discussion of Operating Priorities.  Our first priority is driving productive sales growth by increasing shopper frequency and transaction amount and maximizing sales per square foot. We utilized numerous initiatives in 2008 to enable productive sales growth. For example, we are defining and improving our store standards with a goal of developing a consistent look and feel across all stores. We expanded convenience foods and beverages, added new impulse racks at the checkout stands, and expanded our store operating hours. To further increase space utilization, we have begun the process of raising the height of merchandise fixtures in our stores, starting with the food area.


Our second priority is to increase gross profit through shrink reduction, distribution efficiencies, an improved pricing model, the expansion of private brand offerings and increased foreign sourcing. In 2008, inventory shrink decreased as a result of several focused initiatives, including the elimination of packaway inventories from the stockrooms, the installation of additional security cameras, the implementation of exception-based shrink detection tools, and improved hiring practices and employee retention. In 2008, higher sales volumes contributed to our ability to leverage transportation and distribution costs, and we were able to offset the impact of higher average fuel costs for the year through better trailer utilization, expansion of backhaul opportunities and improved fleet management. We reviewed and reset our consumables planograms, eliminating less productive items in order to add more productive ones. In this process, we reviewed our pricing strategy and worked diligently to minimize vendor cost increases. Some merchandise cost increases were unavoidable in 2008, but as a result of our improved pricing analysis tools, we were able to recoup a portion of these increases through pricing. We continue to focus on sales of private brand consumables, which generally have higher gross profit rates, while continuing to offer a wide variety of national brands in our efforts to offer the optimal mix of products to our customers. With regard to the expansion of foreign sourcing, we are still in the early stages of defining the objectives and building the team.


Our third priority is leveraging process improvements and information technology to reduce costs.  We are committed as an organization to extract costs that do not affect the customer experience.  Examples of cost reduction initiatives in 2008 include recycling of cardboard, reduction of workers compensation expense through a focus on safety, and improvement of energy management in the stores through installation and monitoring of new equipment. With regard to information technology, we are focusing our resources on improving systems that are designed to enhance retail store operations and merchandising.




26



Our fourth priority is to strengthen and expand Dollar General's culture of serving others. For customers this means helping them Save Time. Save Money. Every Day.  For employees, this means creating an environment that attracts and retains key employees throughout the organization. For communities, this means giving back to our store communities.


In 2009, we plan to continue to focus on these same four operating priorities. We will continue to refine and improve our store standards, focusing on achieving a consistent look and feel across the chain, and plan to measure customer satisfaction in 2009. We expect to complete the process of raising the height of our merchandise fixtures, allowing us to better utilize our store square footage. We will continue to focus on reducing inventory shrink by implementing additional analytical tools and expanding the utilization of surveillance equipment. We have identified additional opportunities to reduce labor and other costs in our distribution centers. In addition, we plan to continue to expand our private brand consumables offerings and to increase and upgrade our private brand merchandise in the home and seasonal categories. We intend to make strides in expanding our foreign sourcing efforts and expect to begin seeing a greater impact from this initiative in late 2009.


With regard to leveraging information technology and process improvements to reduce costs, we will continue to focus on making improvements that benefit our merchandising and operations efforts, including projects such as pricing and profitability analysis, merchandise selection and allocation and labor scheduling. By the end of 2009, we expect each of our store managers to have access to a back office computer which will improve reporting and communications with the stores and, consequently, should assist us in improving store productivity.


Finally, in 2009, we plan to open 450 new stores within the 35 states in which we currently operate, and to remodel or relocate an additional 400 stores. With regard to planned new store openings, our criteria are based on numerous factors including, among other things, availability of appropriate sites, expected sales, lease terms, population demographics, competition, and the employment environment. We use various real estate site selection tools to determine target markets and optimum site locations within those markets. With regard to new store expansion in fiscal 2009, our plans include expansion only within our existing markets. With respect to store relocations, we begin to evaluate a store for relocation opportunities approximately 18 months prior to the store’s lease expiration using the same basic tools and criteria as those used for new stores. Remodels, which require a much smaller investment, are determined based on the need, the opportunity for sales improvement at the location and an expectation of a desirable return on investment.  The majority of 2009’s new store sites have been identified and terms agreed to. However, due to uncertainties in the economy and its potential impact on commercial real estate sites and developers, there is a heightened level of risk that these stores may not open as scheduled.

 

We expect to continue to face difficult economic issues in 2009 which will restrict our customers’ ability to spend and, therefore, will challenge our efforts to increase sales and gross profit. We also believe that competitive pricing, promotions, and advertising will continue and are likely to increase if overall retail sales continue to decline. We remain committed to our



27



operating model and to making improvements in our stores and our merchandise to better serve the needs of our customers.   

Key Financial Metrics . We have identified the following as our most critical financial metrics for 2008 and 2009:


·

Same-store sales growth / sales per square foot;


·

Gross profit, as a percentage of sales;


·

Inventory turnover;


·

Cash flow; and


·

Earnings before interest, taxes and depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”).


Readers should refer to the detailed discussion of our operating results below for additional comments on financial performance in the current year periods as compared with the prior year periods.




28



Results of Operations


The following table contains results of operations data for fiscal year 2008, the Successor and Predecessor periods in 2007, and fiscal year 2006.


(amounts in millions)

Successor

Predecessor

2008

2007(a)

2007(b)

2006(c)

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales by category:

 

 

 

 

Highly consumable

$ 7,248.4

$ 3,701.7

$ 2,615.1

$ 6,022.0

% of net sales

69.31%

66.44%

66.65%

65.67%

Seasonal

1,521.5

908.3

604.9

1,510.0

% of net sales

14.55%

16.30%

15.42%

16.47%

Home products

862.2

507.0

362.7

914.4

% of net sales

8.24%

9.10%

9.24%

9.97%

Basic clothing

825.6

454.4

341.0

723.5

% of net sales

7.89%

8.16%

8.69%

7.89%

Net sales

$ 10,457.7

$ 5,571.5

$ 3,923.8

$ 9,169.8

Cost of goods sold

7,396.6

3,999.6

2,852.2

6,801.6

% of net sales

70.73%

71.79%

72.69%

74.17%

Gross profit

3,061.1

1,571.9

1,071.6

2,368.2

% of net sales

29.27%

28.21%

27.31%

25.83%

Selling, general and administrative expenses

2,448.6

1,324.5

960.9

2,119.9

% of net sales

23.41%

23.77%

24.49%

23.12%

Litigation settlement and related costs, net

32.0

-

-

-

% of net sales

0.31%

-

-

-

Transaction and related costs

-

1.2

101.4

-

% of net sales

-

0.02%

2.58%

-

Operating profit

580.5

246.1

9.2

248.3

% of net sales

5.55%

4.42%

0.24%

2.71%

Interest income

(3.1)

(3.8)

(5.0)

(7.0)

% of net sales

(0.03)%

(0.07)%

(0.13)%

(0.08)%

Interest expense

391.9

252.9

10.3

34.9

% of net sales

3.75%

4.54%

0.26%

0.38%

Other (income) expense

(2.8)

3.6

-

-

% of net sales

(0.03)%

0.07%

-

-

Income (loss) before income taxes

194.4

(6.6)

4.0

220.4

% of net sales

1.86%

(0.12)%

0.10%

2.40%

Income taxes

86.2

(1.8)

12.0

82.4

% of net sales

0.82%

(0.03)%

0.31%

0.90%

Net income (loss)

$ 108.2

$ (4.8)

$ (8.0)

$ 137.9

% of net sales

1.03%

(0.09)%

(0.20)%

1.50%


(a)

Includes the results of operations of Buck Acquisition Corp. for the period prior to its Merger with and into Dollar General Corporation from March 6, 2007 (its formation) through July 6, 2007 (reflecting the change in fair value of interest rate swaps), and the post-Merger results of Dollar General Corporation for the period from July 7, 2007 through February 1, 2008.

(b)

Includes the pre-Merger results of Dollar General Corporation for the period from February 3, 2007 through July 6, 2007.

(c)

Includes the impacts of certain strategic real estate and inventory management initiatives as described under the heading “Strategic Initiatives—Project Alpha” in Item 1 above.



29



The following discussion of our financial performance also includes supplemental unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial information for fiscal years 2007 and 2006. Because the Merger occurred during our 2007 second quarter, we believe this information aids in the comparison between the years presented. The pro forma information does not purport to represent what our results of operations would have been had the Merger and related transactions actually occurred at the beginning of the years indicated, and they do not purport to project our results of operations or financial condition for any future period. The following table contains results of operations data for 2008 compared to pro forma results of operations for fiscal years 2007 and 2006, and the dollar and percentage variances among those years. See “Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Information” below.


(amounts in millions)

   2008

Pro Forma

2008 vs.
2007 Pro Forma

2007 Pro Forma vs.
2006 Pro Forma

2007

2006

$

change

%

 change

$

change

 %

 change

 

 

 

 

 


 


Net sales by category:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Highly consumable

$ 7,248.4

$ 6,316.8

$ 6,022.0

$ 931.6

14.7%

$ 294.8

4.9%

% of net sales

69.31%

66.53%

65.67%

 

 

 

 

Seasonal

1,521.5

1,513.2

1,510.0

8.2

0.5

3.2

0.2

% of net sales

14.55%

15.94%

16.47%

 

 

 

 

Home products

862.2

869.8

914.4

(7.5)

(0.9)

(44.6)

(4.9)

% of net sales

8.24%

9.16%

9.97%

 

 

 

 

Basic clothing

825.6

795.4

723.5

30.2

3.8

72.0

9.9

% of net sales

7.89%

8.38%

7.89%

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$ 10,457.7

$ 9,495.2

$ 9,169.8

$ 962.4

10.1%

$ 325.4

3.5%

Cost of goods sold

7,396.6

6,852.5

6,803.1

544.1

7.9

49.3

0.7

% of net sales

70.73%

72.17%

74.19%

 

 

 

 

Gross profit

3,061.1

2,642.8

2,366.7

418.3

15.8

276.1

11.7

% of net sales

29.27%

27.83%

25.81%

 

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses

2,448.6

2,310.9

2,180.9

137.7

6.0

130.0

6.0

% of net sales

23.41%

24.34%

23.78%

 

 

 

 

Litigation settlement and related costs, net

32.0

-

-

32.0

-

-

-

% of net sales

0.31%

-

-

 

 

-

-

Transaction and related costs

-

1.2

-

(1.2)

-

1.2

-

% of net sales

-

0.01%

-

 

 

 

 

Operating profit

580.5

330.6

185.7

249.9

75.6

144.9

78.0

% of net sales

5.55%

3.48%

2.03%

 

 

 

 

Interest income

(3.1)

(8.8)

(7.0)

5.8

(65.4)

(1.8)

26.3

% of net sales

(0.03)%

(0.09)%

(0.08)%

 

 

 

 

Interest expense

391.9

436.7

436.9

(44.8)

(10.3)

(0.2)

(0.0)

% of net sales

3.75%

4.60%

4.76%

 

 

 

 

Other (income) expense

(2.8)

3.6

-

(6.4)

-

3.6

-

% of net sales

(0.03)%

0.04%

-

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

194.4

(100.9)

(244.2)

295.3

-

143.3

(58.7)

% of net sales

1.86%

(1.06)%

(2.66)%

 

 

 

 

Income taxes

86.2

(42.9)

(88.0)

129.1

-

45.1

(51.2)

% of net sales

0.82%

(0.45)%

(0.96)%

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$ 108.2

$ (57.9)

$ (156.2)

$ 166.1

-%

$ 98.2

(62.9)%

% of net sales

1.03%

(0.61)%

(1.70)%

 

 

 

 




30



Net Sales . The net sales increase in fiscal 2008 reflects a same-store sales increase of 9% compared to 2007. Same-stores include stores that have been open for 13 months and remain open at the end of the reporting period. For the 2008 fiscal year, there were 8,153 same-stores which accounted for sales of $10.12 billion. There were no purchase accounting or other adjustments to net sales as a result of the Merger, therefore, the 2007 net sales and other amounts presented related to 2007 net sales are calculated using the 2007 52-week fiscal year.   The remainder of the increase in sales in fiscal 2008 was attributable to new stores, partially offset by sales from closed stores. The increase in highly consumable sales reflects the various initiatives implemented in 2008, including the impact of improved store standards, the expansion of convenience food and beverage offerings, improved utilization of square footage and extended store hours. The majority of our merchandising efforts in 2008 related to the highly consumable category, including planogram resets and increased emphasis on private brand products as further discussed above in the Executive Overview. Both the number of customer transactions and average transaction amount increased for the year. and we believe that our stores benefited to some degree from attracting new customers who are seeking value as a result of the current economic environment.

 

The net sales increase in 2007 primarily reflects a same-store sales increase of 1.9% for the 2007 Successor period and 2.6% for the Predecessor period compared to the same periods in 2006.  For the 2007 Successor period, there were 7,735 same-stores (generating $5.26 billion of net sales) and for the 2007 Predecessor period, there were 7,655 same-stores (generating $3.66 billion of net sales).  Sales resulting from new store growth, including 170 new stores in the 2007 Successor period and 195 stores in the 2007 Predecessor period, were partially offset by the impact of store closings in the 2007 Predecessor and Successor periods and in 2006. Sales of highly consumables were 66.4% of total sales in the 2007 Successor period and 66.6% of total sales in the 2007 Predecessor period, compared to 65.7% of total sales in 2006, resulting from successful changes during the 2007 periods to our consumables merchandising mix. Sales of seasonal merchandise increased slightly in dollars but declined as a percentage of total sales in the 2007 periods compared to 2006. Apparel sales increased as a percentage of total sales in the 2007 periods compared to 2006, while home products sales decreased as a percentage of sales. To some extent, sales in these more discretionary categories were impacted by our efforts to eliminate our inventory packaway strategy by the end of 2007 and to reduce overall inventory levels. In addition, we believe sales of seasonal merchandise, apparel and home products were negatively affected by continued economic pressures on our customers, particularly in the fourth quarter of 2007. The increase in same-store sales represents an increase in average customer purchase, offset by a slight decrease in customer traffic.


As discussed above, we monitor our sales internally by the following four major categories: highly consumable, seasonal, home products and basic clothing. The highly consumable category has a lower gross profit rate than the other three categories and has grown significantly over the past several years. Because of the impact of sales mix on gross profit, we continually review our merchandise mix and strive to adjust it when appropriate. Maintaining an appropriate sales mix is an integral part of achieving our gross profit and sales goals.


Gross Profit . The gross profit rate as a percentage of sales was 29.3% in 2008 compared to 28.2% in the 2007 Successor period, 27.3% in the 2007 Predecessor period, and 27.8% for pro



31



forma 2007. Factors contributing to the increase in the 2008 gross profit rate include a lower inventory shrink rate; lower promotional markdowns; improved leverage on distribution and transportation costs; and improved markups related to changes resulting from the outcome of pricing analysis, our ability to react more quickly to product cost changes and diligent vendor negotiations. In January 2009, we marked down merchandise as the result of a recent change in the interpretation of the phthalates provision of the Consumer Product Safety Improvement Act of 2008 resulting in a charge of $8.6 million. Also in 2008, we faced increased commodity cost pressures mainly related to food and pet products which have been driven by rising fruit and vegetable prices and freight costs.  Increases in petroleum, resin, metals, pulp and other raw material commodity driven costs also resulted in multiple product cost increases.  Related to these commodity cost increases, we recorded a LIFO provision of $43.9 million in 2008, compared to the LIFO provision recorded in the 2007 Successor period of $6.1 million. We intend to address these commodity cost increases through negotiations with our vendors and by increasing retail prices as necessary. On a quarterly basis, we estimate the annual impact of commodity cost fluctuations based upon the best available information at that point in time.


The gross profit rate as a percentage of sales was 27.3% in the 2007 Predecessor period, 28.2% in the 2007 Successor period, and 27.8% in pro forma 2007 compared to 25.8% in 2006. Factors affecting the increase in the gross profit rate include: lower markdowns, including markdowns from retail and below cost markdowns (markdowns in 2006 included significant markdowns and below cost adjustments relating to the move away from our packaway inventory strategy); and improved leverage on distribution and transportation costs driven by logistics efficiencies. The gross profit rate in the 2007 Successor period was greater than in the Predecessor period, in part due to the seasonality of our sales which result in greater sales of higher margin discretionary purchases in the fourth quarter. Offsetting the factors listed above was an increase in our shrink rate in the 2007 periods as compared to 2006 and a shift in the mix of sales to more highly consumable products which have relatively lower gross profit rates.


Selling, General and Administrative (“SG&A”) Expense .  SG&A expense as a percentage of sales decreased to 23.4% in 2008, compared to 23.8% and 24.5% in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively.  The more significant items resulting in the decrease in 2008 compared to the 2007 periods include: approximately $9.0 million and $45.0 million in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively (including $2.4 million and $4.1 million, respectively, also included in advertising costs discussed below) relating to the closing of stores and the elimination of our packaway inventory strategy; $40.5 million in 2008 compared to $23.4 million in the 2007 Successor period related to amortization of leasehold intangibles capitalized in connection with the revaluation of assets at the date of the Merger; a $12.0 million loss in the 2007 Successor period compared to a $5.0 million gain in 2008 relating to potential losses on distribution center leases; advertising costs of $27.8 million in 2008 compared to $23.6 million and $17.3 million in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively; and decreases in workers compensation and other insurance-related costs compared to the 2007 periods. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in incentive compensation and related payroll taxes in 2008 compared to the 2007 periods due to improved overall financial performance and an increase in professional fees in 2008 compared to the 2007 periods primarily reflecting legal expenses related to shareholder litigation.



32



SG&A decreased to 23.4% in 2008 compared to 24.3% in pro forma 2007.  The more significant items resulting in the decrease from the 2007 pro forma results include: $54.0 million of costs in pro forma 2007 SG&A relating to the closing of stores and the elimination of our packaway inventory strategy; a $12.0 million loss in the 2007 pro forma period compared to a $5.0 million gain in 2008 relating to possible losses on distribution center leases; and decreases in workers compensation and other insurance-related costs in 2008 of $10.4 million compared to the 2007 pro forma period. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in incentive compensation and related payroll taxes of $42.0 million in 2008 compared to pro forma 2007 due to improved overall financial performance and an increase in professional fees in 2008 of $10.4 million compared to pro forma 2007 primarily reflecting legal expenses related to shareholder litigation.


SG&A expense increased as a percentage of sales to 23.8% in the 2007 Successor period and 24.5% in the 2007 Predecessor period from 23.1% in 2006. SG&A in the 2007 periods includes: $23.4 million in the 2007 Successor period related to amortization of leasehold intangibles capitalized in connection with the revaluation of assets at the date of the Merger; $19.3 million and $7.6 million of administrative employee incentive compensation expense in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively, resulting from meeting certain financial targets (compared to $9.6 million of discretionary bonuses in 2006); approximately $9.0 million and $45.0 million of expenses in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively, relating to the closing of stores and the elimination of our packaway inventory strategy (compared to approximately $33 million in 2006) and an accrued loss of approximately $12.0 million in the 2007 Successor period relating to probable losses for certain distribution center leases. In addition, SG&A in the 2007 Successor period includes approximately $4.8 million of KKR-related consulting and monitoring fees. SG&A expense in 2006 was partially offset by insurance proceeds of $13.0 million received during the year related to losses incurred due to Hurricane Katrina.


On a pro forma basis, SG&A expense increased as a percentage of sales to 24.3% in 2007 compared to 23.8% in 2006. Pro forma SG&A includes: $26.9 million of administrative employee incentive compensation expense in 2007 resulting from meeting certain financial targets, compared to $9.6 million of discretionary bonuses in 2006; approximately $54 million of expenses in 2007 relating to the closing of stores and the elimination of our packaway inventory strategy, compared to approximately $33 million in 2006; and an accrued loss of approximately $12.0 million in 2007 relating to probable losses for certain distribution center leases. SG&A expense in 2006 was partially offset by insurance proceeds of $13.0 million received during the year related to losses incurred due to Hurricane Katrina.


Litigation Settlement and Related Costs, Net. The $32.0 million in 2008 represents the settlement of a class action lawsuit filed in response to the Merger, and includes a $40.0 million settlement and estimated expenses of $2.0 million, net of $10.0 million of insurance proceeds received in the fourth quarter of 2008.


Transaction and Related Costs. The $1.2 million and $101.4 million of expenses recorded in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods reflect $1.2 million and $62.0 million, respectively, of expenses related to the Merger, such as investment banking and legal fees as



33



well as $39.4 million of compensation expense in the Predecessor period related to stock options, restricted stock and restricted stock units which were fully vested immediately prior to and as a result of the Merger.


Interest Income. Interest income consists primarily of interest on investments. The decrease in interest income in 2008 compared to the 2007 periods was a result of lower interest rates, partially offset by higher investments. In the 2007 periods (primarily the 2007 Predecessor period) we had higher levels of cash and short term investments on hand as compared to 2006.


Interest Expense . The significant increase in interest expense in 2008 and the 2007 Successor period subsequent to the Merger is due to interest on long-term obligations incurred to finance the Merger. See further discussion under “Liquidity and Capital Resources” below.  We had outstanding variable-rate debt of $623 million and $787 million, after taking into consideration the impact of interest rate swaps, as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively. The remainder of our outstanding indebtedness at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 was fixed rate debt.


Interest expense in 2008 was less than 2007 pro forma interest expense due to lower borrowing amounts, specifically on the revolving credit agreement and senior subordinated notes, along with lower interest rates. Pro forma interest expense for both 2007 and 2006 was approximately $437 million.

Other (Income) Expense. In 2008, we recorded a gain of $3.8 million resulting from the repurchase of $44.1 million of our senior subordinated notes, offset by expense of $1.0 million related to hedge ineffectiveness related to certain interest rate swaps.


During the 2007 Successor period, we recorded an unrealized loss of $4.1 million related to the change in the fair value of interest swaps prior to the designation of such swaps as cash flow hedges in October 2007, offset by earnings of $1.7 million under the contractual provisions of the swap agreements. Also during the 2007 Successor period, we recorded $6.2 million of expenses related to consent fees and other costs associated with a tender offer for certain notes payable maturing in June 2010 (“2010 Notes”). Approximately 99% of the 2010 Notes were retired as a result of the tender offer. The costs related to the tender of the 2010 Notes were partially offset by a $4.9 million gain in the 2007 Successor period resulting from the repurchase of $25.0 million of our senior subordinated notes.


Income Taxes .  The effective income tax rates for 2008, the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods and 2006 were an expense of 44.4%, a benefit of 26.9% and expense of 300.2%, and 37.4%, respectively.


The 2008 income tax rate is greater than the expected U.S. statutory tax rate of 35% principally due to the non-deductibility of the settlement and related expenses associated with the Merger-related shareholder lawsuit.

The income tax rate for the Successor period ended February 1, 2008 is a benefit of 26.9%.  This benefit is less than the expected U.S. statutory rate of 35% due to the incurrence of state income taxes in several of the group’s subsidiaries that file their state income tax returns on



34



a separate entity basis and the election to include, effective February 3, 2007, income tax related interest and penalties in the amount reported as income tax expense.


The income tax rate for the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 is an expense of 300.2%.  This expense is higher than the expected U.S. statutory rate of 35% due principally to the non-deductibility of certain acquisition related expenses.


Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Financial Information

The following supplemental unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement of operations data has been developed by applying pro forma adjustments to our historical consolidated statement of operations. We were acquired on July 6, 2007 through a merger accounted for as a reverse acquisition. Although we continued as the same legal entity after the Merger, the accompanying unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial information is presented for the Predecessor and Successor relating to the periods preceding and succeeding the Merger, respectively. As a result of the Merger, we applied purchase accounting standards and a new basis of accounting effective July 7, 2007. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statements of operations for the years ended February 1, 2008 and February 2, 2007 gives effect to the Merger as if it had occurred on February 3, 2007 and February 4, 2006, respectively. Assumptions underlying the pro forma adjustments are described in the accompanying notes, which should be read in conjunction with this unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial statement.

The unaudited pro forma adjustments are based upon available information and certain assumptions that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial information is presented for supplemental informational purposes only, although we believe this information is useful in providing comparisons between years. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated financial information does not purport to represent what our results of operations would have been had the Merger and related transactions actually occurred on the date indicated, and they do not purport to project our results of operations or financial condition for any future period. The unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statements of operations should be read in conjunction with the information contained in other sections of this 2008 Form 10-K including “Selected Financial Data”, in our consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto, and other sections of this Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” appearing elsewhere in this fiscal 2008 Form 10-K. All pro forma adjustments and their underlying assumptions are described more fully in the notes to our unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statements of operations.




35






 

Fiscal Year Ended February 1, 2008

(In thousands)

 

Successor

 

 

Predecessor

 

 

Adjustments

 

 

Pro Forma

Net sales

$

5,571,493 

 

$

3,923,753 

 

$

 

$

9,495,246 

Cost of goods sold

 

3,999,599 

 

 

2,852,178 

 

 

695 

(a)

 

6,852,472 

Gross profit

 

1,571,894 

 

 

1,071,575 

 

 

(695)

 

 

2,642,774 

Selling, general and administrative

 

1,324,508 

 

 

960,930 

 

 

25,461 

(b)

 

2,310,899 

Transaction and related costs

 

1,242 

 

 

101,397 

 

 

(101,397)

(c)

 

1,242 

Operating profit

 

246,144 

 

 

9,248 

 

 

75,241 

 

 

330,633 

Interest income

 

(3,799)

 

 

(5,046)

 

 

 

 

(8,845)

Interest expense

 

252,897 

 

 

10,299 

 

 

173,502 

(d)

 

436,698 

Other (income) expense

 

3,639 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,639 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

(6,593)

 

 

3,995 

 

 

(98,261)

 

 

(100,859)

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

(1,775)

 

 

11,993 

 

 

(53,138)

(e)

 

(42,920)

Net loss

$

(4,818)

 

$

(7,998)

 

$

(45,123)

 

$

(57,939)


See notes to unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement of operations

 

 

 

 

Fiscal Year Ended February 2, 2007

(In thousands)

 

 

 

 

Predecessor

 

 

Adjustments

 

 

Pro Forma

Net sales

 

 

 

$

9,169,822 

 

$

 

$

9,169,822 

Cost of goods sold

 

 

 

 

6,801,617 

 

 

1,532 

(a)

 

6,803,149 

Gross profit

 

 

 

 

2,368,205 

 

 

(1,532)

 

 

2,366,673 

Selling, general and administrative

 

 

 

 

2,119,929 

 

 

61,016 

(b)

 

2,180,945 

Operating profit

 

 

 

 

248,276 

 

 

(62,548)

 

 

185,728 

Interest income

 

 

 

 

(7,002)

 

 

 

 

(7,002)

Interest expense

 

 

 

 

34,915 

 

 

401,987 

(d)

 

436,902 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

 

 

 

220,363 

 

 

(464,535)

 

 

(244,172)

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

 

 

 

82,420 

 

 

(170,404)

(e)

 

(87,984)

Net income (loss)

 

 

 

$

137,943 

 

$

(294,131)

 

$

(156,188)


See notes to unaudited pro forma condensed consolidated statement of operations



36



Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Consolidated Statement of Operations

(a) Represents the estimated impact on cost of goods sold of the adjustment to fair value of the property and equipment at our distribution centers.

(b) Primarily represents depreciation and amortization of the fair value adjustments related to tangible and intangible long-lived assets. Identifiable intangible assets with a determinable life have been amortized on a straight-line basis in the unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations over a period ranging from 2 to 17.5 years. The primary fair value adjustments (on which the pro forma adjustments are based) impacting SG&A expenses were to leasehold interests ($185 million), property and equipment ($101 million) and internally developed software ($12 million). This adjustment also includes management fees that are payable to affiliates of certain of the Investors subsequent to the closing of the Merger and related transactions (at an initial annual rate of $5.0 million which shall be increased by 5% for each succeeding year during the term of the agreement).

(c) Represents $101.4 million of charges that are non-recurring in nature and directly attributable to the Merger and related transactions. Such charges are comprised of $39.4 million of stock compensation expense from the acceleration of unvested stock options, restricted stock and restricted stock units as required as a result of the Merger and $62.0 million of transaction costs we incurred that were expensed as one-time charges upon the close of the Merger. Such adjustments do not include any adjustments to reflect the effects of our new stock based compensation plan.

(d) Reflects pro forma interest expense resulting from our new capital structure as follows (in millions):

 

Predecessor

 

Fiscal Year Ended
February 2, 2007

 

Period Ended
July 6, 2007

 

 

 

 

Revolving credit facility (1)

$

21.4 

 

$

8.9 

Term loan facilities (2)

 

177.8 

 

 

74.1 

Notes (3)

 

210.9 

 

 

87.9 

Letter of credit fees (4)

 

1.7 

 

 

0.7 

Bank commitment fees (5)

 

2.3 

 

 

1.0 

Other existing debt obligations (6)

 

7.2 

 

 

3.0 

Total cash interest expense

 

421.3 

 

 

175.6 

Amortization of capitalized debt issuance costs and debt discount (7)

 

9.8 

 

 

4.1 

Amortization of discounted liabilities (8)

 

8.5 

 

 

3.5 

Other (9)

 

(2.7)

 

 

0.6 

Total pro forma interest expense

 

436.9 

 

 

183.8 

Less historical interest expense

 

(34.9)

 

 

(10.3)

Net adjustment to interest expense

$

402.0 

 

$

173.5 


(1) The $1.125 billion revolving credit facility carries an interest rate of 3-month LIBOR of 5.32% plus 1.50% for tranche A loans and 3-month LIBOR of 5.32% plus 2.25% for tranche A-1 loans. Reflects assumed borrowings of $175.0 million under tranche A and $125.0 million under tranche A-1. Such levels of borrowings will fluctuate in future periods dependent upon short term cash needs. Changes in the levels of borrowings would impact interest expense.



37



(2) Reflects interest on the $2.3 billion term loan facility at a rate of LIBOR plus 2.75%. To hedge against interest rate risk, we have entered into a swap agreement with respect to a $2.0 billion notional amount for 4.93%. This swap agreement became effective as a result of the acquisition on July 31, 2007 and will amortize on a quarterly basis until maturity at July 31, 2012. The unhedged portion of the facility is reflected at an interest rate of LIBOR of 5.32% plus 2.75%.

(3) Reflects interest on the 10.625% senior notes and 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated notes. Assumes the cash interest payment option at a rate of 11.875% has been elected with respect to all of the senior subordinated notes.

(4) Represents fees on balances of trade letters of credit of $141.2 million at 0.75% and standby letters of credit of $40.7 million at 1.50%.

(5) Represents commitment fees of 0.375% on the $612.1 million unutilized balance of the revolving credit facility at July 6, 2007. Outstanding letters of credit noted in (4) above reduce the availability under the revolving credit facility.

(6) Represents historical interest expense on other existing indebtedness.

(7) Represents debt issuance costs associated with the new bank facilities amortized using the effective interest method over 6 years for the revolving facility, 7 years for the term loan facility, 8 years for the senior notes, 10 years for the senior subordinated notes and 8 years for other capitalized debt issuance costs. Also includes the amortization of debt discount of the senior notes.

(8) Represents interest expense on long-term liabilities which were discounted as a result of the Merger.

(9) Represents an adjustment to historical interest expense to reflect the effect of the adoption of current accounting standards for income taxes, offset by capitalized interest expense.

(e) Represents the tax effect of the pro forma adjustments, calculated at an effective rate of 54.1% for the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 and 36.7% for the fiscal year ended February 2, 2007. The effective tax rate, a benefit, applied to the pro forma changes for the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007, reflects the pro forma elimination of non-deductible transaction costs from income before taxes. The pro forma income tax expense for the year ended February 2, 2007 has been adjusted to reflect changes required by FIN 48 as if FIN 48 had been adopted as of the beginning of the year.

Effects of Inflation


In 2008, increased commodity cost pressures mainly related to food and pet products which have been driven by fruit and vegetable prices and rising freight costs have increased the costs of certain products. Increases in petroleum, resin, metals, pulp and other raw material commodity driven costs also resulted in multiple product cost increases. We believe that our ability to increase selling prices in response to cost increases largely mitigated the effect of these cost increases on our overall results of operations. We believe that inflation and/or deflation had a minimal impact on our overall operations during 2007 and 2006.


Liquidity and Capital Resources


Current Financial Condition / Recent Developments . During the past three years, we have generated an aggregate of approximately $1.4 billion in cash flows from operating



38



activities. During that period, we expanded the number of stores we operate by approximately 5% (433 stores), remodeled or relocated over 9% of our currently operated stores (768 stores), and incurred approximately $607 million in capital expenditures. As noted above, we made certain strategic decisions which slowed our store growth in 2007 and 2008, but we plan to accelerate store growth again in 2009.


At January 30, 2009, we had total outstanding debt (including the current portion of long-term obligations) of $4.14 billion.  We also had an additional $932.8 million available for borrowing under our senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility at that date.  Our liquidity needs are significant, primarily due to our debt service and other obligations.  Our substantial debt could adversely affect our ability to raise additional capital to fund our operations, limit our ability to react to changes in the economy or our industry, expose us to interest rate risk to the extent of our variable rate debt and prevent us from meeting our obligations under our outstanding debt securities.


Management believes our cash flow from operations and existing cash balances, combined with availability under the Credit Facilities (described below), will provide sufficient liquidity to fund our current obligations, projected working capital requirements and capital spending for a period that includes the next twelve months.


Credit Facilities


Overview. We have two senior secured credit facilities (the “Credit Facilities”) which provide financing of up to $3.425 billion. The Credit Facilities consist of a $2.3 billion senior secured term loan facility and a senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility of up to $1.125 billion (of which up to $350.0 million is available for letters of credit), subject to borrowing base availability. The asset-based revolving credit facility includes borrowing capacity available for letters of credit and for short-term borrowings referred to as swingline loans.


The agreements governing the Credit Facilities provide that we have the right at any time to request up to $325.0 million of incremental commitments under one or more incremental term loan facilities and/or asset-based revolving credit facilities. The lenders under these facilities are not under any obligation to provide any such incremental commitments and any such addition of or increase in commitments will be subject to our not exceeding certain senior secured leverage ratios and certain other customary conditions precedent.  Our ability to obtain extensions of credit under these incremental commitments also will be subject to the same conditions as extensions of credit under the Credit Facilities.


The amount available under the senior secured asset-based credit facility (including letters of credit) shall not exceed the sum of the tranche A borrowing base and the tranche A-1 borrowing base. The tranche A borrowing base equals the sum of (i) 85% of the net orderly liquidation value of all our eligible inventory and that of each guarantor thereunder and (ii) 90% of all our accounts receivable and credit/debit card receivables and that of each guarantor thereunder, in each case, subject to a reserve equal to the principal amount of the 2010 Notes that remain outstanding at any time and other customary reserves and eligibility criteria. An



39



additional 10% to 12% of the net orderly liquidation value of all of our eligible inventory and that of each guarantor thereunder is made available to us in the form of a “last out” tranche under which we may borrow up to a maximum amount of $125.0 million. Borrowings under the asset-based credit facility will be incurred first under the last out tranche, and no borrowings will be permitted under any other tranche until the last out tranche is fully utilized. Repayments of the senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility will be applied to the last out tranche only after all other tranches have been fully paid down.

Interest Rates and Fees. Borrowings under the Credit Facilities bear interest at a rate equal to an applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) LIBOR or (b) a base rate (which is usually equal to the prime rate).  The applicable margin for borrowings is (i) under the term loan facility, 2.75% for LIBOR borrowings and 1.75% for base-rate borrowings (ii) as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively, under the asset-based revolving credit facility (except in the last out tranche described above), 1.25% and 1.50% for LIBOR borrowings; 0.25% and 0.50% for base-rate borrowings and for any last out borrowings, 2.25% for LIBOR borrowings and 1.25% for base-rate borrowings.  The applicable margins for borrowings under the asset-based revolving credit facility (except in the case of last out borrowings) are subject to adjustment each quarter based on average daily excess availability under the asset-based revolving credit facility.  We are also required to pay a commitment fee to the lenders under the asset-based revolving credit facility for any unutilized commitments at a rate of 0.375% per annum.  We also must pay customary letter of credit fees. See Item 7A. “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” below for a discussion of our use of interest rate swaps to manage our interest rate risk.


Prepayments. The senior secured credit agreement for the term loan facility requires us to prepay outstanding term loans, subject to certain exceptions, with:


·

50% of our annual excess cash flow (as defined in the credit agreement) which will be reduced to 25% and 0% if we achieve and maintain a total net leverage ratio of 6.0 to 1.0 and 5.0 to 1.0, respectively;


·

100% of the net cash proceeds of all non-ordinary course asset sales or other dispositions of property in excess of $25.0 million in the aggregate and subject to our right to reinvest the proceeds; and


·

100% of the net cash proceeds of any incurrence of debt, other than proceeds from debt permitted under the senior secured credit agreement.


The mandatory prepayments discussed above will be applied to the term loan facility as directed by the senior secured credit agreement. Through January 30, 2009, no prepayments have been required under the prepayment provisions listed above.


In addition, the senior secured credit agreement for the asset-based revolving credit facility requires us to prepay the asset-based revolving credit facility, subject to certain exceptions, with:




40



·

100% of the net cash proceeds of all non-ordinary course asset sales or other dispositions of revolving facility collateral (as defined below) in excess of $1.0 million in the aggregate and subject to our right to reinvest the proceeds; and


·

to the extent such extensions of credit exceed the then current borrowing base (as defined in the senior secured credit agreement for the asset-based revolving credit facility).


We may be obligated to pay a prepayment premium on the amount repaid under the term loan facility if the term loans are voluntarily repaid in whole or in part before July 6, 2009. We may voluntarily repay outstanding loans under the asset-based revolving credit facility at any time without premium or penalty, other than customary “breakage” costs with respect to LIBOR loans.


An event of default under the senior secured credit agreements will occur upon a change of control as defined in the senior secured credit agreements governing our Credit Facilities. Upon an event of default, indebtedness under the Credit Facilities may be accelerated, in which case we will be required to repay all outstanding loans plus accrued and unpaid interest and all other amounts outstanding under the Credit Facilities.


Amortization. Beginning September 30, 2009, we are required to repay installments on the loans under the term loan credit facility in equal quarterly principal amounts in an aggregate amount per annum equal to 1% of the total funded principal amount at July 6, 2007, with the balance payable on July 6, 2014. There is no amortization under the asset-based revolving credit facility. The entire principal amounts (if any) outstanding under the asset-based revolving credit facility are due and payable in full at maturity, on July 6, 2013, on which day the commitments thereunder will terminate.


Guarantee and Security. All obligations under the Credit Facilities are unconditionally guaranteed by substantially all of our existing and future domestic subsidiaries (excluding certain immaterial subsidiaries and certain subsidiaries designated by us under our senior secured credit agreements as “unrestricted subsidiaries”), referred to, collectively, as U.S. Guarantors.


All obligations and related guarantees under the term loan credit facility are secured by:


·

a second-priority security interest in all existing and after-acquired inventory, accounts receivable, and other assets arising from such inventory and accounts receivable, of our company and each U.S. Guarantor (the “Revolving Facility Collateral”), subject to certain exceptions;


·

a first priority security interest in, and mortgages on, substantially all of our and each U.S. Guarantor’s tangible and intangible assets (other than the Revolving Facility Collateral); and


·

a first-priority pledge of 100% of the capital stock held by us, or any of our domestic subsidiaries that are directly owned by us or one of the U.S. Guarantors and 65% of



41



the voting capital stock of each of our existing and future foreign subsidiaries that are directly owned by us or one of the U.S. Guarantors.


All obligations and related guarantees under the asset-based credit facility are secured by the Revolving Facility Collateral, subject to certain exceptions.


Certain Covenants and Events of Default. The senior secured credit agreements contain a number of covenants that, among other things, restrict, subject to certain exceptions, our ability to:


·

incur additional indebtedness;

·

sell assets;

·

pay dividends and distributions or repurchase our capital stock;

·

make investments or acquisitions;

·

repay or repurchase subordinated indebtedness (including the senior subordinated notes discussed below) and the senior notes discussed below;

·

amend material agreements governing our subordinated indebtedness (including the senior subordinated notes discussed below) or our senior notes discussed below;

·

and change our lines of business.

The senior secured credit agreements also contain certain customary affirmative covenants and events of default.

At January 30, 2009, we had no borrowings, $51.0 million of commercial letters of credit, and $83.7 million of standby letters of credit outstanding under our asset-based revolving credit facility.


Senior Notes due 2015 and Senior Subordinated Toggle Notes due 2017


Overview. We have $1.175 billion aggregate principal amount of 10.625% senior notes due 2015 (the “senior notes”) outstanding, which mature on July 15, 2015, pursuant to an indenture dated as of July 6, 2007 (the “senior indenture”), and $655.9 million aggregate principal amount of 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated toggle notes due 2017 (the “senior subordinated notes”) outstanding, which mature on July 15, 2017, pursuant to an indenture dated as of July 6, 2007 (the “senior subordinated indenture”). The senior notes and the senior subordinated notes are collectively referred to herein as the “notes.” The senior indenture and the senior subordinated indenture are collectively referred to herein as the “indentures.” We may redeem some or all of the notes at any time at redemption prices described or set forth in the indentures.


Interest on the notes is payable on January 15 and July 15 of each year. Interest on the senior notes is payable in cash. Cash interest on the senior subordinated notes accrues at a rate of



42



11.875% per annum, and PIK interest (as that term is defined below) accrues at a rate of 12.625% per annum, if applicable. The initial interest payment on the senior subordinated notes was payable in cash. For any interest period thereafter through July 15, 2011, we may elect to pay interest on the senior subordinated notes (i) in cash, (ii) by increasing the principal amount of the senior subordinated notes or issuing new senior subordinated notes (“PIK interest”) or (iii) by paying interest on half of the principal amount of the senior subordinated notes in cash interest and half in PIK interest. After July 15, 2011, all interest on the senior subordinated notes will be payable in cash. Through January 30, 2009, all such interest has been paid in cash.


The notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by each of the existing and future direct or indirect wholly owned domestic subsidiaries that guarantee the obligations under our Credit Facilities.


We may redeem some or all of the notes at any time at redemption prices described or set forth in the indentures. We also may seek, from time to time, to retire some or all of the notes through cash purchases on the open market, in privately negotiated transactions or otherwise. Such repurchases, if any, will depend on prevailing market conditions, our liquidity requirements, contractual restrictions and other factors. The amounts involved may be material. We repurchased $44.1 million and $25.0 million of the senior subordinated notes in the fourth quarters of 2008 and 2007, respectively.


Change of Control. Upon the occurrence of a change of control, which is defined in the indentures, each holder of the notes has the right to require us to repurchase some or all of such holder’s notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the repurchase date.


Covenants. The indentures contain covenants limiting, among other things, our ability and the ability of our restricted subsidiaries to (subject to certain exceptions):


·

incur additional debt, issue disqualified stock or issue certain preferred stock;


·

pay dividends on or make certain distributions and other restricted payments;

·

create certain liens or encumbrances;


·

sell assets;


·

enter into transactions with affiliates;


·

make payments to us;


·

consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets; and


·

designate our subsidiaries as unrestricted subsidiaries.




43



Events of Default. The indentures also provide for events of default which, if any of them occurs, would permit or require the principal of and accrued interest on the notes to become or to be declared due and payable.


Adjusted EBITDA


Under the agreements governing the Credit Facilities and the indentures, certain limitations and restrictions could arise if we are not able to satisfy and remain in compliance with specified financial ratios. Management believes the most significant of such ratios is the senior secured incurrence test under the Credit Facilities.  This test measures the ratio of the senior secured debt to Adjusted EBITDA. This ratio would need to be no greater than 4.25 to 1 to avoid such limitations and restrictions. As of January 30, 2009, this ratio was 2.1 to 1. Senior secured debt is defined as our total debt secured by liens or similar encumbrances less cash and cash equivalents.  EBITDA is defined as income (loss) from continuing operations before cumulative effect of change in accounting principle plus interest and other financing costs, net, provision for income taxes, and depreciation and amortization. Adjusted EBITDA is defined as EBITDA, further adjusted to give effect to adjustments required in calculating this covenant ratio under our Credit Facilities. EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA are not presentations made in accordance with U.S. GAAP, are not measures of financial performance or condition, liquidity or profitability, and should not be considered as an alternative to (i) net income, operating income or any other performance measures determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP or (ii) operating cash flows determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Additionally, EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA are not intended to be measures of free cash flow for management’s discretionary use, as they do not consider certain cash requirements such as interest payments, tax payments and debt service requirements and replacements of fixed assets.


Our presentation of EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA has limitations as an analytical tool, and should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for analysis of our results as reported under U.S. GAAP. Because not all companies use identical calculations, these presentations of EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA may not be comparable to other similarly titled measures of other companies. We believe that the presentation of EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA is appropriate to provide additional information about the calculation of this financial ratio in the Credit Facilities. Adjusted EBITDA is a material component of this ratio. Specifically, non-compliance with the senior secured indebtedness ratio contained in our Credit Facilities could prohibit us from making investments, incurring liens, making certain restricted payments and incurring additional secured indebtedness (other than the additional funding provided for under the senior secured credit agreement and pursuant to specified exceptions).  




44



The calculation of Adjusted EBITDA under the Credit Facilities is as follows:


(in millions)

Year Ended

January 30,
2009

February 1,
2008

Net income (loss)

$

108.2 

$

(12.8)

Add (subtract):

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

(3.1)

 

(8.8)

Interest expense

 

391.9 

 

263.2 

Depreciation and amortization

 

235.1 

 

226.4 

Income taxes

 

86.2 

 

10.2 

EBITDA

 

818.3 

 

478.2 

 

 

 

 

 

Adjustments:

 

 

 

 

Transaction and related costs

 

 

102.6 

(Gain) loss on debt retirements

 

(3.8)

 

1.2 

Loss on interest rate swaps

 

1.1 

 

2.4 

Contingent (gain) loss on distribution center leases

 

(5.0)

 

12.0 

Impact of markdowns related to inventory
clearance activities, net of purchase accounting
adjustments

 

(24.9)

 

(0.4)

SG&A related to store closing and inventory  clearance activities

 

 

54.0 

Operating losses (cash) of stores to be closed

 

 

10.5 

Hurricane-related expenses and write-offs

 

2.2 

 

Monitoring and consulting fees to affiliates

 

8.6 

 

4.8 

Stock option and restricted stock unit expense

 

10.0 

 

6.5 

Indirect Merger-related costs

 

20.7 

 

4.6 

Litigation settlement and related costs, net

 

32.0 

 

Other non-cash charges (primarily LIFO)

 

54.7 

 

6.1 

Other

 

 

1.0 

Total Adjustments

 

95.6 

 

205.3 

 

 

 

 

 

Adjusted EBITDA

$

913.9 

$

683.5 


Interest Rate Swaps


We use interest rate swaps to minimize the risk of adverse changes in interest rates. These swaps are intended to reduce risk by hedging an underlying economic exposure. Because of high correlation between the derivative financial instrument and the underlying exposure being hedged, fluctuations in the value of the financial instruments are generally offset by reciprocal changes in the value of the underlying economic exposure. Our principal interest rate exposure relates to outstanding amounts under our Credit Facilities. At January 30, 2009, we had interest rate swaps with a total notional amount of approximately $1.69 billion. For more information see Item 7A “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” below.

Fair Value Accounting


We have classified our interest rate swaps, as further discussed in Item 7A. “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” below, in Level 2 (as defined by SFAS 157) of the fair value hierarchy, as the significant inputs to the overall valuations are based on market-



45



observable data or information derived from or corroborated by market-observable data, including market-based inputs to models, model calibration to market-clearing transactions, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value a derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. We use similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, and correlations of such inputs.  For our derivatives, all of which trade in liquid markets, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment.


To comply with the provisions of SFAS 157, we incorporate credit valuation adjustments to appropriately reflect both our own nonperformance risk and the respective counterparty’s nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements of our derivatives. The credit valuation adjustments are calculated by determining the total expected exposure of the derivatives (which incorporates both the current and potential future exposure) and then applying each counterparty’s credit spread to the applicable exposure. For derivatives with two-way exposure, such as interest rate swaps, the counterparty’s credit spread is applied to our exposure to the counterparty, and our own credit spread is applied to the counterparty’s exposure to us, and the net credit valuation adjustment is reflected in our derivative valuations.  The total expected exposure of a derivative is derived using market-observable inputs, such as yield curves and volatilities.  The inputs utilized for our own credit spread are based on implied spreads from our publicly-traded debt.  For counterparties with publicly available credit information, the credit spreads over LIBOR used in the calculations represent implied credit default swap spreads obtained from a third party credit data provider.  In adjusting the fair value of our derivative contracts for the effect of nonperformance risk, we have considered the impact of netting and any applicable credit enhancements, such as collateral postings, thresholds, mutual puts, and guarantees.  Additionally, we actively monitor counterparty credit ratings for any significant changes.


As of January 30, 2009, the net credit valuation adjustments reduced the settlement values of our derivative liabilities by $8.5 million.  Various factors impact changes in the credit valuation adjustments over time, including changes in the credit spreads of the parties to the contracts, as well as changes in market rates and volatilities, which affect the total expected exposure of the derivative instruments. When appropriate, valuations are also adjusted for various factors such as liquidity and bid/offer spreads, which factors we deemed to be immaterial as of January 30, 2009.  


Other Considerations


Our inventory balance represented approximately 44% of our total assets exclusive of goodwill and other intangible assets as of January 30, 2009. Our proficiency in managing our inventory balances can have a significant impact on our cash flows from operations during a given fiscal year. As a result, efficient inventory management has been and continues to be an area of focus for us.




46



The following table summarizes our significant contractual obligations and commercial commitments as of January 30, 2009 (in thousands):


 

Payments Due by Period

Contractual obligations

Total

 

< 1 yr

 

1-3 yrs

 

3-5 yrs

> 5 yrs

Long-term debt obligations

$

4,147,109

 

 

$

11,500

 

 

$

47,723

 

 

$

46,000

 

$

4,041,886

 

Capital lease obligations

 

9,939

 

 

 

2,658

 

 

 

2,471

 

 

 

564

 

 

4,246

 

Interest (a)

 

2,159,555

 

 

 

332,792

 

 

 

661,518

 

 

 

656,169

 

 

509,076

 

Self-insurance liabilities (b)

 

216,817

 

 

 

70,047

 

 

 

93,198

 

 

 

30,590

 

 

22,982

 

Operating leases (c)

 

1,671,935

 

 

 

358,367

 

 

 

569,005

 

 

 

371,966

 

 

372,597

 

Monitoring agreement (d)

 

20,682

 

 

 

5,403

 

 

 

11,630

 

 

 

3,649

 

 

-

 

Subtotal

$

8,226,037

 

 

$

780,767

 

 

$

1,385,545

 

 

$

1,108,938

 

$

4,950,787

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


 

Commitments Expiring by Period

Commercial
commitments
(e)

 

Total

 

 

 

< 1 yr

 

 

 

1-3 yrs

 

 

 

3-5 yrs

 

 

> 5 yrs

 

Letters of credit

$

51,014

 

 

$

51,014

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Purchase obligations (f)

 

634,014

 

 

 

632,857

 

 

 

1,157

 

 

 

-

 

 

-

 

Subtotal

$

685,028

 

 

$

683,871

 

 

$

1,157

 

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

Total contractual obligations and commercial commitments

$

8,911,065

 

 

$

1,464,638

 

 

$

1,386,702

 

 

$

1,108,938

 

$

4,950,787

 


(a)

Represents obligations for interest payments on long-term debt and capital lease obligations, and includes projected interest on variable rate long-term debt, based upon 2008 year end rates.

(b)

We retain a significant portion of the risk for our workers’ compensation, employee health insurance, general liability, property loss and automobile insurance. As these obligations do not have scheduled maturities, these amounts represent undiscounted estimates based upon actuarial assumptions. Reserves for workers’ compensation and general liability which existed as of the Merger date were discounted in order to arrive at estimated fair value.  All other amounts are reflected on an undiscounted basis in our consolidated balance sheets.

(c)

Operating lease obligations are inclusive of amounts included in deferred rent and closed store obligations in our consolidated balance sheets.

(d)

We entered into a monitoring agreement, dated July 6, 2007, with affiliates of certain of our Investors pursuant to which those entities will provide management and advisory services.  Such agreement has no contractual term and for purposes of this schedule is presumed to be outstanding for a period of five years.

(e)

Commercial commitments include information technology license and support agreements, supplies, fixtures, letters of credit for import merchandise, and other inventory purchase obligations.

(f)

Purchase obligations include legally binding agreements for software licenses and support, supplies, fixtures, and merchandise purchases excluding such purchases subject to letters of credit.


In 2008 and 2007, our South Carolina-based wholly owned captive insurance subsidiary, Ashley River Insurance Company (“ARIC”), had investments in U.S. Government securities, obligations of Government Sponsored Enterprises, short- and long-term corporate obligations, and asset-backed obligations. These investments were held pursuant to South Carolina regulatory requirements to maintain certain asset balances in relation to ARIC’s liability and equity balances which could limit our ability to use these assets for general corporate purposes. In May 2008, the state of South Carolina made certain changes to these regulatory requirements, which had the effect of reducing the amounts and types of investments required, allowing ARIC to liquidate investments (primarily U.S. Government and corporate debt securities) totaling $48.6 million during 2008.  At January 30, 2009, the asset balances held pursuant to these regulatory requirements equaled $20.0 million and were reflected in our consolidated balance sheet as cash and cash equivalents.



47



In August 2005, we incurred significant losses caused by Hurricane Katrina, primarily inventory and fixed assets in the form of store fixtures and leasehold improvements. We reached final settlement of our related insurance claim in 2006 and received proceeds totaling $21.0 million due to these losses, including $13.0 million in 2006 and $8.0 million prior to 2006, and have utilized a portion of these proceeds to replace lost assets. Insurance proceeds related to fixed assets are included in cash flows from investing activities, and proceeds related to inventory losses and business interruption are included in cash flows from operating activities.


Legal actions, claims and tax contingencies . As described in Note 8 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, we are involved in a number of legal actions and claims, some of which could potentially result in material cash payments.  Adverse developments in those actions could materially and adversely affect our liquidity.  As discussed in Note 5 we also have certain income tax-related contingencies as more fully described below under “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates.” Future negative developments could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity.


Considerations regarding distribution center leases . The Merger and certain of the related financing transactions may be interpreted as giving rise to certain trigger events (which may include events of default) under leases for three of our distribution centers (“DCs”). We do not believe such an interpretation would be appropriate under the terms of the leases. During the 2007 Successor period, we concluded that a probable loss existed in connection with the lease contingencies and accrued SG&A expenses totaling $12.0 million in the Successor statement of operations for the period ended February 1, 2008. As of January 30, 2009, $7.0 million of such amount has been paid. We believe that we have negotiated with the property owners proposed lease terms that would be implemented if the owners were to refinance or sell the property and that the resolution of these negotiations is primarily dependent on conditions in the real estate and financial markets. We believe that any remaining potential loss on the resolution of these matters would currently be properly categorized as reasonably possible rather than probable and therefore reversed the remaining $5.0 million of previously recorded SG&A expenses during the year ended January 30, 2009. However, the possibility remains that the ultimate resolution of these matters could require us to make a significant cash investment to purchase these DCs.

Credit ratings.  On December 15, 2008 Standard & Poor’s revised our long-term debt rating outlook to positive from stable and affirmed our long-term rating of B.  On September 18, 2008 Moody’s affirmed our long-term debt rating of B3 and changed the outlook to positive from stable.  These current ratings are considered non-investment grade.  Our current credit ratings, as well as future rating agency actions, could (1) negatively impact our ability to obtain financings to finance our operations on satisfactory terms; (2) have the effect of increasing our financing costs; and (3) have the effect of increasing our insurance premiums and collateral requirements necessary for our self-insured programs.


Cash flows


Cash flows from operating activities.

A significant component of the change in cash flows from operating activities in 2008 compared to the 2007 periods was our strong operating performance due to greater sales, higher gross margins and lower SG&A expenses as a percentage of sales, partially offset by significantly higher interest expense, as described in more



48



detail above under “Results of Operations.” In addition, we experienced increased inventory turns and improved merchandise payment terms in 2008 as compared to the 2007 periods. Accounts payable balances increased by $140.4 million in 2008 compared to a decline of $41.4 million in the 2007 Successor period and an increase of $34.8 million in the 2007 Predecessor period partially as a result of our implementation of initiatives to aggressively manage our payables.  Also positively affecting cash flows from operations were increases in accrued expenses and other in 2008, which was primarily attributable to increases in litigation reserves, incentive bonus accruals, deferred vendor rebates, and property and sales tax accruals. Other significant components of the change in cash flows from operating activities in 2008 as compared to 2007 were changes in inventory balances, which increased by 10% in 2008 compared to decreases of approximately 6% and 1% during the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively. Inventory levels in the highly consumable category increased by $77.8 million, or 12%, in 2008 compared to a decline of $90.7 million, or 12%, in the 2007 Successor period and an increase of $48.8 million, or 7%, in the 2007 Predecessor period. The seasonal category increased by $20.9 million, or 8%, in 2008 compared to a decline of $24.2 million, or 8%, in the 2007 Successor period and a decline of $38.7 million, or 11%, in the 2007 Predecessor period. The home products category declined by $2.6 million, or 2%, in 2008 compared to an increase of $25.4 million, or 19%, in the 2007 Successor period and a decline of $15.0 million, or 10%, in the 2007 Predecessor period. The basic clothing category increased by $30.2 million, or 15%, in 2008 compared to an increase of $10.0 million, or 5%, in the 2007 Successor period and a decline of $11.5 million, or 5%, in the 2007 Predecessor period. In addition, net income in 2008 compared to the net losses in the 2007 periods discussed above was a principal factor in the increase in income taxes paid in 2008. Income tax refunds received in 2007 for taxes paid in prior years that did not reoccur in 2008 also contributed to the increase in income taxes paid during 2008.


Cash flows from operating activities for the 2007 periods were impacted by a net loss of $4.8 million and $8.0 million in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively, compared to net income of $137.9 million in 2006, as described in detail under “Results of Operations” above, including the incurrence of $101.4 million of Transaction and related costs in the 2007 Predecessor period. Other significant components of the change in cash flows from operating activities in 2007 as compared to 2006 were changes in inventory balances, which decreased by approximately 6% and 1% during the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, respectively, compared to a decrease of approximately 3% during 2006. As compared to changes in inventory levels in the 2007 periods discussed above, in 2006 highly consumable increased $63.2 million, or 10%; seasonal increased $6.7 million, or 2%; home products decreased $52.5 million, or 25%; and basic clothing decreased $59.5 million, or 21%. In addition to inventory changes, the net losses in the 2007 periods discussed above were principal factors in the reduction in income taxes paid in those periods as compared to 2006. Also offsetting the decline in net income were changes in accrued expenses, particularly in the 2007 Predecessor period as compared to 2006, which was primarily attributable to income tax related reserves, accruals for lease liabilities on closed stores and property and sales tax accruals.


Cash flows from investing activities . Cash flows used in investing activities totaling $152.6 million in 2008 were primarily related to capital expenditures and sales of investments. Significant components of our property and equipment purchases in 2008 included the following



49



approximate amounts: $149 million for improvements, upgrades, remodels and relocations of existing stores; $22 million for new stores; $17 million for distribution and transportation-related capital expenditures; and $13 million for information systems upgrades and technology-related projects. During 2008 we opened 207 new stores and remodeled or relocated 404 stores.

Purchases and sales of short-term investments, which equaled net sales of $51.6 million in 2008, primarily reflect our investment activities in our captive insurance subsidiary, including a change in regulatory requirements as discussed in more detail above under “Other Considerations.”

The Merger, as discussed in more detail above, required cash payments in the 2007 Successor period of approximately $6.7 billion, net of cash acquired of $350 million. Significant components of property and equipment purchases in the 2007 Successor period included the following approximate amounts: $45 million for improvements, upgrades, remodels and relocations of existing stores; $23 million for distribution and transportation-related capital expenditures; and $16 million for new stores. During the 2007 Successor period, we opened 170 new stores and remodeled or relocated 235 stores. Significant components of property and equipment purchases in the 2007 Predecessor period included the following approximate amounts: $29 million for new stores; $15 million for improvements, upgrades, remodels and relocations of existing stores; and $7 million for distribution and transportation-related capital expenditures. During the 2007 Predecessor period, we opened 195 new stores and remodeled or relocated 65 stores.

During the 2007 Successor period we purchased a secured promissory note for $37.0 million which represents debt issued by a third-party entity from which we lease our distribution center in Ardmore, Oklahoma. Purchases and sales of short-term investments, which equaled net sales of $17.6 million and $4.4 million in the respective 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, primarily reflect our investment activities in our captive insurance subsidiary, and all purchases of long-term investments were related to the captive insurance subsidiary.


Cash flows used in investing activities totaling $282.0 million in 2006 were primarily related to capital expenditures and, to a lesser degree, purchases of long-term investments. Significant components of our property and equipment purchases in 2006 included the following approximate amounts: $66 million for distribution and transportation-related capital expenditures (including approximately $30 million related to our distribution center in Marion, Indiana which opened in 2006); $66 million for new stores; $50 million for a capital project designed to improve inventory flow from our DCs to consumers; and $38 million for capital projects in existing stores. During 2006 we opened 537 new stores and remodeled or relocated 64 stores.


Purchases and sales of short-term investments in 2006, which equaled net sales of $1.9 million, reflect our investment activities in tax-exempt auction rate securities as well as investing activities of our captive insurance subsidiary. Purchases of long-term investments are related to the captive insurance subsidiary.


Capital expenditures during 2009 are projected to be in the range of $250-275 million. We anticipate funding 2009 capital requirements with cash flows from operations and our revolving credit facility, if necessary. Significant components of the 2009 capital plan include



50



growth initiatives including leasehold improvements, fixtures and equipment for approximately 450 new stores; continued investment in our existing store base with plans for remodeling and relocating approximately 400 stores; and additional investments in our supply chain and information technology. We plan to undertake these expenditures in order to improve our infrastructure and increase our cash generated from operating activities.

Cash flows from financing activities .  In 2008, we repaid borrowings of $102.5 million under our revolving credit facility and as of January 30, 2009, we had no borrowings under the revolving credit facility. Also during 2008, we repurchased $44.1 million of our outstanding senior subordinated notes.


In the 2007 Successor period, to finance the Merger, we issued long-term debt of approximately $4.2 billion and issued common stock in the amount of approximately $2.8 billion (primarily relating to the cash equity contributions from the Investors); we incurred costs associated with the issuance of Merger-related long-term debt of $87.4 million; we completed a cash tender offer for our 2010 Notes as discussed above, resulting in the valid tender of approximately 99% of the 2010 Notes resulting in repayments of long-term debt and related consent fees in the amount of $215.6 million; and incurred borrowings, net of repayments, under our new asset-based revolving credit facility of $102.5 million.


Cash flows used in financing activities during 2006 included the repurchase of approximately 4.5 million shares of the Predecessor’s common stock at a total cost of $79.9 million, cash dividends paid of $62.5 million, or $0.20 per share, on the Predecessor’s outstanding common stock, and $14.1 million to reduce our outstanding capital lease and financing obligations. These uses of cash were partially offset by proceeds from the exercise of stock options during 2006 of $19.9 million.


The borrowings and repayments under the revolving credit agreements in 2008, the 2007 Successor period and 2006 were primarily a result of activity associated with periodic cash needs.


Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates


The preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect reported amounts and related disclosures.  In addition to the estimates presented below, there are other items within our financial statements that require estimation, but are not deemed critical as defined below. We believe these estimates are reasonable and appropriate. However, if actual experience differs from the assumptions and other considerations used, the resulting changes could have a material effect on the financial statements taken as a whole.


Management believes the following policies and estimates are critical because they involve significant judgments, assumptions, and estimates. Management has discussed the development and selection of the critical accounting estimates with the Audit Committee of our Board of Directors, and the Audit Committee has reviewed the disclosures presented below relating to those policies and estimates.




51



Merchandise Inventories . Merchandise inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market with cost determined using the retail last-in, first-out (“LIFO”) method. Under our retail inventory method (“RIM”), the calculation of gross profit and the resulting valuation of inventories at cost are computed by applying a calculated cost-to-retail inventory ratio to the retail value of sales at a department level. The RIM is an averaging method that has been widely used in the retail industry due to its practicality. Also, it is recognized that the use of the RIM will result in valuing inventories at the lower of cost or market (“LCM”) if markdowns are currently taken as a reduction of the retail value of inventories.


Inherent in the RIM calculation are certain significant management judgments and estimates including, among others, initial markups, markdowns, and shrinkage, which significantly impact the gross profit calculation as well as the ending inventory valuation at cost. These significant estimates, coupled with the fact that the RIM is an averaging process, can, under certain circumstances, produce distorted cost figures. Factors that can lead to distortion in the calculation of the inventory balance include:


·

applying the RIM to a group of products that is not fairly uniform in terms of its cost and selling price relationship and turnover;


·

applying the RIM to transactions over a period of time that include different rates of gross profit, such as those relating to seasonal merchandise;


·

inaccurate estimates of inventory shrinkage between the date of the last physical inventory at a store and the financial statement date; and


·

inaccurate estimates of LCM and/or LIFO reserves.


Factors that reduce potential distortion include the use of historical experience in estimating the shrink provision (see discussion below) and recent improvements in the annual LIFO analysis whereby all SKUs are considered in the index formulation. An actual valuation of inventory under the LIFO method can be made only at the end of each year based on the inventory levels and costs at that time. Accordingly, interim LIFO calculations are based on management’s estimates of expected year-end inventory levels, sales for the year and the expected rate of inflation/deflation for the year and are thus subject to adjustment in the final year-end LIFO inventory valuation. We also perform interim inventory-aging analysis for determining obsolete inventory. Our policy is to write down inventory to an LCM value based on various management assumptions including estimated markdowns and sales required to liquidate such aged inventory in future periods. Inventory is reviewed on a quarterly basis and adjusted as appropriate to reflect write-downs determined to be necessary.


Factors such as slower inventory turnover due to changes in competitors’ tactics, consumer preferences, consumer spending and unseasonable weather patterns, among other factors, could cause excess inventory requiring greater than estimated markdowns to entice consumer purchases, resulting in an unfavorable impact on our consolidated financial statements. Sales shortfalls due to the above factors could cause reduced purchases from vendors and



52



associated vendor allowances that would also result in an unfavorable impact on our consolidated financial statements.

 

We calculate our shrink provision based on actual physical inventory results during the fiscal period and an accrual for estimated shrink occurring subsequent to a physical inventory through the end of the fiscal reporting period. This accrual is calculated as a percentage of sales at each retail store, at a department level, and is determined by dividing the book-to-physical inventory adjustments recorded during the previous twelve months by the related sales for the same period for each store. To the extent that subsequent physical inventories yield different results than this estimated accrual, our effective shrink rate for a given reporting period will include the impact of adjusting the estimated results to the actual results. Although we perform physical inventories in virtually all of our stores on an annual basis, the same stores do not necessarily get counted in the same reporting periods from year to year, which could impact comparability in a given reporting period.


Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets. We amortize intangible assets over their estimated useful lives unless such lives are deemed indefinite. If impairment indicators are noted, amortizable intangible assets are tested for impairment based on projected undiscounted cash flows, and, if impaired, written down to fair value based on either discounted projected cash flows or appraised values. Future cash flow projections are based on management’s projections. Significant judgments required in this testing process may include projecting future cash flows, determining appropriate discount rates and other assumptions. Projections are based on management’s best estimates given recent financial performance, market trends, strategic plans and other available information. Changes in these estimates and assumptions could materially affect the determination of fair value or impairment. Future indicators of impairment could result in an asset impairment charge.


Under SFAS 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets,” we are required to test goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives for impairment annually, or more frequently if impairment indicators occur. The goodwill impairment test is a two-step process that requires management to make judgments in determining what assumptions to use in the calculation. The first step of the process consists of estimating the fair value of our reporting unit based on valuation techniques (including a discounted cash flow model using revenue and profit forecasts) and comparing that estimated fair value with the recorded carrying value, which includes goodwill. If the estimated fair value is less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to compute the amount of the impairment by determining an “implied fair value” of goodwill. The determination of the “implied fair value” of goodwill would require us to allocate the estimated fair value of our reporting unit to its assets and liabilities. Any unallocated fair value represents the “implied fair value” of goodwill, which would be compared to its corresponding carrying value.

We performed our annual impairment tests of goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets during the third quarter of 2008 based on conditions as of the end of our second quarter, and subsequently reviewed such results as of the end of 2008. These analyses indicated that no impairment was necessary. We are not currently projecting a decline in cash flows that could be expected to have an adverse effect such as a violation of debt covenants or future impairment charges.



53



Purchase Accounting. The Merger was accounted for as a reverse acquisition in accordance with the purchase accounting provisions of SFAS 141, “Business Combinations,” under which our assets and liabilities have been accounted for at their estimated fair values as of the date of the Merger. The aggregate purchase price was allocated to the tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed, based upon an assessment of their relative fair values as of the date of the Merger. These estimates of fair values, the allocation of the purchase price and other factors related to the accounting for the Merger are subject to significant judgments and the use of estimates.


Property and Equipment . Property and equipment are recorded at cost. We group our assets into relatively homogeneous classes and generally provide for depreciation on a straight-line basis over the estimated average useful life of each asset class, except for leasehold improvements, which are amortized over the lesser of the applicable lease term or the estimated useful life of the asset. Certain store and warehouse fixtures, when fully depreciated, are removed from the cost and related accumulated depreciation and amortization accounts. The valuation and classification of these assets and the assignment of useful depreciable lives involves significant judgments and the use of estimates.


Impairment of Long-lived Assets. We review the carrying value of all long-lived assets for impairment at least annually, and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of an asset may not be recoverable. In accordance with SFAS 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets,” we review for impairment stores open for approximately two years or more for which recent cash flows from operations are negative. Impairment results when the carrying value of the assets exceeds the estimated undiscounted future cash flows over the life of the lease. Our estimate of undiscounted future cash flows over the lease term is based upon historical operations of the stores and estimates of future store profitability which encompasses many factors that are subject to variability and are difficult to predict. If a long-lived asset is found to be impaired, the amount recognized for impairment is equal to the difference between the carrying value and the asset’s estimated fair value. The fair value is estimated based primarily upon future cash flows (discounted at our credit adjusted risk-free rate) or other reasonable estimates of fair market value in accordance with U.S. GAAP.


We recorded impairment charges included in SG&A expense of approximately $4.0 million in 2008, $0.2 million in the 2007 Predecessor period and $9.4 million in 2006 to reduce the carrying value of certain of our stores’ assets as deemed necessary based on our evaluation that such amounts would not be recoverable, primarily due to insufficient sales or excessive costs resulting in negative current and projected future cash flows at these locations. Such assets, to the extent still functional, are held for use in other store locations. The majority of the 2006 charges were recorded pursuant to certain strategic initiatives discussed above.


Insurance Liabilities . We retain a significant portion of the risk for our workers’ compensation, employee health insurance, general liability, property loss and automobile coverage. These costs are significant primarily due to the large employee base and number of stores. At the date of the Merger the liability for workers’ compensation and general liability was discounted in accordance with purchase accounting standards. Subsequent to the Merger,



54



provisions are made to these insurance liabilities on an undiscounted basis based on actual claim data and estimates of incurred but not reported claims developed using actuarial methodologies based on historical claim trends. If future claim trends deviate from recent historical patterns, we may be required to record additional expenses or expense reductions, which could be material to our future financial results.

Contingent Liabilities – Income Taxes. Income tax reserves are determined using the methodology established by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Interpretation 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – An Interpretation of FASB Statement 109 (“FIN 48”).  FIN 48, which we adopted on February 3, 2007, requires companies to assess each income tax position taken using a two step process.  A determination is first made as to whether it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained, based upon the technical merits, upon examination by the taxing authorities.  If the tax position is expected to meet the more likely than not criteria, the benefit recorded for the tax position equals the largest amount that is greater than 50% likely to be realized upon ultimate settlement of the respective tax position. Uncertain tax positions require determinations and estimated liabilities to be made based on provisions of the tax law which may be subject to change or varying interpretation.  If our determinations and estimates prove to be inaccurate, the resulting adjustments could be material to our future financial results.


Contingent Liabilities - Legal Matters . We are subject to legal, regulatory and other proceedings and claims. We establish liabilities as appropriate for these claims and proceedings based upon the probability and estimability of losses and to fairly present, in conjunction with the disclosures of these matters in our financial statements and SEC filings, management’s view of our exposure. We review outstanding claims and proceedings with external counsel to assess probability and estimates of loss. We re-evaluate these assessments on a quarterly basis or as new and significant information becomes available to determine whether a liability should be established or if any existing liability should be adjusted. The actual cost of resolving a claim or proceeding ultimately may be substantially different than the amount of the recorded liability. In addition, because it is not permissible under U.S. GAAP to establish a litigation liability until the loss is both probable and estimable, in some cases there may be insufficient time to establish a liability prior to the actual incurrence of the loss (upon verdict and judgment at trial, for example, or in the case of a quickly negotiated settlement). See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements.


Lease Accounting and Excess Facilities . The majority of our stores are subject to short-term leases (usually with initial or current terms of 3 to 5 years) with multiple renewal options when available. We also have stores subject to build-to-suit arrangements with landlords, which typically carry a primary lease term of 10 years with multiple renewal options. Approximately 42% of our stores have provisions for contingent rentals based upon a percentage of defined sales volume. We recognize contingent rental expense when the achievement of specified sales targets is considered probable. We recognize rent expense over the term of the lease. We record minimum rental expense on a straight-line basis over the base, non-cancelable lease term commencing on the date that we take physical possession of the property from the landlord, which normally includes a period prior to store opening to make necessary leasehold improvements and install store fixtures. When a lease contains a predetermined fixed escalation of the minimum rent, we recognize the related rent expense on a straight-line basis and record



55



the difference between the recognized rental expense and the amounts payable under the lease as deferred rent. Tenant allowances, to the extent received, are recorded as deferred incentive rent and amortized as a reduction to rent expense over the term of the lease. We reflect as a liability any difference between the calculated expense and the amounts actually paid. Improvements of leased properties are amortized over the shorter of the life of the applicable lease term or the estimated useful life of the asset.


For store closures (excluding those associated with a business combination) where a lease obligation still exists, we record the estimated future liability associated with the rental obligation on the date the store is closed in accordance with SFAS 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities.” Based on an overall analysis of store performance and expected trends, management periodically evaluates the need to close underperforming stores. Liabilities are established at the point of closure for the present value of any remaining operating lease obligations, net of estimated sublease income, and at the communication date for severance and other exit costs, as prescribed by SFAS 146. Key assumptions in calculating the liability include the timeframe expected to terminate lease agreements, estimates related to the sublease potential of closed locations, and estimation of other related exit costs. If actual timing and potential termination costs or realization of sublease income differ from our estimates, the resulting liabilities could vary from recorded amounts. These liabilities are reviewed periodically and adjusted when necessary.


Share-Based Payments . Our share-based stock option awards are valued on an individual grant basis using the Black-Scholes-Merton closed form option pricing model. The application of this valuation model involves assumptions that are judgmental and highly sensitive in the valuation of stock options, which affects compensation expense related to these options. These assumptions include an estimate of the fair value of our common stock (as our stock is not publicly traded), the term that the options are expected to be outstanding, an estimate of the volatility of our stock price (which is based on a peer group of publicly traded companies), applicable interest rates and the dividend yield of our stock. Other factors involving judgments that affect the expensing of share-based payments include estimated forfeiture rates of share-based awards. If our estimates differ materially from actual experience, we may be required to record additional expense or reductions of expense, which could be material to our future financial results.


Fair Value Measurements. We measure fair value of financial assets and liabilities in accordance with SFAS 157, which requires that fair values be determined based on the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability.  SFAS 157 establishes a fair value hierarchy that distinguishes between market participant assumptions based on market data obtained from sources independent of the reporting entity (observable inputs that are classified within Levels 1 and 2 of the hierarchy) and the reporting entity’s own assumptions about market participant assumptions (unobservable inputs classified within Level 3 of the hierarchy). Therefore, Level 3 inputs are typically based on an entity’s own assumptions, as there is little, if any, related market activity, and thus requires the use of significant judgment and estimates.

Our fair value measurements are primarily associated with our derivative financial instruments and to a lesser degree our mutual fund holdings. The values of our derivative



56



financial instruments are determined using widely accepted valuation techniques, including discounted cash flow analysis on the expected cash flows of each derivative. This analysis reflects the contractual terms of the derivatives, including the period to maturity, and uses observable market-based inputs, including interest rate curves.  The fair values of interest rate swaps are determined using the market standard methodology of netting the discounted future fixed cash payments (or receipts) and the discounted expected variable cash receipts (or payments).  The variable cash receipts (or payments) are based on an expectation of future interest rates (forward curves) derived from observable market interest rate curves. 


Derivative Financial Instruments. We account for derivative instruments in accordance with SFAS 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”, as amended and interpreted.  SFAS 133 establishes accounting and reporting standards for derivative instruments, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other contracts (collectively referred to as derivatives), and for hedging activities. SFAS 133 requires that every derivative instrument be recorded in the balance sheet as either an asset or liability measured at its fair value, and that changes in the derivative’s fair value be recognized currently in earnings unless specific hedge accounting criteria are met.  See “Fair Value Measurements” above for a discussion of derivative valuations.  Special accounting for qualifying hedges allows a derivative’s gains and losses to either offset related results on the hedged item in the statement of operations or be accumulated in other comprehensive income, and requires that a company formally document, designate, and assess the effectiveness of transactions that receive hedge accounting. We use derivative instruments to manage our exposure to changing interest rates, primarily with interest rate swaps.


In addition to making valuation estimates, we also bear the risk that certain derivative instruments that have been designated as hedges and currently meet the strict hedge accounting requirements of SFAS 133 may not qualify in the future as “highly effective,” as defined, as well as the risk that hedged transactions in cash flow hedging relationships may no longer be considered probable to occur. Further, new interpretations and guidance related to SFAS No. 133 may be issued in the future, and we cannot predict the possible impact that such guidance may have on our use of derivative instruments going forward.


Adoption of Accounting Standards


In May 2008, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 162, “The Hierarchy of Generally Accepted Accounting Principles.” SFAS 162 identifies the sources of accounting principles and the framework for selecting the principles used in the preparation of financial statements of nongovernmental entities that are presented in conformity with generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP) in the United States (the GAAP hierarchy). SFAS 162 became effective in November 2008. The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on our financial statements.

On February 2, 2008, we adopted components of SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements”. We have not adopted SFAS 157 for nonfinancial assets and liabilities. SFAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements.  SFAS 157 applies to reported balances that are required or



57



permitted to be measured at fair value under existing accounting pronouncements. Accordingly, the standard does not require any new fair value measurements of reported balances.

We adopted the provisions of FIN 48 effective February 3, 2007. The adoption resulted in an $8.9 million decrease in retained earnings and a reclassification of certain amounts between deferred income taxes and other noncurrent liabilities to conform to the balance sheet presentation requirements of FIN 48. As of the date of adoption, the total reserve for uncertain tax benefits was $77.9 million.  This reserve excludes the federal income tax benefit for the uncertain tax positions related to state income taxes which is now included in deferred tax assets. As a result of the adoption of FIN 48, the reserve for interest expense related to income taxes was increased to $15.3 million and a reserve for potential penalties of $1.9 million related to uncertain income tax positions was recorded. As of the date of adoption, approximately $27.1 million of the reserve for uncertain tax positions would have impacted our effective income tax rate subsequently if we were to recognize the tax benefit for these positions.


Subsequent to the adoption of FIN 48, we elected to record income tax related interest and penalties as a component of the provision for income tax expense.


Accounting Pronouncements


In March 2008, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 161, “Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”, an amendment of FASB Statement 133. SFAS 161 applies to all derivative instruments and nonderivative instruments that are designated and qualify as hedging instruments pursuant to paragraphs 37 and 42 of SFAS 133 and related hedged items accounted for under SFAS 133. SFAS 161 requires entities to provide greater transparency through additional disclosures about how and why an entity uses derivative instruments, how derivative instruments and related hedged items are accounted for under SFAS 133 and its related interpretations, and how derivative instruments and related hedged items affect an entity’s financial position, results of operations, and cash flows. SFAS 161 is effective as of the beginning of an entity’s first fiscal year that begins after November 15, 2008.  We plan to adopt SFAS 161 during the first quarter of our 2009 fiscal year and its impact is expected to be limited to the additional disclosures discussed above.


In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 141(R), “Business Combinations”. The new standard establishes the requirements for how an acquirer recognizes and measures in its financial statements the identifiable assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and any non-controlling interest (formerly minority interest) in an acquiree; provides updated requirements for recognition and measurement of goodwill acquired in the business combination or a gain from a bargain purchase; and provides updated disclosure requirements to enable users of financial statements to evaluate the nature and financial effects of the business combination. This Statement applies prospectively to business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2008. Early adoption is not allowed.  Unless a qualifying transaction is consummated subsequent to the effective date, the adoption of this standard on our financial statements is expected to be limited to any future Merger-related adjustments to uncertain tax positions that would, if subsequently recognized, impact our results of operations rather than goodwill.




58



In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS 157, “Fair Value Measurements.” SFAS 157 provides guidance for using fair value to measure assets and liabilities. The standard also requires expanded information about the extent to which companies measure assets and liabilities at fair value, the information used to measure fair value, and the effect of fair value measurements on earnings. SFAS 157 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, and interim periods within those fiscal years. For non-financial assets and liabilities, the effective date has been delayed to fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008. We currently expect to adopt the components of SFAS 157 relating to nonfinancial assets and liabilities during 2009. We are in the process of evaluating the potential impact of this standard on our consolidated financial statements.


ITEM 7A.

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK


Financial Risk Management


We are exposed to market risk primarily from adverse changes in interest rates, and to a lesser degree commodity prices. To minimize this risk, we may periodically use financial instruments, including derivatives. As a matter of policy, we do not buy or sell financial instruments for speculative or trading purposes and all derivative financial instrument transactions must be authorized and executed pursuant to approval by the Board of Directors. All financial instrument positions taken by us are intended to be used to reduce risk by hedging an underlying economic exposure. Because of high correlation between the derivative financial instrument and the underlying exposure being hedged, fluctuations in the value of the financial instruments are generally offset by reciprocal changes in the value of the underlying economic exposure.

Interest Rate Risk


We manage our interest rate risk through the strategic use of fixed and variable interest rate debt and, from time to time, derivative financial instruments. Our principal interest rate exposure relates to outstanding amounts under our Credit Facilities. Our Credit Facilities provide for variable rate borrowings of up to $3.425 billion including availability of $1.125 billion under our senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility, subject to the borrowing base.  In order to mitigate a portion of the variable rate interest exposure under the Credit Facilities, we entered into interest rate swaps which became effective on July 31, 2007. Pursuant to the swaps, we swapped three month LIBOR rates for fixed interest rates, resulting in the payment of an all-in fixed rate of 7.68% on an original notional amount of $2.0 billion originally scheduled to amortize on a quarterly basis until maturity at July 31, 2012.

On October 3, 2008, a counterparty to one of our 2007 swap agreements declared bankruptcy, which constituted a technical default under this contract and on October 30, 2008, we terminated this swap agreement. We subsequently cash settled the swap on November 10, 2008 for approximately $7.6 million, including interest accrued to the date of termination. As of January 30, 2009, the notional amount under the remaining 2007 swaps is $866.7 million.

 



59



Effective February 28, 2008, we entered into a $350.0 million step-down interest rate swap in order to mitigate an additional portion of the variable rate interest exposure under the Credit Facilities. Under the terms of this agreement we swapped one month LIBOR rates for fixed interest rates, which will result in the payment of a fixed rate of 5.58% on a notional amount of $350.0 million for the first year and $150.0 million for the second year.  

Effective December 31, 2008, we entered into a $475.0 million interest rate swap in order to mitigate an additional portion of the variable rate interest exposure under the Credit Facilities. This swap is scheduled to mature on January 31, 2013. Under the terms of this agreement we swapped one month LIBOR rates for fixed interest rates, which will result in the payment of a fixed rate of 5.06% on a notional amount of $475.0 million through April 2010, $400.0 million from May 2010 to October 2011, and $300.0 million to maturity.  

A change in interest rates on variable rate debt impacts our pre-tax earnings and cash flows; whereas a change in interest rates on fixed rate debt impacts the economic fair value of debt but not our pre-tax earnings and cash flows.  Our interest rate swaps qualify for hedge accounting as cash flow hedges.  Therefore, changes in market fluctuations related to the effective portion of these cash flow hedges do not impact our pre-tax earnings until the accrued interest is recognized on the derivatives and the associated hedged debt.  Based on our outstanding debt as of January 30, 2009 and assuming that our mix of debt instruments, derivative instruments and other variables remain the same, the annualized effect of a one percentage point change in variable interest rates would have a pretax impact on our earnings and cash flows of approximately $6.2 million.


The interest rate swaps are accounted for in accordance with SFAS No. 133 “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”, as amended and interpreted (collectively, “SFAS 133”).  SFAS 133 establishes accounting and reporting standards for derivative instruments and hedging activities. SFAS 133 requires that all derivatives be recognized as either assets or liabilities at fair value.

The conditions and uncertainties in the global credit markets have substantially increased the credit risk of other counterparties to our swap agreements.  In the event such counterparties fail to perform under our swap agreements and we are unable to enter into new swap agreements on terms favorable to us, our ability to effectively manage our interest rate risk may be materially impaired. We attempt to manage counterparty credit risk by periodically evaluating the financial position and creditworthiness of such counterparties, monitoring the amount for which we are at risk with each counterparty, and where possible, dispersing the risk among multiple counterparties. There can be no assurance that we will manage or mitigate our counterparty credit risk effectively.



60



ITEM 8.

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm


To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of

Dollar General Corporation


We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Dollar General Corporation and subsidiaries as of January 30, 2009 (Successor) and February 1, 2008 (Successor), and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders' equity, and cash flows for the year ended January 30, 2009 (Successor), the periods from March 6, 2007 to February 1, 2008 (Successor) and from February 3, 2007 to July 6, 2007 (Predecessor), and the year ended February 2, 2007 (Predecessor). These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures  that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting.  Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of Dollar General Corporation and subsidiaries at January 30, 2009 (Successor) and February 1, 2008 (Successor), and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for the year ended January 30, 2009 (Successor), the periods from March 6, 2007 to February 1, 2008 (Successor) and from February 3, 2007 to July 6, 2007 (Predecessor), and the year ended February 2, 2007 (Predecessor), in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

As discussed in Notes 1 and 5 to the consolidated financial statements, effective February 3, 2007, the Company changed its method of accounting for uncertain tax positions in connection with the adoption of FASB Interpretation No. 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes”.


/s/ Ernst & Young LLP


Nashville, Tennessee

March 24, 2009



61



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(In thousands except per share amounts)

 

Successor

 

January 30,
2009

 

February 1,
2008

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets:

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

$

377,995 

 

$

100,209 

Short-term investments

 

 

 

19,611 

Merchandise inventories

 

1,414,955 

 

 

1,288,661 

Income taxes receivable

 

6,392 

 

 

32,501 

Deferred income taxes

 

4,600 

 

 

17,297 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

66,183 

 

 

59,465 

Total current assets

 

1,870,125 

 

 

1,517,744 

Net property and equipment

 

1,268,960 

 

 

1,274,245 

Goodwill

 

4,338,589 

 

 

4,344,930 

Intangible assets, net

 

1,325,558 

 

 

1,370,557 

Other assets, net

 

85,967 

 

 

148,955 

Total assets

$

8,889,199 

 

$

8,656,431 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

Current portion of long-term obligations

$

14,158 

 

$

3,246 

Accounts payable

 

678,421 

 

 

551,040 

Accrued expenses and other

 

375,045 

 

 

300,956 

Income taxes payable

 

7,611 

 

 

2,999 

Total current liabilities

 

1,075,235 

 

 

858,241 

Long-term obligations

 

4,122,956 

 

 

4,278,756 

Deferred income taxes

 

556,101 

 

 

486,725 

Other liabilities

 

289,288 

 

 

319,714 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Redeemable common stock

 

13,924 

 

 

9,122 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock, 1,000,000 shares authorized

 

 

 

Common stock; $0.50 par value, 1,000,000 shares authorized, 556,228 and 555,482 shares issued and outstanding at

January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively

 

278,114 

 

 

277,741 

Additional paid-in capital

 

2,489,647 

 

 

2,480,062 

Retained earnings (Accumulated deficit)

 

103,364 

 

 

(4,818)

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(39,430)

 

 

(49,112)

Total shareholders’ equity

 

2,831,695 

 

 

2,703,873 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

$

8,889,199 

 

$

8,656,431 


The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.



62



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

(In thousands)

 

Successor

 

Predecessor

 

For the year
ended
January 30, 2009

 

March 6, 2007 through
February 1,

2008 (a)

 

February 3,
2007
through
July 6, 2007

 

For the year ended
February 2, 2007

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

10,457,668 

 

$

5,571,493 

 

$

3,923,753 

 

$

9,169,822 

Cost of goods sold

 

7,396,571 

 

 

3,999,599 

 

 

2,852,178 

 

 

6,801,617 

Gross profit

 

3,061,097 

 

 

1,571,894 

 

 

1,071,575 

 

 

2,368,205 

Selling, general and administrative

 

2,448,611 

 

 

1,324,508 

 

 

960,930 

 

 

2,119,929 

Litigation settlement and related costs, net

 

32,000 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Transaction and related costs

 

 

 

1,242 

 

 

101,397 

 

 

Operating profit

 

580,486 

 

 

246,144 

 

 

9,248 

 

 

248,276 

Interest income

 

(3,061)

 

 

(3,799)

 

 

(5,046)

 

 

(7,002)

Interest expense

 

391,932 

 

 

252,897 

 

 

10,299 

 

 

34,915 

Other (income) expense

 

(2,788)

 

 

3,639 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

194,403 

 

 

(6,593)

 

 

3,995 

 

 

220,363 

Income tax expense (benefit)

 

86,221 

 

 

(1,775)

 

 

11,993 

 

 

82,420 

Net income (loss)

$

108,182 

 

$

(4,818)

 

$

(7,998)

 

$

137,943 


(a)

Includes the results of operations of Buck Acquisition Corp. for the period prior to its Merger with and into Dollar General Corporation from March 6, 2007 (its formation) through July 6, 2007 (reflecting the change in fair value of interest rate swaps), and the post-Merger results of Dollar General Corporation for the period from July 7, 2007 through February 1, 2008.  See Notes 1 and 2.


The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.




63



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

(In thousands except per share amounts)

 

Common
Stock
Shares

Common
Stock

Additional
Paid-in
Capital

Retained
Earnings

(Accumulated Deficit)

Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss

Other
Shareholders’
Equity

Total

Predecessor Balances, February 3, 2006

315,679 

$ 157,840 

$  462,383 

$1,106,165 

$           (794)

$        (4,799)

$1,720,795 

Comprehensive income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

137,943 

137,943 

Reclassification of net loss on derivatives

188 

188 

Comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

 

 

138,131 

Cash dividends, $0.20 per common share

(62,472)

(62,472)

Issuance of common stock under stock incentive plans

1,573 

786 

19,108 

19,894 

Tax benefit from share-based payments

2,513 

2,513 

Repurchases of common stock

(4,483)

(2,242)

(77,705)

(79,947)

Reversal of unearned compensation upon adoption of SFAS 123(R) (see Note 10)

(364)

(182)

(4,997)

5,179 

Share-based compensation expense

7,578 

7,578 

Vesting of restricted stock and restricted stock units

149 

75 

(75)

Transition adjustment upon adoption of SFAS 158

(381)

(381)

Other equity transactions

(118)

(59)

(365)

20 

40 

(364)

Predecessor Balances, February 2, 2007

312,436 

$ 156,218 

$  486,145 

$1,103,951 

$           (987)

$            420 

$1,745,747 

Adoption of FIN 48

(8,917)

(8,917)

Predecessor Balances as adjusted, February 2, 2007

312,436 

 156,218 

486,145 

1,095,034 

(987)

420 

1,736,830 

Comprehensive income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

(7,998)

(7,998)

Reclassification of net loss on derivatives

76 

76 

Comprehensive loss

(7,922)

Cash dividends, $0.05 per common share

(15,710)

(15,710)

Issuance of common stock under stock incentive plans

2,496 

1,248 

40,294 

41,542 

Tax benefit from stock option exercises

3,927 

3,927 

Share-based compensation expense

45,458 

45,458 

Vesting of restricted stock and restricted stock units

126 

63 

(63)

Other equity transactions

(28)

(13)

(580)

(48)

(634)

Elimination of Predecessor equity in connection with Merger (see Notes 1 and 2)

(315,030)

(157,516)

(575,181)

(1,071,278)

911 

(427)

(1,803,491)

Predecessor Balances subsequent to Merger

$           - 

$              - 

$              - 

$                  - 

$                 - 

$               - 

Successor capital contribution, net

554,035 

$277,018 

$2,476,958 

$              - 

$                  - 

$                 - 

$2,753,976 

Comprehensive loss:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

(4,818)

(4,818)

Unrealized net loss on hedged transactions

(49,112)

(49,112)

Comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

(53,930)

Issuance of common stock under stock incentive plans

574 

287 

(287)

Issuance of restricted common stock under stock incentive plans

890 

445 

(445)

Repurchases of common stock

(17)

(9)

Share-based compensation expense

3,827 

3,827 

Successor Balances, February 1, 2008

555,482 

$277,741 

$2,480,062 

$     (4,818)

$       (49,112)

$                 - 

$2,703,873 

Comprehensive income:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

108,182 

108,182 

Unrealized net gain on hedged transactions

9,682 

9,682 

Comprehensive income

 

 

 

 

 

 

117,864 

Issuance of common stock under stock incentive plans

846 

423 

(423)

Repurchases of common stock

(100)

(50)

50 

Share-based compensation expense

9,958 

9,958 

Successor Balances, January 30, 2009

556,228 

$278,114 

$2,489,647 

$     103,364 

$      (39,430)

$                 - 

$2,831,695 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.



64



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(In thousands)

 

Successor

 

Predecessor

 

For the year ended
January 30, 2009

 

March 6, 2007 through
February 1,
2008 (a)

 

February 3, 2007
through
July 6, 2007

 

For the year
ended
February 2,
2007

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$

108,182 

 

$

(4,818)

 

$

(7,998)

 

$

137,943 

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

247,899 

 

 

150,213 

 

 

83,917 

 

 

200,608 

Deferred income taxes

 

73,434 

 

 

19,551 

 

 

(20,874)

 

 

(38,218)

Tax benefit of stock options

 

(950)

 

 

 

 

(3,927)

 

 

(2,513)

Noncash inventory adjustments and asset impairments

 

50,671 

 

 

6,113 

 

 

 

 

76,599 

Noncash share-based compensation

 

9,958 

 

 

3,827 

 

 

45,433 

 

 

7,578 

Other noncash gains and losses

 

2,434 

 

 

5,525 

 

 

5,098 

 

 

5,820 

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

(173,014)

 

 

73,356 

 

 

16,424 

 

 

(26,541)

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

(598)

 

 

3,739 

 

 

(6,184)

 

 

(5,411)

Accounts payable

 

140,356 

 

 

(41,395)

 

 

34,794 

 

 

53,544 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities

 

68,736 

 

 

16,061 

 

 

52,995 

 

 

38,353 

Income taxes

 

33,986 

 

 

7,348 

 

 

2,809 

 

 

(35,165)

Other

 

14,084 

 

 

84 

 

 

(541)

 

 

(7,240)

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

575,178 

 

 

239,604 

 

 

201,946 

 

 

405,357 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merger, net of cash acquired

 

 

 

(6,738,391)

 

 

 

 

Purchases of property and equipment

 

(205,546)

 

 

(83,641)

 

 

(56,153)

 

 

(261,515)

Purchases of short-term investments

 

(9,903)

 

 

(3,800)

 

 

(5,100)

 

 

(49,675)

Sales of short-term investments

 

61,547 

 

 

21,445 

 

 

9,505 

 

 

51,525 

Purchases of long-term investments

 

 

 

(7,473)

 

 

(15,754)

 

 

(25,756)

Purchase of promissory notes

 

 

 

(37,047)

 

 

 

 

Sale and insurance proceeds related to property and equipment

 

1,266 

 

 

533 

 

 

620 

 

 

3,457 

Net cash used in investing activities

 

(152,636)

 

 

(6,848,374)

 

 

(66,882)

 

 

(281,964)

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issuance of common stock

 

4,228 

 

 

2,759,540 

 

 

 

 

Net borrowings (repayments) under revolving credit facility

 

(102,500)

 

 

102,500 

 

 

 

 

Issuance of long-term obligations

 

 

 

4,176,817 

 

 

 

 

Repayments of long-term obligations

 

(44,425)

 

 

(241,945)

 

 

(4,500)

 

 

(14,118)

Debt issuance costs

 

 

 

(87,392)

 

 

 

 

(584)

Payment of cash dividends

 

 

 

 

 

(15,710)

 

 

(62,472)

Exercises (repurchases) of stock options

 

(2,511)

 

 

 

 

41,546 

 

 

19,894 

Repurchases of common stock

 

(498)

 

 

(541)

 

 

 

 

(79,947)

Tax benefit of stock options

 

950 

 

 

 

 

3,927 

 

 

2,513 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

(144,756)

 

 

6,708,979 

 

 

25,263 

 

 

(134,714)

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

 

277,786 

 

 

100,209 

 

 

160,327 

 

 

(11,321)

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

 

100,209 

 

 

 

 

189,288 

 

 

200,609 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

$

377,995 

 

$

100,209 

 

$

349,615 

 

$

189,288 



65






Supplemental cash flow information:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash paid (received) for:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest

$

377,022 

 

$

226,738 

 

$

11,246 

 

$

24,180 

Income taxes

$

7,091 

 

$

(30,574)

 

$

26,012 

 

$

155,825 

Supplemental schedule of noncash investing and financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of property and equipment awaiting processing for payment, included in Accounts payable


$

7,474 

 

$

20,449 

 

$

13,544 

 

$

18,094 

Purchases of property and equipment under capital lease obligations

$

3,806 

 

$

592 

 

$

1,036 

 

$

5,366 

Expiration of equity repurchase rights

$

2,548 

 

$

 

$

 

$

Exchange of shares and stock options in business combination

$

 

$

7,685 

 

$

 

$

Elimination of financing obligations (See Note 8)

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

46,608 

Elimination of promissory notes receivable (See Note 8)

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

46,608 


(a)

Includes the cash flows of Buck Acquisition Corp. for the period prior to its Merger with and into Dollar General Corporation from March 6, 2007 (its formation) through July 6, 2007 (which were zero), and the post-Merger results of Dollar General Corporation for the period from July 7, 2007 through February 1, 2008.  See Notes 1 and 2.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the consolidated financial statements.



66



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS


1.

Basis of presentation and accounting policies


Basis of presentation


These notes contain references to the years 2008 and 2006, which represent fiscal years ended January 30, 2009 and February 2, 2007, respectively, each of which were 52-week accounting periods. The Company completed a merger transaction on July 6, 2007 and therefore the 2007 presentation includes separate presentation of the periods before and after the merger. The Company’s fiscal year ends on the Friday closest to January 31. The consolidated financial statements include all subsidiaries of the Company, except for its not-for-profit subsidiary which the Company does not control.  Intercompany transactions have been eliminated.


Dollar General Corporation (the “Company”) was acquired on July 6, 2007 through a Merger (as defined and discussed in greater detail in Note 2 below) accounted for as a reverse acquisition.  Although the Company continued as the same legal entity after the Merger, the accompanying consolidated financial statements are presented for the “Predecessor” and “Successor” relating to the periods preceding and succeeding the Merger, respectively.  As a result of the Company applying purchase accounting and a new basis of accounting beginning on July 7, 2007, the financial reporting periods presented are as follows:


·

The 2008 presentation reflects the Successor.


·

The 2007 periods presented include the Predecessor period of the Company, reflecting 22 weeks of operating results from February 3, 2007 to July 6, 2007 and 30 weeks of operating results for the Successor period, reflecting the Merger of the Company and Buck Acquisition Corp. (“Buck”) from July 7, 2007 to February 1, 2008.  


·

Buck’s results of operations for the period from March 6, 2007 to July 6, 2007 (prior to the Merger on July 6, 2007) are also included in the consolidated financial statements for the Successor period described above as a result of certain derivative financial instruments entered into by Buck prior to the Merger, as further described below.  Other than these financial instruments, Buck had no assets, liabilities, or operations prior to the Merger.


·

The 2006 presentation reflects the Predecessor.


The consolidated financial statements for the Predecessor periods have been prepared using the Company’s historical basis of accounting.  As a result of purchase accounting, the pre-Merger and post-Merger consolidated financial statements are not comparable.  


The Company leases three of its distribution centers (“DCs”) from lessors, which meet the definition of a Variable Interest Entity (“VIE”) as described by Financial Accounting



67



Standards Board (“FASB”) Interpretation 46, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities” (“FIN 46”), as revised. One of these DCs has been recorded as a financing obligation whereby the property and equipment are reflected in the consolidated balance sheets.  The land and buildings of the other two DCs have been recorded as operating leases in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) 13, “Accounting for Leases.”  The Company is not the primary beneficiary of these VIEs and, accordingly, has not included these entities in its consolidated financial statements.


Business description


The Company sells general merchandise on a retail basis through 8,362 stores (as of January 30, 2009) in 35 states covering most of the southern, southwestern, midwestern and eastern United States.  The Company has DCs in Scottsville, Kentucky; Ardmore, Oklahoma; South Boston, Virginia; Indianola, Mississippi; Fulton, Missouri; Alachua, Florida; Zanesville, Ohio; Jonesville, South Carolina and Marion, Indiana.


The Company purchases its merchandise from a wide variety of suppliers. Approximately 10% of the Company’s purchases in 2008 were made from The Procter & Gamble Company. The Company’s next largest supplier accounted for approximately 6% of the Company’s purchases in 2008.


Cash and cash equivalents


Cash and cash equivalents include highly liquid investments with insignificant interest rate risk and original maturities of three months or less when purchased.  Such investments primarily consist of money market funds, certificates of deposit (which may include foreign time deposits), and commercial paper.  The carrying amounts of these items are a reasonable estimate of their fair value due to the short maturity of these investments. The Company held foreign time deposits of $0 and $5.2 million as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively.


Payments due from banks for third-party credit card, debit card and electronic benefit transactions classified as cash and cash equivalents totaled approximately $16.2 million and $13.9 million at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively.


The Company’s cash management system provides for daily investment of available balances and the funding of outstanding checks when presented for payment.  Outstanding but unpresented checks totaling approximately $127.6 million and $107.9 million at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively, have been included in Accounts payable in the consolidated balance sheets.  Upon presentation for payment, these checks are funded through available cash balances or the Company’s credit facilities.


The Company has certain cash and cash equivalents balances that are being held in accordance with certain insurance-related regulatory requirements which could limit the Company’s ability to use these assets for general corporate purposes, as further described below under “Investments in debt and equity securities.”




68



Investments in debt and equity securities


The Company accounts for its investment in debt and marketable equity securities in accordance with SFAS 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities,” and accordingly, classifies them as held-to-maturity, available-for-sale, or trading.  Debt securities categorized as held-to-maturity are stated at amortized cost.  Debt and equity securities categorized as available-for-sale are stated at fair value, with any unrealized gains and losses, net of deferred income taxes, reported as a component of Accumulated other comprehensive loss.  Trading securities (primarily mutual funds held pursuant to deferred compensation and supplemental retirement plans, as further discussed in Note 9) are stated at fair value, with changes in fair value recorded in income as a component of Selling, general and administrative (“SG&A”) expense.


In general, the Company invests excess cash in shorter-dated, highly liquid investments such as money market funds, certificates of deposit, and commercial paper.  Such securities have been classified either as held-to-maturity or available-for-sale, depending on the type of securities purchased (debt versus equity) as well as the Company’s intentions with respect to the potential sale of such securities before their stated maturity dates.  Given the short maturities of such investments (except for those securities described in further detail below), the carrying amounts approximate the fair values of such securities.


In years prior to 2007, the Company invested in tax-exempt auction rate securities, which are debt instruments having longer-dated (in some cases, many years) legal maturities, but with interest rates that are generally reset every 28-35 days under an auction system.  There were no such investments outstanding as of January 30, 2009 or February 1, 2008.


In 2008 and 2007, the Company’s South Carolina-based wholly owned captive insurance subsidiary, Ashley River Insurance Company (“ARIC”), had investments in U.S. Government securities, obligations of Government Sponsored Enterprises, short- and long-term corporate obligations, and asset-backed obligations. These investments were held pursuant to South Carolina regulatory requirements to maintain certain asset balances in relation to ARIC’s liability and equity balances which could limit the Company’s ability to use these assets for general corporate purposes. In May 2008, the state of South Carolina made certain changes to these regulatory requirements, which had the effect of reducing the amounts and types of investments required to be held. As a result of these changes, the Company reclassified certain investments held by ARIC from held-to-maturity to available-for-sale, and ARIC subsequently liquidated investments (primarily U.S. Government and corporate debt securities) totaling $48.6 million during 2008. At January 30, 2009, the asset balances held pursuant to these regulatory requirements equaled $20.0 million and were reflected in the Company’s consolidated balance sheet as cash and cash equivalents.


Historical cost information pertaining to investments in mutual funds by participants in the Company’s supplemental retirement and compensation deferral plans classified as trading securities is not readily available to the Company.




69



On January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, held-to-maturity, available-for-sale and trading securities consisted of the following (in thousands):


Successor

January 30, 2009

Cost

 

Gross Unrealized

 

Estimated
Fair Value

Gains

 

Losses

Held-to-maturity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other debt securities (see Note 8)

$

31,388

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

2,442

 

 

$

28,946

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trading securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

8,703

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

8,703

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total debt and equity securities

$

40,091

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

2,442

 

 

$

37,649

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


Successor

February 1, 2008

Cost

 

Gross Unrealized

 

Estimated
Fair Value

Gains

 

Losses

Held-to-maturity securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bank and corporate debt

$

24,254

 

 

$

244

 

 

$

107

 

 

$

24,391

 

U.S. Government securities

 

16,652

 

 

 

676

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

17,328

 

Obligations of Government sponsored enterprises

 

9,834

 

 

 

40

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

9,874

 

Asset-backed securities

 

1,815

 

 

 

21

 

 

 

5

 

 

 

1,831

 

Other debt securities (see Note 8)

 

33,453

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

709

 

 

 

32,744

 

 

 

86,008

 

 

 

981

 

 

 

821

 

 

 

86,168

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trading securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity securities

 

15,066

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

15,066

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total debt and equity securities

$

101,074

 

 

$

981

 

 

$

821

 

 

$

101,234

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

On January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, these investments were included in the following accounts in the consolidated balance sheets (in thousands):


Successor

January 30, 2009

Held-to-Maturity Securities

 

Available-
for-Sale Securities

 

Trading

Securities

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

$

-

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

2,055

 

Other assets, net

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

6,648

 

Long-term obligations (see Note 8)

 

31,388

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

$

31,388

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

8,703

 


Successor

February 1, 2008

Held-to-Maturity Securities

 

Available-
for-Sale Securities

 

Trading

Securities

Cash and cash equivalents

$

1,000

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

-

 

Short-term investments

 

19,611

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

2,166

 

Other assets, net

 

31,944

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

12,900

 

Long-term obligations (see Note 8)

 

33,453

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

$

86,008

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

15,066

 





70



The contractual maturities of held-to-maturity securities as of January 30, 2009 were in excess of three years and were $31.4 million at cost and $28.9 million at fair value, respectively.

For the Successor year ended January 30, 2009 and period ended February 1, 2008, and the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 and year ended February 2, 2007, gross realized gains and losses on the sales of available-for-sale securities were not material.  The cost of securities sold is based upon the specific identification method.


Merchandise inventories


Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market with cost determined using the retail last-in, first-out (“LIFO”) method. Under the Company’s retail inventory method (“RIM”), the calculation of gross profit and the resulting valuation of inventories at cost are computed by applying a calculated cost-to-retail inventory ratio to the retail value of sales at a department level.  Costs directly associated with warehousing and distribution are capitalized into inventory. The excess of current cost over LIFO cost was approximately $50.0 million at January 30, 2009 and $6.1 million at February 1, 2008. Current cost is determined using the retail first-in, first-out method.  The Company’s LIFO reserves were adjusted to zero at July 6, 2007 as a result of the Merger. The Successor recorded LIFO provisions of $43.9 million and $6.1 million during 2008 and 2007, respectively. The Predecessor recorded a LIFO credit of $1.5 million in 2006.

In 2008, the increased commodity cost pressures mainly related to food and pet products which have been driven by fruit and vegetable prices and rising freight costs.  Increases in petroleum, resin, metals, pulp and other raw material commodity driven costs also resulted in multiple product cost increases. The Company intends to address these commodity cost increases through negotiations with its vendors and by increasing retail prices as necessary.  On a quarterly basis, the Company estimates the annual impact of commodity cost fluctuations based upon the best available information at that point in time.   


Store pre-opening costs


Pre-opening costs related to new store openings and the construction periods are expensed as incurred.


Property and equipment


Property and equipment are recorded at cost.  The Company provides for depreciation and amortization on a straight-line basis over the following estimated useful lives:


 

Land improvements

20

 

Buildings

39-40

 

Furniture, fixtures and equipment

3-10


Improvements of leased properties are amortized over the shorter of the life of the applicable lease term or the estimated useful life of the asset.




71



Impairment of long-lived assets


When indicators of impairment are present, the Company evaluates the carrying value of long-lived assets, other than goodwill, in relation to the operating performance and future cash flows or the appraised values of the underlying assets. In accordance with SFAS 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets,” the Company reviews for impairment stores open more than two years for which current cash flows from operations are negative. Impairment results when the carrying value of the assets exceeds the undiscounted future cash flows over the life of the lease. The Company’s estimate of undiscounted future cash flows over the lease term is based upon historical operations of the stores and estimates of future store profitability which encompasses many factors that are subject to variability and difficult to predict. If a long-lived asset is found to be impaired, the amount recognized for impairment is equal to the difference between the carrying value and the asset’s estimated fair value. The fair value is estimated based primarily upon estimated future cash flows (discounted at the Company’s credit adjusted risk-free rate) or other reasonable estimates of fair market value. Assets to be disposed of are adjusted to the fair value less the cost to sell if less than the book value.  


The Company recorded impairment charges included in SG&A expense of approximately $4.0 million in 2008, $0.2 million in the 2007 Predecessor period and $9.4 million in 2006 to reduce the carrying value of certain of its stores’ assets as deemed necessary based on the Company’s evaluation that such amounts would not be recoverable primarily due to insufficient sales or excessive costs resulting in negative current and projected future cash flows at these locations. The majority of the 2006 charges were recorded pursuant to certain strategic initiatives discussed in Note 3.


Goodwill and other intangible assets


The Company amortizes intangible assets over their estimated useful lives unless such lives are deemed indefinite. Amortizable intangible assets are tested for impairment when indicators of impairment are present, based on undiscounted cash flows, and if impaired, written down to fair value based on either discounted cash flows or appraised values.

Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives are tested for impairment annually or more frequently if indicators of impairment are present and written down to fair value as required. No impairment of intangible assets has been identified during any of the periods presented.


The goodwill impairment test is a two-step process that requires management to make judgments in determining what assumptions to use in the calculation. The first step of the process consists of estimating the fair value of the Company’s reporting unit based on valuation techniques (including a discounted cash flow model using revenue and profit forecasts) and comparing that estimated fair value with the recorded carrying value, which includes goodwill. If the estimated fair value is less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to compute the amount of the impairment by determining an “implied fair value” of goodwill. The determination of the “implied fair value” of goodwill would require the Company to allocate the estimated fair value of its reporting unit to its assets and liabilities. Any unallocated fair value would represent



72



the “implied fair value” of goodwill, which would be compared to its corresponding carrying value.  


Other assets


Other assets consist primarily of long-term investments, qualifying prepaid expenses, debt issuance costs which are amortized over the life of the related obligations, and utility and security deposits. Such debt issuance costs increased substantially subsequent to the Merger as further discussed in Notes 2 and 6.


Vendor rebates


The Company accounts for all cash consideration received from vendors in accordance with the provisions of Emerging Issues Task Force Issue (“EITF”) 02-16, “Accounting by a Customer (Including a Reseller) for Certain Consideration Received from a Vendor.” Cash consideration received from a vendor is generally presumed to be a rebate or an allowance and is accounted for as a reduction of merchandise purchase costs and classified as a current or long term liability, as applicable, until recognition in the statement of operations at the time the goods are sold. However, certain specific, incremental and otherwise qualifying SG&A expenses related to the promotion or sale of vendor products may be offset by cash consideration received from vendors, in accordance with arrangements such as cooperative advertising, when earned for dollar amounts up to but not exceeding actual incremental costs. The Company recognizes amounts received for cooperative advertising on performance, “first showing” or distribution, consistent with its policy for advertising expense in accordance with the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Statement of Position 93-7, “Reporting on Advertising Costs.”


Rent expense


Rent expense is recognized over the term of the lease.  The Company records minimum rental expense on a straight-line basis over the base, non-cancelable lease term commencing on the date that the Company takes physical possession of the property from the landlord, which normally includes a period prior to the store opening to make necessary leasehold improvements and install store fixtures.  When a lease contains a predetermined fixed escalation of the minimum rent, the Company recognizes the related rent expense on a straight-line basis and records the difference between the recognized rental expense and the amounts payable under the lease as deferred rent.  Tenant allowances, to the extent received, are recorded as deferred incentive rent and are amortized as a reduction to rent expense over the term of the lease.  Any difference between the calculated expense and the amounts actually paid are reflected as a liability, with the current portion in Accrued expenses and other and the long-term portion in Other liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets, and totaled approximately $7.7 million and $3.7 million at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively.


The Company recognizes contingent rental expense when the achievement of specified sales targets are considered probable, in accordance with EITF Issue 98-9, “Accounting for Contingent Rent.” The amount expensed but not paid as of January 30, 2009 and February 1,



73



2008 was approximately $10.4 million and $8.3 million, respectively, and is included in Accrued expenses and other in the consolidated balance sheets (See Note 8).


In the normal course of business, based on an overall analysis of store performance and expected trends, management periodically evaluates the need to close underperforming stores. Generally, for store closures where a lease obligation still exists, the Company records the estimated future liability associated with the rental obligation on the date the store is closed in accordance with SFAS 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities.” The estimated future liability associated with the rental obligation for certain store closures associated with the Merger were based on EITF 95-3, “Recognition of Liabilities in Connection with a Purchase Business Combination.” Key assumptions in calculating the liability include the timeframe expected to terminate lease agreements, estimates related to the sublease potential of closed locations, and estimation of other related exit costs. Liabilities are reviewed periodically and adjusted when necessary.  The current portion of the closed store rent liability is reflected in Accrued expenses and other and the long-term portion in Other liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets, and totaled approximately $13.2 million at January 30, 2009 and $20.2 million at February 1, 2008.


Accrued expenses and other liabilities


Accrued expenses and other consist of the following:


 

Successor

(In thousands)

January 30,

2009

 

February 1,

2008

Compensation and benefits

$

87,451

 

$

60,720

Insurance

 

65,524

 

 

64,418

Taxes (other than taxes on income)

 

66,983

 

 

55,990

Other

 

155,087

 

 

119,828

 

$

375,045

 

$

300,956


Other accrued expenses primarily include the current portion of liabilities for legal settlements, freight expense, contingent rent expense, interest, electricity, lease contract termination liabilities for closed stores, common area and other maintenance charges, store insurance liabilities and income tax related reserves.


Insurance liabilities


The Company retains a significant portion of risk for its workers’ compensation, employee health, general liability, property and automobile claim exposures.  Accordingly, provisions are made for the Company’s estimates of such risks.  The undiscounted future claim costs for the workers’ compensation, general liability, and health claim risks are derived using actuarial methods.  To the extent that subsequent claim costs vary from those estimates, future results of operations will be affected. Ashley River Insurance Company (or ARIC, as defined above), a South Carolina-based wholly owned captive insurance subsidiary of the Company, charges the operating subsidiary companies premiums to insure the retained workers’ compensation and non-property general liability exposures.  Pursuant to South Carolina insurance regulations, ARIC has cash and cash equivalents balances that may be limited for



74



general corporate purposes, as further described above under “Investments in debt and equity securities.” ARIC currently insures no unrelated third-party risk.


As a result of the Merger, the Company recorded its assumed self-insurance reserves as of the Merger date at their present value in accordance with SFAS 141, “Business Combinations”, using a discount rate of 5.4%. The balance of the resulting discount was $11.7 million and $18.7 million at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively. Other than for reserves assumed in a business combination, the Company’s policy is to record self-insurance reserves on an undiscounted basis.


Other liabilities


Other non-current liabilities consist of the following:


 

Successor

(In thousands)

January 30,

2009

 

February 1,

2008

Compensation and benefits

$

8,399

 

$

13,744

Insurance

 

139,410

 

 

123,276

Income tax related reserves

 

44,990

 

 

78,277

Derivatives

 

63,523

 

 

82,319

Other

 

32,966

 

 

22,098

 

$

289,288

 

$

319,714


Other liabilities consist primarily of deferred rent, lease contract termination liabilities for closed stores, leasehold interests liabilities, and rebate obligations.  


Fair value accounting


On February 2, 2008, the Company adopted components of SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements”.  The Company has not adopted SFAS 157 for nonfinancial assets and liabilities. SFAS 157 defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring fair value, and expands disclosures about fair value measurements.  SFAS 157 applies to reported balances that are required or permitted to be measured at fair value under existing accounting pronouncements. Accordingly, the standard does not require any new fair value measurements of reported balances.


SFAS 157 emphasizes that fair value is a market-based measurement, not an entity-specific measurement.  Therefore, a fair value measurement should be determined based on the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability.  As a basis for considering market participant assumptions in fair value measurements, SFAS 157 establishes a fair value hierarchy that distinguishes between market participant assumptions based on market data obtained from sources independent of the reporting entity (observable inputs that are classified within Levels 1 and 2 of the hierarchy) and the reporting entity’s own assumptions about market participant assumptions (unobservable inputs classified within Level 3 of the hierarchy).




75



Level 1 inputs utilize quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the Company has the ability to access. Level 2 inputs are inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1 that are directly or indirectly observable for the asset or liability. Level 2 inputs may include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets, as well as inputs that are observable for the asset or liability (other than quoted prices), such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, and yield curves that are observable at commonly quoted intervals. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability, which are based on an entity’s own assumptions, as there is little, if any, related market activity. In instances where the determination of the fair value measurement is based on inputs from different levels of the fair value hierarchy, the level in the fair value hierarchy within which the entire fair value measurement falls is based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement in its entirety. The Company’s assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires judgment and considers factors specific to the asset or liability.


The valuation of the Company’s derivative financial instruments is determined using widely accepted valuation techniques, including discounted cash flow analysis on the expected cash flows of each derivative. This analysis reflects the contractual terms of the derivatives, including the period to maturity, and uses observable market-based inputs, including interest rate curves.  The fair values of interest rate swaps are determined using the market standard methodology of netting the discounted future fixed cash payments (or receipts) and the discounted expected variable cash receipts (or payments).  The variable cash receipts (or payments) are based on an expectation of future interest rates (forward curves) derived from observable market interest rate curves. 


To comply with the provisions of SFAS 157, the Company incorporates credit valuation adjustments (CVAs) to appropriately reflect both its own nonperformance risk and the respective counterparty’s nonperformance risk in the fair value measurements.  In adjusting the fair value of its derivative contracts for the effect of nonperformance risk, the Company has considered the impact of netting and any applicable credit enhancements, such as collateral postings, thresholds, mutual puts, and guarantees.


Although the Company has determined that the majority of the inputs used to value its derivatives fall within Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy, the CVAs associated with its derivatives utilize Level 3 inputs, such as estimates of current credit spreads to evaluate the likelihood of default by itself and its counterparties.  However, as of January 30, 2009, the Company has assessed the significance of the impact of the CVAs on the overall valuation of its derivative positions and has determined that the CVAs are not significant to the overall valuation of its derivatives. Based on the Company's review of the CVAs by counterparty portfolio, the Company has determined that the CVAs are not significant to the overall portfolio valuations, as the CVAs are deemed to be immaterial in terms of basis points and are a very small percentage of the aggregate notional value.  Although some of the CVAs as a percentage of termination value appear to be more significant, primary emphasis was placed on a review of the CVA in basis points and the percentage of the notional value. As a result, the Company has determined that its derivative valuations in their entirety are classified in Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.




76



The following table presents the Company’s assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of January 30, 2009, aggregated by the level in the fair value hierarchy within which those measurements fall.


(In thousands)

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets and Liabilities
(Level 1)

Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)

Balance at
January 30, 2009

Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trading securities (a)

 

8,703 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,703 

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments (b)

 

 

 

63,523 

 

 

 

 

63,523 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(a)

Reflected in the consolidated balance sheet as Prepaid expenses and other current assets of $2,055 and Other assets, net of $6,648.

(b)

Reflected in the consolidated balance sheet as Other (noncurrent) liabilities.


The Company does not have any fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) as of January 30, 2009.


The carrying amounts reflected in the consolidated balance sheets for cash, cash equivalents, short-term investments, receivables and payables approximate their respective fair values.  At January 30, 2009, the fair value of the Company’s debt, excluding capital lease obligations, was approximately $3.747 billion, or approximately $380.1 million less than the carrying values of the debt, compared to a fair value of $3.783 billion at February 1, 2008, or approximately $489.2 million less than the carrying value. The estimated fair value of the debt is based primarily on quoted prices for those or similar instruments.


Derivative financial instruments


The Company accounts for derivative financial instruments in accordance with SFAS No. 133 “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”, as amended and interpreted (collectively, “SFAS 133”). This literature requires the Company to recognize all derivative instruments on the balance sheet at fair value, and contains accounting rules for hedging instruments, which depend on the nature of the hedge relationship. All financial instrument positions taken by the Company are intended to be used to reduce risk by hedging an underlying economic exposure.


The Company’s derivative financial instruments, in the form of interest rate swaps at January 30, 2009, are related to variable interest rate risk exposures associated with the Company’s long-term debt and were entered into in an attempt to manage that risk. The counterparties to the Company’s derivative agreements are all major international financial institutions. The Company continually monitors its position and the credit ratings of its counterparties and does not anticipate nonperformance by the counterparties, however, there can be no assurance that such nonperformance will not occur.




77



Share-based payments


Effective February 4, 2006, the Company adopted SFAS 123 (Revised 2004) “Share Based Payment” (“SFAS 123(R)”) and began recognizing compensation expense for share-based compensation based on the fair value of the awards on the grant date. SFAS 123(R) requires share-based compensation expense recognized since February 4, 2006 to be based on: (a) grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the original provisions of SFAS 123, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation,” for unvested options granted prior to the adoption date and (b) grant date fair value estimated in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 123(R) for unvested options granted after the adoption date. The Company adopted SFAS 123(R) under the modified-prospective-transition method and, therefore, results from prior periods have not been restated.


Under SFAS 123(R), forfeitures are estimated at the time of valuation and reduce expense ratably over the vesting period. This estimate is adjusted periodically based on the extent to which actual forfeitures differ, or are expected to differ, from the prior estimate. The forfeiture rate is the estimated percentage of options granted that are expected to be forfeited or canceled before becoming fully vested. The Company bases this estimate on historical experience or estimates of future trends, as applicable. An increase in the forfeiture rate will decrease compensation expense.


SFAS 123(R) also requires the benefits of tax deductions in excess of recognized compensation cost to be reported as a financing cash flow, rather than as an operating cash flow as required prior to the adoption of SFAS 123(R).


The fair value of each option grant is separately estimated and amortized into compensation expense on a straight-line basis between the applicable grant date and each vesting date. The Company has estimated the fair value of all stock option awards as of the grant date by applying the Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing valuation model. The application of this valuation model involves assumptions that are judgmental and highly sensitive in the determination of compensation expense.


The Company also accounts for nonvested restricted stock awards in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 123(R). The Company calculates compensation expense as the difference between the market price of the underlying stock on the grant date and the purchase price, if any, and recognizes such amount on a straight-line basis over the period in which the recipient earns the nonvested restricted stock and restricted stock unit award. Under the provisions of SFAS 123(R), unearned compensation is not recorded within shareholders’ equity.


The Company has elected to determine its excess tax benefit pool upon adoption of SFAS 123(R) in accordance with the provisions of FASB Staff Position (“FSP”) 123(R)-3, “Transition Election Related to Accounting for the Tax Effects of Share-Based Payment Awards.” Under the provisions of this FSP, the cumulative benefit of stock option exercises included in additional paid-in capital for the periods after the effective date of SFAS 123 is reduced by the cumulative income tax effect of the pro forma stock option expense previously disclosed in accordance with the requirements of SFAS 123. (The provision of this FSP applied only to options that were fully vested before the date of adoption of SFAS 123(R). The amount of any excess tax benefit for



78



options that are either granted after the adoption of SFAS 123(R) or are partially vested on the date of adoption were computed in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 123(R).) The amount of any excess deferred tax asset over the actual income tax benefit realized for options that are exercised after the adoption of SFAS 123(R) will be absorbed by the excess tax benefit pool. Income tax expense will be increased should the Company’s excess tax benefit pool be insufficient to absorb any future deferred tax asset amounts in excess of the actual tax benefit realized. The Company has determined that its excess tax benefit pool was approximately $68 million as of the adoption of SFAS 123(R) on February 4, 2006.  After the Merger and the related application of purchase accounting, the excess tax benefit pool has been reduced to zero.


Revenue and gain recognition


The Company recognizes retail sales in its stores at the time the customer takes possession of merchandise.  All sales are net of discounts and estimated returns and are presented net of taxes assessed by governmental authorities that are imposed concurrent with those sales.  The liability for retail merchandise returns is based on the Company’s prior experience. The Company records gain contingencies when realized.


The Company recognizes gift card sales revenue at the time of redemption.  The liability for the gift cards is established for the cash value at the time of purchase. The liability for outstanding gift cards was approximately $1.5 million and $1.2 million at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively, and is recorded in Accrued expenses and other. Through January 30, 2009, the Company has not recorded any breakage income related to its gift card program.


Advertising costs


Advertising costs are expensed upon performance, “first showing” or distribution, and are reflected net of qualifying cooperative advertising funds provided by vendors in SG&A expenses. Advertising costs were $27.8 million, $23.6 million, $17.3 million and $45.0 million in 2008, the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, and 2006, respectively.  These costs primarily include promotional circulars, targeted circulars supporting new stores, television and radio advertising, in-store signage, and costs associated with the sponsorships of certain automobile racing activities. Vendor funding for cooperative advertising offset reported expenses by $7.8 million, $6.6 million, $2.0 million and $7.9 million in 2008, the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, and 2006, respectively.


Capitalized interest


To assure that interest costs properly reflect only that portion relating to current operations, interest on borrowed funds during the construction of property and equipment is capitalized.  Interest costs capitalized were equal to zero in 2008 and the 2007 periods, and were approximately $2.9 million in 2006.




79



Income taxes


The Company reports income taxes in accordance with SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes” (“SFAS 109”).  Under SFAS 109, the asset and liability method is used for computing the future income tax consequences of events that have been recognized in the Company’s consolidated financial statements or income tax returns.  Deferred income tax expense or benefit is the net change during the year in the Company’s deferred income tax assets and liabilities.


As discussed in Note 5, effective February 3, 2007 the Predecessor modified its method of accounting for income taxes in connection with the adoption of FASB Interpretation 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – An Interpretation of FASB Statement 109 (“FIN 48”). The adoption resulted in an $8.9 million decrease in retained earnings and a reclassification of certain amounts between deferred income taxes and other noncurrent liabilities to conform to the balance sheet presentation requirements of FIN 48. As of the date of adoption, the total reserve for uncertain tax benefits was $77.9 million. This reserve excludes the federal income tax benefit for the uncertain tax positions related to state income taxes, which is now included in deferred tax assets. As a result of the adoption of FIN 48, the reserve for interest expense related to income taxes was increased to $15.3 million and a reserve for potential penalties of $1.9 million related to uncertain income tax positions was recorded. As of the date of adoption, approximately $27.1 million of the reserve for uncertain tax positions would have impacted the Company’s effective income tax rate subsequently if the Company were to recognize the tax benefit for these positions.


Subsequent to the adoption of FIN 48, the Company has elected to record income tax related interest and penalties as a component of the provision for income tax expense.


Income tax reserves are determined using the methodology established by FIN 48.  FIN 48 requires companies to assess each income tax position taken using a two step process.  A determination is first made as to whether it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained, based upon the technical merits, upon examination by the taxing authorities.  If the tax position is expected to meet the more likely than not criteria, the benefit recorded for the tax position equals the largest amount that is greater than 50% likely to be realized upon ultimate settlement of the respective tax position.  Uncertain tax positions require determinations and estimated liabilities to be made based on provisions of the tax law which may be subject to change or varying interpretation.  If the Company’s determinations and estimates prove to be inaccurate, the resulting adjustments could be material to the Company’s future financial results.


Management estimates


The preparation of financial statements and related disclosures in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting periods.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.



80



Accounting pronouncements


In March 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 161, “Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities”, an amendment of FASB Statement 133. SFAS 161 applies to all derivative instruments and nonderivative instruments that are designated and qualify as hedging instruments pursuant to paragraphs 37 and 42 of SFAS 133 and related hedged items accounted for under SFAS 133. SFAS 161 requires entities to provide greater transparency through additional disclosures about how and why an entity uses derivative instruments, how derivative instruments and related hedged items are accounted for under SFAS 133 and its related interpretations, and how derivative instruments and related hedged items affect an entity’s financial position, results of operations, and cash flows. SFAS 161 is effective as of the beginning of an entity’s first fiscal year that begins after November 15, 2008.  The Company plans to adopt SFAS 161 during the first quarter of 2009 and its impact is expected to be limited to the additional disclosures discussed above.


In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 141(R), “Business Combinations”. The new standard establishes the requirements for how an acquirer recognizes and measures in its financial statements the identifiable assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and any non-controlling interest (formerly minority interest) in an acquiree; provides updated requirements for recognition and measurement of goodwill acquired in the business combination or a gain from a bargain purchase; and provides updated disclosure requirements to enable users of financial statements to evaluate the nature and financial effects of the business combination. This Statement applies prospectively to business combinations for which the acquisition date is on or after the beginning of the first annual reporting period beginning on or after December 15, 2008. Early adoption is not allowed.  Unless a qualifying transaction is consummated subsequent to the effective date, the adoption of this standard on the Company’s financial statements is expected to be limited to any future Merger-related adjustments to uncertain tax positions that would, if subsequently recognized, impact results of operations rather than goodwill.


In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS 157, “Fair Value Measurements.” SFAS 157 provides guidance for using fair value to measure assets and liabilities. The standard also requires expanded information about the extent to which companies measure assets and liabilities at fair value, the information used to measure fair value, and the effect of fair value measurements on earnings. The standard applies whenever other standards require (or permit) assets or liabilities to be measured at fair value. The standard does not expand the use of fair value in any new circumstances. SFAS 157 is effective for financial statements issued for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007, and interim periods within those fiscal years. For non-financial assets and liabilities, the effective date has been delayed to fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008. The Company adopted components of SFAS 157 in 2008 and currently expects to adopt the components of SFAS 157 relating to nonfinancial assets and liabilities during 2009. The Company is in the process of evaluating the potential impact of this standard on its consolidated financial statements.







81



Reclassifications


Certain reclassifications of the 2006 and 2007 amounts have been made to conform to the 2008 presentation.


2.

Merger


On March 11, 2007, the Company entered into an Agreement and Plan of Merger (the “Merger Agreement”) with Buck Holdings L.P., a Delaware limited partnership (“Parent”), and Buck, a Tennessee corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of Parent.  Parent is and Buck was (prior to the Merger) controlled by investment funds affiliated with Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., L.P. (“KKR”).  On July 6, 2007, the transaction was consummated through a merger (the “Merger”) of Buck with and into the Company. The Company survived the Merger as a subsidiary of Parent.  The Company’s results of operations after July 6, 2007 include the effects of the Merger.  


The aggregate purchase price was approximately $7.1 billion, including direct costs of the Merger, and was funded primarily through debt financings as described more fully below in Note 6 and cash equity contributions from KKR, GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P. and affiliated funds (affiliates of Goldman, Sachs & Co.), Citi Private Equity, Wellington Management Company, LLP, CPP Investment Board (USRE II) Inc., and other equity co-investors (collectively, the “Investors”) of approximately $2.8 billion (553.4 million shares of new common stock, $0.50 par value per share, valued at $5.00 per share).  Also in connection with the Merger, certain of the Company’s management employees invested in and were issued new shares, representing less than 1% of the outstanding shares, in the Company.  Pursuant to the terms of the Merger Agreement, the former holders of the Predecessor’s common stock, par value $0.50 per share, received $22.00 per share, or approximately $6.9 billion, and all such shares were acquired as a result of the Merger. As of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, there were approximately 556,227,947 and 555,481,897 shares of Company common stock outstanding, respectively, a portion of which is redeemable as further discussed below in Note 10.


As discussed in Note 1, the Merger was accounted for as a reverse acquisition in accordance with the purchase accounting provisions of SFAS 141, “Business Combinations”.  Because of this accounting treatment, the Company’s assets and liabilities have properly been accounted for at their estimated fair values as of the Merger date.  The aggregate purchase price has been allocated to the tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based upon an assessment of their relative fair values as of the Merger date.




82



The allocation of the purchase price is as follows (in thousands):


Cash and cash equivalents

$

349,615 

Short-term investments

 

30,906 

Merchandise inventories

 

1,368,130 

Income taxes receivable

 

40,199 

Deferred income taxes

 

57,176 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

63,204 

Property and equipment, net

 

1,301,119 

Goodwill

 

4,338,589 

Intangible assets

 

1,396,612 

Other assets, net

 

66,537 

Current portion of long-term obligations

 

(7,088)

Accounts payable

 

(585,518)

Accrued expenses and other

 

(306,394)

Income taxes payable

 

(84)

Long-term obligations

 

(267,927)

Deferred income taxes

 

(540,675)

Other liabilities

 

(208,710)

Total purchase price assigned

$

7,095,691 


The purchase price allocation as of January 30, 2009 included approximately $4.34 billion of goodwill, none of which is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.  The goodwill balance at February 1, 2008 increased by $21.3 million over the balance immediately following the Merger, representing a refinement of the purchase price allocation related to the Merger. The goodwill balance at January 30, 2009 decreased $6.3 million from February 1, 2008 due to an adjustment to income tax contingencies as further discussed in Note 5. The purchase price allocation as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 also included approximately $1.4 billion of other intangible assets, as follows:


 

As of January 30, 2009

(In thousands)

Estimated
Useful Life

 

 

Amount

 

 

Accumulated

Amortization

 

 

Net

Leasehold interests

2 to 17.5 years

 

$

184,570

 

$

64,020

 

$

120,550

Internally developed software

3 years

 

 

12,300

 

 

6,492

 

 

5,808

 

 

 

 

196,870

 

 

70,512

 

 

126,358

Trade names and trademarks

Indefinite

 

 

1,199,200

 

 

-

 

 

1,199,200

 

 

 

$

1,396,070

 

$

70,512

 

$

1,325,558


 

As of February 1, 2008

(In thousands)

Estimated
Useful Life

 

 

Amount

 

 

Accumulated

Amortization

 

 

Net

Leasehold interests

2 to 17.5 years

 

$

185,112

 

$

23,663

 

$

161,449

Internally developed software

3 years

 

 

12,300

 

 

2,392

 

 

9,908

 

 

 

 

197,412

 

 

26,055

 

 

171,357

Trade names and trademarks

Indefinite

 

 

1,199,200

 

 

-

 

 

1,199,200

 

 

 

$

1,396,612

 

$

26,055

 

$

1,370,557


The Company recorded amortization expense related to amortizable intangible assets for 2008 and the 2007 Successor period of $45.0 million and $26.1 million, respectively, ($40.9 million and $23.7 million, respectively, of which is included in rent expense).




83



For intangible assets subject to amortization, the estimated aggregate amortization expense for each of the five succeeding fiscal years is as follows: 2009 - $41.1 million, 2010 - $27.3 million, 2011 - $20.9 million, 2012 - $17.0 million, and 2013 - $12.0 million.


Fees and expenses related to the Merger totaled $102.6 million, principally consisting of investment banking fees, legal fees and stock compensation ($39.4 million as further discussed in Note 10), and are reflected in the 2007 results of operations.  Capitalized debt issuance costs as of the Merger date of $87.4 million for Merger-related financing were reflected in other long-term assets in the consolidated balance sheet.


The following represents the unaudited pro forma results of the Company’s consolidated operations as if the Merger had occurred on February 3, 2007 and February 4, 2006, respectively, after giving effect to certain adjustments, including the depreciation and amortization of the assets acquired based on their estimated fair values and changes in interest expense resulting from changes in consolidated debt (in thousands):


(In thousands)

Year Ended February 1,

 2008

 

Year ended February 2, 2007

Revenue

$

9,495,246 

 

$

9,169,822 

Net loss

 

(57,939)

 

 

(156,188)


The pro forma information does not purport to be indicative of what the Company’s results of operations would have been if the acquisition had in fact occurred at the beginning of the periods presented, and is not intended to be a projection of the Company’s future results of operations.


Subsequent to the announcement of the Merger Agreement, the Company and its directors, along with other parties, were named in seven putative class actions filed in Tennessee state courts alleging claims for breach of fiduciary duty arising out of the proposed Merger, all as described more fully under “Legal Proceedings” in Note 8 below.   


3.

Strategic initiatives


During 2006, the Company began implementing certain strategic initiatives related to its historical inventory management and real estate strategies, as more fully described below.  


Inventory management


In November 2006, the Company undertook an initiative to discontinue its historical inventory packaway model for virtually all merchandise by the end of fiscal 2007. Under the packaway model, certain unsold inventory items (primarily seasonal merchandise) were stored on-site and returned to the sales floor until the items were eventually sold, damaged or discarded. Through end-of-season and other markdowns, this initiative resulted in the elimination of seasonal, home products and basic clothing packaway merchandise to allow for increased levels of newer, current-season merchandise.  In connection with this strategic change, in the third quarter of 2006 the Company recorded a reserve for lower of cost or market inventory



84



impairment estimates of $63.5 million and incurred higher markdowns and writedowns on inventory in the second half of 2006 and in 2007 than in comparable prior-year periods.  As a result of the Merger and in accordance with SFAS 141, the Company’s inventory balances, including the inventory associated with this strategic change, were adjusted to fair value and the related reserve was eliminated.  


Exit and disposal activities


In November 2006, the Company decided to close, in addition to those stores that might be closed in the ordinary course of business, approximately 400 stores by the end of fiscal 2007, all of which were closed by February 1, 2008.  Additionally, in connection with the Merger, management approved and completed a plan to close an additional 60 stores prior to February 1, 2008.  The Company has recorded the following pre-tax costs associated with the closing of these approximately 460 stores (in millions):


 

Total (a)

Incurred in 2006

Incurred in 2007

Merger Additions (b)

Incurred in 2008

Remaining

Lease contract termination costs (c)

$

38.1

 

$

5.7

 

$

16.3

 

$

12.3

 

$

3.8 

 

$

-

 

One-time employee termination benefits

 

1.0

 

 

0.3

 

 

0.5

 

 

0.2

 

 

 

 

-

 

Other associated store closing costs

 

8.4

 

 

0.2

 

 

7.2

 

 

1.2

 

 

(0.2)

 

 

-

 

Inventory liquidation fees

 

4.4

 

 

1.6

 

 

2.8

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

-

 

Asset impairment & accelerated depreciation

 

12.8

 

 

8.3

 

 

3.6

 

 

0.9

 

 

 

 

-

 

Inventory markdowns below cost

 

8.3

 

 

6.7

 

 

0.9

 

 

0.7

 

 

 

 

-

 

Total

$

73.0

 

$

22.8

 

$

31.3

 

$

15.3

 

$

3.6 

 

$

-

 


(a)

Reflects amounts as of January 30, 2009, which, in total, are $3.6 million greater than estimates as of February 1, 2008.

(b)

These amounts were recorded as assumed liabilities in connection with the Merger.

(c)

Including reversals of deferred rent accruals totaling $0.5 million, of which $0.1 million is reflected in 2006, and $0.4 million is reflected in 2007.  Excludes accretion expense to be incurred in future periods.  


Other associated store closing costs as listed in the table above primarily include the removal of any usable assets as well as real estate consulting and other services.


Liability balances related to exit activities discussed above are as follows (in millions):


 

Balance,
February 1,
2008

2008

 Expenses (a)

2008 Payments and Other

Balance, January 30, 2009

Lease contract termination costs

$

20.1

 

$

3.8 

 

$

11.3

 

$

12.6

 

Other associated store closing costs (b)

 

1.0

 

 

(0.2)

 

 

0.7

 

 

0.1

 

Total

$

21.1

 

$

3.6 

 

$

12.0

 

$

12.7

 


(a)

2008 expenses associated with exit and disposal activities are included in selling, general and administrative (“SG&A”) expenses in the consolidated statement of operations.

(b)

Primarily represents store closing costs including removal of store fixtures.



85



4.

Property and equipment


Property and equipment is recorded at cost and summarized as follows:


(In thousands)

Successor

January 30, 2009

 

February 1, 2008

Land and land improvements

$

137,779

 

$

137,539 

Buildings

 

518,933

 

 

516,482 

Leasehold improvements

 

117,846

 

 

87,343 

Furniture, fixtures and equipment

 

781,425

 

 

645,376 

Construction in progress

 

5,025

 

 

2,823 

 

 

1,561,008

 

 

1,389,563 

Less accumulated depreciation and amortization

 

292,048

 

 

115,318 

Net property and equipment

$

1,268,960

 

$

1,274,245 


Depreciation expense related to property and equipment was approximately $190.5 million for 2008, $116.9 million for the 2007 Successor period, $83.5 million for the 2007 Predecessor period, and $199.6 million for 2006.  Amortization of capital lease assets is included in depreciation expense.


5.

Income taxes


The provision (benefit) for income taxes consists of the following:


 

Successor

 

Predecessor

(In thousands)

2008

March 6, 2007
through
February 1, 2008

 

February 3, 2007
through
July 6, 2007

 

2006

Current:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal

$

10,489 

 

$

(25,726)

 

$

31,114 

 

$

101,919 

Foreign

 

1,084 

 

 

409 

 

 

495 

 

 

1,200 

State

 

1,214 

 

 

4,306 

 

 

1,258 

 

 

17,519 

 

 

12,787 

 

 

(21,011)

 

 

32,867 

 

 

120,638 

Deferred:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal

 

64,403 

 

 

22,157 

 

 

(18,750)

 

 

(34,807)

Foreign

 

(3)

 

 

 

 

 

 

13 

State

 

9,034 

 

 

(2,921)

 

 

(2,124)

 

 

(3,424)

 

 

73,434 

 

 

19,236 

 

 

(20,874)

 

 

(38,218)

 

$

86,221 

 

$

(1,775)

 

$

11,993 

 

$

82,420 



86



A reconciliation between actual income taxes and amounts computed by applying the federal statutory rate to income before income taxes is summarized as follows:


 

Successor

 

Predecessor

(Dollars in thousands)

2008

March 6, 2007 through
February 1, 2008

 

February 3, 2007

through

July 6, 2007

2006

U.S. federal statutory rate on earnings before income taxes

$

68,041 

35.0 

%

$

(2,308)

35.0 

%

$

1,399 

35.0 

%

$

77,127 

35.0 

%

State income taxes, net of federal income tax benefit

 

5,361 

2.8 

 

 

904 

(13.7)

 

 

(1,135)

(28.4)

 

 

5,855 

2.7 

 

Jobs credits, net of federal income taxes

 

(9,149)

(4.7)

 

 

(3,022)

45.8 

 

 

(2,227)

(55.7)

 

 

(5,008)

(2.3)

 

Increase (decrease)
in valuation allowances

 

3,038 

1.6 

 

 

 

 

551 

13.8 

 

 

3,211 

1.5 

 

Income tax related interest expense, net of federal income tax benefit

 

(2,015)

(1.0)

 

 

2,738 

(41.5)

 

 

(172)

(4.3)

 

 

 

Nondeductible Merger- related lawsuit settlement

 

18,130 

9.3 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Nondeductible transaction costs

 

 

 

 

 

13,501 

337.9 

 

 

 

Other, net

 

2,815 

1.4 

 

 

(87)

1.3 

 

 

76 

1.9 

 

 

1,235 

0.5 

 

 

$

86,221 

44.4 

%

$

(1,775)

26.9 

%

$

11,993 

300.2 

%

$

82,420 

37.4 

%


The 2008 effective income tax rate is an expense of 44.4%.  This expense is greater than the expected U.S. statutory tax rate of 35% principally due to the non-deductibility of the settlement and related expenses associated with the Merger-related shareholder lawsuit.

The income tax rate for the Successor period ended February 1, 2008 is a benefit of 26.9%.  This benefit is less than the expected U.S. statutory rate of 35% due to the incurrence of state income taxes in several of the group’s subsidiaries that file their state income tax returns on a separate entity basis and the election to include, effective February 3, 2007, income tax related interest and penalties in the amount reported as income tax expense.


The income tax rate for the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 is an expense of 300.2%.  This expense is higher than the expected U.S. statutory rate of 35% due principally to the non-deductibility of certain acquisition related expenses.


The 2006 income tax rate was higher than the U.S. statutory rate of 35% principally due to state income taxes.


Deferred taxes reflect the effects of temporary differences between carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes. Significant components of the Company’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows:



87






(In thousands)

Successor

January 30,
2009

 

 

February 1,
2008

Deferred tax assets:

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred compensation expense

$

5,350 

 

$

6,254 

Accrued expenses and other

 

4,815 

 

 

4,379 

Accrued rent

 

4,830 

 

 

5,909 

Accrued insurance

 

66,091 

 

 

61,887 

Accrued bonuses

 

23,016 

 

 

100 

Interest rate hedges

 

25,327 

 

 

30,891 

Tax benefit of FIN 48 income tax and interest reserves

 

11,859 

 

 

16,209 

Other

 

12,021 

 

 

9,947 

State tax net operating loss carryforwards, net of federal tax

 

9,252 

 

 

10,342 

State tax credit carryforwards, net of federal tax

 

13,545 

 

 

8,727 

 

 

176,106 

 

 

154,645 

Less valuation allowances

 

(9,808)

 

 

(1,560)

Total deferred tax assets

 

166,298 

 

 

153,085 

Deferred tax liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

Property and equipment

 

(156,591)

 

 

(108,675)

Inventories

 

(38,901)

 

 

(20,291)

Trademarks

 

(431,654)

 

 

(428,627)

Amortizable assets

 

(47,446)

 

 

(64,419)

Insurance related tax method change

 

(42,641)

 

 

Other

 

(566)

 

 

(501)

Total deferred tax liabilities

 

(717,799)

 

 

(622,513)

Net deferred tax liabilities

$

(551,501)

 

$

(469,428)


Net deferred tax liabilities are reflected separately on the consolidated balance sheets as current and noncurrent deferred income taxes. The following table summarizes net deferred tax liabilities as recorded in the consolidated balance sheets:


(In thousands)

Successor

January 30,
2009

 

February 1, 2008

Current deferred income tax assets, net

$

4,600

 

$

17,297 

Noncurrent deferred income tax liabilities, net

 

(556,101)

 

 

(486,725)

Net deferred tax liabilities

$

(551,501)

 

$

(469,428)


The Company has state net operating loss carryforwards as of January 30, 2009 that total approximately $307.7 million which will expire in 2013 through 2028.  The Company also has state tax credit carryforwards of approximately $20.8 million that will expire beginning in 2009 through 2027.


The valuation allowance has been provided for federal capital losses and state tax credit carryforwards.  The 2008 increase of $8.2 million was recorded as income tax expense of $3.0 million and an adjustment to goodwill of $5.2 million.  The full amount of the change in the valuation allowance for the 2007 Successor period, a decrease of $4.2 million, was recorded as an adjustment to goodwill. The increase of $0.6 million in the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 and the increase of $3.2 million in 2006 were included in income tax expense for the respective periods.  Based upon expected future income, management believes that it is more



88



likely than not that the results of operations will generate sufficient taxable income to realize the deferred tax assets after giving consideration to the valuation allowance.


During 2008, goodwill recorded in connection with the Merger was reduced by $6.3 million principally as a result of the favorable settlement of uncertain income tax positions that existed at the time of the Merger.


The Predecessor adopted the provisions of FIN 48 effective February 3, 2007.  The adoption resulted in an $8.9 million decrease in retained earnings and a reclassification of certain amounts between deferred income taxes and other noncurrent liabilities to conform to the balance sheet presentation requirements of FIN 48.  As of the date of adoption, the total uncertain tax benefits were $77.9 million.  This amount excludes the federal income tax benefit for the uncertain tax positions related to state income taxes, which is included in deferred tax assets.  As a result of the adoption of FIN 48, the reserve for interest expense related to income taxes was increased to $15.3 million and a reserve for potential penalties of $1.9 million related to uncertain income tax positions was recorded.  


Subsequent to the adoption of FIN 48, the Company has elected to record income tax related interest and penalties as a component of the provision for income tax expense.


In the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007, the Internal Revenue Service completed an examination of the Company’s federal income tax returns through fiscal year 2003 resulting in a net income tax refund.  There are no unresolved issues related to this examination.  None of the Company’s federal income tax returns are currently under examination by the Internal Revenue Service; however, fiscal years 2005 and later are still subject to possible examination by the Internal Revenue Service.  The Company has various state income tax examinations that are currently in progress.  The estimated liability related to these state income tax examinations is included in the Company’s reserve for uncertain tax positions.  Generally, the Company’s tax years ended in 2005 and forward remain open for examination by the various state taxing authorities.


As of January 30, 2009, the total uncertain tax benefits, interest expense related to income taxes and potential income tax penalties were $59.1 million, $11.3 million and $1.5 million, respectively, for a total of $71.9 million.  Of this amount, $20.8 million and $47.3 million are reflected in current liabilities as accrued expenses and other and in other noncurrent liabilities, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheet with the remaining $3.8 million reducing deferred tax assets related to net operating loss carry forwards.


As of February 1, 2008, the total uncertain tax benefits, interest expense related to income taxes and potential income tax penalties were $96.6 million, $19.7 million and $1.5 million, respectively, for a total of $117.8 million.  Of this amount, $23.2 million and $78.3 are reflected in current liabilities as accrued expenses and other and in other noncurrent liabilities, respectively, in the consolidated balance sheet with the remaining $16.3 million reducing deferred tax assets related to net operating loss carry forwards.




89



The change, from the date of adoption, through the end of the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 in the uncertain tax benefits, interest expense related to income taxes and potential income tax penalties that impacted the consolidated statement of operations was a net increase of $10.4 million and $0.2 million and a decrease of $0.4 million, respectively.  The change, from the end of the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007, through the end of the Successor period ended February 1, 2008, in the uncertain tax benefits and interest expense related to income taxes that impacted the consolidated statement of operations was a net increase of $0.2 million and $4.2 million, respectively.   There was no change in the reserve for potential income tax penalties during the Successor period ended February 1, 2008.

During 2008, the Company included in its consolidated statement of operations a net increase of $0.8 million, a net decrease of $1.0 million and a net increase of $0.3 million related to uncertain tax benefits, interest expense related to income taxes and potential tax penalties, respectively. The net decrease in interest expense related to uncertain tax positions is due to the reduction during 2008 in amounts previously accrued related to uncertain tax positions.

The Company believes that it is reasonably possible that the reserve for uncertain tax positions may be reduced by approximately $33.6 million in the coming twelve months principally as a result of the settlement of currently ongoing state income tax examinations and the anticipated filing of an income tax accounting method change request that is expected to resolve certain uncertainties related to accounting methods employed by the Company.  The reasonably possible change of $33.6 million is included in both current liabilities ($20.1 million) and other noncurrent liabilities ($13.5 million) in the consolidated balance sheet as of January 30, 2009. Also, as of January 30, 2009, approximately $23.9 million of the uncertain tax positions would impact the Company’s effective income tax rate if the Company were to recognize the tax benefit for these positions.


A reconciliation of the uncertain income tax positions from February 3, 2007 (the date of adoption) through January 30, 2009 is as follows:


(In thousands)

 

Balance as of February 3, 2007

$

77,864 

Increases – tax positions taken in the current year

 

19,568 

Increases – tax positions taken in prior years

 

1,149 

Decrease – tax positions taken in prior years

 

(9)

Statute expirations

 

(185)

Settlements

 

(1,787)

 

 

 

Balance as of February 1, 2008

$

96,600 

 

 

 

Increases – tax positions taken in the current year

 

25,977 

Decrease – tax positions taken in the current year

 

(2,250)

Increases – tax positions taken in prior years

 

3,271 

Decrease – tax positions taken in prior years

 

(58,607)

Statute expirations

 

(1,955)

Settlements

 

(3,979)

 

 

 

Balance as of January 30, 2009

$

59,057 




90



6.

Current and long-term obligations


Current and long-term obligations consist of the following:


 

Successor

(In thousands)

January 30, 2009

 

February 1, 2008

Senior secured term loan facility

$

2,300,000 

 

 

 

$

2,300,000 

 

Senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility

 

 

 

 

 

102,500 

 

10 5/8% Senior Notes due July 15, 2015, net of discount of  $20,033 and $22,083, respectively

 

1,154,967 

 

 

 

 

1,152,917 

 

11 7/8/12 5/8% Senior Subordinated Notes due July 15, 2017

 

655,891 

 

 

 

 

700,000 

 

8 5/8% Notes due June 15, 2010

 

1,822 

 

 

 

 

1,822 

 

Capital lease obligations

 

9,939 

 

 

 

 

10,268 

 

Tax increment financing due February 1, 2035

 

14,495 

 

 

 

 

14,495 

 

 

 

4,137,114 

 

 

 

 

4,282,002 

 

Less: current portion

 

(14,158)

 

 

 

 

(3,246)

 

Long-term portion

$

4,122,956 

 

 

 

$

4,278,756 

 


On July 6, 2007, the Company entered into two senior secured credit agreements (the “Credit Facilities”).  The Credit Facilities provide financing of $3.425 billion, consisting of $2.3 billion in a senior secured term loan facility which matures on July 6, 2014, and a senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility of up to $1.125 billion, subject to borrowing base availability, which matures on July 6, 2013.

Under the Credit Facilities, the Company has the right at any time to request up to $325.0 million of incremental commitments under one or more incremental term loan facilities and/or asset-based revolving credit facilities, subject to certain conditions and subject to the lender’s desire to extend the incremental facilities.  


The amount available under the senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility (including up to $350.0 million for letters of credit) may not exceed the borrowing base (consisting of specified percentages of eligible inventory and credit card receivables less any applicable availability reserves).  The senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility includes a $1.0 billion tranche and a $125.0 million (“last out”) tranche.  Repayments of the senior secured asset-based revolving credit facility will be applied to the $125.0 million tranche only after all other tranches have been fully paid down.  As of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, the Company had outstanding borrowings of $0 and $102.5 million, respectively, under the “last out” tranche.  


Borrowings under the Credit Facilities bear interest at a rate equal to an applicable margin plus, at the Company’s option, either (a) LIBOR or (b) a base rate (which is usually equal to the prime rate).  The applicable margin for borrowings is (i) under the term loan facility, 2.75% for LIBOR borrowings and 1.75% for base-rate borrowings (ii) as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively, under the asset-based revolving credit facility (except in the last out tranche described above), 1.25% and 1.50% for LIBOR borrowings; 0.25% and 0.50% for base-rate borrowings and for any last out borrowings, 2.25% for LIBOR borrowings and 1.25% for base-rate borrowings.  The applicable margins for borrowings under the asset-based revolving credit facility (except in the case of last out borrowings) are subject to adjustment each quarter based on average daily excess availability under the asset-based revolving credit facility.  



91



As of February 1, 2008, the average interest rate for borrowings under the revolving credit facility was 6.35%.  The interest rate for borrowings under the term loan facility was 3.44% and 6.22% (without giving effect to the interest rate swaps discussed in Note 7) as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively.


In addition to paying interest on outstanding principal under the Credit Facilities, the Company is required to pay a commitment fee to the lenders under the asset-based revolving credit facility for any unutilized commitments.  The commitment fee rate is 0.375% per annum.  The commitment fee rate will be reduced (except with regard to the last out tranche) to 0.25% per annum at any time that the unutilized commitments under the asset-based credit facility are equal to or less than 50% of the aggregate commitments under the asset-based revolving credit facility.  The Company also must pay customary letter of credit fees.  


The senior secured credit agreement for the term loan facility requires the Company to prepay outstanding term loans, subject to certain exceptions, with percentages of excess cash flow, proceeds of non-ordinary course asset sales or dispositions of property, and proceeds of incurrences of certain debt.  In addition, the senior secured credit agreement for the asset-based revolving credit facility requires the Company to prepay the asset-based revolving credit facility, subject to certain exceptions, with proceeds of non-ordinary course asset sales or dispositions of property and any borrowings in excess of the then current borrowing base.  Beginning September 30, 2009, the Company is required to repay installments on the loans under the term loan credit facility in equal quarterly principal amounts in an aggregate amount per annum equal to 1% of the total funded principal amount at July 6, 2007, with the balance payable on July 6, 2014.  

All obligations under the Credit Facilities are unconditionally guaranteed by substantially all of the Company’s existing and future domestic subsidiaries (excluding certain immaterial subsidiaries and certain subsidiaries designated by the Company under the Credit Facilities as “unrestricted subsidiaries”).


All obligations and guarantees of those obligations under the term loan credit facility are secured by, subject to certain exceptions, a second-priority security interest in all existing and after-acquired inventory and accounts receivable; a first priority security interest in substantially all of the Company’s and the guarantors’ tangible and intangible assets (other than the inventory and accounts receivable collateral); and a first-priority pledge of the capital stock held by the Company.  All obligations under the asset-based revolving credit facility are secured by all existing and after-acquired inventory and accounts receivable, subject to certain exceptions.


The Credit Facilities contain certain covenants, including, among other things, covenants that limit the Company’s ability to incur additional indebtedness, sell assets, incur additional liens, pay dividends, make investments or acquisitions, or repay certain indebtedness.


For the year ended January 30, 2009, the Company had borrowings of $0 and repayments of $102.5 million, and for the 2007 Successor period the Company had borrowings of $1.522 billion and repayments of $1.420 billion, under the asset based revolving credit facility. For the year ended February 2, 2007, the Company had borrowings of $2.013 billion and repayments of $2.013 billion, under a prior revolving credit facility. As of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, respectively, the Company had $0 and $102.5 million in borrowings, $51.0 million and



92



$28.8 million of commercial letters of credit, and $83.7 million and $69.2 million of standby letters of credit outstanding under the asset-based revolving credit facility, with excess availability under that facility of $932.8 million and $769.2 million.  As of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, the Company had $2.3 billion outstanding under the term loan facility.  


In addition, on July 6, 2007, in conjunction with the Merger, the Company issued $1.175 billion aggregate principal amount of 10.625% senior notes due 2015 (the “senior notes”) which were issued net of a discount of $23.2 million and which mature on July 15, 2015 pursuant to an indenture, dated as of July 6, 2007 (the “senior indenture”), and $725 million aggregate principal amount of 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated toggle notes due 2017 (the “senior subordinated notes”), which mature on July 15, 2017, pursuant to an indenture, dated as of July 6, 2007 (the “senior subordinated indenture”).  The senior notes and the senior subordinated notes are collectively referred to herein as the “notes”.  The senior indenture and the senior subordinated indenture are collectively referred to herein as the “indentures”.


Interest on the notes is payable on January 15 and July 15 of each year, beginning January 15, 2008.  Interest on the senior notes is payable in cash.  Cash interest on the senior subordinated notes will accrue at a rate of 11.875% per annum and PIK interest (as that term is defined below) will accrue at a rate of 12.625% per annum.  For certain interest periods, the Company may elect to pay interest on the senior subordinated notes by increasing the principal amount of the senior subordinated notes or issuing new senior subordinated notes (“PIK interest”).

The notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by each of the existing and future direct or indirect wholly owned domestic subsidiaries that guarantee the obligations under the Company’s Credit Facilities.

The Company may redeem some or all of the notes at any time at redemption prices described or set forth in the indentures. In January 2009 and January 2008, the Company repurchased $44.1 million and $25.0 million, respectively, of the 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated toggle notes due 2017, resulting in pretax gains of $3.8 million and $4.9 million, respectively.


The indentures contain certain covenants, including, among other things, covenants that limit the Company’s ability to incur additional indebtedness, create liens, sell assets, enter into transactions with affiliates, or consolidate or dispose of all of its assets.


Scheduled debt maturities for the Company’s fiscal years listed below are as follows (in thousands): 2009 - $14,158; 2010 - $26,415; 2011 - $23,779; 2012 - $23,272; 2013 - $23,292 thereafter - $4,046,132.


On July 6, 2007, immediately after the completion of the Merger, the Company completed a cash tender offer to purchase any and all of its $200 million principal amount of 8 5/8% Notes due June 2010 (the “2010 Notes”).  Approximately 99% of the 2010 Notes were validly tendered and accepted for payment.  The tender offer included a consent payment equal to 3% of the par value of the 2010 Notes, and such payments along with associated settlement costs totaling $6.2 million were paid and reflected as Other (income) expense in the 2007



93



Successor period presented.  Additionally, because the Company received the requisite consents to the proposed amendments to the indenture pursuant to which the 2010 Notes were issued, a supplemental indenture to effect such amendments was executed and delivered.  The amendments, which eliminated substantially all of the restrictive covenants contained in the indenture, became operative upon the purchase of the tendered 2010 Notes.


7.

Derivative financial instruments


The Company uses interest rate swaps to manage its interest rate risk. In April 2007, Buck entered into interest rate swaps, contingent upon the completion of the Merger, on a portion of the loans anticipated to result from the Merger. These swaps were designated as cash flow hedges on October 12, 2007. As a result of these swaps, the Company is paying an all-in fixed interest rate of 7.68% on a notional amount equal to $866.7 million as of January 30, 2009. The notional amount of these swaps amortizes on a quarterly basis through July 31, 2012. Unrealized losses of $3.7 million for the 2007 Successor period are included in Other (income) expense in the consolidated statements of operations, reflecting the changes in fair value of these swaps prior to their designation as qualifying cash flow hedging relationships in October 2007, which were offset by earnings under the contractual provisions of the swaps of $1.7 million during the same time period.


In October 2008 the Company terminated one of the interest rate swaps entered into by Buck in April 2007 with a notional amount equal to $486.7 million as of the date of termination. The termination was the result of the bankruptcy declaration by the counterparty to the swap and this technical default gave the Company the right to terminate the derivative contract.  The Company subsequently cash settled the swap in November 2008 for approximately $7.6 million, including interest accrued to the date of termination.

The estimated fair value of the Company’s terminated interest rate swap was a liability of approximately $5.0 million as of October 30, 2008 (the termination date). Based on various factors, the Company concluded that the hedge was expected to be highly effective at achieving offsetting cash flows attributable to the hedged risk, and has therefore applied hedge accounting for this interest rate swap through the termination date.


Upon termination, the Company performed the final effectiveness test, and the amount related to the gains and losses since the hedge designation date of approximately $3.7 million (after adjusting for the termination) remained in Accumulated other comprehensive loss at the termination date. Such amount is being reclassified into earnings as interest expense over the term of the original swap as the hedged forecasted transactions impact earnings and this expense is expected to be approximately $1.4 million in 2009.


In February and December 2008, the Company entered into additional interest rate swaps, each of which were designated as cash flow hedges at inception. At January 30, 2009, the Company is paying all-in fixed interest rates of 5.58% and 5.06% on notional amounts of $350.0 million and $475.0 million, respectively, pursuant to the February 2008 and December 2008 swaps. The notional amount of the February 2008 swap reduces to $150.0 million in February



94



2009 and matures in February 2010. The December 2008 swap amortizes to a notional amount of $300.0 million upon its maturity in January 2013.

As of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, the fair value of the Company’s interest rate swaps of $(63.5) million and $(82.3) million was recorded in non-current Other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets. For the year ended January 30, 2009, the effective portion of the change in fair value of the swaps of $14.2 million was recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive loss, a separate component of equity, offset by related income taxes of $4.5 million. From the date the swaps were designated as hedges to February 1, 2008, the effective portion of the change in fair value of the swaps of ($78.6) million was recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive loss, offset by related income taxes of $29.5 million. The Company also recorded expense in Other (income) expense in the consolidated statements of operations related to hedge ineffectiveness of $1.0 million and $0.4 million during 2008 and the 2007 Successor period, respectively.

In February 2009, the Company entered into a contract to hedge approximately 50% of its anticipated 2009 fuel usage related to the transportation of merchandise. Such contract is not expected to qualify for hedge accounting treatment, and as a result, gains or losses under this contract will be recorded in Other (gains) losses in the consolidated statement of operations.

8.

Commitments and contingencies


Leases


As of January 30, 2009, the Company was committed under capital and operating lease agreements and financing obligations for most of its retail stores, three of its DCs, and certain of its furniture, fixtures and equipment.  The majority of the Company’s stores are subject to short-term leases (usually with initial or current terms of three to five years), often with multiple renewal options.  The Company also has stores subject to build-to-suit arrangements with landlords, which typically carry a primary lease term of 10 years with multiple renewal options. Approximately 42% of the stores have provisions for contingent rentals based upon a percentage of defined sales volume.  Certain leases contain restrictive covenants.  As of January 30, 2009, the Company is not aware of any material violations of such covenants.

The Merger and certain of the related financing transactions may be interpreted as giving rise to certain trigger events (which may include events of default) under leases for three of the Company’s distribution centers (“DCs”). The Company does not believe such an interpretation would be appropriate under the terms of the leases. During the 2007 Successor period, the Company concluded that a probable loss existed in connection with the restructurings and accrued SG&A expenses totaling $12.0 million in the Successor statement of operations for the period ended February 1, 2008. As of January 30, 2009, $7.0 million of such amount has been paid. The Company believes that it has negotiated with the property owners proposed lease terms that would be implemented if the owners were to refinance or sell the property and that the resolution of these negotiations is primarily dependent on conditions in the real estate and financial markets. The Company’s current position is that any remaining potential loss on the resolution of these matters would currently be properly characterized as reasonably possible rather than probable and has therefore reversed the remaining $5.0 million of SG&A expenses



95



related to the leases during the year ended January 30, 2009. However, the possibility remains that the ultimate resolution of these matters could require the Company to make a significant cash investment to purchase these DCs.

In January 1999 and April 1997, the Company sold its DCs located in Ardmore, Oklahoma and South Boston, Virginia, respectively, for 100% cash consideration.  Concurrent with the sale transactions, the Company leased the properties back for periods of 23 and 25 years, respectively.  The transactions were recorded as financing obligations rather than sales as a result of, among other things, the lessor’s ability to put the properties back to the Company under certain circumstances.  The property and equipment, along with the related lease obligations, associated with these transactions were recorded in the consolidated balance sheets.


In August 2007, the Company purchased a secured promissory note (the “Ardmore Note”) from Principal Life Insurance Company, which had a face value of $34.3 million at the date of purchase and approximated the remaining financing obligation. The Ardmore Note represents debt issued by the third party entity from which the Company leases the Ardmore DC. The Ardmore Note is being accounted for as a “held to maturity” debt security in accordance with the provisions of SFAS 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities” (see Note 1). However, by acquiring the Ardmore Note, the Company holds the debt instrument pertaining to its lease financing obligation and, because a legal right of offset exists, is accounting for the acquired Ardmore Note as a reduction of its outstanding financing obligations in its consolidated balance sheets as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 in accordance with the provisions of FASB Interpretation 39, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts – An Interpretation of APB Opinion 10 and FASB Statement 105.”


In May 2003, the Company purchased two secured promissory notes (the “South Boston Notes”) from Principal Life Insurance Company totaling $49.6 million. The South Boston Notes represented debt issued by the third party entity from which the Company leased the South Boston DC. In June 2006, the Company acquired the third party entity, which owned legal title to the South Boston DC assets and had issued the related debt in connection with the original financing transaction. There was no material gain or loss recognized as a result of this transaction. Based on the Company’s ownership of the third party entity at January 30, 2009, the financing obligation and South Boston Notes are eliminated in the Company’s consolidated financial statements.




96



Future minimum payments as of January 30, 2009 for capital and operating leases are as follows:


(In thousands)

Capital

Leases

 

Operating

Leases

2010

3,144 

 

358,367

 

2011

 

2,097 

 

 

308,503

 

2012

 

1,128 

 

 

260,502

 

2013

 

599 

 

 

211,049

 

2014

 

599 

 

 

160,917

 

Thereafter

 

5,877 

 

 

372,597

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total minimum payments

 

13,444 

 

1,671,935

 

Less: imputed interest

 

(3,505)

 

 

 

 

Present value of net minimum lease payments

 

9,939 

 

 

 

 

Less: current portion, net

 

(2,658)

 

 

 

 

Long-term portion

7,281 

 

 

 

 

Capital leases were discounted at an effective interest rate of approximately 5.4% at January 30, 2009.  The gross amount of property and equipment recorded under capital leases and financing obligations at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, was $34.8 million and $33.5 million, respectively.  Accumulated depreciation on property and equipment under capital leases and financing obligations at January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, was $5.3 million and $2.7 million, respectively.  


Rent expense under all operating leases is as follows:


 

Successor

 

Predecessor

(In thousands)

2008

 

March 6, 2007
through
February 1, 2008

 

February 3, 2007
through
July 6, 2007

 

2006

 

Minimum rentals (a)

$

370,827

 

$

205,672

 

$

143,188

 

$

327,911

 

Contingent rentals

 

18,796

 

 

8,780

 

 

6,964

 

 

16,029

 

 

$

389,623

 

$

214,452

 

$

150,152

 

$

343,940

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(a)

Excludes net contract termination costs of $2.5 million, $2.4 million, $19.1 million, and $5.7 million for the Successor periods ended January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 and the Predecessor periods ended July 6, 2007 and February 2, 2007, respectively.  These expenses were recorded in association with the closing of stores associated with strategic initiatives as further discussed in Note 3. Also excludes amortization of leasehold interests of $40.9 million and $23.7 million included in rent expense for the Successor periods ended January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008.


Legal proceedings


On August 7, 2006, a lawsuit entitled Cynthia Richter, et al. v. Dolgencorp, Inc., et al. was filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Alabama (Case No. 7:06-cv-01537-LSC) (“Richter”) in which the plaintiff alleges that she and other current and former Dollar General store managers were improperly classified as exempt executive employees under the Fair Labor Standards Act (“FLSA”) and seeks to recover overtime pay,



97



liquidated damages, and attorneys’ fees and costs. On August 15, 2006, the Richter plaintiff filed a motion in which she asked the court to certify a nationwide class of current and former store managers. The Company opposed the plaintiff’s motion. On March 23, 2007, the court conditionally certified a nationwide class of individuals who worked for Dollar General as store managers since August 7, 2003. The number of persons who will be included in the class has not been determined, and the court has not approved the Notice that will be sent to the class.


On May 30, 2007, the court stayed all proceedings in the case, including the sending of the Notice, to evaluate, among other things, certain appeals pending in the Eleventh Circuit involving claims similar to those raised in this action. That stay was extended through May 15, 2009. During the stay, the statute of limitations has been tolled for potential class members. If the court ultimately permits Notice to issue, the Company will have an opportunity at the close of the discovery period to seek decertification of the class, and the Company expects to file such a motion if necessary.


The Company believes that its store managers are and have been properly classified as exempt employees under the FLSA and that this action is not appropriate for collective action treatment. The Company intends to vigorously defend this action. However, at this time, it is not possible to predict whether the court ultimately will permit this action to proceed collectively, and no assurances can be given that the Company will be successful in the defense on the merits or otherwise. If the Company is not successful in its efforts to defend this action, the resolution could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial statements as a whole.


On May 18, 2006, the Company was served with a lawsuit entitled Tammy Brickey, Becky Norman, Rose Rochow, Sandra Cogswell and Melinda Sappington v. Dolgencorp, Inc. and Dollar General Corporation (Western District of New York, Case No. 6:06-cv-06084-DGL, originally filed on February 9, 2006 and amended on May 12, 2006 (“Brickey”)). The Brickey plaintiffs seek to proceed collectively under the FLSA and as a class under New York, Ohio, Maryland and North Carolina wage and hour statutes on behalf of, among others, assistant store managers who claim to be owed wages (including overtime wages) under those statutes. At this time, it is not possible to predict whether the court will permit this action to proceed collectively or as a class. However, the Company believes that this action is not appropriate for either collective or class treatment and that the Company’s wage and hour policies and practices comply with both federal and state law. The Company plans to vigorously defend this action; however, no assurances can be given that the Company will be successful in the defense on the merits or otherwise, and, if it is not successful, the resolution of this action could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial statements as a whole.


On March 7, 2006, a complaint was filed in the United States District Court for the Northern District of Alabama ( Janet Calvert v. Dolgencorp, Inc. , Case No. 2:06-cv-00465-VEH (“Calvert”)), in which the plaintiff, a former store manager, alleged that she was paid less than male store managers because of her sex, in violation of the Equal Pay Act and Title VII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964, as amended (“Title VII”). The complaint subsequently was amended to include additional plaintiffs, who also allege to have been paid less than males because of their sex, and to add allegations that the Company’s compensation practices disparately impact females. Under the amended complaint, Plaintiffs seek to proceed collectively under the Equal



98



Pay Act and as a class under Title VII, and request back wages, injunctive and declaratory relief, liquidated damages, punitive damages and attorney’s fees and costs.


On July 9, 2007, the plaintiffs filed a motion in which they asked the court to approve the issuance of notice to a class of current and former female store managers under the Equal Pay Act. The Company opposed plaintiffs’ motion. On November 30, 2007, the court conditionally certified a nationwide class of females under the Equal Pay Act who worked for Dollar General as store managers between November 30, 2004 and November 30, 2007. The notice was issued on January 11, 2008, and persons to whom the notice was sent were required to opt into the suit by March 11, 2008. Approximately 2,100 individuals have opted into the lawsuit.  The Company will have an opportunity at the close of the discovery period to seek decertification of the Equal Pay Act class, and the Company expects to file such motion.


The plaintiffs have not yet moved for class certification relating to their Title VII claims.  The Company expects such motion to be filed within the next several months and will strenuously oppose such a motion.


At this time, it is not possible to predict whether the court ultimately will permit the Calvert action to proceed collectively under the Equal Pay Act or as a class under Title VII. However, the Company believes that the case is not appropriate for class or collective treatment and that its policies and practices comply with the Equal Pay Act and Title VII.  The Company intends to vigorously defend the action; however, no assurances can be given that the Company will be successful in the defense on the merits or otherwise. If the Company is not successful in defending the Calvert action, its resolution could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial statements as a whole.


On July 30, 2008, the Company was served with a complaint filed in the District Court for Dallas County, Iowa ( Julie Cox, et al. v. Dolgencorp, Inc., et al – Case No. LACV-034423) in which the plaintiff, a former store manager, alleges that the Company discriminates against pregnant employees on the basis of sex and retaliates against employees in violation of the Iowa Civil Rights Act.  Cox seeks to represent a class of “all current, former and future employees from the State of Iowa who are employed by Dollar General who suffered from, are currently suffering from or in the future may suffer from” alleged sex/pregnancy discrimination and retaliation and seeks declaratory and injunctive relief as well as equitable, compensatory and punitive damages and attorneys’ fees and costs.


The plaintiff has not yet moved for class certification.  At this time, it is not possible to predict whether the court ultimately will permit the Cox action to proceed as a class. However, the Company believes that the case is not appropriate for class treatment and that its policies and practices comply with the Iowa Civil Rights Act.  The Company intends to vigorously defend the action; however, no assurances can be given that the Company will be successful in the defense on the merits or otherwise. If the Company is not successful in defending this action, its resolution could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial statements as a whole.




99



On December 4, 2008, a complaint was filed in the United States District Court for the Western District of Tennessee ( Tressa Holt, et al v. Dollar General Corporation, et al. , Case No.1:08-cv-01298 JDB) in which the plaintiff, on behalf of herself and a putative class of non-exempt store employees, alleges that the Company violated the Fair Labor Standards Act by failing to pay for all hours worked, including overtime hours. At this time, it is not possible to predict whether the court will permit this action to proceed collectively.  However, the Company believes that this action is not appropriate for collective treatment and that the Company’s wage and hour policies and practices comply with the FLSA. The Company plans to vigorously defend this action; however, no assurances can be given that the Company will be successful in the defense on the merits or otherwise, and, if it is not successful, the resolution of this action could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial statements as a whole.


Subsequent to the announcement of the agreement relating to the Merger, the Company and its directors were named in seven putative class actions alleging claims for breach of fiduciary duty arising out of the Company’s proposed sale to KKR. Each of the complaints alleged, among other things, that the Company’s directors engaged in “self-dealing” by agreeing to recommend the transaction to the Company’s shareholders and that the consideration available to such shareholders in the transaction is unfairly low. On motion of the plaintiffs, each of these cases was transferred to the Sixth Circuit Court for Davidson County, Twentieth Judicial District, at Nashville. By order dated April 26, 2007, the seven lawsuits were consolidated in the court under the caption, “In re: Dollar General,” Case No. 07MD-1. On June 13, 2007, the court denied the Plaintiffs’ motion for a temporary injunction to block the shareholder vote that was then held on June 21, 2007. On June 22, 2007, the Plaintiffs filed their amended complaint making claims substantially similar to those outlined above. The court on November 6, 2008 certified a class of all persons who held stock in the Company on the date of the Merger.  The defendants filed for summary judgment.


On November 24, 2008, all defendants, including the Company, reached an agreement in principle to settle this lawsuit, subject to final documentation and court approval. The Company determined that the agreement would be in the best interest of the Company to avoid costly and time consuming litigation. Based on the agreement in principle, the Company recorded a charge of approximately $34.5 million in the third quarter of 2008 in connection with the proposed settlement, net of anticipated insurance proceeds of $7.5 million. In the fourth quarter, the Company ultimately collected $10 million in insurance proceeds ($2.5 million more than the anticipated amount), and on February 2, 2009, the Company funded the settlement. On February 11, 2009, the court approved the terms of the settlement. The additional $2.5 million in insurance proceeds received in the fourth quarter of 2008 has been recorded as a reduction of Litigation settlement and related costs, net in the 2008 statement of operations. Additional adjustments, not expected to be material, may be made to the estimated additional legal fees and costs.


From time to time, the Company is a party to various other legal actions involving claims incidental to the conduct of its business, including actions by employees, consumers, suppliers, government agencies, or others through private actions, class actions, administrative proceedings, regulatory actions or other litigation, including under federal and state employment laws and wage and hour laws.  The Company believes, based upon information currently available, that such other litigation and claims, both individually and in the aggregate, will be



100



resolved without a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial statements as a whole. However, litigation involves an element of uncertainty. Future developments could cause these actions or claims to have a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations, cash flows, or financial position. In addition, certain of these lawsuits, if decided adversely to the Company or settled by the Company, may result in liability material to the Company’s financial position or may negatively affect operating results if changes to the Company’s business operation are required.


Other


In August of 2008, the Consumer Product Safety Improvement Act of 2008 was signed into law.  The new law addresses, among other things, the permissible levels of lead and listed phthalates in certain products.  The first tier of new standards for permissible levels of lead and phthalates became effective in February 2009; the second tier is effective in August 2009. To ensure compliance, the Company undertook a process during the fourth quarter of 2008 to identify, mark down and cease the sale of any remaining inventory that would be impacted by the new law. The effect of these markdowns resulted in a 2008 charge of $8.6 million included in Cost of goods sold in the consolidated statement of operations. The Company is continuing to evaluate its inventory for the next implementation phase of the new law, but does not currently expect the impact of this process to be material to its financial statements. Until the process is complete, however, the Company cannot definitely rule out that possibility.


9.

Benefit plans


The Dollar General Corporation 401(k) Savings and Retirement Plan, which became effective on January 1, 1998, is a safe harbor defined contribution plan and is subject to the Employee Retirement and Income Security Act (“ERISA”).


Participants are permitted to contribute between 1% and 25% of their pre-tax annual eligible compensation as defined in the 401(k) plan document, subject to certain limitations under the Internal Revenue Code.  Employees who are over age 50 are permitted to contribute additional amounts on a pre-tax basis under the catch-up provision of the 401(k) plan subject to Internal Revenue Code limitations. The Company currently matches employee contributions, including catch-up contributions, at a rate of 100% of employee contributions up to 5% of annual eligible salary, after an employee has been employed for one year and has completed a minimum of 1,000 hours of service.


A participant’s right to claim a distribution of his or her account balance is dependent on ERISA guidelines and Internal Revenue Service regulations. All active employees are fully vested in all contributions to the 401(k) plan. During 2008, the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods, and 2006, the Company expensed approximately $8.0 million, $3.0 million, $4.3 million, and $6.4 million, respectively, for matching contributions. The Merger did not significantly impact the comparability of such expense amounts between periods.


The Company also has a nonqualified supplemental retirement plan (“SERP”) and compensation deferral plan (“CDP”), called the Dollar General Corporation CDP/SERP Plan, for



101



a select group of management and highly compensated employees.  The supplemental retirement plan is a noncontributory defined contribution plan with annual Company contributions ranging from 2% to 12% of base pay plus bonus depending upon age plus years of service and job grade.  Under the CDP, participants may defer up to 65% of base pay and up to 100% of bonus pay. An employee may be designated for participation in one or both of the plans, according to the eligibility requirements of the plans. The Company matches base pay deferrals at a rate of 100% of base pay deferral, up to 5% of annual salary, with annual salary offset by the amount of match-eligible salary in the 401(k) plan. All participants are 100% vested in their CDP accounts.


Effective May 22, 2008, CDP eligibility changed as follows: to be eligible for CDP salary deferrals, individuals must earn compensation in excess of the IRS limit under IRC 401(a)(17) and to be eligible for CDP bonus deferrals, individuals must earn compensation in excess of the IRS highly compensated limit under Section 414(q)(1)(B). Also, effective May 28, 2008, SERP eligibility was frozen and management or highly compensated employees hired on or after that date are not eligible for SERP participation.


As a result of the Merger which constituted a “change in control” under the CDP/SERP Plan, all previously unvested amounts under the SERP vested on July 6, 2007.  For newly eligible SERP participants after July 6, 2007, the SERP accounts vest at the earlier of the participant’s attainment of age 50 or the participant’s being credited with 10 or more “years of service”, upon termination of employment due to death or “total and permanent disability” or upon a “change in control”, all as defined in the CDP/SERP Plan.  The Company incurred compensation expense for these plans of approximately $1.2 million in 2008, $0.3 million in the 2007 Successor period, $0.5 million in the 2007 Predecessor period, and $0.8 million in 2006.


The CDP/SERP Plan assets are invested at the option of the participant in an account that mirrors the performance of a fund or funds selected by the Company’s Compensation Committee or its delegate (the “Mutual Fund Options”) or, prior to the Merger, in an account that mirrored the performance of the Company’s common stock (the “Common Stock Option”).  Effective August 2, 2008, the deemed fund options under the CDP/SERP Plan were changed to mirror the same fund options offered under the 401(k) plan. A participant’s CDP and SERP account balances will be paid in accordance with the participant’s election by (a) lump sum, (b) monthly installments over a 5, 10 or 15 year period or (c) a combination of lump sum and installments.  The vested amount will be payable at the time designated by the plan upon the participant’s termination of employment or retirement, except that participants may elect to receive an in-service distribution or an “unforeseeable emergency hardship” distribution of vested amounts credited to the CDP account. Account balances deemed to be invested in the Mutual Fund Options are payable in cash and, prior to the Merger, account balances deemed to be invested in the Common Stock Option were payable in shares of Dollar General common stock and cash in lieu of fractional shares.


As a result of the Merger, the CDP/SERP Plan liabilities as of the Merger date were fully funded into an irrevocable rabbi trust. All account balances deemed to be invested in the Common Stock Option were liquidated at a value of $22.00 per share and the proceeds were transferred to an existing Mutual Fund Option within the Plan.




102



Asset balances in the Mutual Funds Option are stated at fair market value, which is based on quoted market prices. The current portion of these balances is included in Prepaid expenses and other current assets and the long term portion is included in Other assets, net in the consolidated balance sheets. In accordance with EITF 97-14 “Accounting for Deferred Compensation Arrangements Where Amounts Earned Are Held in a Rabbi Trust and Invested,” the Company’s stock was recorded at historical cost and included in Other shareholders’ equity, prior to the Merger. Also, prior to the Merger, the deferred compensation liability related to the Company stock for active plan participants was included in shareholders’ equity and subsequent changes to the fair value of the obligation were not recognized, in accordance with the provisions of EITF 97-14. However, as a result of the Merger, Company stock is no longer an available option to Plan participants. The deferred compensation liability related to the Mutual Funds Option is recorded at the fair value of the investment options as chosen by the participants. The current portion of these balances is included in Accrued expenses and other and the long term portion is included in Other liabilities in the consolidated balance sheets.


Through January 2008, the Company sponsored a supplemental executive retirement plan for the Chief Executive Officer (called the Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan for David A. Perdue) and accounted for the plan in accordance with SFAS 158. As a result of the Merger, which constituted a change in control under the terms of this plan and the grantor trust agreement, and Mr. Perdue’s subsequent resignation, Mr. Perdue became 100% vested. A deposit of approximately $6.2 million was made to the trust representing Mr. Perdue’s lump sum vested benefit and accumulated interest, which amount was paid to Mr. Perdue on January 7, 2008, effectively terminating the plan.


Prior to the Merger, non-employee directors could defer all or a part of any fees normally paid by the Company to a voluntary nonqualified compensation deferral plan. The compensation eligible for deferral included the annual retainer, meeting and other fees, as well as any per diem compensation for special assignments, earned by a director for his or her service to the Company’s Board of Directors or one of its committees. The deferred compensation was credited to a liability account, which was then invested at the option of the director, in deemed investments which mirrored either the Mutual Fund Options or the Common Stock Option and the deferred compensation was to be paid in accordance with the director’s election. All deferred compensation was immediately due and payable upon a “change in control” of the Company, as defined by the Plan. As a result of the Merger, which constituted a change in control under the Plan, all accounts held in the Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors were distributed.


10.

Share-based payments


The Company accounts for share-based payments in accordance with SFAS 123(R).  Under SFAS 123(R), the fair value of each award is separately estimated and amortized into compensation expense over the service period.  The fair value of the Company’s stock option grants are estimated on the grant date using the Black-Scholes-Merton valuation model.  The application of this valuation model involves assumptions that are judgmental and highly sensitive in the determination of compensation expense.  




103



The Company adopted SFAS 123(R) effective February 4, 2006 and began recognizing compensation expense for stock options based on the fair value of the awards on the grant date. The Company adopted SFAS 123(R) under the modified-prospective-transition method and, therefore, results from prior periods have not been restated. Under SFAS 123(R), forfeitures are estimated at the time of valuation and reduce expense ratably over the vesting period.


Prior to the Merger, the Company maintained various share-based compensation programs which included options, restricted stock and restricted stock units.  In connection with the Merger, the Company’s outstanding stock options, restricted stock and restricted stock units became fully vested immediately prior to the closing of the Merger and were settled in cash, canceled or, in limited circumstances, exchanged for new options of the Company, as described below.  Unless exchanged for new options, each option holder received an amount in cash, without interest and less applicable withholding taxes, equal to $22.00 less the exercise price of each in-the-money option.  Additionally, each restricted stock and restricted stock unit holder received $22.00 in cash, without interest and less applicable withholding taxes.  Certain stock options held by Company management were exchanged for new options to purchase common stock in the Company (the “Rollover Options”).  The exercise price of the Rollover Options and the number of shares of Company common stock underlying the Rollover Options were adjusted as a result of the Merger.  The Rollover Options otherwise continue under the terms of the equity plan under which the original options were issued.


On July 6, 2007, the Company’s Board of Directors adopted the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees, which Plan was subsequently amended (as so amended, the “Plan”).  The Plan provides for the granting of stock options, stock appreciation rights, and other stock-based awards or dividend equivalent rights to key employees, directors, consultants or other persons having a service relationship with the Company, its subsidiaries and certain of its affiliates.  The number of shares of Company common stock authorized for grant under the Plan is 27.5 million, 24 million of which may be granted in the form of stock options. As of January 30, 2009, 4,154,826 of such shares are available for future grants, including 2,913,210 shares which may be granted in the form of stock options.


During the 2008 and the 2007 Successor period, the Company granted options that vest solely upon the continued employment of the recipient (“Time Options”) as well as options that vest upon the achievement of predetermined annual or cumulative financial-based targets (“Performance Options”).  According to the award terms, 20% of the Time Options and Performance Options generally vest annually over a five-year period. In the event the performance target is not achieved in any given period, such options for that period will subsequently vest upon the achievement of a cumulative performance target.  Vesting of the Time Options and Performance Options is also subject to acceleration in the event of an earlier change in control or public offering.  Each of these options, whether Time Options or Performance Options have a contractual term of 10 years and an exercise price equal to the fair value of the stock on the date of grant.  


Both the Time Options and the Performance Options are subject to various provisions set forth in a management stockholder’s agreement entered into with each option holder by which the Company may require the employee, upon termination, to sell to the Company any vested



104



options or shares received upon exercise of the Time Options or Performance Options at amounts that differ based upon the reason for the termination. In particular, in the event that the employee resigns “without good reason” (as defined in the management stockholder’s agreement), then any options whether or not then exercisable are forfeited and any shares received upon prior exercise of such options are callable at the Company’s option at an amount equal to the lesser of fair value or the amount paid for the shares (i.e. the exercise price).  In such cases, because the employee would not benefit in any share appreciation over the exercise price, for accounting purposes, under SFAS 123(R) such options are not considered vested until the expiration of the Company’s call option, which is generally five years subsequent to the date of grant.  Accordingly, all references to the vesting provisions or vested status of the options discussed in this note give effect to the vesting pursuant to the provisions of SFAS 123(R) and may differ from descriptions of the vesting status of the Time Options and Performance Options located elsewhere in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K.


Each of the Company’s management-owned shares, Rollover Options, and vested new options include certain provisions by which the holder of such shares, Rollover Options, or vested new options may require the Company to repurchase such instruments in limited circumstances.  Specifically, each such instrument is subject to a repurchase right for a period of 365 days after termination due to the death or disability of the holder of the instrument that occurs generally within five years from the date of grant.  In such circumstances, the holder of such instruments may require the Company to repurchase any shares at the fair market value of such shares and any Rollover Options or vested new options at a price equal to the intrinsic value of such Rollover or vested new options.  Because the Company does not have control over the circumstances in which it may be required to repurchase the outstanding shares or Rollover Options, such shares and Rollover Options, valued at $9.7 million and $4.2 million, respectively, at January 30, 2009, and at $6.0 million and $3.2 million, respectively, at February 1, 2008 have been classified as Redeemable common stock in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets as of these dates.  The values of these equity instruments are based upon the fair value and intrinsic value of the underlying stock and Rollover Options at the date of issuance. Because redemption of such shares is uncertain, such shares are not subject to re-measurement until their redemption becomes probable.


In addition to the repurchase rights upon death or disability that are common to all management held shares, Rollover Options, and vested new options, the management stockholder’s agreement which the Company entered into with certain executive officers provided such officers with an additional repurchase right in the event their employment terminated for any reason prior to the expiration of this repurchase right on July 21, 2008.  Such executive officers could have required the Company to repurchase their outstanding shares and Rollover Options at a price of $5 per share in the case of shares and the difference in $5 per share and the exercise price of any Rollover Options that they hold.  This repurchase right existed for a period of 365 days following termination of employment within the required timeframe.  As noted above, each of the shares, whether held by general members of management or executive officers, has been classified within Redeemable common stock on the accompanying consolidated balance sheet as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008.  In the case of the Rollover Options held by the executive officers, however, the additional repurchase rights in the event of termination of employment prior to July 21, 2008 were considered within the control of



105



the employee, and as such, $3.6 million (representing the fixed repurchase price) related to such Rollover Options were classified in Other (noncurrent) liabilities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet at February 1, 2008 pursuant to SFAS 123(R).

Subsequent to the Merger, the Company’s Board of Directors adopted an Equity Appreciation Rights Plan (the “Rights Plan”).  The Rights Plan provides for the granting of equity appreciation rights to nonexecutive managerial employees.  Through January 30, 2009, 1,050,674 equity appreciation rights had been granted, 50,237 of such rights had been cancelled and 1,000,437 of such rights remain outstanding. The vesting of such rights is based upon continued employment and either a change in control of the Company or a qualified public offering as defined in the Rights Plan. Through January 30, 2009, no compensation expense related to the Rights Plan had been recognized based primarily on the uncertainty of the vesting events.


For the year ended January 30, 2009, the fair value method of SFAS 123(R) resulted in share-based compensation expense and a corresponding reduction in net income before income taxes in the amount of $10.0 million ($6.1 million net of tax) of which $8.9 million ($5.4 million net of tax) was related to stock options and $1.1 million ($0.7 million net of tax) was related to restricted stock as discussed below.


The 2007 Successor statement of operations reflects share-based compensation expense (a component of SG&A expenses) under the fair value method of SFAS 123(R) for outstanding share-based awards and a corresponding reduction of pre-tax income in the amount of $3.8 million ($2.4 million net of tax).


The Company recognized $45.4 million of share-based compensation expense in the 2007 Predecessor statement of operations ($28.5 million net of tax), including $6.0 million of  compensation expense prior to the Merger included in SG&A expenses comprised of $2.3 million for stock options and $3.7 million for restricted stock and restricted stock units. The remaining $39.4 million of such expense related directly to the Merger is reflected in Transaction and related costs in the consolidated statement of operations for the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007, for the accelerated vesting of stock options ($18.7 million) and restricted stock and restricted stock units ($20.7 million).


For the year ended February 2, 2007, the fair value method of SFAS 123(R) resulted in additional share-based compensation expense and a corresponding reduction in net income before income taxes in the amount of $3.6 million ($2.2 million net of tax).


The fair value of each option grant is separately estimated by applying the Black-Scholes-Merton option pricing valuation model. The weighted average for key assumptions used in determining the fair value of options granted in the year ended January 30, 2009, the Successor period ended February 1, 2008, the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 and the year ended February 2, 2007, and a summary of the methodology applied to develop each assumption, are as follows:




106






 

Successor Period Ended

 

Predecessor Period Ended

 

January 30, 2009

February 1, 2008

 

July 6,

2007

February 2, 2007

Expected dividend yield

%

%

 

0.91 

%

0.82 

%

Expected stock price volatility

40.2 

%

41.9 

%

 

18.5 

%

28.8 

%

Weighted average risk-free interest rate

2.8 

%

4.6 

%

 

4.5 

%

4.7 

%

Expected term of options (years)

7.4 

 

7.5 

 

 

5.7 

 

5.7 

 


Expected dividend yield - This is an estimate of the expected dividend yield on the Company’s stock.  Prior to the Merger this estimate was based on historical dividend payment trends. Subsequent to the Merger, the Company is subject to limitations on the payment of dividends under its credit facilities as further discussed in Note 6.  An increase in the dividend yield will decrease compensation expense.


Expected stock price volatility - This is a measure of the amount by which the price of the Company’s common stock has fluctuated or is expected to fluctuate. Prior to the Merger, the Company used actual historical changes in the market price of the Company’s common stock and implied volatility based upon traded options, weighted equally, to calculate the volatility assumption, as it was the Company’s belief that this methodology provided the best indicator of future volatility. For historical volatility, the Company calculated daily market price changes from the date of grant over a past period representative of the expected life of the options to determine volatility. Subsequent to the Merger the expected volatilities have been based upon the historical volatilities of a peer group of four companies, as the Company’s common stock is not publicly traded. An increase in the expected volatility will increase compensation expense.

 

Weighted average risk-free interest rate - This is the U.S. Treasury rate for the week of the grant having a term approximating the expected life of the option. An increase in the risk-free interest rate will increase compensation expense.

Expected term of options - This is the period of time over which the options granted are expected to remain outstanding. For options issued prior to the Merger, the Company took into consideration that its stock option grants prior to August 2002 were significantly different than grants issued on and after that date, and therefore that the historical and post-vesting employee behavior patterns for grants prior to that date were of little or no value in determining future expectations. As a result, the Company excluded these pre-August 2002 grants from its analysis of expected term. For pre-Merger options, the Company estimated expected term using a computation based on an assumption that outstanding options would be exercised approximately halfway through their contractual term, taking into consideration such factors as grant date, expiration date, weighted-average time-to-vest, actual exercises and post-vesting cancellations. Options granted have a maximum term of 10 years. Due to the absence of historical data for grants issued subsequent to the Merger, the Company has estimated the expected term as the mid-point between the vesting date and the contractual term of the option. An increase in the expected term will increase compensation expense.

 

All nonvested restricted stock and restricted stock unit awards granted in the 2007 Successor and Predecessor periods had a purchase price of zero. The Company records compensation expense on a straight-line basis over the restriction period based on the market price of the underlying stock on the date of grant. The nonvested restricted stock and restricted



107



stock unit awards granted under the plan to employees during the 2007 Predecessor period were originally scheduled to vest and become payable ratably over a three-year period from the respective grant dates. The nonvested restricted stock unit awards granted under the plan to non-employee directors during the 2007 Predecessor period were originally scheduled to vest over a one-year period from the respective grant dates, but became payable as a result of the Merger as discussed above.


In accordance with the provisions of SFAS 123(R), unearned compensation is not recorded within shareholders’ equity for nonvested restricted stock and restricted stock unit awards. Accordingly, during the year ended February 2, 2007, the Company reversed its unearned compensation balance as of February 3, 2006 of approximately $5.2 million, with an offset to common stock and additional paid-in capital.


At January 30, 2009, 1,129,297 Rollover Options were outstanding, all of which were exercisable. The aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding Rollover Options was $4.8 million with a weighted average remaining contractual term of 6.44 years, and a weighted average exercise price of $1.25. At February 1, 2008, 1,799,102 Rollover Options were outstanding, all of which were exercisable. The aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding Rollover Options was $6.7 million with a weighted average remaining contractual term of 7.36 years, and a weighted average exercise price of $1.25.


During the Predecessor period from February 3, 2007 to July 6, 2007 and year ended February 2, 2007, the weighted average grant date fair value of options granted was $5.37 and $5.86, respectively; 4,213,373 and 617,234 options vested, net of forfeitures, respectively; with a total fair value of approximately $23.6 million and $2.5 million, respectively; and the total intrinsic value of stock options exercised was $10.8 million and $6.8 million, respectively. The total intrinsic value of stock options repurchased by the Company under terms of the management stockholder’s agreements during 2008 and the 2007 Successor period was $2.5 million and $0.5 million, respectively.


All stock options granted prior to the Merger in the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007 and year ended February 2, 2007 under the terms of the Company’s pre-Merger stock incentive plan were non-qualified stock options issued at a price equal to the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant, were originally scheduled to vest ratably over a four-year period, and were to expire 10 years following the date of grant.


A summary of Time Options activity during the Successor period ended January 30, 2009 is as follows:


 

Options
Issued

 

Weighted Average
Exercise Price

Balance, February 1, 2008

 

  9,535,000 

 

 

 

$

5.00 

 

Granted

 

  2,979,645 

 

 

 

 

5.00 

 

Exercised

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Canceled

 

  (1,977,000)

 

 

 

 

5.00 

 

Balance, January 30, 2009

 

 10,537,645 

 

 

 

$

5.00 

 




108



During 2008, the weighted average grant date fair value of Time Options granted was $2.38; 1,566,000 Time Options vested and are exercisable, net of forfeitures, with a total fair value of approximately $4.1 million, and none of those options were exercised.  At January 30, 2009, the aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding 2007 Time Options was $5.3 million with a weighted average remaining contractual term of 8.9 years. During the 2007 Successor period, the weighted average grant date fair value of Time Options granted was $2.65; no options vested or were exercised. At February 1, 2008, the aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding 2007 Time Options was $0 with a weighted average remaining contractual term of 9.6 years, and none of the outstanding Time Options were exercisable.


A summary of Performance Options activity during the Successor period ended January 30, 2009 is as follows:


 

Options
Issued

 

Weighted Average
Exercise Price

Balance, February 1, 2008

 

  9,535,000 

 

 

 

$

5.00 

 

Granted

 

  2,979,645 

 

 

 

 

5.00 

 

Exercised

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Canceled

 

  (1,965,500)

 

 

 

 

5.00 

 

Balance, January 30, 2009

 

 10,549,145 

 

 

 

$

5.00 

 


During 2008, the weighted average grant date fair value of Performance Options granted was $2.38; 1,848,487 Performance Options vested and are exercisable, net of forfeitures, with a total fair value of approximately $4.8 million, and none of those options were exercised. At January 30, 2009, the aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding Performance Options was $5.3 million with a weighted average remaining contractual term of 8.9 years. During the 2007 Successor period, the weighted average grant date fair value of Performance Options granted was $2.65; 1,907,000 Performance Options vested and are exercisable, net of forfeitures, with a total fair value of approximately $5.1 million, and none of those options were exercised. At February 1, 2008, the aggregate intrinsic value of outstanding 2007 Performance Options was $0 with a weighted average remaining contractual term of 9.6 years.


At January 30, 2009, the total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested stock options was $42.9 million with an expected weighted average expense recognition period of 3.8 years.


The Company currently believes that the performance targets related to the Performance Options will be achieved.  If such goals are not met, and there is no change in control, no compensation cost relating to these Performance Options will be recognized and any compensation cost recognized to date will be reversed.  


In January 2008, the Company granted 890,000 nonvested restricted shares to its Chief Executive Officer. These shares vest on the first to occur of (i) a change in control, (ii) an initial public offering, (iii) termination without cause or due to death or disability, or (iv) the last day of the Company’s 2011 fiscal year. These shares represent the only outstanding restricted shares as of January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008. For 2008 and the 2007 Successor period, the share-based compensation expense related to restricted shares before income taxes was $1.1 million



109



($0.7 million net of tax) and less than $0.1 million, respectively. At January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008, the total compensation cost related to nonvested restricted stock awards not yet recognized was approximately $3.3 million and $4.4 million, respectively.

11.

Related party transactions


Affiliates of certain of the Investors participated as (i) lenders in the Company’s Credit Facilities discussed in Note 6; (ii) initial purchasers of the Company’s notes discussed in Note 6; (iii) counterparties to certain interest rate swaps discussed in Note 7 and (iv) as advisors in the Merger. Certain fees were paid upon closing of the Merger to affiliates of certain of the Investors.  These fees primarily included underwriting fees, advisory fees, equity commitment fees, syndication fees, Merger and acquisition fees, sponsor fees, costs of raising equity, and out of pocket expenses.  The aggregate fees paid to these related parties during the Successor period ended February 1, 2008 totaled $134.9 million, portions of which have been capitalized as debt financing costs or as direct acquisition costs.


Affiliates of KKR (among other entities) are lenders under, and Citicorp North America, Inc. serves as administrative agent and collateral agent for, the Company’s $2.3 billion senior secured term loan facility.  The amount of principal outstanding under this term loan facility at all times since the Merger was $2.3 billion, and the Company paid no principal and approximately $133.4 million of interest on the senior secured term loan during 2008.  The Company  paid $0.2 million to Citicorp North America, Inc. for its services relating to this facility in 2008 as further discussed in Note 6.


Goldman, Sachs & Co. is a counterparty to an amortizing interest rate swap totaling $433.3 million as of January 30, 2009, entered into in connection with the Company’s senior secured term loan facility. The Company paid Goldman, Sachs & Co. approximately $9.5 million in 2008 pursuant to the interest rate swap as further discussed in Note 7.

The Company entered into a monitoring agreement, dated July 6, 2007, with affiliates of certain of the Investors pursuant to which those entities will provide management and advisory services to the Company. Under the terms of the monitoring agreement, among other things, the Company is obliged to pay to those entities an aggregate, initial annual management fee of $5.0 million payable in arrears at the end of each calendar quarter plus all reasonable out of pocket expenses incurred in connection with the provision of services under the agreement upon request.  The management fees and other expenses incurred for the Successor periods ended January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 totaled $6.6 million and $2.9 million, respectively.  The management fee increases at a rate of 5% per year. Those entities also are entitled to receive a fee equal to 1% of the gross transaction value in connection with certain subsequent financing, acquisition, disposition, and change in control transactions, as well as a termination fee in the event of an initial public offering or under certain other circumstances. In addition, on July 6, 2007, the Company entered into a separate indemnification agreement with the parties to the monitoring agreement, pursuant to which the Company agreed to provide customary indemnification to such parties and their affiliates.


The Company uses Capstone Consulting, LLC, a team of executives who work exclusively with KKR portfolio companies providing certain consulting services.  The Chief



110



Executive Officer of Capstone served on the Company’s Board of Directors until March 2009. Although neither KKR nor any entity affiliated with KKR owns any of the equity of Capstone, prior to January 1, 2007 KKR had provided financing to Capstone.  The aggregate fees incurred for Capstone services for the Successor periods ended January 30, 2009 and February 1, 2008 totaled $3.0 million and $1.9 million, respectively.


The Company purchased certain of its 11.857%/12.625% senior subordinated notes held by Goldman Sachs & Co. in the amount of $25.0 million in January 2008 as further discussed in Note 6, and paid commissions less than $0.1 million in connection therewith.

  

12.

Capital stock


On November 29, 2006 and September 30, 2005, the Predecessor’s Board of Directors authorized the Company to repurchase up to $500 million and up to 10 million shares, respectively, of the Predecessor’s outstanding common stock. These authorizations allowed for purchases in the open market or in privately negotiated transactions from time to time, subject to market conditions. The objective of these share repurchase initiatives was to enhance shareholder value by purchasing shares at a price that produced a return on investment that was greater than the Company’s cost of capital. Additionally, share repurchases generally were undertaken only if such purchases resulted in an accretive impact on the Company’s fully diluted earnings per share calculation.  No purchases were made pursuant to the 2006 authorization, which was terminated as a result of the Merger. During 2006, the Company purchased approximately 4.5 million shares of the Predecessor pursuant to the 2005 authorization at a total cost of $79.9 million.


13.

Hurricane Katrina insurance settlement


During 2006, the Company settled an insurance claim related to Hurricane Katrina and received proceeds of $13.0 million representing insurance recoveries for destroyed and damaged assets, costs incurred and business interruption coverage, which are reflected in results of operations for 2006 as a reduction of SG&A expenses. The business interruption portion of the proceeds was approximately $5.8 million. Insurance recoveries related to fixed assets losses are included in cash flows from investing activities and recoveries related to inventory losses and business interruption are included in cash flows from operating activities.


14.

Segment reporting


The Company manages its business on the basis of one reportable segment.  See Note 1 for a brief description of the Company’s business.  As of January 30, 2009, all of the Company’s operations were located within the United States with the exception of an immaterial Hong Kong subsidiary which assists in the importing of certain merchandise that began operations in 2004.  The following net sales data is presented in accordance with SFAS 131, “Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information.”




111






 

Successor

 

Predecessor

(In thousands)

2008

 

March 6, 2007 through
February 1, 2008

 

February 3, 2007 through
July 6, 2007

 

2006

Classes of similar products:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Highly consumable

$

7,248,418

 

 

$

3,701,724

 

 

$

2,615,110

 

 

$

6,022,014

 

Seasonal

 

1,521,450

 

 

 

908,301

 

 

 

604,935

 

 

 

1,509,999

 

Home products

 

862,226

 

 

 

507,027

 

 

 

362,725

 

 

 

914,357

 

Basic clothing

 

825,574

 

 

 

454,441

 

 

 

340,983

 

 

 

723,452

 

Net sales

$

10,457,668

 

 

$

5,571,493

 

 

$

3,923,753

 

 

$

9,169,822

 


15.

Quarterly financial data (unaudited)


The following is selected unaudited quarterly financial data for the fiscal year ended January 30, 2009, the Successor period ended February 1, 2008, and the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007. Each quarterly period listed below was a 13-week accounting period. The sum of the four quarters for any given year may not equal annual totals due to rounding.  


Successor

(In thousands)

 

First Quarter

 

 

 

Second Quarter

 

 

 

Third Quarter

 

 

 

Fourth Quarter

 

2008:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

2,403,498

 

 

$

2,609,384

 

 

$

2,598,938 

 

 

$

2,845,848

 

Gross profit

 

693,077

 

 

 

758,035

 

 

 

772,287 

 

 

 

837,698

 

Operating profit

 

110,871

 

 

 

143,055

 

 

 

103,732 

 

 

 

222,828

 

Net income (loss)

 

5,916

 

 

 

27,718

 

 

 

(7,306)

 

 

 

 81,854

 


 

Predecessor

 

Successor (a)

(In thousands )

 

First Quarter

 

May 5,
2007
through
July 6,
2007

 

 

March 6,
2007
through
August 3,
2007

 

 

Third

Quarter

 

 

Fourth Quarter

2007:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

2,275,267

$

1,648,486 

 

$

699,078 

 

$

2,312,842 

 

$

2,559,573

Gross profit

 

633,060

 

438,515 

 

 

184,723 

 

 

646,800 

 

 

740,371

Operating profit (loss)

 

55,368

 

(46,120)

 

 

(6,025)

 

 

65,703 

 

 

186,466

Net income (loss)

 

34,875

 

(42,873)

 

 

(27,175)

 

 

(33,032)

 

 

55,389


(a)

Includes the results of operations of Buck Acquisition Corp. for the period prior to its Merger with and into Dollar General Corporation from March 6, 2007 (its formation) through July 6, 2007 (reflecting the change in fair value of interest rate swaps), and the post-Merger results of Dollar General Corporation for the period from July 7, 2007 through February 1, 2008.  See Notes 1 and 2.

As discussed in Note 1, in the second, third, and fourth quarters of 2008, the Company recorded LIFO provisions of $16.0 million, $15.7 million, and $12.1 million respectively.  These charges are reflected in Cost of goods sold for each quarter, respectively.  


As discussed in Note 8, in the third quarter of 2008, based on the agreement in principle to settle the Merger-related shareholder litigation, the Company recorded charges of approximately $34.5 million in connection with the proposed settlement, which was net of anticipated insurance proceeds of $7.5 million.  In the fourth quarter of 2008, the Company received insurance proceeds totaling $10.0 million, thus reducing the charges to $32.0 million



112



net of insurance proceeds and increasing operating profit by the incremental $2.5 million. These amounts are reflected as Litigation settlement and related costs, net in the respective quarters.   


As discussed in Note 3, in the fourth quarter of 2008, the Company recorded net additional pre-tax expenses of $3.3 million related to underperforming stores closed in fiscal years 2006 and 2007.  These additional expenses are related to re-evaluation of the existing lease contract termination liabilities based on current market conditions and are reflected as SG&A expense.


As discussed in Note 6, in the fourth quarter of 2008, the Company repurchased $44.1 million of the 11.875%/12.625% senior subordinated toggle notes due 2017 resulting in a net gain of $3.8 million which is recognized as Other (income) expense.  


As discussed in Note 8, in the fourth quarter of 2008, the Company recorded an $8.6 million charge included in Cost of goods sold related to the markdown of certain products covered by the Consumer Products Safety Improvement Act of 2008, and reversed $5.0 million of SG&A expenses originally recorded in fiscal 2007 related to certain distribution center lease contingencies.

As discussed in Note 2, in the Predecessor period ended July 6, 2007, the Company recorded transaction and other costs related to the Merger of $56.7 million and share-based compensation expense related directly to the Merger of $39.4 million as discussed in Note 10. As discussed in Note 2, in the Successor period ended August 3, 2007, the Company recorded transaction and other costs related to the Merger of $5.6 million, a loss on debt retirement related to the Merger of $6.2 million as discussed in Note 6; a contingent loss related to certain DC leases of $8.6 million as discussed in Note 8; and a gain on certain interest rate swaps discussed in Note 7 of $6.8 million.


In the third quarter of 2007, the Company recorded an additional contingent loss related to certain DC leases of $3.4 million as discussed in Note 8.

As discussed in Note 6, in the fourth quarter of 2007, the Company recorded a gain on debt retirement of $4.9 million.


16.

Guarantor subsidiaries


Certain of the Company’s subsidiaries (the “Guarantors”) have fully and unconditionally guaranteed on a joint and several basis the Company's obligations under certain outstanding debt obligations. Each of the Guarantors is a direct or indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. The following consolidating schedules present condensed financial information on a combined basis, in thousands.




113






SUCCESSOR

As of January 30, 2009

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

BALANCE SHEET:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

$

292,637 

 

 

$

64,404 

 

 

$

20,954

 

 

$

 

 

$

377,995 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

 

 

 

1,414,955 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,414,955 

 

Income tax receivable

 

50,601 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(44,209)

 

 

 

6,392 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

5,892 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,560

 

 

 

(3,852)

 

 

 

4,600 

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

462,572 

 

 

 

2,016,712 

 

 

 

5,894

 

 

 

(2,418,995)

 

 

 

66,183 

 

Total current assets

 

811,702 

 

 

 

3,496,071 

 

 

 

29,408

 

 

 

(2,467,056)

 

 

 

1,870,125 

 

Net property and equipment

 

82,616 

 

 

 

1,186,125 

 

 

 

219

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,268,960 

 

Goodwill

 

4,338,589 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,338,589 

 

Intangible assets

 

1,205,667 

 

 

 

119,891 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,325,558 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,518

 

 

 

(3,518)

 

 

 

 

Other assets, net

 

3,384,089 

 

 

 

130,100 

 

 

 

280,204

 

 

 

(3,708,426)

 

 

 

85,967 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

$

9,822,663 

 

 

$

4,932,187 

 

 

$

313,349

 

 

$

(6,179,000)

 

 

$

8,889,199 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current portion of long-term obligations

$

11,500 

 

 

$

2,658 

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

 

 

$

14,158 

 

Accounts payable

 

2,007,625 

 

 

 

1,035,057 

 

 

 

46,644

 

 

 

(2,410,905)

 

 

 

678,421 

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

108,504 

 

 

 

220,142 

 

 

 

54,489

 

 

 

(8,090)

 

 

 

375,045 

 

Income taxes payable

 

1,659 

 

 

 

48,467 

 

 

 

1,694

 

 

 

(44,209)

 

 

 

7,611 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

 

 

 

3,852 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(3,852)

 

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

 

2,129,288 

 

 

 

1,310,176 

 

 

 

102,827

 

 

 

(2,467,056)

 

 

 

1,075,235 

 

Long-term obligations

 

4,346,258 

 

 

 

2,383,304 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(2,606,606)

 

 

 

4,122,956 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

397,570 

 

 

 

162,049 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(3,518)

 

 

 

556,101 

 

Other non-current liabilities

 

103,928 

 

 

 

37,653 

 

 

 

147,707

 

 

 

 

 

 

289,288 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Redeemable common stock

 

13,924 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,924 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common stock

 

278,114 

 

 

 

23,855 

 

 

 

100

 

 

 

(23,955)

 

 

 

278,114 

 

Additional paid-in capital

 

2,489,647 

 

 

 

553,639 

 

 

 

19,900

 

 

 

(573,539)

 

 

 

2,489,647 

 

Retained earnings

 

103,364 

 

 

 

461,511 

 

 

 

42,815

 

 

 

(504,326)

 

 

 

103,364 

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(39,430)

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

(39,430)

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

2,831,695 

 

 

 

1,039,005 

 

 

 

62,815

 

 

 

(1,101,820)

 

 

 

2,831,695 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

$

9,822,663 

 

 

$

4,932,187 

 

 

$

313,349

 

 

$

(6,179,000)

 

 

$

8,889,199 

 



114




SUCCESSOR

As of February 1, 2008

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

BALANCE SHEET:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

$

8,320 

 

 

$

59,379

 

 

$

32,510

 

 

$

 

 

$

100,209 

 

Short-term investments

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

19,611

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,611 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

 

 

 

1,288,661

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,288,661 

 

Income tax receivable

 

102,273 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(69,772)

 

 

 

32,501 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

3,966 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

20,626

 

 

 

(7,295)

 

 

 

17,297 

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

221,408 

 

 

 

337,741

 

 

 

9,341

 

 

 

(509,025)

 

 

 

59,465 

 

Total current assets

 

335,967 

 

 

 

1,685,781

 

 

 

82,088

 

 

 

(586,092)

 

 

 

1,517,744 

 

Net property and equipment

 

83,658 

 

 

 

1,190,131

 

 

 

456

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,274,245 

 

Goodwill

 

4,344,930 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,344,930 

 

Intangible assets

 

10,911 

 

 

 

1,359,646

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,370,557 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

43,890 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

47,067

 

 

 

(90,957)

 

 

 

 

Other assets, net

 

2,629,967 

 

 

 

1,652

 

 

 

111,597

 

 

 

(2,594,261)

 

 

 

148,955 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

$

7,449,323 

 

 

$

4,237,210

 

 

$

241,208

 

 

$

(3,271,310)

 

 

$

8,656,431 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current portion of long-term obligations

$

 

 

$

3,246

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

 

 

$

3,246 

 

Accounts payable

 

253,477 

 

 

 

736,844

 

 

 

40

 

 

 

(439,321)

 

 

 

551,040 

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

62,957 

 

 

 

188,877

 

 

 

55,185

 

 

 

(6,063)

 

 

 

300,956 

 

Income taxes payable

 

 

 

 

59,264

 

 

 

13,507

 

 

 

(69,772)

 

 

 

2,999 

 

Total current liabilities

 

316,434 

 

 

 

988,231

 

 

 

68,732

 

 

 

(515,156)

 

 

 

858,241 

 

Long-term obligations

 

4,257,250 

 

 

 

1,837,715

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(1,816,209)

 

 

 

4,278,756 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

 

 

 

584,976

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

(98,251)

 

 

 

486,725 

 

Other liabilities

 

162,644 

 

 

 

21,191

 

 

 

135,879

 

 

 

 

 

 

319,714 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Redeemable common stock

 

9,122 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,122 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Common stock

 

277,741 

 

 

 

23,753

 

 

 

100

 

 

 

(23,853)

 

 

 

277,741 

 

Additional paid-in capital

 

2,480,062 

 

 

 

653,711

 

 

 

19,900

 

 

 

(673,611)

 

 

 

2,480,062 

 

Retained earnings

 

(4,818)

 

 

 

127,633

 

 

 

16,597

 

 

 

(144,230)

 

 

 

(4,818)

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(49,112)

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

(49,112)

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

2,703,873 

 

 

 

805,097

 

 

 

36,597

 

 

 

(841,694)

 

 

 

2,703,873 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

$

7,449,323 

 

 

$

4,237,210

 

 

$

241,208

 

 

$

(3,271,310)

 

 

$

8,656,431 

 



115




SUCCESSOR

For the year ended January 30, 2009

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

236,682 

 

 

$

10,457,668 

 

 

$

97,917 

 

 

$

(334,599)

 

 

$

10,457,668 

 

Cost of goods sold

 

 

 

 

7,396,571 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,396,571 

 

Gross profit

 

236,682 

 

 

 

3,061,097 

 

 

 

97,917 

 

 

 

(334,599)

 

 

 

3,061,097 

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

210,665 

 

 

 

2,499,331 

 

 

 

73,214 

 

 

 

(334,599)

 

 

 

2,448,611 

 

Litigation settlement and related costs, net

 

32,000 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

32,000 

 

Operating profit (loss)

 

(5,983)

 

 

 

561,766 

 

 

 

24,703 

 

 

 

 

 

 

580,486 

 

Interest income

 

(62,722)

 

 

 

(36,844)

 

 

 

(13,532)

 

 

 

110,037 

 

 

 

(3,061)

 

Interest expense

 

427,365 

 

 

 

74,586 

 

 

 

18 

 

 

 

(110,037)

 

 

 

391,932 

 

Other (income) expense

 

(2,788)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(2,788)

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

(367,838)

 

 

 

524,024 

 

 

 

38,217 

 

 

 

 

 

 

194,403 

 

Income taxes

 

(115,924)

 

 

 

190,146 

 

 

 

11,999 

 

 

 

 

 

 

86,221 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net of taxes

 

360,096 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(360,096)

 

 

 

 

Net income

$

108,182 

 

 

$

333,878 

 

 

$

26,218 

 

 

$

(360,096)

 

 

$

108,182 

 


SUCCESSOR

March 6, 2007 through February 1, 2008

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

96,300 

 

 

$

5,571,493 

 

 

$

65,057 

 

 

$

(161,357)

 

 

$

5,571,493 

 

Cost of goods sold

 

 

 

 

3,999,599 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,999,599 

 

Gross profit

 

96,300 

 

 

 

1,571,894 

 

 

 

65,057 

 

 

 

(161,357)

 

 

 

1,571,894 

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

102,030 

 

 

 

1,337,311 

 

 

 

46,524 

 

 

 

(161,357)

 

 

 

1,324,508 

 

Transaction and related costs

 

1,242 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,242 

 

Operating profit (loss)

 

(6,972)

 

 

 

234,583 

 

 

 

18,533 

 

 

 

 

 

 

246,144 

 

Interest income

 

(58,786)

 

 

 

(23,206)

 

 

 

(8,013)

 

 

 

86,206 

 

 

 

(3,799)

 

Interest expense

 

274,104 

 

 

 

64,991 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(86,206)

 

 

 

252,897 

 

Other (income) expense

 

3,639 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,639 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

(225,929)

 

 

 

192,798 

 

 

 

26,538 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(6,593)

 

Income taxes

 

(76,881)

 

 

 

65,166 

 

 

 

9,940 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1,775)

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net of taxes

 

144,230 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(144,230)

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$

(4,818)

 

 

$

127,632 

 

 

$

16,598 

 

 

$

(144,230)

 

 

$

(4,818)

 



116





PREDECESSOR

February 3, 2007 through July 6, 2007

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

76,945 

 

 

$

3,923,753 

 

 

$

44,206 

 

 

$

(121,151)

 

 

$

3,923,753 

 

Cost of goods sold

 

 

 

 

2,852,178 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,852,178 

 

Gross profit

 

76,945 

 

 

 

1,071,575 

 

 

 

44,206 

 

 

 

(121,151)

 

 

 

1,071,575 

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

64,827 

 

 

 

982,321 

 

 

 

34,933 

 

 

 

(121,151)

 

 

 

960,930 

 

Transaction and related costs

 

101,397 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

101,397 

 

Operating profit (loss)

 

(89,279)

 

 

 

89,254 

 

 

 

9,273 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,248 

 

Interest income

 

(53,278)

 

 

 

(11,472)

 

 

 

(5,626)

 

 

 

65,330 

 

 

 

(5,046)

 

Interest expense

 

19,796 

 

 

 

55,828 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(65,330)

 

 

 

10,299 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

 

(55,797)

 

 

 

44,898 

 

 

 

14,894 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,995 

 

Income taxes

 

(4,814)

 

 

 

11,924 

 

 

 

4,883 

 

 

 

 

 

 

11,993 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net of taxes

 

42,985 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(42,985)

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$

(7,998)

 

 

$

32,974 

 

 

$

10,011 

 

 

$

(42,985)

 

 

$

(7,998)

 


PREDECESSOR

For the year ended February 2, 2007

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net sales

$

165,463 

 

 

$

9,169,822 

 

 

$

107,383 

 

 

$

(272,846)

 

 

$

9,169,822 

 

Cost of goods sold

 

 

 

 

6,801,617 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,801,617 

 

Gross profit

 

165,463 

 

 

 

2,368,205 

 

 

 

107,383 

 

 

 

(272,846)

 

 

 

2,368,205 

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

149,272 

 

 

 

2,154,371 

 

 

 

89,132 

 

 

 

(272,846)

 

 

 

2,119,929 

 

Operating profit

 

16,191 

 

 

 

213,834 

 

 

 

18,251 

 

 

 

 

 

 

248,276 

 

Interest income

 

(126,628)

 

 

 

(33,521)

 

 

 

(11,543)

 

 

 

164,690 

 

 

 

(7,002)

 

Interest expense

 

60,856 

 

 

 

138,749 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(164,690)

 

 

 

34,915 

 

Income before income taxes

 

81,963 

 

 

 

108,606 

 

 

 

29,794 

 

 

 

 

 

 

220,363 

 

Income taxes

 

36,513 

 

 

 

36,568 

 

 

 

9,339 

 

 

 

 

 

 

82,420 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net of taxes

 

92,493 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(92,493)

 

 

 

 

Net income

$

137,943 

 

 

$

72,038 

 

 

$

20,455 

 

 

$

(92,493)

 

 

$

137,943 

 



117






SUCCESSOR

For the year ended January 30, 2009

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

$

108,182 

 

 

$

333,878 

 

 

$

26,218 

 

 

$

(360,096)

 

 

$

108,182 

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

34,638 

 

 

 

213,003 

 

 

 

258 

 

 

 

 

 

 

247,899 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

(4,681)

 

 

 

16,500 

 

 

 

61,615 

 

 

 

 

 

 

73,434 

 

Tax benefit of stock options

 

(950)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(950)

 

Noncash inventory adjustments and asset impairments

 

 

 

 

50,671 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

50,671 

 

Noncash share-based compensation

 

9,958 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,958 

 

Other noncash gains and losses

 

(3,104)

 

 

 

5,538 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,434 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net

 

(360,096)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

360,096 

 

 

 

 

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

 

 

 

(173,014)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(173,014)

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

(2,310)

 

 

 

3,765 

 

 

 

(2,053)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(598)

 

Accounts payable

 

18,717 

 

 

 

121,546 

 

 

 

93 

 

 

 

 

 

 

140,356 

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

11,427 

 

 

 

46,177 

 

 

 

11,132 

 

 

 

 

 

 

68,736 

 

Income taxes

 

56,596 

 

 

 

(10,797)

 

 

 

(11,813)

 

 

 

 

 

 

33,986 

 

Other

 

2,529 

 

 

 

11,643 

 

 

 

(88)

 

 

 

 

 

 

14,084 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

 

(129,094)

 

 

 

618,910 

 

 

 

85,362 

 

 

 

 

 

 

575,178 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of property and equipment

 

(16,467)

 

 

 

(189,058)

 

 

 

(21)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(205,546)

 

Purchases of short-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(9,903)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(9,903)

 

Sales of short-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

61,547 

 

 

 

 

 

 

61,547 

 

Proceeds from sale of property and equipment

 

 

 

 

1,266 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,266 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

 

(16,467)

 

 

 

(187,792)

 

 

 

51,623 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(152,636)

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issuance of common stock

 

4,228 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,228 

 

Net borrowings (repayments) under revolving credit facility

 

(102,500)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(102,500)

 

Repayments of long-term obligations

 

(40,780)

 

 

 

(3,645)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(44,425)

 

Repurchases of stock options

 

(2,511)

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(2,511)

 

Repurchases of common stock

 

(498)

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(498)

 

Tax benefit of stock options

 

950 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

950 

 

Changes in intercompany note balances, net

 

570,989 

 

 

 

(422,448)

 

 

 

(148,541)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

429,878 

 

 

 

(426,093)

 

 

 

(148,541)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(144,756)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

 

284,317 

 

 

 

5,025 

 

 

 

(11,556)

 

 

 

 

 

 

277,786 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

 

8,320 

 

 

 

59,379 

 

 

 

32,510 

 

 

 

 

 

 

100,209 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

$

292,637 

 

 

$

64,404 

 

 

$

20,954 

 

 

$

 

 

$

377,995 

 



118






SUCCESSOR

March 6, 2007 through February 1, 2008

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$

(4,818)

 

 

$

127,632 

 

 

$

16,598 

 

 

$

(144,230)

 

 

$

(4,818)

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

21,634 

 

 

 

128,431 

 

 

 

148 

 

 

 

 

 

 

150,213 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

(2,120)

 

 

 

20,208 

 

 

 

1,463 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,551 

 

Noncash inventory adjustments and asset impairments

 

 

 

 

6,113 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,113 

 

Noncash share-based compensation

 

3,827 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,827 

 

Other noncash gains and losses

 

4,954 

 

 

 

571 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,525 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net

 

(144,230)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

144,230 

 

 

 

 

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

 

 

 

73,356 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

73,356 

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

(1,120)

 

 

 

4,783 

 

 

 

76 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,739 

 

Accounts payable

 

(40,745)

 

 

 

12,428 

 

 

 

(13,078)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(41,395)

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

(7,456)

 

 

 

6,418 

 

 

 

17,099 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16,061 

 

Income taxes

 

(45,416)

 

 

 

44,829 

 

 

 

7,935 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,348 

 

Other

 

(3,169)

 

 

 

3,675 

 

 

 

(422)

 

 

 

 

 

 

84 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

 

(218,659)

 

 

 

428,444 

 

 

 

29,819 

 

 

 

 

 

 

239,604 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merger, net of cash acquired

 

(5,649,182)

 

 

 

(1,129,953)

 

 

 

40,744 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(6,738,391)

 

Purchases of property and equipment

 

(1,617)

 

 

 

(82,003)

 

 

 

(21)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(83,641)

 

Purchases of short-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3,800)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3,800)

 

Sales of short-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,445 

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,445 

 

Purchases of long-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(7,473)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(7,473)

 

Purchase of promissory note

 

 

 

 

(37,047)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(37,047)

 

Proceeds from sale of property and equipment

 

 

 

 

533 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

533 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

 

(5,650,799)

 

 

 

(1,248,470)

 

 

 

50,895 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(6,848,374)

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issuance of common stock

 

2,759,540 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,759,540 

 

Net borrowings (repayments) under revolving credit facility

 

102,500 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

102,500 

 

Issuance of long-term obligations

 

4,176,817 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

4,176,817 

 

Repayments of long-term obligations

 

(236,084)

 

 

 

(5,861)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(241,945)

 

Debt issuance costs

 

(87,392)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(87,392)

 

Repurchase of common stock

 

(541)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(541)

 

Changes in intercompany note balances, net

 

(837,062)

 

 

 

885,266 

 

 

 

(48,204)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

5,877,778 

 

 

 

879,405 

 

 

 

(48,204)

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,708,979 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

8,320 

 

 

 

59,379 

 

 

 

32,510 

 

 

 

 

 

 

100,209 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

$

8,320 

 

 

$

59,379 

 

 

$

32,510 

 

 

$

 

 

$

100,209 

 



119






PREDECESSOR

February 3, 2007 through July 6, 2007

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

$

(7,998)

 

 

$

32,974 

 

 

$

10,011 

 

 

$

(42,985)

 

 

$

(7,998)

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

9,051 

 

 

 

74,770 

 

 

 

96 

 

 

 

 

 

 

83,917 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

(7,982)

 

 

 

(9,194)

 

 

 

(3,698)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(20,874)

 

Tax benefit of stock options

 

(3,927)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(3,927)

 

Noncash share-based compensation

 

45,433 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

45,433 

 

Other noncash gains and losses

 

 

 

 

5,098 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,098 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net

 

(42,985)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

42,985 

 

 

 

 

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

 

 

 

16,424 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16,424 

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

5,758 

 

 

 

(11,762)

 

 

 

(180)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(6,184)

 

Accounts payable

 

44,909 

 

 

 

(23,103)

 

 

 

12,988 

 

 

 

 

 

 

34,794 

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

7,897 

 

 

 

36,021 

 

 

 

9,077 

 

 

 

 

 

 

52,995 

 

Income taxes

 

(24,998)

 

 

 

31,741 

 

 

 

(3,934)

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,809 

 

Other

 

21 

 

 

 

(372)

 

 

 

(190)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(541)

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

25,179 

 

 

 

152,597 

 

 

 

24,170 

 

 

 

 

 

 

201,946 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of property and equipment

 

(5,321)

 

 

 

(50,737)

 

 

 

(95)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(56,153)

 

Purchases of short-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5,100)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5,100)

 

Sales of short-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,505 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,505 

 

Purchases of long-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(15,754)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(15,754)

 

Proceeds from sale of property and equipment

 

 

 

 

620 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

620 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

 

(5,321)

 

 

 

(50,117)

 

 

 

(11,444)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(66,882)

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Repayments of long-term obligations

 

(148)

 

 

 

(4,352)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(4,500)

 

Payment of cash dividends

 

(15,710)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(15,710)

 

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

 

41,546 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

41,546 

 

Tax benefit of stock options

 

3,927 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,927 

 

Changes in intercompany note balances, net

 

75,840 

 

 

 

(86,988)

 

 

 

11,148 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

105,455 

 

 

 

(91,340)

 

 

 

11,148 

 

 

 

 

 

 

25,263 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

125,313 

 

 

 

11,140 

 

 

 

23,874 

 

 

 

 

 

 

160,327 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

 

114,310 

 

 

 

58,107 

 

 

 

16,871 

 

 

 

 

 

 

189,288 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

$

239,623 

 

 

$

69,247 

 

 

$

40,745 

 

 

$

 

 

$

349,615 

 




120






PREDECESSOR

For the year ended February 2, 2007

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

GUARANTOR SUBSIDIARIES

 

OTHER  SUBSIDIARIES

 

ELIMINATIONS

 

CONSOLIDATED

TOTAL

STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

$

137,943 

 

 

$

72,038 

 

 

$

20,455 

 

 

$

(92,493)

 

 

$

137,943 

 

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

21,436 

 

 

 

178,920 

 

 

 

252 

 

 

 

 

 

 

200,608 

 

Deferred income taxes

 

(1,845)

 

 

 

(35,118)

 

 

 

(1,255)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(38,218)

 

Tax benefit of stock options

 

(2,513)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(2,513)

 

Noncash inventory adjustments and asset impairments

 

 

 

 

76,599 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

76,599 

 

Noncash share-based compensation

 

7,578 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

7,578 

 

Other noncash gains and losses

 

 

 

 

5,820 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

5,820 

 

Equity in subsidiaries’ earnings, net

 

(92,493)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

92,493 

 

 

 

 

Change in operating assets and liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Merchandise inventories

 

 

 

 

(26,541)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(26,541)

 

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

 

(1,042)

 

 

 

(13,655)

 

 

 

9,286 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(5,411)

 

Accounts payable

 

(4,246)

 

 

 

39,189 

 

 

 

18,601 

 

 

 

 

 

 

53,544 

 

Accrued expenses and other

 

(225)

 

 

 

38,564 

 

 

 

14 

 

 

 

 

 

 

38,353 

 

Income taxes

 

(2,558)

 

 

 

(29,524)

 

 

 

(3,083)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(35,165)

 

Other

 

430 

 

 

 

(7,670)

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

(7,240)

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

62,465 

 

 

 

298,622 

 

 

 

44,270 

 

 

 

 

 

 

405,357 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of property and equipment

 

(13,270)

 

 

 

(247,788)

 

 

 

(457)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(261,515)

 

Purchases of short-term investments

 

(38,700)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(10,975)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(49,675)

 

Sales of short-term investments

 

38,700 

 

 

 

 

 

 

12,825 

 

 

 

 

 

 

51,525 

 

Purchases of long-term investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(25,756)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(25,756)

 

Sale and insurance proceeds related to property and equipment

 

143 

 

 

 

3,303 

 

 

 

11 

 

 

 

 

 

 

3,457 

 

Net cash used in investing activities

 

(13,127)

 

 

 

(244,485)

 

 

 

(24,352)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(281,964)

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net borrowings (repayments) under revolving credit facility

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Repayments of long-term obligations

 

97 

 

 

 

(14,215)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(14,118)

 

Debt issuance costs

 

(584)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(584)

 

Payment of cash dividends

 

(62,472)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(62,472)

 

Exercises of stock options

 

19,894 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

19,894 

 

Repurchases of common stock

 

(79,947)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(79,947)

 

Tax benefit of stock options

 

2,513 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2,513 

 

Changes in intercompany note balances, net

 

75,061 

 

 

 

(40,299)

 

 

 

(34,762)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net cash used in financing activities

 

(45,438)

 

 

 

(54,514)

 

 

 

(34,762)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(134,714)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

 

3,900 

 

 

 

(377)

 

 

 

(14,844)

 

 

 

 

 

 

(11,321)

 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year

 

110,410 

 

 

 

58,484 

 

 

 

31,715 

 

 

 

 

 

 

200,609 

 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of year

$

114,310 

 

 

$

58,107 

 

 

$

16,871 

 

 

$

 

 

$

189,288 

 




121



ITEM 9.

CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE


Not Applicable.


ITEM 9A(T).

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES


(a)

Disclosure Controls and Procedures.  Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, we conducted an evaluation of our disclosure controls and procedures, as such term is defined under Rule 13a-15(e) or 15d-15(e) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”). Based on this evaluation, our principal executive officer and our principal financial officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report.

 

(b)

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our management prepared and is responsible for the consolidated financial statements and all related financial information contained in this report. This responsibility includes establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) or 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Our internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with United States generally accepted accounting principles.


To comply with the requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes–Oxley Act of 2002, management designed and implemented a structured and comprehensive assessment process to evaluate its internal control over financial reporting. Such assessment  was based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. Because of its inherent limitations, a system of internal control over financial reporting can provide only reasonable assurance and may not prevent or detect misstatements. Management regularly monitors our internal control over financial reporting, and actions are taken to correct any deficiencies as they are identified. Based on its assessment, management has concluded that our internal control over financial reporting is effective as of January 30, 2009.


This annual report does not include an attestation report of Ernst & Young LLP regarding internal control over financial reporting. Management’s report was not subject to attestation by Ernst & Young LLP pursuant to temporary rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission that permit us to provide only management’s report in this annual report.


(c)

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting .  There have been no changes during the quarter ended January 30, 2009 in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 13a-15(f)) that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.  




122



ITEM 9B.

OTHER INFORMATION


Named Executive Officer Base Salary Adjustments


On March 18, 2009, the Compensation Committee of our Board of Directors approved annual base salary increases for each of our named executive officers listed below (the “named executive officers”), all to be effective April 1, 2009.  Mr. Dreiling’s base salary increase was recommended by the Compensation Committee and, on March 19, 2009, approved by the Board of Directors.


Name and Position

Percent  Increase

Annual Base Salary
Effective April 1, 2009

Richard Dreiling, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

12.1%

$1,121,000

David Bere, President and Chief Strategy Officer

2.25%

$759,339

David Tehle, Executive Vice President and CFO

2.25%

$629,167

Kathleen Guion, Executive Vice President, Division President, Store Operations and Store Development

2.25%

$608,388

Susan Lanigan, Executive Vice President and General Counsel

5.00%

$456,717


Named Executive Officer Bonus Program


On March 18, 2009, the Compensation Committee approved the fiscal 2009 annual bonus program (the “2009 Teamshare Program”) applicable to the named executive officers, among others. Mr. Dreiling’s participation in the 2009 Teamshare Program (to the extent not otherwise required by the terms of his employment agreement with us) was recommended by the Compensation Committee and, on March 19, 2009, approved by the Board of Directors.  


Under the 2009 Teamshare Program, the named executive officers will be eligible to receive a cash bonus payment equal to a certain percentage of base salary based upon the Company’s achievement in fiscal 2009 of a pre-established financial performance measure based upon earnings before interest, taxes, amortization and depreciation (“EBITDA”), with adjustments similar to those made for purposes of calculating performance targets for our long-term incentive program, including exclusions for the impact of: (a) any fee paid to Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., Goldman Sachs & Co. and any affiliates thereof pursuant to the terms of the Monitoring Fee Letter Agreement dated July 6, 2007; (b) all consulting, accounting, legal, valuation, banking, filing, disclosure and similar costs, fees and expenses directly related to the consideration, negotiation, approval and consummation of the proposed acquisition and related financing of the Company by affiliates of Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. (including without limitation any costs, fees and expenses relating to the filing and maintenance of the Form S-1 market maker registration statement) and any litigation or settlement of any litigation related thereto; (c) any costs, fees and expenses directly related to the consideration, negotiation, and



123



consummation of any public offering of our common stock or any asset sale, merger or other transaction that results in a change-in-control of the Company; and (d) any unplanned items of a non-recurring or extraordinary nature as determined in good faith by the CEO and CFO and approved by the Committee.


The Committee established a target financial performance level for purposes of the 2009 Teamshare Program at a level equal to the Company’s annual financial objective.  The Committee also established the threshold financial performance level, below which no bonus may be paid under the 2009 Teamshare Program, at 95% of the target financial performance level. There is no maximum level of EBITDA performance associated with the 2009 Teamshare Program, although any individual payout under the Program is capped at $2.5 million.


The Committee considers the 2009 Teamshare Program target financial performance level to be challenging and generally consistent with the level of difficulty of achievement associated with our performance-based awards for prior years.  We did not achieve the threshold Teamshare performance level in fiscal years 2006 or 2005. We achieved Teamshare performance levels between threshold and target in fiscal year 2004, between target and maximum in fiscal year 2007, and at maximum in fiscal year 2003. Fiscal 2008 was the first year in which we did not associate a maximum level of EBITDA performance with the bonus program.  For fiscal 2008, we achieved a Teamshare performance level of approximately 218% of the target.


The bonus payable to each named executive officer if we reach the 2009 target financial performance level is equal to the applicable percentage, as set forth in the chart below, of such officer’s salary:


Name

Target Payout Percentage

Mr. Dreiling (1)

100%

Mr. Bere

70%

Mr. Tehle

65%

Ms. Guion

65%

Ms. Lanigan

65%

 

 

(1)

Mr. Dreiling’s threshold and target bonus percentages are established in his employment agreement with us.


Payments for financial performance below or above the target level shall be prorated on a graduated scale commensurate with performance levels in accordance with the following schedule. As a threshold matter, unless required by contract, no such named executive officer is eligible to receive a bonus under the 2009 Teamshare Program if that officer receives an “unsatisfactory” overall subjective individual performance rating and payment of any bonus is in the Committee’s discretion if the named executive officer receives a “needs improvement” overall individual performance rating.



124





% of Target Performance Level

% of Bonus Target

95%

50%

96%

60%

97%

70%

98%

80%

99%

90%

100%

100%

101%

110%

102%

120%

103%

130%

104%

140%

105%

150%

106%

160%

107%

170%

108%

180%

109%

190%

110% (1)

200% (1)

 

(1)

For every 1% EBITDA increase over 110%, each named executive officer is eligible to receive an additional 9.14% of his or her bonus target.


PART III


ITEM 10.

DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE


(a)

Information Regarding Directors and Executive Officers.  Information regarding our current directors and executive officers as of March 17, 2009 is set forth below. Each of our directors holds office for a term of 1 year or until a successor is elected and qualified. Each of our executive officers serves at the pleasure of our Board of Directors and is elected annually by the Board to serve until a successor is duly elected. There are no familial relationships between any of our directors or executive officers.


Name

Age

Position

 

 

 

Michael M. Calbert

46

Director

Raj Agrawal

35

Director

Adrian Jones

44

Director

Richard W. Dreiling

55

Director; Chairman & Chief Executive Officer

David L. Bere

55

President & Chief Strategy Officer

David M. Tehle

52

Executive Vice President & Chief Financial Officer

Kathleen R. Guion

57

Executive Vice President, Division President, Store Operations & Store Development

Todd J. Vasos

47

Executive Vice President, Division President & Chief Merchandising Officer

Susan S. Lanigan

46

Executive Vice President & General Counsel

Anita C. Elliott

44

Senior Vice President & Controller

John W. Flanigan

57

Senior Vice President, Global Supply Chain

Robert D. Ravener

50

Senior Vice President & Chief People Officer



125



Mr. Calbert has been with KKR for over eight years and during that time has been directly involved with several portfolio companies. He heads the Retail industry team. Mr. Calbert is currently on the board of directors of Toys “R” Us, Inc. and U.S. Foodservice. He joined Randall’s Food Markets as the Chief Financial Officer in 1994, ultimately taking the company through a transaction with KKR in June 1997. He left Randall’s Food Markets after the company was sold in September 1999 and joined KKR. Mr. Calbert started his professional career as a consultant with Arthur Andersen Worldwide, where his primary focus was on the retail/consumer industry. He has been a member of our Board of Directors since July 2007 and served as our Chairman until December 2008. KKR’s affiliates indirectly own a substantial portion of our outstanding common stock through their investment in Buck Holdings, LLC and Buck Holdings, L.P.


Mr. Agrawal joined KKR in 2006 and is a member of the Infrastructure team.  He previously was a member of KKR’s Retail and Energy industry teams. Prior to joining KKR, he was a Vice President with Warburg Pincus, where he participated in the execution and oversight of a number of investments in the energy sector. Mr. Agrawal’s prior experience also includes Thayer Capital Partners and McKinsey & Co., where he provided strategic and M&A advice to clients in a variety of industries. He has been a member of our Board of Directors since July 2007.


Mr. Jones has been with Goldman, Sachs & Co. since 1994. He is a managing director in Principal Investment Area (PIA) in New York where he focuses on healthcare and consumer-related opportunities and sits on the Global Investment Committee. Mr. Jones joined Goldman, Sachs & Co. as an associate in the Investment Banking Division and, after two years in the Communications and Media Department and mobility assignments in Equity Capital Markets and in the Executive Office of Goldman Sachs International, he joined PIA in London in 1998. He returned to New York with PIA in 2002 and became a managing director later that year. He became a partner in 2004. Affiliates of Goldman, Sachs & Co. indirectly own a substantial portion of our outstanding common stock through investments in Buck Holdings, L.P. Mr. Jones is currently on the board of directors of Biomet, Inc., Education Management Corporation, HealthMarkets, Inc. and Signature Hospital, LLC. He has been a member of our Board of Directors since July 2007.


Mr. Dreiling joined Dollar General in January 2008 as Chief Executive Officer and a member of our Board of Directors. He was appointed Chairman of the Board on December 2, 2008.  Prior to joining Dollar General, Mr. Dreiling served as Chief Executive Officer, President and a director of Duane Reade Holdings, Inc. and Duane Reade Inc., the largest drugstore chain in New York City, from November 2005 until January 2008 and as Chairman of the Board of Duane Reade from March 2007 until January 2008. Mr. Dreiling previously served as Executive Vice President—Chief Operating Officer of Longs Drug Stores Corporation, an operator of a chain of retail drug stores on the West Coast and Hawaii, since March 2005, after having joined Longs in July 2003 as Executive Vice President and Chief Operations Officer. From 2000 to 2003, Mr. Dreiling served as Executive Vice President—Marketing, Manufacturing and Distribution at Safeway, Inc., a food and drug retailer. Prior to that, Mr. Dreiling served from 1998 to 2000 as President of Vons, a Southern California food and drug division of Safeway.



126



Mr. Bere joined Dollar General in December 2006 as President and Chief Operating Officer.  He also served as our Interim Chief Executive Officer from July 6, 2007 to January 21, 2008.  In April 2008, he was named President and Chief Strategy Officer. He served as a member of our Board of Directors from 2002 until March 2008. Mr. Bere served from December 2003 until June 2005 as Corporate Vice President of Ralcorp Holdings, Inc. and as the President and Chief Executive Officer of Bakery Chef, Inc., a leading manufacturer of frozen bakery products that was acquired by Ralcorp Holdings in December 2003. From 1998 until the acquisition, Mr. Bere was the President and Chief Executive Officer of Bakery Chef, Inc., and also served on its board of directors. From 1996 to 1998, he served as President and Chief Executive Officer of McCain Foods USA, a manufacturer and marketer of frozen foods and a subsidiary of McCain Foods Limited. From 1978 to 1995, Mr. Bere worked for The Quaker Oats Company and served as President of the Breakfast Division from 1992 to 1995 and President of the Golden Grain Division from 1990 to 1992.


Mr. Tehle joined Dollar General in June 2004 as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer. He served from 1997 to June 2004 as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Haggar Corporation, a manufacturing, marketing and retail corporation. From 1996 to 1997, he was Vice President of Finance for a division of The Stanley Works, one of the world’s largest manufacturers of tools, and from 1993 to 1996, he was Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Hat Brands, Inc., a hat manufacturer. Earlier in his career, Mr. Tehle served in a variety of financial-related roles at Ryder System, Inc. and Texas Instruments. Mr. Tehle serves as a director of Jack in the Box, Inc.


Ms. Guion joined Dollar General in October 2003 as Executive Vice President, Store Operations. She was named Executive Vice President, Store Operations and Store Development in February 2005, and was promoted to Executive Vice President, Division President, Store Operations and Store Development in November 2005. From 2000 until joining Dollar General, Ms. Guion served as President and Chief Executive Officer of Duke and Long Distributing Company, a convenience store chain operator and wholesale distributor of petroleum products. Prior to that time, she served as an operating partner for Devon Partners (1999-2000), where she developed operating plans and assisted in the identification of acquisition targets in the convenience store industry, and as President and Chief Operating Officer of E-Z Serve Corporation (1997-1998), an owner/operator of convenience stores, mini-marts and gas marts. From 1987 to 1997, Ms. Guion served as the Vice President and General Manager of the largest division (Chesapeake Division) of company-owned stores at 7-Eleven, Inc., a convenience store chain. Other positions held by Ms. Guion during her tenure at 7-Eleven include District Manager, Zone Manager, Operations Manager, and Division Manager (Midwest Division).


Mr. Vasos joined Dollar General in December 2008 as Executive Vice President, Division President and Chief Merchandising Officer.  Prior to joining Dollar General, Mr. Vasos served in executive positions with Longs Drug Stores Corporation for 7 years, including Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer (February 2008 through November 2008) and Senior Vice President and Chief Merchandising Officer (2001-2008), where he was responsible for all pharmacy and front-end marketing, merchandising, procurement, supply chain, advertising, store development, store layout and space allocation, and the operation of



127



three distribution centers. He also previously served in leadership positions at Phar-Mor Food and Drug Inc. and Eckerd Drug Corp.


Ms. Lanigan joined Dollar General in July 2002 as Vice President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary. She was promoted to Senior Vice President in October 2003 and to Executive Vice President in March 2005. Prior to joining Dollar General, Ms. Lanigan served as Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary at Zale Corporation, a specialty retailer of fine jewelry. During her six years with Zale, Ms. Lanigan held various positions, including Associate General Counsel. Prior to that, she held legal positions with both Turner Broadcasting System, Inc. and the law firm of Troutman Sanders LLP.


Ms. Elliott joined Dollar General as Senior Vice President and Controller in August 2005. Prior to joining Dollar General, she served as Vice President and Controller of Big Lots, Inc., a closeout retailer, from May 2001 to August 2005. Overseeing a staff of 140 employees at Big Lots, she was responsible for accounting operations, financial reporting and internal audit. Prior to serving at Big Lots, she served as Vice President and Controller for Jitney-Jungle Stores of America, Inc., a grocery retailer, from April 1998 to March 2001. At Jitney-Jungle, Ms. Elliott was responsible for the accounting operations and the internal and external financial reporting functions. Prior to serving at Jitney-Jungle, she practiced public accounting for 12 years, 6 of which were with Ernst & Young LLP.


Mr. Flanigan joined Dollar General as Senior Vice President, Global Supply Chain, in May 2008. He has 25 years of management experience in retail logistics.  Prior to joining Dollar General, he was group vice president of logistics and distribution for Longs Drug Stores Corporation from October 2005 to April 2008. In this role, he was responsible for overseeing warehousing, inbound and outbound transportation and facility maintenance to service 500+ retail outlets.  From September 2001 to October 2005 he served as the Vice President of Logistics for Safeway Inc. where he oversaw distribution of food products from Safeway distribution centers to all retail outlets, inbound traffic and transportation. He also held distribution and logistics leadership positions at Vons – a Safeway company, Specialized Distribution Management Inc., and Crum & Crum Logistics.


Mr. Ravener joined Dollar General as Senior Vice President and Chief People Officer in August 2008. Prior to joining Dollar General, he served as the Senior Vice President of U.S. Partner Resources for Starbucks Coffee Company from April 2007 to August 2008.  In this role, Mr. Ravener oversaw all aspects of human resources activity for more than 10,000 stores. He also served as Starbucks’ Vice President, Partner Resources-Eastern Division, from September 2005 to March 2007. Prior to serving at Starbucks, Mr. Ravener held Vice President of Human Resources roles for The Home Depot’s Store Support Center and a domestic field division from April 2003 to September 2005. Mr. Ravener also served in executive roles in both human resources and operations at Footstar, Inc. and roles of increasing leadership at PepsiCo.


(b)

Procedures for Shareholders to Nominate Directors; Arrangements to Serve as Directors.  All of our directors are managers of Buck Holdings, LLC which serves as the general partner of Buck Holdings, L.P.  The Second Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement of Buck Holdings, LLC generally requires that the members of Buck Holdings, LLC



128



take all necessary action to ensure that the persons who serve as its managers also serve on our Board. In addition, Mr. Dreiling’s employment agreement provides that he will continue to serve as a member of our Board as long as he remains our Chief Executive Officer.


Because of these requirements, together with Buck Holdings’ controlling ownership of our outstanding common stock, we do not have a policy or procedures with respect to shareholder recommendations for nominees to our Board.


(c)

Audit Committee Financial Expert.   Our Audit Committee is composed of Messrs. Calbert and Agrawal. As a closely held company and in the absence of a public trading market for our common stock, our Board has not designated any member of the Audit Committee as an “audit committee financial expert.” Though not formally considered by our Board given that our securities are not registered or traded on any national securities exchange, we do not believe that Messrs. Calbert or Agrawal would be considered independent because of their relationships with KKR which indirectly owns, through its interests in Parent, a substantial percentage of our outstanding common stock, and certain other relationships with us as more fully described under Item 13 below.


(d)

 Code of Business Conduct and Ethics.  We have adopted a Code of Business Conduct and Ethics that applies to all of our employees, officers and Board members. This Code is posted on our Internet website at www.dollargeneral.com . If we choose to no longer post such Code, we will provide a free copy to any person upon written request to Dollar General Corporation, c/o Investor Relations Department, 100 Mission Ridge, Goodlettsville, TN 37072.  We intend to provide any required disclosure of an amendment to or waiver from the Code that applies to our principal executive officer, principal financial officer, principal accounting officer or controller, or persons performing similar functions, on www.dollargeneral.com promptly following the amendment or waiver.  We may elect to disclose any such amendment or waiver in a report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC either in addition to or in lieu of the website disclosure. The information contained on or connected to our Internet website is not incorporated by reference into this report and should not be considered part of this or any other report that we file with or furnish to the SEC.


ITEM 11.

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION


(a)

Executive Compensation .   We refer to the persons included in the Summary Compensation Table below as our “named executive officers”. References to “2008,” “2007,” and “2006” mean, respectively, our fiscal years ended January 30, 2009, February 1, 2008 and February 2, 2007. References to the “Merger” mean our merger, discussed more fully elsewhere in this document, that occurred on July 6, 2007 as a result of which we became a subsidiary of Buck Holdings, L.P. (“Buck” or “Parent”), a Delaware limited partnership controlled by investment funds affiliated with Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co., L.P. (“KKR” or “Sponsor”).




129



Compensation Discussion and Analysis


Executive Compensation Philosophy and Objectives


We strive to attract, retain and motivate persons with superior ability, to reward outstanding performance, and to align the interests of our named executive officers with the long-term interests of our shareholders. The material compensation principles applicable to the 2008 compensation of our named executive officers included the following, all of which are discussed in more detail in “Elements of 2008 Named Executive Officer Compensation” below:


·

We generally target total compensation at the benchmarked median of our market comparator group, but we make adjustments based on circumstances, such as unique job descriptions and our particular niche in the retail sector, that are not reflected in the market data. For competitive reasons, our levels of total compensation or any component of compensation may exceed the median of our comparator group.


·

We set base salaries to reflect the responsibilities, experience and contributions of the named executive officers and the salaries for comparable benchmarked positions, subject to minimums set forth in employment agreements.


·

We reward named executive officers who enhance our performance by linking cash and equity incentives to the achievement of our financial goals.


·

We promote share ownership to align the interests of our named executive officers with those of our shareholders.  


The Compensation Committee of our Board of Directors utilizes employment agreements with the named executive officers which, among other things, set forth minimum levels of certain compensation components. The Committee believes such arrangements are a common protection offered to named executive officers at comparable companies, and help ensure continuity and aid in retention. The agreements also provide for standard protections to both the officer and to Dollar General should the officer’s employment terminate.


Named Executive Officer Compensation Process


Oversight .  The Compensation Committee of our Board of Directors is responsible for recommending CEO compensation to our Board and for approving compensation of other named executive officers. The Board retains sole authority to determine CEO compensation. The Committee members include Messrs. Calbert, Agrawal and Jones.


Use of Outside Advisors .  Prior to the Merger, the former Compensation Committee selected Hewitt Associates as its compensation consultant and approved a written agreement with Hewitt which describes the general terms of the working relationship.  Hewitt remains a consultant to the Company subsequent to the Merger, and while the written agreement with Hewitt has not been formally renewed, we continue to operate consistent with its terms.   




130



The written agreement with Hewitt specifies that Hewitt may perform compensation consulting services upon management or Committee request, which services may include competitive market pay analyses, support regarding legal, regulatory or accounting considerations impacting compensation programs, redesign of those programs, assistance with market data, trends and competitive practices, meeting preparation and attendance and other miscellaneous work.


While the Committee or any of its members may consult directly with Hewitt should it or they choose to do so, subsequent to the Merger Hewitt has directly dealt solely with Mr. Dreiling, Ms. Challis Lowe (while she served as our EVP of Human Resources) and Mr. Robert Ravener (since he became our SVP and Chief People Officer) (Ms. Lowe or Mr. Ravener, during the applicable time period, our “Senior HR Officer”), as well as with non-executive members of our human resources group, both with respect to management’s work in connection with named executive officer compensation (as described below under “Management’s Role”) and in connection with general employee compensation and benefits matters. Our Committee Chairman, Mr. Calbert, reviews with Mr. Dreiling and our Senior HR Officer information provided by Hewitt, along with Mr. Dreiling’s and our Senior HR Officer’s executive compensation recommendations.


Management’s Role . Mr. Dreiling and the Senior HR Officer, along with non-executive members of the human resources group, assist Hewitt in gathering and analyzing relevant competitive data and identifying and evaluating various alternatives for named executive officer compensation (including their own). Mr. Dreiling and the Senior HR Officer regularly provide and discuss their recommendations regarding named executive officer pay components, typically based on Hewitt benchmarking data, to the Compensation Committee Chairman between Committee meetings and to the full Committee at Committee meetings. Mr. Dreiling assesses named executive officer performance (with Mr. Bere’s assistance with respect to fiscal 2007 performance) for purposes of determining whether each named executive officer is eligible, as a threshold matter, for a base salary increase and for a Teamshare bonus payout in the event the relevant EBITDA performance level is achieved (each as discussed more fully below under “Elements of 2008 Named Executive Officer Compensation”).  


While the Board and the Committee members valued and welcomed such input from management, the Board and the Committee ultimately made all 2008 named executive officer compensation decisions.


Use of Market Benchmarking Data .  To attract and retain named executive officers who we believe will enhance our long-term business results, we must pay compensation that is competitive with the external market for executive talent. We believe that this primary talent market consists of retail companies with revenues and business models similar to ours because those companies have executive positions similar in breadth, complexity and scope of responsibility to our named executive officer positions. For 2008, Hewitt provided data to management regarding total and individual compensation elements from its proprietary salary survey database and from the proxy statements of selected retail companies that met these criteria. We refer to this combined group as the market comparator group. In 2008, this group consisted of Advance Auto Parts, AutoZone, Big Lots, Family Dollar, Kohl’s, Limited Brands,



131



Longs Drug Stores, Nordstrom, OfficeMax, Payless Shoe Source, Retail Ventures, Staples, J.C. Penney, The Gap, Macy’s, Blockbuster, The Pantry, Ross Stores, and SuperValu Inc. Hewitt was also asked to provide summary market data from all of the retail companies in their data base and from the proxy statement information for certain other significantly larger retail companies (Wal-Mart, Target, Walgreen’s and CVS) as additional reference points in assessing the appropriateness of the compensation levels of our named executive officers.


For 2009 compensation decisions, the same market comparator group of nineteen companies was used except for five companies (Advance Auto Parts, Kohl’s, Limited Brands, Retail Ventures and SuperValu) that discontinued their participation in the Hewitt study.  These companies were replaced by 7-Eleven, Genuine Parts, McDonald’s, PetsMart, and Yum Brands which were chosen due to their relative comparability to the companies in the existing market comparator group.


The Committee believes that the median range of the competitive market generally is the appropriate target for a named executive officer’s total compensation, and the Committee takes into account the value of the named executive officer’s long-term compensation when determining the levels of the cash compensation components.  The Committee recognizes, however, that it is difficult to compare equity granted by a private company to equity granted by a public company because of liquidity and other comparability issues.  In addition, the Committee does not make annual equity grants to the named executive officers, as it believes that the long-term equity previously granted to the named executive officers in fiscal 2007 or at the time they were employed, as applicable, is sufficiently retentive and otherwise adequately meets our compensation objectives as discussed under “Long-Term Incentive Program” below.


Elements of 2008 Named Executive Officer Compensation


We provide compensation in the form of base salary, short-term cash incentives, long-term equity incentives, benefits and perquisites. As discussed in more detail below, the Compensation Committee believes that each of these elements is a necessary component of the compensation package and is consistent with compensation programs at competing companies.


Base Salary.   Base salary generally promotes the recruiting and retention functions of our compensation principles by reflecting the salaries for comparable positions in the competitive marketplace and by providing a stable and predictable source of income for our executives. The Committee believes that we would be unable to attract or retain quality named executive officers in the absence of competitive base salary levels. For this reason, base salary constitutes a significant portion of a named executive officer’s total compensation. Base salary also furthers the pay for performance role of our philosophy because, as a threshold matter, a named executive officer is not eligible for a salary increase unless he or she achieves a satisfactory overall subjective performance evaluation.


Following fiscal 2007, Mr. Dreiling (with input from Mr. Bere) subjectively assessed each named executive officer in the context of that officer’s job responsibilities and made a determination as to whether that officer’s performance for fiscal 2007 was satisfactory or unsatisfactory on an overall basis.  A determination of unsatisfactory performance would have



132



precluded that named executive officer from receiving an increase in 2008 base salary.  A threshold determination of satisfactory performance did not by itself result in any variation in a named executive officer’s compensation.  Rather, satisfactory performance merely created the possibility of an increase in base salary.  Once a named executive officer’ eligibility was established, the magnitude of any salary increase was determined on the basis of benchmarking information from Hewitt regarding the compensation and role of each named executive officer within our management structure in comparison to the compensation that companies in our market comparator group provide to similarly situated executives. Because Mr. Dreiling determined that each such person performed satisfactorily overall, as a threshold matter each named executive officer was eligible to be considered for a 2008 salary increase.

In determining each named executive officer’s 2008 base salary, the Compensation Committee reviewed the composition of the market comparator group, as described above, and Ms. Lowe informed the Compensation Committee of the results of the benchmarking analysis, which had been discussed in detail separately with the Committee’s chairman. This benchmarking data showed that there was significant movement in the market median for Ms. Guion’s position and, as a result, the Committee adjusted her pay accordingly which resulted in an approximate 15.5% base salary increase. The Committee approved 3% base salary increases for all other named executive officers (other than Mr. Dreiling, who was not considered for an increase given his recent hiring in January 2008) in order to maintain base salaries within the median range of the market comparator group.


Subsequent to the fiscal 2008 year end but prior to the filing of this document, the Compensation Committee considered the 2009 base salary increases for each named executive officer. Mr. Dreiling advised the Committee that he had subjectively assessed the overall performance of each named executive officer and determined that each had performed the duties and responsibilities of his or her respective position in a satisfactory manner.  As in prior years, a determination of unsatisfactory performance would have precluded that named executive officer from receiving an increase in base salary, and the threshold determination of satisfactory performance did not by itself result in any variation in compensation.  Rather, satisfactory performance merely created the possibility of an increase in base salary. The magnitude of the salary increase was determined on the basis of benchmarking information from Hewitt regarding data from our market comparator group.


After reviewing a summary of the Hewitt data, the Committee determined that a 2.25% increase in base salary for each named executive officer (other than Mr. Dreiling and Ms Lanigan) was within the competitive median range of base salary increases within the market comparator group.  The benchmarking data showed that there was additional movement in the market median for Ms. Lanigan’s position and, as a result, the Committee adjusted her pay accordingly which resulted in an approximate 5% base salary increase.  All such increases are effective April 1, 2009.  


The Committee also met with Mr. Dreiling privately to subjectively review his performance in fiscal 2008 in the context of his job responsibilities.  The Committee determined that Mr. Dreiling’s fiscal 2008 performance was satisfactory on an overall basis, thus also qualifying him for a 2009 base salary increase.  As with other named executive officers, such determination did not by itself result in any variation in Mr. Dreiling’s compensation, but rather



133



merely created the possibility of a base salary increase.  Based on the same Hewitt market data reviewed for the other named executive officers, the Committee recommended, and the non-management members of the Board of Directors approved, a 12.1% base salary increase for Mr. Dreiling, effective April 1, 2009, in order to maintain his base salary within the median range of the market comparator group.

 

Short-Term Incentive Plan.   Our short-term incentive plan, called Teamshare, serves to motivate named executive officers to achieve certain pre-established, objective financial goals. As a threshold matter, unless required by contract, a named executive officer is not eligible to receive a bonus under the 2008 Teamshare program if that officer receives an “unsatisfactory” overall subjective individual performance rating, and payment of any bonus is in the Compensation Committee’s discretion if the officer receives a “needs improvement” overall individual performance rating. Accordingly, Teamshare fulfills an important part of our pay for performance philosophy while aligning the interests of our named executive officers and our shareholders. Teamshare also helps meet our recruiting and retention objectives by providing compensation opportunities that are consistent with those prevalent in our market comparator group.


(a)   2008 Teamshare Structure .  Teamshare provides an opportunity for each named executive officer to receive a cash bonus payment equal to a certain percentage of base salary based upon Dollar General’s achievement of a pre-established financial performance measure. As it did in 2007, the Compensation Committee selected as the 2008 Teamshare financial performance measure a measure based upon earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”), with adjustments similar to those made for the purposes of calculating performance targets for our long term incentive program, including exclusions for the impact of:


·

any fee paid to KKR, Goldman Sachs & Co. and any affiliates thereof pursuant to the terms of the Monitoring Fee Letter Agreement dated July 6, 2007;


·

all consulting, accounting, legal, valuation, banking, filing, disclosure and similar costs, fees and expenses directly related to the consideration, negotiation, approval and consummation of the Merger and related financing and any related litigation or settlement of any related litigation; and


·

any unplanned items of a non-recurring or extraordinary nature as determined in good faith by the CEO and CFO and approved by the Committee.


The Committee established the target financial performance level for purposes of the 2008 Teamshare program at $815 million, which, consistent with prior practice, was equal to our annual financial objective. It also was similar to the fiscal 2008 level for vesting of performance-based options granted on July 6, 2007 to the named executive officers. The Committee established the threshold financial performance level, below which no bonus may be paid under the 2008 Teamshare program, at 95% of the target financial performance level. This differed from prior practice which established the threshold level at 90% of the target level as the



134



Committee believed that a threshold level of 95% of target was more consistent with other companies within the KKR portfolio.

  

Unlike the Teamshare program in prior years, there was no maximum level of EBITDA performance associated with the 2008 Teamshare program. The Committee felt that setting a maximum EBITDA performance level could discourage employees to strive to achieve EBITDA results beyond the maximum level.  


The Committee considered the 2008 Teamshare program target financial performance level to be challenging and generally consistent with the level of difficulty of achievement associated with the our performance-based awards for prior years.  We did not achieve the threshold Teamshare performance level in fiscal years 2006 or 2005. We achieved Teamshare performance levels between threshold and target in fiscal years 2004 and 2002, between target and maximum in fiscal year 2007, and at maximum in fiscal year 2003.


The bonus payable to each named executive officer if Dollar General reached the 2008 target financial performance level was equal to the applicable percentage of each officer’s salary as set forth in the chart below. Such payout levels, which are consistent with prior years’ payout levels, were selected because they are within the median range of the Hewitt data for the market comparator group.


Name

Target Payout Percentage

Mr. Dreiling (1)

100%

Mr. Bere (2)

70%

Mr. Tehle

65%

Ms. Guion

65%

Ms. Lanigan

65%

Mr. Buley

65%

Ms. Lowe

 

65%

 

 

(1)

Mr. Dreiling’s threshold and target bonus percentages are established in his employment agreement with us, and he was guaranteed a payout at least at the threshold level (50% of his target level) for fiscal 2008.

(2)

Per Mr. Bere’s April 9, 2008 letter agreement with us (the “Letter Agreement”), to the extent earned for February and March of 2008, any payout will be based on the Threshold Bonus (35%), Target Bonus (140%) and Maximum Bonus (280%) levels which were contemplated in Mr. Bere’s employment agreement entered into with us in fiscal 2007 (such payout levels had been settled upon as a result of active renegotiations with Mr. Bere when he assumed the position of Interim CEO and were deemed necessary to secure the critical services of Mr. Bere at that time).  We entered into the Letter Agreement at the end of the transition period which followed Mr. Dreiling’s hiring in January 2008 and ran through the date of the Letter Agreement (the “Transition Period”).  The Committee believed it was fair to use the bonus payout levels that were in place under the employment agreement during the Transition Period, but to modify those levels for all months after the Transition Period (as reflected in this table) to reflect the Hewitt data for the market comparator group relative to Mr. Bere’s new position of Chief Strategy Officer.




135



Payments for financial performance below or above the target level are prorated on a graduated scale commensurate with performance levels in accordance with the following schedule.


% of Target Performance Level

% of Bonus Target

95%

50%

96%

60%

97%

70%

98%

80%

99%

90%

100%

100%

101%

110%

102%

120%

103%

130%

104%

140%

105%

150%

106%

160%

107%

170%

108%

180%

109%

190%

110%(1)

200%(1)

 

 

(1)

For every 1% EBITDA increase over 110%, each named executive officer was eligible to receive an additional 7.1491% of his or her bonus target. Individual awards are capped at $2.5 million per the terms of the plan under which our Teamshare program operates.


This pro ration schedule, through 110% of the target EBITDA performance level (the prior maximum EBITDA performance level), is consistent with the pro ration schedule in prior years.  The Committee determined that the pro ration schedule for EBITDA performance above 110% of target should approximate a sharing between Dollar General and the Teamshare participants of 20% of the EBITDA dollars earned above that level.  When calculated against the total incentive dollars that would be paid at 110% of the target EBITDA performance level, the incremental incentive payout equated to an additional 7.1491% of each named executive officer’s bonus target for each additional 1% of EBITDA earned above 110% of the target level.   


(b)   2008 Teamshare Results .   Following fiscal 2008, Mr. Dreiling assessed each named executive officer in the context of that officer’s job responsibilities and made a subjective determination as to whether that officer’s performance for fiscal 2008 was satisfactory or unsatisfactory on an overall basis.  A determination of unsatisfactory performance would have precluded that named executive officer from receiving a Teamshare payout for 2008 performance (unless otherwise contractually provided) regardless of whether we achieved our overall, objective EBITDA performance target for fiscal 2008.  A threshold determination of satisfactory performance did not by itself result in any variation in the named executive officer’s incentive compensation.  Rather, satisfactory performance merely created the possibility of a payout under the Teamshare program.  Once a named executive officer’s eligibility was established, the Teamshare payout was determined based upon our objective EBITDA performance.  Because Mr. Dreiling determined that each such person performed satisfactorily



136



overall, as a threshold matter each named executive officer was eligible to receive a 2008 Teamshare payout to the extent we achieved the relevant EBITDA performance level.


The Committee also subjectively reviewed Mr. Dreiling’s individual performance for 2008 in a manner similar to Mr. Dreiling’s evaluations of the other named executive officers discussed above.  The Committee determined that he had performed satisfactorily and as a threshold matter, he was therefore also eligible to receive a 2008 Teamshare payout to the extent we achieved the relevant EBITDA performance level.  


In March 2009, the Compensation Committee approved the EBITDA performance level at 217.63% of target. Accordingly, Teamshare payouts in the amount reflected in the “Non-Equity Incentive Plan Compensation” column of the Summary Compensation Table will be made to each named executive officer (other than Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe who are no longer employed by Dollar General) at the following percentages of base salary:  Mr. Dreiling, 217.63%; Mr. Bere, 177.73%; Mr. Tehle, 141.46%; Ms. Guion, 141.46%; and Ms. Lanigan, 141.46%.


(c)

2009 Teamshare Structure . As it did in 2008, the Compensation Committee selected as the 2009 Teamshare financial performance measure a measure based upon earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”), with adjustments similar to those described above pertaining to the 2008 Teamshare structure. The Committee established the target financial performance level for purposes of the 2009 Teamshare program at a level equal to our annual financial objective, which was consistent with past practice. The Committee considers the 2009 Teamshare program target financial performance level to be challenging and generally consistent with the level of difficulty of achievement associated with the our performance-based awards for prior years (see “2008 Teamshare Structure” above for a discussion of the level of achievement in recent years of the financial performance targets).  


As in 2008 and for the same reasons identified under “2008 Teamshare Structure” above, the Committee established the threshold financial performance level, below which no bonus may be paid under the 2009 Teamshare program, at 95% of the target financial performance level, and the Committee did not establish a maximum level of EBITDA performance under the 2009 Teamshare program.


The bonus payable to each named executive officer if Dollar General reaches the 2009 target financial performance level is equal to the applicable percentage of each officer’s salary as set forth in the chart below. Such payout levels, which are consistent with prior years’ payout levels, were selected because they are within the median range of the Hewitt data for the market comparator group.



137




Name

Target Payout Percentage

Mr. Dreiling (1)

100%

Mr. Bere

70%

Mr. Tehle

65%

Ms. Guion

65%

Ms. Lanigan

 

65%

 

 

(1)

Mr. Dreiling’s threshold and target bonus percentages are established in his employment agreement with us.


Payments for financial performance below or above the target level are prorated on the same graduated scale commensurate with performance levels as described under “2008 Teamshare Structure” above, except that for every 1% EBITDA increase over 110% of target, each named executive officer is eligible to receive an additional 9.14% of his or her bonus target.


Long-Term Incentive Program.   Long-term equity incentives motivate named executive officers to focus on long-term success for shareholders. These incentives provide a balance between short-term and long-term goals and are also important to our compensation program’s recruiting and retention objectives because most of the companies in our market comparator group offer them.  Our long-term incentives are designed to compensate named executive officers for a long-term commitment to us, while motivating sustained increases in our financial performance.  We believe that our long-term equity incentive program provides significant motivation and retention value to us for many reasons, most notably:


·

Due to limitations on transferability until the occurrence of certain liquidity events, an investment in our common stock generally is illiquid while the executive remains employed by us. If an executive’s employment with us terminates, we may generally compel him or her to sell that stock back to us for a price determined in accordance with the Management Stockholder’s Agreement between us and that executive.


·

Half of all option awards are time-based and vest over a five-year period, provided the executive continues to be employed by us.  The other half are intended to be performance-based and generally require that Dollar General achieve specified financial targets before those options will vest. These terms are further discussed below.


Equity awards are made under our Board-adopted and shareholder-approved 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees (the “2007 Plan”).  Under the current equity award program, a personal financial investment in Dollar General is a prerequisite to eligibility to receive an option grant under the 2007 Plan. In 2007, that personal investment could be made in the form of cash, rollover of stock and/or rollover of in-the-money options issued prior to the Merger. Each named executive officer (other than Mr. Dreiling who joined us in 2008 and is discussed separately below) met the personal investment requirement and, accordingly, received option grants in 2007 under the 2007 Plan. Because the named executive officers received options in 2007, they were not granted any further options in 2008 and are not expected to receive additional options in 2009 absent a job promotion or other special circumstance.



138



The options granted under the 2007 Plan are divided so that half are time-vested and half are performance-vested based on a comparison of an EBITDA-based performance metric, as described below, against pre-set goals for that performance metric. The combination of time and performance based vesting of these awards is designed to compensate executives for long-term commitment to us, while motivating sustained increases in our financial performance. The options have an exercise price of $5 per share, which was the fair market value on the grant date as determined by our Board of Directors.


The time-vested options vest and become exercisable ratably on each of the five anniversary dates of July 6, 2007 solely based upon continued employment with us over that time period. The performance-vested options are eligible to vest and become exercisable ratably if the Board determines in good faith that we achieve specified annual performance targets based on EBITDA and adjusted as described below. For fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2008 that target was $700 million and $828 million, respectively, which targets were based on the long-term financial plan at the time of the Merger and anticipated permitted adjustments, primarily to account for unique expenses related to the Merger.  If a performance target for a given fiscal year is not met, the performance-based options may still vest and become exercisable on a “catch up” basis if, at the end of a subsequent fiscal year through fiscal 2012, a specified cumulative EBITDA-based performance target is achieved. Because the performance targets are based on our long-term financial plan, we believe these levels, while attainable, require strong performance and execution.


For purposes of calculating the achievement of performance targets for our long-term incentive program, “EBITDA” means earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization plus transaction, management and/or similar fees paid to KKR and/or its affiliates. In addition, the Board is required to fairly and appropriately adjust the calculation of EBITDA to reflect, to the extent not contemplated in our financial plan, the following: acquisitions, divestitures, any change required by generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) relating to share-based compensation or for other changes in GAAP promulgated by accounting standard setters that, in each case, the Board in good faith determines require adjustment to the EBITDA performance metric we use for our long-term incentive program. Adjustments to EBITDA for purposes of calculating performance targets or our long-term incentive program may not in all circumstances be identical to adjustments to EBITDA for other purposes, including our Teamshare targets and the covenants contained in our principal financial agreements. Accordingly, comparability of such measures is limited.


The specified adjusted EBITDA performance targets were achieved for both fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2008.


Benefits and Perquisites.   We provide benefits and limited perquisites to named executive officers for retention and recruiting purposes, to promote tax efficiency for such persons, and to replace benefit opportunities lost due to regulatory limits. We also provide named executive officers with benefits and perquisites as additional forms of compensation that are believed to be consistent and competitive with benefits and perquisites provided to similar positions in our market comparator group and our industry. Most of the perquisites were established prior to the Merger by the former Compensation Committee, which believed these benefits and perquisites



139



help to attract and retain executive talent. Along with certain benefits offered to named executive officers on the same terms that are offered to all of our salaried employees (such as health and welfare benefits and matching contributions under our 401(k) plan), we provide such persons with certain additional benefits and perquisites.


The named executive officers have the opportunity to participate in the Compensation Deferral Plan (the “CDP”) and the defined contribution Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (the “SERP”, and together with the CDP, the “CDP/SERP Plan”). Our Compensation Committee determined in 2008 to no longer offer SERP participation to persons to whom employment offers are made after May 28, 2008, including newly hired executive officers.  


We provide each named executive officer a life insurance benefit equal to 2.5 times his or her base salary up to a maximum of $3 million. We pay the premiums and gross up such person’s income to pay the tax cost of this benefit. We also provide each named executive officer a disability insurance benefit that provides income replacement of 60% of base salary up to a maximum monthly benefit of $20,000. We pay the cost of this benefit and gross up such officer’s income to pay the tax cost of the premiums of this benefit to the extent necessary to provide benefits comparable to the group plan applicable to all salaried employees.


Each named executive officer may choose either a leased automobile (for which we pay for gasoline, repairs, service and insurance) or a fixed monthly automobile allowance. We provide a gross-up payment to pay the tax cost of the imputed income for both programs.  Since the Compensation Committee believes that executive automobile programs are no longer typical in the competitive retail market, the Committee determined in 2008 to no longer offer an automobile lease or allowance program to persons to whom employment offers are made after May 28, 2008, including newly hired executive officers, and terminated the program for existing named executive officers as of July 6, 2009.  


We also provide a relocation assistance program to named executive officers under a policy applicable to officer-level employees, which policy is similar to that offered to certain other employees. In 2008, we incurred relocation expenses for Mr. Dreiling in accordance with this policy and his employment agreement (as discussed below in “Compensation of Mr. Dreiling”) and for Mr. Bere in accordance with the policy.  The significant differences between the relocation assistance available to officers from the relocation assistance available to non-officers are as follows:


·

We provide a pre-move allowance of 5% of the officer’s annual base salary (we cap this allowance at $5,000 for other employees);


·

We provide home sale assistance by offering to purchase the officer’s prior home at an independently determined appraised value in the event the prior home is not sold to an outside buyer (we do not offer this service to other employees);  




140



·

We reimburse officers for all reasonable and customary home purchase closing costs (we limit our reimbursement to other employees to 2% of the purchase price to a maximum of $2,500) except for loan origination fees which are limited to 1%; and


·

We provide 60 days of temporary living expenses (we limit temporary living expenses to 30 days for all other employees).


Compensation of Mr. Dreiling


Mr. Dreiling entered into a five-year employment agreement to become CEO and a member of our Board effective January 21, 2008.  Key compensatory provisions of the agreement include:


·

Minimum annual base salary of $1,000,000.

·

Annual bonus payout range of 50% (threshold), 100% (target) and up to no less than 200% (maximum) of base salary based upon EBITDA performance.  For 2008, Mr. Dreiling was guaranteed to earn at least a threshold level bonus.

·

A signing bonus of $2,000,000.

·

Equity grants consisting of 890,000 shares of restricted stock and options to purchase 2.5 million shares of Dollar General at $5 per share (the fair market value on the grant date). The restricted stock is scheduled to vest upon the earlier to occur of the last day of fiscal 2011, a change in control, an initial public offering, termination without cause or due to death or disability, or resignation with good reason. Half of the options are time-vested and the other half are performance-vested. These options vest upon the same terms as the other options that have been granted under the 2007 Plan.

·

Payment of the premiums on his personal long-term disability insurance policies.

·

Use of our plane for Mr. Dreiling and his spouse for up to nine trips per year between our headquarters and his second home in California.

·

Reimbursement and gross-up for taxes of all closing costs and expenses, including broker’s fees, loan origination and/or loan discount fees (not to exceed 2 points in total), and attorney fees incurred to purchase a residence in the Nashville, Tennessee area and for up to 2 months’ lease cancellation on his apartment in the New York metropolitan area.  Reimbursement and/or payment of and gross-up for taxes of temporary living expenses for 120 days as well as 2 house hunting trips not to exceed 7 nights/8 days. Relocation also includes the payment of packing, loading, transporting, storing and delivering his household goods including the movement of 1 car and a miscellaneous expense allowance equal to $50,000 less applicable taxes.

·

Reimbursement of legal fees up to $35,000, grossed-up for taxes, incurred in negotiating and preparing the employment agreement and documents associated with Mr. Dreiling’s equity grants.

·

Payment of monthly membership fees and costs related to his membership in professional clubs selected by him, grossed-up for any taxes. 


Mr. Dreiling was chosen for the CEO position after a lengthy and careful search. The Board firmly believes he is the right leader for the Company as we move forward.  The terms of his employment agreement summarized above were settled after negotiation with Mr. Dreiling,



141



and the Board believes that they are fair and appropriate given CEO compensation and benefits at comparable companies and given Mr. Dreiling’s experience and leadership ability.  These arrangements were also necessary to entice Mr. Dreiling to resign from his previous employer and to give him the opportunity to offset the potential financial gain he would be foregoing by leaving that employer.  


Severance Agreements


As noted above, we have an employment agreement with each of our named executive officers that among other things provide for such officer’s rights upon a termination of employment. We believe that reasonable severance benefits are appropriate to protect the named executive officer against circumstances over which he or she does not have control and as consideration for the promises of non-competition, non-solicitation and non-interference that we require in our employment agreements.


All of our severance provisions in the event of a change-in-control operate under a double trigger, requiring both a change-in-control and a termination event, except for the provisions related to long-term equity incentives under our 2007 Plan.  Under the 2007 Plan, (1) all time-vested options will vest and become immediately exercisable as to 100% of the shares of common stock subject to such options immediately prior to a change-in-control and (2) all performance–vested options will vest and become immediately exercisable as to 100% of the shares of common stock subject to such options immediately prior to a change-in-control if, as a result of the change–in-control, (x) investment funds affiliated with KKR realize a specified internal rate of return on 100% of their aggregate investment, directly or indirectly, in our equity securities (the “Sponsor Shares”) and (y) the investment funds affiliated with KKR earn a specified cash return on 100% of the Sponsor Shares; provided, however, that in the event that a change-in-control occurs in which more than 50% but less than 100% of our common stock or other voting securities or the common stock or other voting securities of Buck Holdings, L.P. is sold or otherwise disposed of, then the performance-vested options will become vested up to the same percentage of Sponsor Shares on which investment funds affiliated with KKR achieve a specified internal rate of return on their aggregate investment and earn a specified return on their Sponsor Shares.


Payments to Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe in Connection with Employment Separation


Mr. Buley’s and Ms. Lowe’s employment with us ended in April 2008 and September 2008, respectively. Payments and other benefits to Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe in connection with these employment terminations are itemized under “Potential Payments Upon Termination or Change-in-Control” below and generally were in accordance with the terms of their employment agreements.  In recognition of her service to Dollar General, we transferred to Ms. Lowe title to her Company-leased automobile in connection with her separation from our employment. In addition, we extended health insurance coverage benefits to Ms. Lowe and her eligible dependents from the date of her employment termination through December 31, 2008. Ms. Lowe bore the entire cost of this coverage extension.




142



Considerations Associated with Regulatory Requirements


Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Internal Revenue Code”), disallows a Federal income tax deduction to publicly held companies for compensation paid to specified executive officers to the extent that compensation exceeds $1 million per covered officer in any fiscal year. This limitation applies only to compensation that is not considered performance-based. Because our common stock is not publicly traded, Section 162(m) will not limit the tax deductibility of any executive compensation for 2008.


The Compensation Committee administers our compensation programs with the good faith intention of complying with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, which relates to the taxation of nonqualified deferred compensation arrangements.


Compensation Committee Report


Our Compensation Committee has reviewed and discussed with management the Compensation Discussion and Analysis required by Item 402(b) of Regulation S-K promulgated under the Exchange Act. Based on such review and discussions, the Compensation Committee recommended to our Board of Directors that the Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in this document.


This report has been furnished by:


·

Michael M. Calbert, Chairman

·

Raj Agrawal

·

Adrian Jones


This Compensation Committee Report is deemed furnished, not filed, in this document and will not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act as a result of furnishing the Compensation Committee Report in this manner.



143



Summary Compensation Table


The following table summarizes compensation paid to or earned by our named executive officers in each of fiscal 2008, fiscal 2007 and fiscal 2006. We have omitted from this table the column for Change in Pension Value and Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Earnings as no amounts are required to be reported in such column for any named executive officer.


Name and Principal Position (1)

Year

Salary
($)
(2)

Bonus
($)
(3)

Stock
Awards
($)
(4)

Option
Awards
($)
(5)

Non-Equity
Incentive Plan
Compensation
($)
(6)

All Other
Compensation
($)

Total
($)

Richard W. Dreiling,
Chairman &
Chief Executive Officer

2008
2007

1,000,038
34,615

--
2,000,000

1,103,306
36,777

1,395,576
42,174

2,176,300
41,760

342,645
62,141

(7)

6,017,865
2,217,467

David L. Bere,
President &
Chief Strategy Officer

2008
2007

739,053
717,528

--
--

--
974,231

1,212,228
1,381,712

1,319,885
1,009,400

211,275
187,046

(8)

3,482,441
4,269,917

David M. Tehle,
Executive Vice President
& Chief Financial Officer

2008
2007
2006

612,358
594,523
580,022

--
--
188,500

--
632,162
235,247

592,644
1,149,922
194,127

870,431
493,213
--

153,431
130,464
121,126

(9)

2,228,864
3,000,284
1,319,022

Kathleen R. Guion,
Executive Vice President, Division President,
Store Operations &
Store Development

2008
2007
2006

581,689
512,520
500,019

--
--
162,500

--
521,453
206,455

471,422
917,214
   154,982

841,684
425,184
--

141,333
115,011
151,971

(10)

2,036,128
2,491,382
1,175,927

Susan S. Lanigan,
Executive Vice President
& General Counsel

2008

432,874

--

--

363,668

615,305

93,315

(11)

1,505,162

Beryl J. Buley,
Former Division President,
Merchandising, Marketing
& Supply Chain

2008
2007
2006

124,131
589,398
575,022

--
--
186,875

--
690,116
183,223

(35,357)
1,065,045
180,669

--
488,962
--

2,052,060
111,234
273,801

(12)

2,140,834
2,944,755
1,399,590

Challis M. Lowe,
Former Executive Vice
President, Human
Resources

2008
2007
2006

269,754
420,266
404,182

--
--
133,250

--
512,771
130,813

155,258
768,251
117,933

--
348,651
--

1,540,836
118,133
174,322

(13)

1,965,848
2,168,072
960,500

 

(1)

Mr. Dreiling was hired on January 21, 2008.  Mr. Bere joined the Company in December 2006. Ms. Lanigan joined the Company in July 2002, but was not a named executive officer in fiscal 2007 or fiscal 2006.  Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe separated from the Company on April 15, 2008 and September 15, 2008, respectively.


(2)

All named executive officers deferred a portion of their fiscal 2008 salaries under the CDP. The amounts of such deferrals are included in the Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Table. All named executive officers also contributed a portion of their fiscal 2008 salary to our 401(k) Plan. All named executive officers (other than Mr. Dreiling) for which fiscal 2007 salaries are reported in this column deferred a portion of their fiscal 2007 salaries under the CDP and contributed a portion of their salaries to our 401(k) Plan.  All named executive officers for which fiscal 2006 salaries are reported in this column deferred a portion of their fiscal 2006 salaries under the CDP and contributed a portion of their salaries to our 401(k) Plan.


(3)

The 2007 amount for Mr. Dreiling represents the signing bonus paid pursuant to his employment agreement.  The 2006 amounts represent a one-time discretionary bonus awarded to these named executive officers for fiscal 2006.


(4)

Represents the dollar amount recognized for financial statement reporting purposes with respect to the fiscal year in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards 123(R) (“SFAS 123(R)”), but disregarding the estimate of forfeitures related to service-based vesting conditions, for outstanding awards of restricted stock and restricted stock units (“RSUs”).  Prior to the Merger, the expense was recorded on a straight-line basis over the restriction period based on the market price of the underlying stock on the grant date. There were no forfeitures of restricted stock or RSUs held by the named executive officers during fiscal 2008, fiscal 2007 or fiscal 2006. For more information regarding the assumptions used in the valuation of these awards, see Note 10 of the annual consolidated financial statements included in this document. As a result of the Merger, all restricted stock and RSU awards outstanding immediately before the Merger vested



144



and, therefore, all remaining compensation expense associated with those awards was recognized in fiscal 2007 in accordance with SFAS 123(R).


(5)

Represents the dollar amount recognized for financial statement reporting purposes with respect to the fiscal year in accordance with SFAS 123(R), but disregarding the estimate of forfeitures related to service-based vesting conditions, for stock options. Option awards were valued under the fair value method of SFAS 123(R) using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions:


 

March 16, 2006

March 23, 2007

July 7, 2007

January 21, 2008

Expected dividend yield

.82%

.91%

0%

0%

Expected stock price volatility

28.7%

18.5%

42.3%

41.1%

Risk-free interest rate

4.7%

4.5%

4.9%

3.7%

Expected life of options (years)

5.7

5.7

7.5

7.3

Exercise price

$17.54

$21.25

$5.00

$5.00

Stock price on date of grant

$17.54

$21.25

$5.00

$5.00


For more information regarding the assumptions used in the valuation of these awards, see Note 10 of the annual consolidated financial statements included in this document.  As a result of the Merger, all options outstanding immediately before the Merger vested and, therefore, all compensation expense associated with those awards was recognized in fiscal 2007 in accordance with SFAS 123(R). In connection with their employment separations, Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe had 787,500 and 540,000 options, respectively, that were forfeited in fiscal 2008 and, as a result of those forfeitures, certain previously recorded expenses related to these options were reversed.  Mr. Tehle and Ms. Guion had 63,000 and 50,300 options, respectively, that were forfeited in fiscal 2007 as a result of the Merger.  There were no forfeitures of options held by named executive officers in fiscal 2006.  


(6)

Represents amounts earned pursuant to our Teamshare bonus program for fiscal 2008 and fiscal 2007.  See the discussion of the “Short-Term Incentive Plan” in “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” above.  The 2007 amount reported for Mr. Dreiling represents a prorated payment for the number of days worked in fiscal 2007.  Mr. Bere and Ms. Guion each deferred 5% of his or her fiscal 2008 bonus payments under the CDP. Messrs. Bere and Buley and Ms. Guion deferred 5%, 20% and 5%, respectively, of their fiscal 2007 bonus payments under the CDP. No amounts were earned under our Teamshare bonus program for fiscal 2006 because we did not meet the financial performance level required for a payout.  


(7)

Includes $45,840 for tax reimbursements related to relocation, $26,200 for tax reimbursements related to our payment of certain legal expenses, $7,832 for tax reimbursements related to life and disability insurance premiums,  $5,183 for premiums paid under Mr. Dreiling’s existing portable long-term disability policies, $4,167 for our match contributions to the CDP, $3,824 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs, and $249,599 which represents the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites, including $114,647 for costs associated with personal airplane usage, $76,641 for costs associated with relocation, $33,706 for reimbursement of legal expenses incurred in connection with negotiating his employment agreement with us, $21,000 for an annual automobile allowance, and other amounts which individually did not equal the greater of $25,000 or 10% of total perquisites, including a decorative plaque, expenses related to attendance at entertainment events, and a racing scanner/headset.  The aggregate incremental cost related to the personal airplane usage was calculated using costs we would not have incurred but for the usage (including costs incurred as a result of “deadhead” legs of personal flights), including fuel costs, maintenance costs, engine restoration/reserve fees, crew expenses, landing, parking and other associated fees, and supplies and catering costs. The aggregate incremental cost related to relocation included moving expenses, househunting meal and transportation expenses, temporary living expenses, and closing costs incurred in connection with his new home (such as loan origination fees, points and other closing fees).


(8)

Includes $130,999 for our contributions to the SERP, $25,363 for our match contributions to the CDP, $11,586 for our match contributions to the 401(k) Plan, $13,407 for the reimbursement of taxes related to life and disability insurance premiums, the personal use of a company-leased automobile, and the receipt of a holiday gift, $4,081 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs, and $25,839 which represents the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites, including $18,698 for personal use of a company-leased automobile and other amounts which individually did not equal the greater of $25,000 or 10% of total perquisites, including costs associated with relocation, expenses related to attendance at entertainment events, costs incurred in connection with a medical physical examination, and a holiday gift.


(9)

Includes $82,806 for our contributions to the SERP, $19,043 for our match contributions to the CDP, $11,571 for our match contributions to the 401(k) Plan, $3,829 for the reimbursement of taxes related to life and disability insurance premiums and the receipt of a holiday gift, $3,325 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs, and $32,858 which represents the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites, including $21,000 for an automobile allowance and other amounts which individually did not equal the greater of $25,000 or 10% of total perquisites, including expenses related to Mr. Tehle’s and his guests’ attendance at entertainment events, and a holiday gift.


(10)

Includes $75,015 for our contributions to the SERP, $17,251 for our match contributions to the CDP, $11,792 for our match contributions to the 401(k) Plan, $6,052 for the reimbursement of taxes related to life and disability insurance premiums and the receipt of a holiday gift, $3,860 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs, and $27,363 which represents the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites, including $21,000 for an automobile allowance and other amounts which individually did not equal the greater of $25,000 or 10% of total perquisites, including a directed donation to charity, expenses related to attendance at entertainment events, and a holiday gift.


(11)

Includes $35,121 for our contributions to the SERP, $11,550 for our match contributions to the 401(k) Plan, $10,091 for our match contributions to the CDP, $9,150 for the reimbursement of taxes related to life and disability insurance premiums, the personal use of a company-leased automobile, and the receipt of a holiday gift, $2,494 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs, and $24,909 which represents the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites, including $12,128 for personal use of a



145



company-leased automobile, $7,162 for a pro-rated automobile allowance, and other amounts which individually did not equal the greater of $25,000 or 10% of total perquisites, including expenses related to Ms. Lanigan’s and her guests’ attendance at entertainment events, costs incurred in connection with a medical physical exam, and a holiday gift.


(12)

Includes $2,044,598 paid in connection with Mr. Buley’s employment termination (see “Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control” below), $5,834 for our match contributions to the 401(k) Plan, $894 for the reimbursement of taxes related to life and disability insurance premiums, and $734 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs. Excludes the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites to Mr. Buley which totaled less than $10,000.


(13)

Includes $1,487,873 paid in connection with Ms. Lowe’s employment termination (including $1,455,223 in severance and $32,650 which constituted the fair market value of a company vehicle transferred to Ms. Lowe in connection with her termination.  See “Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control” below.), $12,895 for the reimbursement of taxes related to life and disability insurance premiums and the personal use of a company-leased automobile, $9,412 for our match contributions to the 401(k) Plan, $3,747 for our match contributions to the CDP, $2,929 for premiums paid under our life and disability insurance programs, and $23,980 which represents the aggregate incremental cost of providing certain perquisites, including $18,260 for personal use of a company-leased automobile and other amounts which individually did not equal the greater of $25,000 or 10% of total perquisites, including a directed charitable donation and costs incurred in connection with a medical physical exam.


Grants of Plan-Based Awards in Fiscal 2008


The table below sets forth each named executive officer’s annual Teamshare bonus opportunity established for fiscal 2008. Actual bonus amounts earned by each named executive officer for fiscal 2008 as a result of our EBITDA performance are set forth in the Summary Compensation Table above and represent prorated payment on a graduated scale for performance above the target EBITDA performance level, but below the maximum payout cap of $2.5 million, for each of the named executive officers.  Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe did not receive a Teamshare payout for fiscal 2008 due to their employment separations from the Company prior to the end of the fiscal year.  See “Short-Term Incentive Plan” in “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” above for further discussion of the fiscal 2008 Teamshare program.  


We did not make any equity awards to our named executive officers in fiscal 2008.  Accordingly, we have omitted from this table all columns pertaining to equity grants.  


 

Estimated Possible Payouts Under
Non-Equity Incentive Plan Awards

Name

Threshold
($)

Target
($)

Maximum
($)

Mr. Dreiling

500,000

1,000,000

2,500,000

Mr. Bere

303,241

 606,481

2,500,000

Mr. Tehle

199,980

 399,959

2,500,000

Ms. Guion

193,375

 386,750

2,500,000

Ms. Lanigan

141,365

 282,730

2,500,000

Mr. Buley

198,256

 396,512

2,500,000

Ms. Lowe

141,365

 282,730

2,500,000



146



Outstanding Equity Awards at 2008 Fiscal Year-End


The table below sets forth information regarding outstanding equity awards held by our named executive officers as of the end of fiscal 2008, including (1) equity awards granted under our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan; and (2) Rollover Options, as defined and discussed following the table, granted under our 1998 Stock Incentive Plan.  We have omitted from this table the columns pertaining to stock awards under equity incentive plans because they are inapplicable.


 

Option Awards

Stock Awards

Name

Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
(#)
Exercisable

Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Options
(#)
Unexercisable
(1)


Equity
Incentive
Plan Awards:
Number of
Securities
Underlying
Unexercised
Unearned
Options
(#)
(2)

Option
Exercise
Price
($)

Option
Expiration
Date

Number
of Shares
or Units
of Stock
That
Have Not
Vested
(#)
(3)

Market
Value
of
Shares or
Units of
Stock That
Have
Not Vested
($) ( 4)

Mr. Dreiling

250,000

(5)

1,000,000

--

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

 

500,000

(6)

--

750,000

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

 

--

 

--

--

--

--

890,000

4,895,000

Mr. Bere

5,809

(7)

--

--

1.25

08/12/2012

--

--

 

17,590

(8)

--

--

1.25

03/13/2013

--

--

 

25,313

(9)

--

--

1.25

03/23/2017

--

--

 

225,000

(5)

900,000

--

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

 

450,000

(6)

--

675,000

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

Mr. Tehle

54,426

(10)

--

--

1.25

08/09/2014

--

--

 

44,464

(11)

--

--

1.25

08/24/2014

--

--

 

83,134

(12)

--

--

1.25

03/16/2016

--

--

 

9,983

(9)

--

--

1.25

03/23/2017

--

--

 

110,000

(5)

440,000

--

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

 

220,000

(6)

--

330,000

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

Ms. Guion

22,942

(13)

--

--

1.25

12/02/2013

--

--

 

35,504

(11)

--

--

1.25

08/24/2014

--

--

 

66,364

(12)

--

--

1.25

03/16/2016

--

--

 

7,976

(9)

--

--

1.25

03/23/2017

--

--

 

87,500

(5)

350,000

--

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

 

175,000

(6)

--

262,500

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

Ms. Lanigan

39,379

(7)

- --

--

1.25

08/12/2012

--

--

 

10,483

(14)

--

--

1.25

08/26/2013

--

--

 

21,133

(11)

--

--

1.25

08/24/2014

--

--

 

59,466

(12)

--

--

1.25

03/16/2016

--

--

 

7,146

(9)

--

--

1.25

03/23/2017

--

--

 

67,500

(5)

270,000

--

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

 

135,000

(6)

--

202,500

5.00

07/06/2017

--

--

Mr. Buley

--

 

--

--

--

--

--

--

Ms. Lowe

--

 

--

--

--

--

--

--



147



(1)

The options reported in this column were granted under our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan and are scheduled to vest 25% per year on July 6, 2009, July 6, 2010, July 6, 2011 and July 6, 2012. In addition, these options are subject to certain accelerated vesting provisions as described in “Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control” below.


(2)

If we achieve specific EBITDA targets, options reported in this column, which were granted under our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan, are eligible to vest 1/3 per year on January 29, 2010, January 28, 2011, and February 3, 2012.  If an annual EBITDA target is not met, these options may still vest on a “catch up” basis if, at the end of fiscal years 2009, 2010, 2011, or 2012, the applicable cumulative EBITDA target is achieved.  These options also are subject to certain accelerated vesting provisions as described in “Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control” below.


(3)

These restricted shares were granted under our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan and are scheduled to vest upon the earliest to occur of:  a change in control of the Company, an initial public offering of the Company, Mr. Dreiling’s termination without cause or due to death or disability, Mr. Dreiling’s resignation for good reason, or February 3, 2012.


(4)

Based on a per share fair market value of $5.50 as of January 30, 2009 as determined by our Board in good faith.  Such good faith determination was based upon (a) a third party valuation as of January 30, 2009; (b) management’s opinion that no events have occurred between such third party valuation date and the date of the Board’s determination that would materially change the information used as a basis for such third party valuation; and (c) all other material factors known to the Board at the time of the determination, including a report on material pending and threatened litigation and financial results through the end of the period immediately preceding the date of such valuation.  


(5)

These options were granted under our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan and vested on July 6, 2008.


(6)

These options were granted under our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan and vested 50% as of February 1, 2008 and 50% as of January 30, 2009.


(7)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested on August 12, 2003.


(8)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested on March 13, 2004.


(9)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested on July 6, 2007.


(10)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested 25% on August 9, 2005 and 75% on February 3, 2006.


(11)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested 25% on August 24, 2005 and 75% on February 3, 2006.


(12)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested 25% on March 16, 2007 and 75% on July 6, 2007.


(13)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested 25% per year on December 2, 2004 and December 2, 2005 and 50% on February 3, 2006.


(14)

The options for which these Rollover Options were exchanged vested 25% per year on August 26, 2004, August 26, 2005, August 26, 2006 and July 6, 2007.


Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe held no outstanding equity awards at fiscal year end due to their separation from our employment during fiscal 2008. See “Option Exercises and Stock Vested During Fiscal 2008”.


In connection with the Merger, certain named executive officers elected to roll over all or a portion of their options held prior to the Merger (the “Rollover Options”) rather than receive in exchange for each such option the cash Merger consideration, without interest and less applicable withholding taxes, equal to $22.00 less the exercise price of each option. The exercise



148



price of the Rollover Options and the number of shares underlying the Rollover Options were adjusted as a result of the Merger to provide their pre-Merger value equivalents. The Rollover Options are fully vested and are deemed to have been granted, and otherwise continue, under the terms of our 1998 Stock Incentive Plan under which the original options were issued.


See “Long-Term Incentive Program” in “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” above for discussion of the terms of the equity awards granted under the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan.


Option Exercises and Stock Vested During Fiscal 2008


In connection with Mr. Buley’s and Ms. Lowe’s employment separations, we exercised our call rights under our Management Stockholder’s Agreement with each of Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe to purchase all of our outstanding equity owned by each such executive, including shares of stock previously purchased from us by each executive as well as all vested options and Rollover Options held by each executive. All unvested options held by Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe were automatically cancelled upon the employment terminations.  The table below provides information regarding the value realized by Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe upon our purchase of vested stock options and Rollover Options pursuant to each Management Stockholder’s Agreement. The vested options and Rollover Options were cancelled upon their purchase by us from each of Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe. We have omitted from this table the columns pertaining to stock awards because they are inapplicable.


 

Option Awards

Name

Number of Shares
Acquired on
Exercise
(#)

Value Realized
on Exercise
($)
(1)

Mr. Dreiling

--

--

Mr. Bere

--

--

Mr. Tehle

--

--

Ms. Guion

--

--

Ms. Lanigan

--

--

Mr. Buley

--

754,864

Ms. Lowe

--

396,375


(1)

Represents the aggregate dollar amount realized by each named executive officer upon the transfer of vested options and Rollover Options to us when we exercised our call rights under the applicable Management Stockholder’s Agreement. The value realized is computed by multiplying the number of vested options and Rollover Options by the difference between the per share fair market value of our common stock as determined by our Board as of the last day of the month preceding the call ($5.00) and the per share exercise price of the vested options ($5.00) and Rollover Options ($1.25). Such good faith determination was based upon (a) a third party valuation as of May 2, 2008; (b) management’s opinion that no events have occurred between such third party valuation date and the date of the Board’s determination that would materially change the information used as a basis for such third party valuation; and (c) all other



149



material factors known to the Board at the time of the determination, including a report on material pending and threatened litigation and financial results through the end of the period immediately preceding the date of such valuation.  The amounts reported in this column were previously reported in the same column in the Option Exercises and Stock Vested Table in our Form 10-K for the 2007 fiscal year because they represented the value that the applicable named executive officer would have received in the Merger in exchange for options held prior to the Merger, but which value the executive chose to roll over into the Rollover Options that we called in 2008. Ms. Lowe also realized $130,275 not reflected in this table as a result of our call of shares of stock that she previously purchased from us at fair market value.


Pension Benefits

Fiscal 2008


We have omitted the Pension Benefits table as it is inapplicable.


Nonqualified Deferred Compensation

Fiscal 2008


Information regarding each named executive officer’s participation in our CDP/SERP Plan is included in the following table. The material terms of the CDP/SERP Plan are described after the table.  Please also see “Benefits and Perquisites” in “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” above.  


Name

Executive
Contributions in
Last FY
($) (1)

Registrant
Contributions
in Last FY
($) (2)

Aggregate
Earnings in
Last FY
($) (3)

Aggregate
Withdrawals/
Distributions
($)

Aggregate
Balance at
Last FYE
($) (4)

Mr. Dreiling

 4,167

 4,167

 (79)

--

 8,254

Mr. Bere

 87,423

156,361

 (81,064)

--

290,801

Mr. Tehle

 30,618

 101,849

 (144,526)

--

 320,529

Ms. Guion

 50,840

 92,266

(103,543)

--

 336,169

Ms. Lanigan

 21,644

 45,212

 (82,568)

--

 175,427

Mr. Buley

105,240

 --

 (125,394)

--

 173,182

Ms. Lowe

 13,488

 3,747

 (67,307)

--

 125,992


(1)

Reported as "Salary" in the Summary Compensation Table.


(2)

Reported as "All Other Compensation" in the Summary Compensation Table.


(3)

The amounts shown in this column are not reported in the Summary Compensation Table because they do not represent above-market or preferential earnings.  


(4)

Includes the following amounts previously reported as compensation to each named executive officer in the Summary Compensation Table in the Form 10-K or proxy statements, as applicable, filed for the fiscal years indicated:



150






Name

Fiscal 2007
($)

Fiscal 2006
($)

Fiscal 2005
($)

Fiscal 2004
($)*

Mr. Dreiling

--

--

--

--

Mr. Bere

122,431

--

--

--

Mr. Tehle

117,642

102,104

84,387

3,333

Ms. Guion

98,597

61,503

43,168

57,689

Ms. Lanigan

--

--

--

42,976

Mr. Buley

92,323

89,392

4,792

--

Ms. Lowe

72,162

91,496

--

--


*

Amounts for Mss. Guion and Lanigan represent the respective aggregate amounts previously reported in the Summary Compensation Table contained in the proxy statement filed in calendar year 2005 with respect to compensation in fiscal years 2002, 2003 and 2004.


Pursuant to the CDP, named executive officers may annually elect to defer up to 65% of base salary if their compensation is in excess of the Internal Revenue Service limit set forth in Section 401(a)(17) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Internal Revenue Code”), and up to 100% of bonus pay if their compensation equals or exceeds the Internal Revenue Service highly compensated limit under Section 414(g)(1)(B) of the Internal Revenue Code. We currently match base pay deferrals at a rate of 100%, up to 5% of annual salary, with annual salary offset by the amount of match-eligible salary under the 401(k) plan. All named executive officers are 100% vested in all compensation and matching deferrals and earnings on those deferrals.


Pursuant to the SERP, we make an annual contribution equal to a certain percentage of a participant's annual salary and bonus to all participants who are actively employed in an eligible job grade on January 1 and continue to be employed as of December 31 of a given year. Persons hired after May 27, 2008 (the “Eligibility Freeze Date”) are not eligible to participate in the SERP. The contribution percentage is based on age, years of service and job grade. The fiscal 2008 contribution percentage for each eligible named executive officer was 7.5% for Mr. Bere, Mr. Tehle and Ms. Guion and 4.5% for Ms. Lanigan. Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe were not eligible for a fiscal 2008 contribution due to their employment separations prior to December 31, 2008.  Mr. Dreiling was not eligible for a fiscal 2008 contribution because he was not employed by us as of January 1, 2008.


As a result of the Merger, which constituted a change-in-control under the CDP/SERP Plan, all previously unvested SERP amounts vested on July 6, 2007. For newly eligible SERP participants after July 6, 2007 but prior to the Eligibility Freeze Date, SERP amounts vest at the earlier of the participant's attainment of age 50 or the participant's being credited with 10 or more "years of service", or upon termination of employment due to death or "total and permanent disability" or upon a “change-in-control”, all as defined in the CDP/SERP Plan.




151



The amounts deferred or contributed to the CDP/SERP Plan are credited to a liability account, which is then invested at the participant's option in an account that mirrors the performance of a fund or funds selected by the Compensation Committee or its delegate (the "Mutual Fund Options"). Beginning on August 2, 2008, these funds are identical to the funds offered in our 401(k) Plan.


A participant who ceases employment with at least 10 years of service or after reaching age 50 and whose CDP account balance or SERP account balance exceeds $25,000 may elect for that account balance to be paid in cash by (a) lump sum, (b) monthly installments over a 5, 10 or 15-year period or (c) a combination of lump sum and installments.  Otherwise, payment is made in a lump sum.  The vested amount will be payable at the time designated by the Plan upon the participant's termination of employment. A participant's CDP/SERP benefit normally is payable in the following February if employment ceases during the first 6 months of a calendar year or is payable in the following August if employment ceases during the last 6 months of a calendar year. However, participants may elect to receive an in-service lump sum distribution of vested amounts credited to the CDP account, provided that the date of distribution is no sooner than 5 years after the end of the year in which the amounts were deferred. In addition, a participant who is actively employed may request an "unforeseeable emergency hardship" in-service lump sum distribution of vested amounts credited to the participant’s CDP account.  Account balances deemed to be invested in the Mutual Fund Options are payable in cash.  As a result of the Merger, the CDP/SERP Plan liabilities through July 6, 2007 were fully funded into an irrevocable rabbi trust. We also funded into the rabbi trust deferrals into the CDP/SERP Plan between July 6, 2007 and October 15, 2007. All CDP/SERP Plan liabilities incurred on or after October 15, 2007 are unfunded.


Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control


Other than with respect to Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe, the tables below reflect potential payments to each of our named executive officers in various termination and change-in-control scenarios based on compensation, benefit, and equity levels in effect on January 30, 2009. The amounts shown assume that the termination or change-in-control event was effective as of January 30, 2009. For stock valuations, we have assumed that the price per share is the fair market value of our stock on January 30, 2009 ($5.50), which was the value determined by our Board of Directors in good faith based upon a third party valuation as of January 30, 2009 and the other factors described in footnote 4 to the table set forth under “Outstanding Equity Awards at 2008 Fiscal Year-End” above . The amounts shown are merely estimates. We cannot determine the actual amounts to be paid until the time of the named executive officer’s termination of employment or the time of a change-in-control.


Because Mr. Buley’s and Ms. Lowe’s employment separations occurred prior to the end of fiscal 2008, we discuss below, and the tables below present, the payments they actually received in connection with such employment separations.




152



Payments Regardless of Manner of Termination


Regardless of the termination scenario, the named executive officers will receive (and Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe received) earned but unpaid base salary through the employment termination date, along with any other payments or benefits owed under any of our plans or agreements covering the named executive officer as governed by the terms of those plans or agreements. These benefits include vested amounts in the CDP/SERP Plan discussed under “Nonqualified Deferred Compensation” above.


The tables below exclude any amounts payable to the named executive officer to the extent that they are available generally to all salaried employees and do not discriminate in favor of our executive officers.


Payments Upon Termination Due to Retirement


Retirement is not treated differently from any other voluntary termination without good reason (as defined under the relevant agreements) under any of our plans or agreements for named executive officers, except that all Rollover Options will remain exercisable for a period of 3 years following the named executive officer’s retirement unless the options expire earlier.  To be entitled to the extended exercise period for the Rollover Options, the retirement must occur on or after the named executive officer reaches the age of 65 or, with our express consent, prior to age 65 in accordance with any applicable early retirement policy then in effect or as may be approved by our Compensation Committee.


Payments Upon Termination Due to Death or Disability


In the event of death or disability, with respect to each named executive officer:


·

The 20% portion of the time-based options that would have become exercisable on the next anniversary date of the Merger if the named executive officer had remained employed with us through that date will become vested and exercisable.


·

The 20% portion of the performance-based options that would have become exercisable in respect of the fiscal year in which the named executive officer’s employment terminates if the named executive officer had remained employed with us through that date, will remain outstanding through the date we determine whether the applicable performance targets are met for that fiscal year.  If the performance targets are met for that fiscal year, that 20% portion of the performance-based options will become exercisable on such performance-vesting determination date. Otherwise, that 20% portion will be forfeited.


·

All unvested options will be forfeited, and vested options generally may be exercised (by the employee’s survivor in the case of death) for a period of 1 year (3 years in the case of Rollover Options) from the service termination date unless we purchase such vested options in total at the fair market value of the shares of our common stock underlying the vested options less the aggregate exercise price of the vested options.



153



In the event of death, each named executive officer’s beneficiary will receive payments under our group life insurance program in an amount, up to a maximum of $3 million, equal to 2.5 times the named executive officer’s annual base salary. We have excluded from the tables below amounts that the named executive officer would receive under our disability insurance program since the same benefit level is provided to all of our salaried employees. The named executive officer’s CDP/SERP Plan benefit also becomes fully vested (to the extent not already vested) upon his or her death and is payable in a lump sum within 60 days after the end of the calendar quarter in which the named executive officer’s death occurs.


In the event of disability, each named executive officer’s CDP/SERP Plan benefit becomes fully vested (to the extent not already vested) and is payable in a lump sum within 60 days after the end of the calendar quarter in which we receive notification of the determination of the named executive officer’s disability by the Social Security Administration.

 

In addition to the foregoing payments and benefits, in the event of Mr. Dreiling’s death or termination of employment due to disability, any then unvested shares of his 890,000 restricted shares will vest. In the event of Mr. Dreiling’s termination of employment due to disability, he will also be entitled to receive any incentive bonus accrued in respect of any of our previously completed fiscal years but unpaid as of the date of his termination. In the event of his termination of employment due to his disability, he will also receive a lump sum cash payment, payable at the time annual bonuses are paid to our other senior executives, equal to a pro-rata portion of his annual incentive bonus, if any, that he would have been entitled to receive, if such termination had not occurred, for the fiscal year in which his termination occurred.


In the event Mr. Bere’s employment is terminated due to death or disability, he will also be entitled to receive any incentive bonus accrued in respect of any of our previously completed fiscal years but unpaid as of the date of such termination.


For purposes of the named executive officers’ employment agreements, other than Mr. Dreiling’s, “disability” means the employee must be disabled for purposes of our long-term disability insurance plan. For purposes of Mr. Dreiling’s employment agreement, “disability” means he must be disabled for purposes of our long-term disability insurance plan or for purposes of his portable long-term disability insurance policy. For purposes of the CDP/SERP Plan, “disability” means total and permanent disability for purposes of entitlement to Social Security disability benefits.


Payments Upon Voluntary Termination


The payments to be made to a named executive officer upon voluntary termination vary depending upon whether the named executive officer resigns with or without “good reason” or after our failure to offer to renew, extend or replace the named executive officer’s employment agreement under certain circumstances. For purposes of each named executive officer, “good reason” generally means (as more fully described in the applicable employment agreement):



154



·

a reduction in base salary or target bonus level;


·

our material breach of the named executive officer’s employment agreement;


·

the failure of any successor to all or substantially all of our business and/or assets to assume and agree to perform the employment agreement;


·

our failure to continue any significant compensation plan or benefit without replacing it with a similar plan or a compensation equivalent (except for across-the-board changes or terminations similarly affecting at least 95% of all of our executives);


·

relocation of our principal executive offices outside of the middle-Tennessee area or basing the officer anywhere other than our principal executive offices; or

·

assignment of duties inconsistent, or the significant reduction of the title, powers and functions associated, with the named executive officer’s position, all without the named executive officer’s written consent. For all named executive officers other than Mr. Dreiling, such acts will not constitute good reason if it results from our restructuring or realignment of duties and responsibilities for business reasons that leaves the named executive officer at the same compensation and officer level and with similar responsibility levels or results from the named executive officer’s failure to meet performance criteria.


No event (in the case of Messrs. Dreiling and Bere, no isolated, insubstantial and inadvertent event not in bad faith) will constitute "good reason" if we cure the claimed event within 30 days (10 business days in the case of Messrs. Dreiling and Bere) after receiving notice from the named executive officer.

 

Voluntary Termination with Good Reason or After Failure to Renew the Employment Agreement.   If any named executive officer resigns with good reason, all then unvested option grants held by that officer will be forfeited. Unless we purchase any then vested options (including Rollover Options) in total at a price equal to the fair market value of the shares underlying the vested options, less the aggregate exercise price of the vested options, the named executive officer generally may exercise vested options for a period of 180 days (90 days in the case of Rollover Options) from the termination date.


Any unvested shares of Mr. Dreiling’s 890,000 shares of restricted stock will vest if he resigns with good reason.


In the event any named executive officer (other than Mr. Dreiling or Mr. Bere) resigns under the circumstances described in (2) below, or in the event we fail to extend the term of Mr. Dreiling’s employment as provided in (3) below, the relevant named executive officer’s equity will be treated as described under “Voluntary Termination without Good Reason” below.


Additionally, if the named executive officer (1) resigns with good reason, or (2) in the case of named executive officers other than Mr. Dreiling and Mr. Bere, resigns within 60 days of



155



our failure to offer to renew, extend or replace the named executive officer’s employment agreement before, at or within 60 days after the end of the agreement's term (unless we enter into a mutually acceptable severance arrangement or the resignation is a result of the named executive officer’s voluntary retirement or termination), or (3) in the case of Mr. Dreiling, in the event we elect not to extend the term of his employment by providing 60 days prior written notice before the applicable extension date, then the named executive officer will receive the following benefits as soon as administratively practicable after the 60 th day after termination of employment but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of a release of certain claims against us and our affiliates in the form attached to the named executive officer’s employment agreement:


·

Continuation of base salary, as in effect immediately before the termination, for 24 months payable in accordance with our normal payroll cycle and procedures (Mr. Bere will instead receive a lump sum payment equal to 2 times his base salary in effect on July 6, 2007).


·

A lump sum payment equal to 2 times the named executive officer’s target incentive bonus then in effect (Mr. Dreiling’s target incentive bonus payment instead will be payable over 24 months; Mr. Bere will instead receive a lump sum payment equal to 2 times the target incentive bonus he was eligible to earn under our bonus plan as in effect on July 6, 2007).


·

A lump sum payment equal to 2 times our annual contribution for the named executive officer’s participation in our medical, dental and vision benefits program (in the case of Mr. Dreiling, the medical, dental and vision benefit instead will be in the form of a continuation of these benefits to Mr. Dreiling, his spouse and his eligible dependents to the extent covered immediately prior to the employment termination, for 2 years from the termination date or, if earlier, until he is or becomes eligible for comparable coverage under the group health plans of a subsequent employer).


·

Mr. Dreiling will receive a prorated bonus payment based on our performance for the fiscal year, paid at the time bonuses are normally paid for that fiscal year.


·

If Mr. Bere’s termination occurred prior to the payment of our fiscal 2008 bonus, he would receive a lump sum payment of his fiscal 2008 bonus, determined as if he had remained employed through the date necessary to receive the payment of the fiscal 2008 bonus but prorated based on the number of months during fiscal 2008 during which he was employed by us.


·

Outplacement services, at our expense, for 1 year or, if earlier, until other employment is secured.


Note that any amounts owed to a named executive officer in the form of salary continuation that would otherwise have been paid during the 60 day period after the named executive officer’s employment termination will instead be payable in a single



156



lump sum as soon as administratively practicable after the 60 th day after such termination date and the remainder will be paid in the form of salary continuation payments as set forth above.


Subject to any applicable prohibition on acceleration of payment under Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), we may, at any time and in our sole discretion, elect to make a lump-sum payment of all these amounts (other than Mr. Dreiling’s medical, dental and vision benefit continuation which shall be provided over 24 months), or all other earned, but unpaid amounts, due as a result of this type of termination.


The named executive officer will forfeit any unpaid severance amounts upon a material breach of any continuing obligation under the employment agreement or the release (the “Continuing Obligations”), which include:


·

The named executive officer must maintain the confidentiality of, and refrain from disclosing or using, our (a) trade secrets for any period of time as the information remains a trade secret under applicable law and (b) confidential information for a period of 2 years following the employment termination date.


·

For a period of 2 years after the employment termination date, the named executive officer may not accept or work in a “competitive position” within any state in which we maintain stores at the time of his termination date or any state in which we have specific plans to open stores within 6 months of that date.  For this purpose, “competitive position” means any employment, consulting, advisory, directorship, agency, promotional or independent contractor arrangement between the named executive officer and any person engaged wholly or in material part in the business in which we are engaged, including but not limited to Wal-Mart, Target, K-Mart, Walgreen’s, Rite-Aid, CVS, Family Dollar Stores, Fred’s, the 99 Cents Stores, and Dollar Tree Stores (and, with respect to Messrs. Dreiling and Bere, Costco, BJ’s Wholesale Club, Casey’s General Stores and The Pantry, Inc.; and also, with respect to Mr. Bere, Longs Drug Stores; Walgreen’s, Rite-Aid and CVS are not specifically listed in Mr. Dreiling’s employment agreement), or any person then planning to enter the deep discount consumable basics retail business, if the named executive officer is required to perform services for that person which are substantially similar to those he or she provided or directed at any time while employed by us.


·

For a period of 2 years after the employment termination date, the named executive officer may not actively recruit or induce any of our exempt employees (exempt executives in the case of Mr. Dreiling) to cease employment with us.


·

For a period of 2 years after the employment termination date, the named executive officer may not solicit or communicate with any person who has a business relationship with us and with whom the named executive officer had contact while employed by us, if that contact would likely interfere with our business relationships or result in an unfair competitive advantage over us.




157



·

The named executive officer may not engage in any communications to persons outside Dollar General which disparages Dollar General or interferes with our existing or prospective business relationships.


Voluntary Termination without Good Reason.   If the named executive officer resigns without good reason, he or she will forfeit all unvested equity grants and all vested but unexercised options (other than Rollover Options).  Rollover Options are fully exercisable and generally may be exercised for 3 months from the termination date unless they expire earlier or unless we repurchase them, on a per share basis, at a per share price equal to the lesser of (1) the fair market value of one of our shares, minus the per share exercise price of a Rollover Option or (2) the sum of (x) $5.00 per share (the “Base Price”) plus (y) the applicable percentage (e.g., 20% for each anniversary of July 6, 2007 or each anniversary of the grant date, depending upon the executive officer) of the excess of the fair market value of one of our shares over the per share Base Price, minus (z) the per share exercise price of a Rollover Option.


Payments Upon Involuntary Termination


The payments to be made to a named executive officer upon involuntary termination vary depending upon whether termination is with or without “cause”. For purposes of each named executive officer, “cause” generally means (as more fully described in the applicable employment agreement):


·

Attendance at work in a state of intoxication or in possession of any prohibited drug or substance which would amount to a criminal offense;


·

Assault or other act of violence;


·

Any act involving fraud or dishonesty;


·

Any material breach of any SEC or other law or regulation or any Dollar General policy governing securities trading or inappropriate disclosure or "tipping";


·

Any activity or public statement, other than as required by law, that prejudices Dollar General or reduces our good name and standing or would bring Dollar General into public contempt or ridicule; or


·

Conviction of, or plea of guilty or nolo contendere to, any felony whatsoever or any misdemeanor that would preclude employment under our hiring policy.


For purposes of determining treatment of a named executive officer’s Rollover Options, “cause” means, to the extent that our Compensation Committee determines that it is directly and materially harmful to our business or reputation:


·

A felony conviction or the failure to contest prosecution of a felony; or


·

Willful misconduct or dishonesty.



158



Involuntary Termination for Cause.   If the named executive officer is involuntarily terminated for cause, he or she will forfeit all unvested equity grants, as well as all vested but unexercised options. However, we may repurchase all Rollover Options at a per share price equal to the lesser of (x) Base Price over the per share exercise price of these options and (y) the fair market value of one of our shares underlying these options over the per share exercise price of these options.


Involuntary Termination without Cause.   If the named executive officer is involuntarily terminated without cause, the named executive officer’s equity grants will be treated as described under “Voluntary Termination with Good Reason or After Failure to Renew the Employment Agreement” above. In addition, each named executive officer will receive the applicable payments and benefits as described under “Voluntary Termination with Good Reason or After Failure to Renew the Employment Agreement” above.

Payments After a Change-in-Control


Upon a change-in-control, regardless of whether the named executive officer’s employment terminates:


·

All unvested time-based options will become fully vested and exercisable, and all unvested performance-based options will become fully vested and exercisable subject to KKR’s achievement of certain return-based performance targets.

  

·

All CDP/SERP Plan benefits will become fully vested (to the extent not already vested).


·

Any then unvested shares of Mr. Dreiling’s 890,000 shares of restricted stock will vest.


If the named executive officer, other than Messrs. Dreiling or Bere, is involuntarily terminated without cause or resigns for good reason, in each case within 2 years following a change-in-control that constitutes a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code, he or she will receive, as soon as administratively practicable after the 60 th day after the employment termination but contingent upon execution and effectiveness of a release of certain claims against us and our affiliates in the form attached to the relevant employment agreement, a lump sum payment equal to the sum of (x) 2 times the named executive officer’s annual base salary plus 2 times the named executive officer’s target incentive bonus, each as in effect immediately prior to the change-in-control (or in each case, if greater, at the employment termination date) plus (y) 2 times our annual contribution for the named executive officer’s participation in our medical, dental and vision benefits program. The named executive officer also will receive outplacement services, at our expense, for 1 year or, if earlier, until other employment is secured.


If the named executive officer, other than Messrs. Dreiling or Bere, is involuntarily terminated without cause or resigns for good reason, in each case within 2 years following a change-in-control that does not constitute a change in ownership or effective control within the



159



meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code, the termination will be treated in the same manner as a voluntary termination with good reason as described under “Voluntary Termination with Good Reason or after Failure to Renew the Employment Agreement” above.


For Messrs. Dreiling and Bere, an involuntary termination without cause or a resignation for good reason following a change-in-control event will be treated in the same manner as a “Voluntary Termination with Good Reason or After Failure to Renew the Employment Agreement” as described above.


If any payments or benefits in connection with a change-in-control would be subject to the “golden parachute” excise tax under federal income tax rules, we will pay an additional amount to the named executive officer to cover the excise tax and any other excise and income taxes resulting from this payment. However, if after receiving this payment the named executive officer’s after-tax benefit would not be at least $25,000 more than it would be without this payment, then this payment will not be made and the severance and other benefits due to the named executive officer will be reduced so that the golden parachute excise tax is not incurred.


For purposes of the CDP/SERP Plan and the named executive officers’ (other than Messrs. Dreiling and Bere) employment agreements, a change-in-control generally is deemed to occur (as more fully described in those documents):


·

if any person (other than Dollar General or any of our employee benefit plans) acquires 35% or more of our voting securities (other than as a result of our issuance of securities in the ordinary course of business);


·

for purposes of our CDP/SERP Plan, if a majority of our Board members at the beginning of any consecutive 2-year period are replaced within that period without the approval of at least 2/3 of our Board members who served as directors at the beginning of the period;


·

for purposes of the specified employment agreements, if a majority of our Board members as of the effective date of the applicable employment agreement are replaced without the approval of at least 75% of our Board members who served as directors on that effective date or are replaced, even with this 75% approval, by persons who initially assumed office as a result of an actual or threatened election contest or other actual or threatened proxy solicitation other than by our Board; or


·

upon the consummation of a merger, other business combination or sale of assets of, or cash tender or exchange offer or contested election with respect to, Dollar General if less than 65% (less than a majority, for purposes of our CDP/SERP Plan) of our voting securities are held after the transaction in the aggregate by holders of our securities immediately prior to the transaction.


For purposes of the treatment of equity discussed above, a change-in-control generally means (as more fully described in the Management Stockholder’s Agreement between us and the named executive officers) one or a series of related transactions described below which results in



160



us, KKR and its affiliates or an employee benefit plan referenced below ceasing to hold the ability to elect (or cause to be elected) a majority of our Board members:


·

the sale of all or substantially all of the assets of Buck Holdings, L.P. or us  and our subsidiaries to any person (or group of persons acting in concert), other than to (x) investment funds affiliated with KKR or its affiliates or (y) any employee benefit plan (or trust forming a part thereof) maintained by us, KKR or our respective affiliates or other person of which a majority of its voting power or other equity securities is owned, directly or indirectly, by us, KKR or our respective affiliates; or


·

a merger, recapitalization or other sale by us, KKR (indirectly) or any of our respective affiliates, to a person (or group of persons acting in concert) of our common stock or our other voting securities that results in more than 50% of our common stock or our other voting securities (or any resulting company after a merger) being held, directly or indirectly, by a person (or group of persons acting in concert) that is not controlled by (x) KKR or its affiliates or (y) an employee benefit plan (or trust forming a part thereof) maintained us, KKR or our respective affiliates or other person of which a majority of its voting power or other equity securities is owned, directly or indirectly, by us, KKR or our respective affiliates.


Payments to Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe


Mr. Buley’s and Ms. Lowe’s employment with us ended in April 2008 and September 2008, respectively.  Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe each received the following payments and benefits under their respective employment agreements and other plans in which he or she participated.  The severance payments were contingent upon execution and effectiveness of a release of certain claims against us and our affiliates in the form attached to the relevant employment agreement.


·

A lump sum payment equal to the sum of (x) 2 times the sum of his or her annual base salary as in effect at the relevant employment termination date, plus (y) 2 times his or her target incentive bonus for fiscal 2008, plus (z) 2 times our annual contribution for his or her participation in our medical, dental and vision benefits program.


·

In lieu of providing Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe the third party outplacement services described above, we paid a cash amount to each equal to the estimated amount we would have incurred to provide such services.


·

All unvested equity grants automatically terminated.


·

We exercised our call rights under our Management Stockholder’s Agreement with each of Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe to purchase all of our outstanding equity owned by each such executive, including shares of stock previously purchased from us by Ms. Lowe, as well as all vested options and vested Rollover Options held by each executive.  See “Option Exercises and Stock Vested during Fiscal 2008” above.




161



We also transferred to Ms. Lowe the title to her Company-provided vehicle (valued at $32,650), and we extended to her and her eligible dependents coverage under our health benefits plan from the date of her termination through December 31, 2008.  Ms. Lowe paid 100% of the premium costs of such extended insurance coverage.  


Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe are subject to the Continuing Obligations set forth under “Voluntary Termination with Good Reason or After Failure to Renew the Employment Agreement” above.  However, because all severance amounts have been paid to Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe in full, we will have no right to recoup those payments in the event either such person breaches any of the Continuing Obligations.


Potential Payments to Named Executive Officers Upon Occurrence of Various Termination Events

As of January 30, 2009


Name

Voluntary
Without
Good Reason

Involuntary
Without Cause
or Voluntary
With Good
Reason

Involuntary
With Cause

Death

Disability

Retirement

Change-in-
Control (1)

Richard W. Dreiling

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vested Options Prior to Event

$375,000

$375,000

$375,000

$375,000

$375,000

$375,000

$375,000

Vesting of Options Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

$250,000

$250,000

N/A

$875,000

Vesting of Restricted Stock Due to the Event

N/A

$4,895,000

N/A

$4,895,000

$4,895,000

N/A

$4,895,000

SERP Benefits Prior to the Event

$0

$0

$0

$0

$0

$0

$0

SERP Benefits Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Prior to and After the Event

$8,254

$8,254

$8,254

$8,254

$8,254

$8,254

$8,254

Cash Severance

N/A

$6,176,300

N/A

N/A

$2,176,300

N/A

$6,176,300

Health and Welfare Continuation (2)

N/A

$10,923

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,923

Health and Welfare Continuation Gross-Up

N/A

$14,851

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$14,851

Outplacement (3)

N/A

$10,000

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Life Insurance Proceeds

N/A

N/A

N/A

$2,500,000

N/A

N/A

N/A

Total

$383,254

$11,490,328

$383,254

$8,028,254

$7,704,554

$383,254

$12,365,328



162




David L. Bere

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vested Options Prior to Event

$544,526

$544,526

$544,526

$544,526

$544,526

$544,526

$544,526

Vesting of Options Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

$225,000

$225,000

N/A

$787,500

Vesting of Restricted Stock Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

SERP Benefits Prior to the Event

$164,956

$164,956

$164,956

$164,956

$164,956

$164,956

$164,956

SERP Benefits Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Prior to and After the Event

$125,844

$125,844

$125,844

$125,844

$125,844

$125,844

$125,844

Cash Severance

N/A

$3,844,818

N/A

$1,319,876

$1,319,876

N/A

$3,844,818

Health and Welfare Payment

N/A

$17,422

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$17,422

Outplacement (3)

N/A

$10,000

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$0

Life Insurance Proceeds

N/A

N/A

N/A

$1,856,575

N/A

N/A

N/A

Total

$835,326

$4,707,566

$835,326

$4,236,777

$2,380,202

$835,326

$5,495,066

David M. Tehle

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vested Options Prior to Event

$981,030

$981,030

$981,030

$981,030

$981,030

$981,030

$981,030

Vesting of Options Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

$110,000

$110,000

N/A

$385,000

Vesting of Restricted Stock Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

SERP Benefits Prior to the Event

$179,041

$179,041

$179,041

$179,041

$179,041

$179,041

$179,041

SERP Benefits Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Prior to and After the Event

$141,488

$141,488

$141,488

$141,488

$141,488

$141,488

$141,488

Cash Severance

N/A

$2,030,563

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$2,030,563

Health and Welfare Payment

N/A

$17,422

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$107,681

Outplacement (3)

N/A

$10,000

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$0

Life Insurance Proceeds

N/A

N/A

N/A

$1,538,305

N/A

N/A

N/A

Total

$1,301,557

$3,359,541

$1,301,557

$2,949,862

$1,411,557

$1,301,557

$3,834,800

Kathleen R. Guion

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vested Options Prior to Event

$695,591

$695,591

$695,591

$695,591

$695,591

$695,591

$695,591

Vesting of Options Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

$87,500

$87,500

N/A

$306,250

Vesting of Restricted Stock Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

SERP Benefits Prior to the Event

$170,880

$170,880

$170,880

$170,880

$170,880

$170,880

$170,880

SERP Benefits Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Prior to and After the Event

$165,290

$165,290

$165,290

$165,290

$165,290

$165,290

$165,290

Cash Severance

N/A

$1,963,500

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$1,963,500

Health and Welfare Payment

N/A

$10,923

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,923

Outplacement (3)

N/A

$10,000

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$0

Life Insurance Proceeds

N/A

N/A

N/A

$1,487,500

N/A

N/A

N/A

Total

$1,031,758

$3,016,181

$1,031,758

$2,606,758

$1,119,258

$1,031,758

$3,322,431



163




Susan S. Lanigan

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vested Options Prior to Event

$686,080

$686,080

$686,080

$686,080

$686,080

$686,080

$686,080

Vesting of Options Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

$67,500

$67,500

N/A

$236,250

Vesting of Restricted Stock Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

SERP Benefits Prior to the Event

$112,668

$112,668

$112,668

$112,668

$112,668

$112,668

$112,668

SERP Benefits Due to the Event

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Prior to and After the Event

$62,759

$62,759

$62,759

$62,759

$62,759

$62,759

$62,759

Cash Severance

N/A

$1,435,398

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$1,435,398

Health and Welfare Payment

N/A

$10,985

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,985

Outplacement (3)

N/A

$10,000

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

N/A

$0

Life Insurance Proceeds

N/A

N/A

N/A

$1,087,423

N/A

N/A

N/A

Total

$861,506

$2,317,887

$861,506

$2,016,428

$929,006

$861,506

$2,554,137


(1)

All payments in this column require termination of employment to be paid except options (prior to and due to the event) and restricted stock.

(2)

Mr. Dreiling’s Health and Welfare Continuation was calculated in the same manner as the Health and Welfare Payment for the other NEOs.

(3)

Outplacement is estimated based on outplacement services to recently terminated NEOs.


Payments to Mr. Buley in Connection With Termination on April 15, 2008


Vested Options Called by Company

$754,864

SERP Benefits Vested Prior to the Event

$40,898

SERP Benefits Due to the Event

$0

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Paid

$131,552

Cash Severance

$2,013,059

Health and Welfare Continuation Payment

$21,539

Outplacement

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

$0

Total

$2,971,911




164



Payments to Ms. Lowe in Connection With Termination on September 15, 2008


Vested Options Called by Company

$396,375

SERP Benefits Vested Prior to the Event (1)

$53,588

SERP Benefits Due to the Event (1)

$72,404

Deferred Comp Plan Balance Paid

$1,435,398

Cash Severance

$40,400

Health and Welfare Continuation Payment

$9,825

Outplacement

$10,000

Section 280(G) Excise Tax and Gross-Up

N/A

Total

$2,017,990


(1)

Ms. Lowe will be eligible for payments from the SERP and CDP in August 2009. Final payment amounts may vary due to potential gains or losses until payment is made.


Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation


Each of Messrs. Michael Calbert, Raj Agrawal and Adrian Jones was a member of our Compensation Committee during fiscal 2008. None of these persons was at any time during fiscal 2008 an officer or employee of Dollar General or any of our subsidiaries, or an officer of Dollar General or any of our subsidiaries at any time prior to fiscal 2008.  Messrs. Calbert and Agrawal, due to their relationships with KKR, and Mr. Jones, due to his relationship with Goldman, Sachs & Co., may be viewed as having an indirect material interest in certain relationships and transactions with KKR and Goldman, Sachs & Co discussed under Item 13 below. Mr. Dreiling serves and, for a portion of fiscal 2008, Mr. Bere served as a director of Buck Holdings, LLC, for which Messrs. Calbert, Agrawal and Jones serve as executive officers.


(b)

Director Compensation. The following table and text discuss the compensation of persons who served as a member of our Board of Directors during all or part of fiscal 2008, other than Mr. Dreiling and Mr. Bere each of whose compensation is discussed under “Executive Compensation” above and who was not separately compensated for Board service. We have omitted from this table the columns pertaining to stock awards, option awards, non-equity incentive plan compensation, and nonqualified deferred compensation earnings because they are inapplicable.


Fiscal 2008 Director Compensation


Name

Fees Earned or
Paid in Cash
($)

All Other
Compensation
($)
(1)

Total
($)

Raj Agrawal

40,000

--

40,000

Michael M. Calbert

40,000

--

40,000

Adrian Jones

40,000

--

40,000

Dean B. Nelson (2)

40,000

--

40,000


(1)

Perquisites and personal benefits, if any, totaled less than $10,000 per director.

(2)

Mr. Nelson resigned from our Board of Directors on March 16, 2009.



165



Our director compensation structure encompasses only cash compensation.  Cash fees payable to our non-employee directors consist solely of a $40,000 annual retainer fee, payable in quarterly installments. We do not compensate for Board service any director who simultaneously serves as a Dollar General employee. We will reimburse directors for certain fees and expenses incurred in connection with continuing education seminars and for travel and related expenses related to Dollar General business. We allow directors to travel on the Dollar General airplane for those purposes.     



ITEM 12.

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS


(a)

Equity Compensation Plan Information.   The following table sets forth information about securities authorized for issuance under our compensation plans (including individual compensation arrangements) as of January 30, 2009:


Plan category

Number of securities
to be issued upon
exercise of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
(a)

Weighted-average exercise price of outstanding options, warrants and rights
(b)

Number of
securities remaining
available for future
issuance under
equity compensation
plans (excluding
securities reflected
in column (a))
(c)

 

 

 

 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders (1)

22,216,087

$ 4.81

4,154,826

 


 


Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

--

--

--

 


 


Total (1)

22,216,087

$ 4.81

4,154,826

 

 

 

 

(1)

Column (a) consists of shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding options under the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan and the 1998 Stock Incentive Plan. Column (c) consists of shares reserved for issuance pursuant to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan, whether in the form of stock or restricted stock or upon the exercise of an option or right.



(b)

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.   The following table shows the amount of our common stock beneficially owned, as of March 17, 2009, by those who were known by us to beneficially own more than 5% of our common stock, by our directors and named executive officers individually and by our directors and all of our executive officers as a group, all calculated in accordance with Rule 13d-3 of the Exchange Act under which a person generally is deemed to beneficially own a security if he has or shares voting or investment power over the security or if he has the right to acquire beneficial ownership within 60 days. Unless otherwise noted, these persons may be contacted at our executive offices and, to our knowledge, have sole voting and investment power over the shares



166



listed. Percentage computations are based on 556,227,947 shares of our stock outstanding as of March 17, 2009.


Name of Beneficial Owner

Amount and Nature of Beneficial Ownership

Percent of Class

 

 

 

KKR (1)(2)

288,399,897

51.85%

The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (2)(3)

119,999,943

21.57%

Citigroup Capital Partners (2)(4)

39,999,981

7.19%

CPP Investment Board (USRE II) Inc. (2)(5)

40,000,000

7.19%

Wellington Management Company, LLP (2)(6)

40,000,000

7.19%

Michael M. Calbert (7)

288,399,897

51.85%

Raj Agrawal (7)

288,399,897

51.85%

Adrian Jones (8)

119,999,943

21.57%

Richard W. Dreiling (9)(10)

1,640,000

*

David L. Beré (10)

1,137,177

*

David M. Tehle (10)

538,001

*

Kathleen R. Guion (10)

425,698

*

Susan S. Lanigan (10)

340,107

 

Beryl J. Buley

--

--

Challis M. Lowe

--

--

All current directors and executive officers as a group
(12 persons) (7)(8)(9)(10)(11)

412,949,111

73.85%


*

Denotes less than 1% of class.

(1)

Includes the following number of shares held by the following entities: KKR 2006 Fund L.P. (203,464,902.69); KKR PEI Investments, L.P. (49,999,976.09); KKR Partners III, L.P. (4,724,997.74) and Buck Holdings Co-Invest, LP (30,210,020). Buck Holdings Co-Invest GP, LLC, which is controlled through KKR Associates 2006 L.P. by KKR 2006 GP LLC, is the general partner of Buck Holdings Co-Invest, LP, and has the right to manage the affairs of such entity, and thus is deemed to be the beneficial owner of the securities owned by such entity. However, it does not have any economic or other dispositive rights with respect to such securities and thus disclaims beneficial ownership with respect thereto. KKR’s address is c/o Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P., 2800 Sand Hill Road, Suite 200, Menlo Park, CA 94025.

(2)

Indirectly held through Buck Holdings, L.P.

(3)

Includes the following number of shares held by the following entities: GS Capital Partners VI Parallel, L.P. (12,194,145.412); GS Capital Partners VI GmbH & Co. KG (1,576,025.208); GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P. (44,345,094.704); GS Capital Partners VI Offshore Fund, L.P. (36,884,689.242); Goldman Sachs DGC Investors, L.P. (6,692,778.104) and Goldman Sachs DGC Investors Offshore Holdings, L.P. (13,307,212.332) (collectively, the “GS Funds”); and GSUIG, L.L.C. (4,999,997.608). Affiliates of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. are the general partner, managing general partner or investment manager of each of the GS Funds, and each of the GS Funds shares voting and investment power with certain of its respective affiliates. Each of the GS Funds is affiliated with or managed by Goldman, Sachs & Co., a wholly owned subsidiary of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. Each of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and Goldman, Sachs & Co. disclaims beneficial ownership of the shares owned by each of the GS Funds, except to the extent of their pecuniary interest therein, if any. The address of each of the GS Funds and GSUIG, L.L.C. is c/o Goldman, Sachs & Co., 85 Broad Street 10th floor, New York, New York 10004.

(4)

Includes the following number of shares held by the following entities: Citigroup Capital Partners II Employee Master Fund, L.P. (8,598,705.956); Citigroup Capital Partners II 2007 Citigroup Investment, L.P. (7,655,121.066); Citigroup Capital Partners II Onshore, L.P. (3,881,957.266); Citigroup Capital Partners II Cayman Holdings, L.P. (4,864,203.756) and CPE Co-Investment (Dollar General) LLC (14,999,992.826). The address of Citigroup Capital Partners is c/o Citigroup Inc., 388 Greenwich Street, 21 st Floor, New York, New York 10013.



167



(5)

The Address of CPP Investment Board (USRE II) Inc. is c/o Canada Pension Plan Investment Board, One Queen Street East, Suite 2600, Toronto, ON M5C 2W5, Canada.

(6)

Wellington Management Company, LLP (“Wellington”) is an investment advisor registered under the Investment Advisors Act of 1940, as amended. Wellington, in such capacity, may be deemed to share beneficial ownership over the shares held by its client accounts.  Certain of its client accounts hold shares through the following entities: Buck Co-Investor I, LLC (17,933,540); Buck Co-Investor II, LLC (827,780); Buck Co-Investor III, LLC (7,365,100); Buck Co-Investor IV, LLC (5,822,740); Buck Co-Investor V, LLC (2,201,580); Buck Co-Investor VI, LLC (499,900), Buck Co-Investor VII, LLC (2,252,700), Buck Co-Investor VIII, LLC (445,820), Buck Co-Investor IX, LLC (281,560), Buck Co-Investor X, LLC (609,280), Buck Co-Investor XI, LLC (1,160,000), Buck Co-Investor XII, LLC (476,000), and Buck Co-Investor XIII, LLC (124,000). The address of Wellington Management Company, LLP is 75 State Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02109.

(7)

Messrs. Calbert and Agrawal are our directors and are executives of KKR, and as such may be deemed to share beneficial ownership of shares beneficially owned by KKR. Messrs. Calbert and Agrawal disclaim such beneficial ownership except to the extent of their pecuniary interest therein, if any.

(8)

Mr. Jones is our director and an executive of GS Capital Partners, but disclaims any beneficial ownership except to the extent of his pecuniary interest in those shares, if any.

(9)

Includes 890,000 shares of restricted common stock that were unvested as of March 17, 2009 over which the named holder does not have investment power until the vesting of those shares.

(10)

Includes the following number of shares subject to options either currently exercisable or exercisable within 60 days of March 17, 2009 over which the person will not have voting or investment power until the options are exercised: Mr. Dreiling (750,000); Mr. Bere (723,712); Mr. Tehle (522,007); Ms. Guion (395,286); Ms. Lanigan (340,107); and all current directors and executive officers as a group (2,966,520). The shares described in this note are considered outstanding for the purpose of computing the percentage of outstanding stock owned by each named person and by the group, but not for the purpose of computing the percentage ownership of any other person.

(11)

Excluding the shares described in notes (7) and (8), all current directors and executive officers as a group beneficially own 4,549,271 shares.


ITEM 13.

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE


(a)

Director Independence.  Our Board of Directors consists of Richard Dreiling, Michael Calbert, Raj Agrawal and Adrian Jones. Messrs. Calbert and Agrawal serve on our Audit Committee and, along with Mr. Jones, on our Compensation Committee.  David Bere served on our Board until March 2008, and Dean Nelson served on our Board until March 2009.


Though not formally considered by our Board given that our securities are not registered or traded on a national securities exchange, we do not believe any of our current Board members or Messrs. Bere or Nelson would be considered independent under the listing standards of the New York Stock Exchange, on which our common stock was listed prior to the Merger, either because of service on our management team or relationships with certain affiliates of the funds and other entities that hold significant interests in Parent, and other relationships with us described under “Related Party Transactions” below.  Accordingly, we do not believe that any of our Audit Committee members would meet the independence requirements of Rule 10A-1 of the Exchange Act or the NYSE’s audit committee independence requirements, or that any of our Compensation Committee members would meet the NYSE’s independence requirements. We do not have a nominating/corporate governance committee or a committee that serves a similar purpose.




168



(b)

Related Party Transactions .  We describe below the transactions that have occurred since the beginning of fiscal 2008, and any currently proposed transactions, that involve Dollar General and exceed $120,000, and in which a related party had or has a direct or indirect material interest.


Equity Investment by Messrs. Vasos, Flanigan and Ravener .  In fiscal 2008, three of our executive officers, Todd Vasos, Executive Vice President, Division President, Chief Merchandising Officer, John Flanigan, Senior Vice President of Global Supply Chain, and Robert Ravener, Senior Vice President and Chief People Officer, purchased shares of Dollar General common stock that were issued pursuant to our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan, as follows:


Name

Effective Date of Purchase

Number of Shares

Per Share Purchase Price*

Aggregate Purchase Price

Mr. Vasos

12/19/2008

130,000

$ 5.00

$ 650,000

Mr. Flanigan

08/28/2008

 40,000

$ 5.00

$ 200,000

Mr. Ravener

08/28/2008

 25,000

$ 5.00

$ 125,000

 

12/19/2008

 35,000

$ 5.00

$ 175,000


*

Equals the per share fair market value of our common stock on the effective date of purchase as determined in good faith by our Board of Directors considering the factors referenced in, or similar to those referenced in, Footnote 1 to the table entitled “Option Exercises and Stock Vested During Fiscal 2008” in Item 11 above.


In addition, in August 2008 and December 2008, each of Mr. Flanigan and Mr. Ravener respectively indicated an intention to invest an additional $50,000 and $200,000 in Dollar General common stock in May 2009.  The number of shares each of Messrs. Flanigan and Ravener will receive in connection with such investment will be determined based upon the per share fair market value of our common stock on the date of such investment in May 2009 as determined by our Board of Directors. Upon consummation of his investment in May 2009, Mr. Flanigan will be eligible to receive an additional grant of 80,000 stock options issued pursuant to our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan, subject to the approval of our Compensation Committee.


The investments set forth in the table above were a prerequisite to the eligibility of these executives to receive grants of stock options pursuant to our 2007 Stock Incentive Plan (our Compensation Committee granted Messrs. Vasos, Flanigan and Ravener 875,000, 320,000, and 400,000 options, respectively, during fiscal 2008, with a per share exercise price of $5.00). The shares purchased by Messrs. Vasos, Flanigan and Ravener, along with any shares such individuals may otherwise acquire (such as upon exercise of the stock options referenced above) are subject to certain transfer limitations and repurchase rights by Dollar General as set forth in a Management Stockholder’s Agreement between us and each such executive officer.


Calls of Equity Held by Former Executive Officers .  In connection with the separation from our employment of Mr. Wayne Gibson, our former Senior Vice President of Dollar General Markets and Shrink, in June 2008 we paid Mr. Gibson an aggregate of $348,704 (less applicable withholding for taxes and other payroll deductions) in connection with the exercise of our call right under our Management Stockholder’s Agreement with Mr. Gibson to purchase all of our



169



outstanding equity owned by him.  Specifically, we purchased at $5.00 per share (less any applicable option exercise price) 13,721 shares of Dollar General common stock that he previously purchased from us for $5.00 per share, 40,000 vested options with an exercise price of $5.00 per share and 74,693 vested options with an exercise price of $1.25 per share.  The per share purchase price equaled the fair market value of our common stock on the last day of the month preceding the call, as determined in good faith by our Board of Directors pursuant to the terms of our Management Stockholder’s Agreement with Mr. Gibson. All such vested options were cancelled upon their purchase by us, and all 360,000 unvested options held by Mr. Gibson were automatically cancelled upon the end of his employment with us.  


We also exercised our call rights with respect to equity held by Mr. Buley and Ms. Lowe, all as disclosed under “Option Exercises and Stock Vested During 2008” in Item 11 above.


Interlocks.  Mr. Dreiling serves and, for a portion of fiscal 2008, Mr. Bere served as a director of Buck Holdings, LLC for which Messrs. Calbert, Agrawal and Jones (our Compensation Committee members) serve as executive officers.


Relationships with the Investors .   Goldman, Sachs & Co. and KKR provide management and advisory services to us and our affiliates pursuant to a monitoring agreement with us and Parent executed in connection with the Merger (the “Monitoring Agreement”). Under the terms of the Monitoring Agreement, among other things, we are obligated to pay to those entities an aggregate annual management fee plus all reasonable out of pocket expenses incurred in connection with the provision of services under the agreement. We paid to those entities an aggregate management fee of approximately $5.1 million in fiscal 2008, $1.1 million of which was paid to Goldman, Sachs & Co. and $4.0 million of which was paid to KKR.  We also reimbursed KKR approximately $391,086 in expenses.  We expect to incur an aggregate annual fee for fiscal 2009 of approximately $5.4 million plus expenses.  Thereafter, the annual management fee will increase 5% per year. The Monitoring Agreement also provides that such entities will be entitled to receive a fee equal to 1% of the gross transaction value in connection with certain subsequent financing, acquisition or disposition of assets or equity interests, recapitalization and other similar transactions, as well as a termination fee in the event of an initial public offering or under certain other circumstances. All such fees are to be split based upon an agreed upon formula, which results in an initial split of 78.38% of this fee payable to KKR and 21.62% payable to Goldman, Sachs & Co.


In connection with entering into the Monitoring Agreement, on July 6, 2007 we and Parent also entered into a separate indemnification agreement with the parties to the Monitoring Agreement, pursuant to which we agreed to provide customary indemnification to such parties and their affiliates.


In 2008, we paid approximately $1.1 million to KKR for expenses incurred in connection with the recruitment of Mr. Dreiling to serve as our Chief Executive Officer, including fees paid to executive search firms and fees paid to a management assessment firm.


Affiliates of KKR (among other entities) are lenders under, and Citicorp North America, Inc. serves as administrative agent and collateral agent for, our $2.3 billion senior secured term



170



loan facility.  The amount of principal outstanding under this term loan facility at all times during fiscal 2008 and as of March 17, 2009 was $2.3 billion, and we paid no principal and approximately $133.4 million of interest during fiscal 2008.  We paid $200,000 to Citicorp North America, Inc. for its services relating to this facility.  For additional information regarding the senior secured term loan facility, see the discussion under the heading “Credit Facilities” in the Liquidity and Capital Resources portion of Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations in Item 7 above.


Goldman, Sachs & Co. is a counterparty to an amortizing interest rate swap totaling $433.3 million as of January 30, 2009, entered into in connection with such senior secured term loan facility. See Item 7A “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk" for information regarding such interest rate swap.  We paid Goldman, Sachs & Co. approximately $9.5 million in fiscal 2008 pursuant to the interest rate swap.


Our Board members Mr. Calbert and Mr. Agrawal and our former Board member Mr. Nelson serve as a Member,  a Director and a Partner of KKR, respectively, while our Board member Mr. Jones serves as a Managing Director of Goldman, Sachs & Co. KKR indirectly owns approximately 52% of our common stock. Goldman, Sachs & Co. is an affiliate of GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P. and affiliated funds. GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P. and affiliated funds indirectly own approximately 22% of our common stock. Citicorp North America Inc. is an affiliate of Citigroup Private Equity LP.  Funds managed by Citigroup Private Equity LP indirectly own approximately 7% of our common stock.


We use Capstone Consulting, LLC, a team of executives who work exclusively with KKR portfolio companies providing certain consulting services. We pay Capstone a monthly fee, currently $210,000, plus expense reimbursements. During fiscal 2008, the aggregate fees and expenses we incurred for Capstone’s services totaled approximately $3 million. Our former Board member Mr. Nelson is the Chief Executive Officer of Capstone. Although neither KKR nor any entity affiliated with KKR owns any of the equity of Capstone, KKR had provided financing to Capstone prior to January 1, 2007.


(c)

Related Party Transaction Approval Policy .  On August 28, 2008, our Board adopted a written policy for the review, approval or ratification of “related party” transactions.  For purposes of this policy, a “related party” includes our directors, executive officers, and greater than 5% shareholders, as well as their immediate family members, and a “transaction” includes one in which (1) the total amount may exceed $100,000, (2) Dollar General is a participant, and (3) a related party will have a direct or indirect material interest (other than as a director or a less than 10% owner of another entity, or both).


Pursuant to this policy and subject to certain exceptions, all known related party transactions require prior Board approval. In addition, at least annually after receiving a list of immediate family members and affiliates from our directors, executive officers and over 5% shareholders, the Corporate Secretary will coordinate with relevant internal departments to determine whether any transactions were unknowingly entered into with a related party and will present a list of such transactions to the Board for review.




171



This policy authorizes Mr. Dreiling to approve a related party transaction in which he is not involved if the total amount is less than $1 million and if the Board is informed of transactions approved in this manner.  In addition, the following transactions are deemed automatically pre-approved and require no further Board approval or reporting to the Board:


·

Transactions involving a related party that is an entity or involving another company with a relationship to a related party if the total amount does not exceed the greater of $1 million or 2% of that company’s total annual consolidated revenues (total consolidated assets in the case of a lender) and no related party who is an individual participates in the actual provision of services or goods to, or negotiations with, us on the other company’s behalf or receives special compensation as a result.


·

Charitable contributions if the total amount does not exceed 2% of the entity’s total annual receipts and no related party who is an individual participates in the grant decision or receives any special compensation or benefit as a result.


·

Transactions where the interest arises solely from share ownership in Dollar General and all of our shareholders receive the same benefit on a pro rata basis.


·

Transactions where the rates or charges are determined by competitive bid.


·

Transactions for services as a common or contract carrier or public utility at rates or charges fixed in conformity with law or governmental authority.


·

Transactions involving services as a bank depositary of funds, transfer agent, registrar, trustee under a trust indenture, or similar services.


·

Compensatory transactions available on a nondiscriminatory basis to all salaried employees generally, or ordinary course business travel and expenses and reimbursements.


The policy prohibits the related party from participating in any discussion or approval of the transaction and requires the related party to provide to the Board all material information concerning the transaction. None of the requirements in the policy supersede or replace any separate procedures and requirements in our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics or other relevant policy.



172



ITEM 14.

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES


The table below shows the aggregate fees Ernst & Young LLP incurred in connection with various audit and other services provided to us throughout fiscal 2008 and fiscal 2007.  


Service

2008 Aggregate Fees Billed ($)

2007 Aggregate Fees Billed ($)

 

 

 

Audit Fees (1)

1,930,418

2,586,426

Audit-Related Fees (2)

28,500

119,514

Tax Fees (3)

218,129

163,645

All Other Fees (4)

6,000

6,000

 

 

 

(1)

2008 fees include audit services, as well as services associated with the Registration Statement on Form S-1. 2007 fees include audit services, as well as services relating to the debt offering memorandum associated with the Merger and the subsequent exchange offer Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed with the SEC. Such amounts include fees for services rendered for the fiscal year, notwithstanding when the service was provided and billed.

(2)

2008 fees include services relating to the employee benefit plan audit.  2007 fees include services relating to the employee benefit plan audit, as well as accounting consultation services relating to the Merger.  

(3)

2008 and 2007 fees include services relating to a LIFO tax calculation and tax advisory services related to inventory, as well as international, federal, state and local tax advice. 

(4)

2008 and 2007 fees include a subscription fee to an on-line accounting research tool. 


The Audit Committee Charter requires Audit Committee pre-approval for all audit and permissible non-audit services provided by our independent auditors. Where feasible, the Audit Committee considers and, when appropriate, pre-approves services at regularly scheduled meetings after disclosure by management and the auditors of the nature of the proposed services, the estimated fees (when available), and their opinions that the services will not impair the auditors’ independence. The Audit Committee also may consider and pre-approve any such services in between meetings.  





173



PART IV


ITEM 15.

EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES


 

(a)

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

Consolidated Balance Sheets

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(b)

All schedules for which provision is made in the applicable accounting regulations of the SEC are not required under the related instructions, are inapplicable or the information is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements and, therefore, have been omitted.

 

(c)

Exhibits:  See Exhibit Index immediately following the signature pages hereto, which Exhibit Index is incorporated by reference as if fully set forth herein.



174



SIGNATURES


Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.


 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date: March 24, 2009

By:

/s/ Richard W. Dreiling

 

 

Richard W. Dreiling, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer


We, the undersigned directors and officers of the registrant, hereby severally constitute Richard W. Dreiling and David M. Tehle, and each of them singly, our true and lawful attorneys with full power to them and each of them to sign for us, and in our names in the capacities indicated below, any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.  


Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.


Name

 

Title

 

Date

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Richard W. Dreiling

 

Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)

 

March 24, 2009

RICHARD W. DREILING

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ David M. Tehle

 

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)

 

March 24, 2009

DAVID M. TEHLE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Michael M. Calbert

 

Director

 

March 19, 2009

MICHAEL M . CALBERT

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Raj Agrawal

 

Director

 

March 19, 2009

RAJ AGRAWAL

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Adrian Jones

 

Director

 

March 19, 2009

ADRIAN JONES

 

 

 





175



Supplemental Information to be Furnished With Reports Filed Pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act by Registrants Which Have Not Registered Securities Pursuant to Section 12 of the Act


The Registrant has not sent to its security holders an annual report covering its last fiscal year. In addition, the Registrant has not sent to security holders any proxy statement, form of proxy or other proxy soliciting material since such time as the registration of Registrant’s securities under Section 12 of the Act was terminated.



176



EXHIBIT INDEX

2.1

Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of March 11, 2007, by and among Buck Holdings, L.P., Buck Acquisition Corp., and Dollar General Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 11, 2007, filed with the SEC on March 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


3.1

Amended and Restated Charter of Dollar General Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


3.2

Amended and Restated Bylaws of Dollar General Corporation (adopted on September 20, 2007) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.1

Sections 7 and 8 of Dollar General Corporation’s Amended and Restated Charter (included in Exhibit 3.1)


4.2

Indenture, dated as of June 21, 2000, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4 filed with the SEC on August 1, 2000 (file number 333-42704))


4.3

First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 28, 2000, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 2003, filed with the SEC on March 19, 2003 (file number 001-11421))


4.4

Second Supplemental Indenture, dated as of June 18, 2001, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 2003, filed with the SEC on March 19, 2003 (file number 001-11421))


4.5

Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of June 20, 2002, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 2003, filed with the SEC on March 19, 2003 (file number 001-11421))




177



4.6

Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of December 11, 2002, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended January 31, 2003, filed with the SEC on March 19, 2003 (file number 001-11421))


4.7

Fifth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of May 23, 2003, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended August 1, 2003, filed with the SEC on August 29, 2003 (file number 001-11421))


4.8

Sixth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 15, 2003, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended August 1, 2003, filed with the SEC on August 29, 2003 (file number 001-11421))


4.9

Seventh Supplemental Indenture, dated as of May 23, 2005, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended July 29, 2005, filed with the SEC on August 25, 2005 (file number 001-11421))


4.10

Eighth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 27, 2005, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and Wachovia Bank, National Association (formerly known as First Union National Bank), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended July 29, 2005, filed with the SEC on August 25, 2005 (file number 001-11421))


4.11

Ninth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 30, 2006, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and U.S. Bank National Association (successor to Wachovia Bank, National Association), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended November 3, 2006, filed with the SEC on December 12, 2006 (file number 001-11421))


4.12

Tenth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 6, 2007, by and among Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein, as guarantors, and U.S. Bank National Association (successor to Wachovia Bank, National Association), as trustee (incorporated



178



by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.13

Senior Indenture, dated July 6, 2007, among Buck Acquisition Corp., Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein and U.S. Bank National Association (the successor trustee), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.14

Form of 10.625% Senior Notes due 2015 (included in Exhibit 4.13)


4.15

First Supplemental Indenture to the Senior Indenture, dated as of September 25, 2007, between DC Financial, LLC, the Guaranteeing Subsidiary, and U.S. Bank National Association (the successor trustee), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.14 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.16

Second Supplemental Indenture to the Senior Indenture, dated as of December 31, 2007, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, the Guaranteeing Subsidiary, and U.S. Bank National Association (the successor trustee), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.32 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


4.17

Instrument of Resignation, Appointment and Acceptance, effective as of February 25, 2009, by and among Dollar General Corporation, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, and U.S. Bank National Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 25, 2009, filed with the SEC on February 25, 2009 (file number 001-11421))


4.18

Senior Subordinated Indenture, dated July 6, 2007, among Buck Acquisition Corp., Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein and U.S. Bank National Association (the successor trustee), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.9 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.19

Form of 11.875% / 12.625% Senior Subordinated Toggle Notes due 2017 (included in Exhibit 4.18)


4.20

First Supplemental Indenture to the Senior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of September 25, 2007, between DC Financial, LLC, the Guaranteeing Subsidiary, and U.S. Bank National Association (the successor trustee), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.16 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))




179



4.21

Second Supplemental Indenture to the Senior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of December 31, 2007, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, the Guaranteeing Subsidiary, and U.S. Bank National Association (the successor trustee), as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.33 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


4.22

Registration Rights Agreement, dated July 6, 2007, among Buck Acquisition Corp., Dollar General Corporation, the guarantors named therein and the initial purchasers named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.10 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.23

Registration Rights Agreement, dated July 6, 2007, among Buck Holdings, L.P., Buck Holdings, LLC, Dollar General Corporation and Shareholders named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.18 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.24

Credit Agreement, dated as of July 6, 2007, among Dollar General Corporation, as Borrower, Citicorp North America, Inc., as Administrative Agent, and the other lending institutions from time to time party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.25

Guarantee to the Credit Agreement, dated as of July 6, 2007, among certain domestic subsidiaries of Dollar General Corporation, as Guarantors and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.26

Supplement No.1, dated as of September 11, 2007, to the Guarantee to the Credit Agreement, between DC Financial, LLC, as New Guarantor, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.23 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.27

Supplement No. 2, dated as of December 31, 2007, to the Guarantee to the Credit Agreement, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, as New Guarantor, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.34 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


4.28

Security Agreement, dated as of July 6, 2007, among Dollar General Corporation and certain domestic subsidiaries of Dollar General Corporation, as Grantors, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to



180



Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))

4.29

Supplement No.1, dated as of September 11, 2007, to the Security Agreement, between DC Financial, LLC, as New Grantor, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.25 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.30

Supplement No. 2, dated as of December 31, 2007, to the Security Agreement, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, as New Grantor, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.35 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


4.31

Pledge Agreement, dated as of July 6, 2007, among Dollar General Corporation and certain domestic subsidiaries of Dollar General Corporation, as Pledgors, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))  


4.32

Supplement No.1, dated as of September 11, 2007, to the Pledge Agreement, between DC Financial, LLC, as Additional Pledgor, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.27 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.33

Supplement No. 2, dated as of December 31, 2007, to the Pledge Agreement, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, as Additional Pledgor, and Citicorp North America, Inc., as Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.36 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


4.34

ABL Credit Agreement, dated as of July 6, 2007, among Dollar General Corporation, as Parent Borrower, certain domestic subsidiaries of Dollar General Corporation, as Subsidiary Borrowers, The CIT Group/Business Credit Inc., as ABL Administrative Agent, and the other lending institutions from time to time party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.35

Guarantee, dated as of September 11, 2007, to the ABL Credit Agreement, between DC Financial, LLC and The CIT Group/Business Credit Inc., as ABL Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.29 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))




181



4.36

Supplement No. 1, dated as of December 31, 2007, to the Guarantee to the ABL Credit Agreement, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, as New Guarantor, and The CIT Group/Business Credit Inc., as ABL Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.37 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


4.37

ABL Security Agreement, dated as of July 6, 2007, among Dollar General Corporation, as Parent Borrower, certain domestic subsidiaries of Dollar General Corporation, as Subsidiary Borrowers, collectively the Grantors, and The CIT Group/Business Credit Inc., as ABL Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))


4.38

Supplement No.1, dated as of September 11, 2007, to the ABL Security Agreement, between DC Financial, LLC, as New Grantor, and The CIT Group/Business Credit Inc., as ABL Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.31 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


4.39

Supplement No. 2, dated as of December 31, 2007, to the ABL Security Agreement, between Retail Risk Solutions, LLC, as New Grantor, and The CIT Group/Business Credit Inc., as ABL Collateral Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.38 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))


10.1

2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of Dollar General Corporation and its Affiliates (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*


10.2

Amendment No. 1 to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of Dollar General Corporation and its Affiliates (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 29, 2008, filed with the SEC on June 2, 2008 (file number 001-11421))*


10.3

Form of Stock Option Agreement between Dollar General Corporation and officers of Dollar General Corporation granting stock options pursuant to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*


10.4

Form of Option Rollover Agreement between Dollar General Corporation and officers of Dollar General Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*



182




10.5

Form of Management Stockholder’s Agreement among Dollar General Corporation, Buck Holdings, L.P. and officers of Dollar General Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*


10.6

Form of Sale Participation Agreement between Buck Holdings, L.P. and certain officer-level employees, dated July 6, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*


10.7

1998 Stock Incentive Plan (As Amended and Restated effective as of May 31, 2006) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 31, 2006, filed with the SEC on June 2, 2006 (file number 001-11421))*


10.8

Amendment to Dollar General Corporation 1998 Stock Incentive Plan, effective November 28, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended February 2, 2007, filed with the SEC on March 29, 2007 (file number 001-11421))*


10.9

Form of Stock Option Grant Notice in connection with option grants made pursuant to the 1998 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended July 29, 2005, filed with the SEC on August 25, 2005 (file number 001-11421))*


10.10

Dollar General Corporation CDP/SERP Plan (as amended and restated effective December 31, 2007) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*


10.11

First Amendment to the Dollar General Corporation CDP/SERP Plan (as amended and restated effective December 31, 2007) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))*


10.12

Second Amendment to the Dollar General Corporation CDP/SERP Plan (as amended and restated effective December 31, 2007), dated as of June 3, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended August 1, 2008, filed with the SEC on September 3, 2008 (file number 001-11421))*


10.13

Dollar General Corporation Annual Incentive Plan (effective March 16, 2005, as approved by shareholders on May 24, 2005) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended July 29, 2005, filed with the SEC on August 25, 2005) (file number 001-11421))*



183



10.14

Dollar General Corporation 2008 Teamshare Bonus Program for Named Executive Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended May 2, 2008, filed with the SEC on June 16, 200) (file number 001-11421))*


10.15

Summary of Dollar General Corporation Life Insurance Program as Applicable to Executive Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended February 2, 2007, filed with the SEC on March 29, 2007) (file number 001-11421))*


10.16

Dollar General Corporation Domestic Relocation Policy for Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to Dollar General Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended February 2, 2007, filed with the SEC on March 29, 2007) (file number 001-11421))*


10.17

Summary of Director Compensation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


10.18

Employment Agreement, effective as of January 11, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Richard Dreiling (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.19

Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated December 19, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Richard Dreiling*


10.20

Stock Option Agreement, dated as of January 21, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Richard Dreiling (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.21

Restricted Stock Award Agreement, effective as of January 21, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Richard Dreiling (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.22

Management Stockholder’s Agreement, dated as of January 21, 2008, among Dollar General Corporation, Buck Holdings, L.P. and Richard Dreiling (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.23

Sale Participation Agreement, dated January 21, 2008, between Buck Holdings, L.P. and Richard Dreiling (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to Dollar General



184



Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.24

Employment Agreement, dated July 6, 2007, by and between Dollar General Corporation and David L. Beré (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2007, filed with the SEC on July 12, 2007 (file number 001-11421))*


10.25

Extension of Initial Term of Employment Agreement, dated December 27, 2007, between Dollar General Corporation and David Beré (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.26

Notice of Initiation of Transition Period under Employment Agreement, dated January 8, 2008, by Dollar General Corporation to David Beré (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to Dollar General Corporation’s Amendment No. 1 to Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on January 25, 2008 (file number 333-148320))*


10.27

Letter Agreement dated April 9, 2008 between Dollar General Corporation and David L. Beré (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 9, 2008, filed with the SEC on April 10, 2008 (file number 001-11421))*


10.28

Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated December 17, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and David L. Beré*


10.29

Employment Agreement with David M. Tehle effective April 1, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 30, 2006, filed with the SEC on April 5, 2006) (file number 001-11421))*


10.30

First Amendment to Employment Agreement with David M. Tehle, dated as of May 9, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 9, 2008, filed with the SEC on May 15, 2008 (file number 001-11421))*


10.31

Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated December 15, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and David M. Tehle*


10.32

Employment Agreement with Kathleen R. Guion effective April 1, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 30, 2006, filed with the SEC on April 5, 2006) (file number 001-11421))*


10.33

First Amendment to Employment Agreement with Kathleen R. Guion, dated as of May 9, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.2 to Dollar General Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 9, 2008, filed with the SEC on May 15, 2008 (file number 001-11421))*



185



10.34

Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated December 15, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Kathleen R. Guion*

10.35

Employment Agreement, dated December 1, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Todd Vasos*


10.36

Stock Option Agreement, dated December 19, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Todd Vasos*


10.37

Management Stockholder’s Agreement, dated December 19, 2008, among Dollar General Corporation, Buck Holdings, L.P., and Todd Vasos*


10.38

Sale Participation Agreement, effective December 19, 2008, between Buck Holdings, L.P. and Todd Vasos*


10.39

Employment Agreement, effective April 1, 2006, between Dollar General Corporation and Susan S. Lanigan*


10.40

First Amendment to Employment Agreement with Susan S. Lanigan, dated as of May 9, 2008*


10.41

Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated December 15, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation and Susan S. Lanigan*


10.42

Monitoring Fee Letter Agreement, dated July 6, 2007, among Buck Holdings, L.P., Dollar General Corporation, Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co L.P., and Goldman, Sachs & Co. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


10.43

Indemnification Agreement, dated July 6, 2007, among Buck Holdings, L.P., Dollar General Corporation, Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co L.P., and Goldman, Sachs & Co. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))


10.44

Purchase Letter Agreement, dated August 15, 2007, between Principal Life Insurance Company and DC Financial, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Dollar General Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-4, filed with the SEC on December 21, 2007 (file number 333-148320))

12

Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges

21

List of Subsidiaries of Dollar General Corporation


23

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm




186



24

Powers of Attorney (included as part of the signature pages hereto)


31

Certifications of CEO and CFO under Exchange Act Rule 13a-14(a)

32

Certifications of CEO and CFO under 18 U.S.C. 1350

*

Management Contract or Compensatory Plan



187


AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDMENT TO THE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (this “ Amendment ”) is made December 19, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (the “ Company ”), and Richard Dreiling (“ Executive ”).  Capitalized terms used in this Amendment and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Employment Agreement (as defined below).  

WITNESSETH :

WHEREAS , the Company and Executive have previously entered into an Employment Agreement by and between the Company and Executive dated as of January 11, 2008 (the “ Employment Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the Company and Executive desire to amend the Employment Agreement to ensure compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”).

NOW, THEREFORE , the parties agree to amend the Employment Agreement, effective as of the date hereof, as follows:

1.

Release; Timing of Severance Payments .  Section 9(a) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended to delete the first sentence thereof and insert the following sentence in replacement thereof:

“On the 60 th day after Executive’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached hereto prior to such date, and subject to Section 20(r) below, Executive shall be entitled to the following:”

The Company and Executive hereby agree that any severance amounts that would otherwise have been payable during the 60 day period following Executive’s termination of employment shall instead be payable in a single lump sum on the 60 th day after Executive’s termination, with the remaining severance payments paid as set forth under Section 9(a).

2.

Section 409A Compliance Generally .  Section 20(r) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended to add a new subclause (v) thereof to read as follows:

“References under this Agreement to Executive’s termination of employment shall be deemed to refer to the date upon which Executive has experienced a “separation from service” within the meaning of Section 409A of the Code.  All payments made under this Agreement shall constitute “separate payments” for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.  To the extent any reimbursements or in-kind benefits due to Executive under this Agreement constitute “deferred compensation” under Section 409A of the Code, any such reimbursements or in-kind benefits shall be paid to Executive




2


in a manner consistent with Treas. Reg. Section 1.409A-3(i)(1)(iv).”

3.

Continuation of Employment Agreement in Other Respects .  In all other respects, the Employment Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

4.

Counterparts .  This Amendment may be executed by either of the parties hereto in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original Amendment, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Amendment to the Employment Agreement, effective as of the day and the year first set forth above.




DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Michael M. Calbert

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

EXECUTIVE

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Richard Dreiling

Richard Dreiling







AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDMENT TO THE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (this “ Amendment ”) is made December 17, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (the “ Company ”), and David L. Beré (“ Employee ”).  Capitalized terms used in this Amendment and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Employment Agreement (as defined below).  

WITNESSETH :

WHEREAS , the Company and Employee have previously entered into an Employment Agreement by and between the Company and Employee which became effective on July 6, 2007, as amended (the “ Employment Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the Company and Employee desire to amend the Employment Agreement to ensure compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”).

NOW, THEREFORE , the parties agree to amend the Employment Agreement, effective as of the date hereof, as follows:

1.

Incentive Bonus .  The following sentence shall be added to the end of Section 6(b) of the Employment Agreement (as new flush language following the end of Section 6(b)(iii)) as a new last sentence thereof:

“Any bonus payments due hereunder shall be payable to Employee no later than 2½ months after the end of the Company’s taxable year or the calendar year, whichever is later, in which Employee is first vested in such bonus payments for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.”

2.

Release; Timing of Severance Payments .  Section 12(b) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended to delete the first sentence thereof and insert the following sentence in replacement thereof:

“In the event of one of the triggers referenced in Sections 12(a)(i) through (iii) above, then, on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof, and subject to Section 22(n) below, Employee shall be entitled to the following:”

3.

Section 409A Compliance Generally .  Section 22(n) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended as follows:




2


a)

Section 22(n)(ii) is hereby amended to delete the sentence therein commencing with the words “Notwithstanding the foregoing” including the immediately following clauses (A) and (B).

b)

Section 22(n)(iv) is hereby deleted in its entirety, and new sentences shall be inserted in lieu thereof to read as follows:

“References under this Agreement to Employee’s termination of employment shall be deemed to refer to the date upon which Employee has experienced a “separation from service” within the meaning of Section 409A of the Code.  All payments made under this Agreement shall constitute “separate payments” for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.  To the extent any reimbursements or in-kind benefits due to Employee under this Agreement constitute “deferred compensation” under Section 409A of the Code, any such reimbursements or in-kind benefits shall be paid to Employee in a manner consistent with Treas. Reg. Section 1.409A-3(i)(1)(iv).”

4.

Continuation of Employment Agreement in Other Respects .  In all other respects, the Employment Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

5.

Counterparts .  This Amendment may be executed by either of the parties hereto in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original Amendment, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument.


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Amendment to the Employment Agreement, effective as of the day and the year first set forth above.



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Susan Lanigan

 

Name:

Susan Lanigan

 

Title:

EVP, General Counsel

 

 

 

 

 

 

EMPLOYEE

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ David L. Beré

David L. Beré








AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDMENT TO THE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (this “ Amendment ”) is made December 15, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (the “ Company ”), and David M. Tehle (“ Employee ”).  Capitalized terms used in this Amendment and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Employment Agreement (as defined below).  

WITNESSETH :

WHEREAS , the Company and Employee have previously entered into an Employment Agreement by and between the Company and Employee dated April 1, 2006 (the “ Employment Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the Company and Employee desire to amend the Employment Agreement to ensure compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”).

NOW, THEREFORE , the parties agree to amend the Employment Agreement, effective as of the date hereof, as follows:

1.

Incentive Bonus .  The following sentence shall be added to the end of Section 5(b) of the Employment Agreement as a new last sentence thereof:

“Any bonus payments due hereunder shall be payable to Employee no later than 2½ months after the end of the Company’s taxable year or the calendar year, whichever is later, in which Employee is first vested in such bonus payments for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.”

2.

Release; Timing of Severance Payments .  Section 11(b) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended to delete the first sentence thereof and insert the following sentence in replacement thereof:

“In the event of one of the triggers referenced in Sections 11(a)(i) through (iii) above, then, on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof, and subject to Section 22(n) below, Employee shall be entitled to the following:”

The Company and Employee hereby agree that any severance amounts that would otherwise have been payable during the 60 day period following Employee’s termination of employment shall instead be payable in a single lump sum on the 60 th day after




2


Employee’s termination, with the remaining severance payments paid in the form of salary continuation payments as set forth under Section 11(b).

3.

Effect of Change in Control .  The Company and Employee hereby agree that the special timing of severance payments described under Section 12(a) of the Employment Agreement for certain terminations of employment following a Change in Control shall apply only in the event that the Change in Control constitutes a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code.  In the event that the Change in Control does not constitute a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code, then the timing of any severance payments shall be determined pursuant to Section 11 of the Employment Agreement.  The Company and Employee further agree that any severance amounts which become payable pursuant to Section 12(a) of the Employment Agreement shall become payable on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached to the Employment Agreement.

4.

Section 409A Compliance Generally .  Section 22(n) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended as follows:

a)

Section 22(n)(ii) is hereby amended to delete the sentence therein commencing with the words “Notwithstanding the foregoing” including the immediately following clauses (A) and (B).

b)

Section 22(n)(iv) is hereby deleted in its entirety, and new sentences shall be inserted in lieu thereof to read as follows:

“References under this Agreement to Employee’s termination of employment shall be deemed to refer to the date upon which Employee has experienced a “separation from service” within the meaning of Section 409A of the Code.  All payments made under this Agreement shall constitute “separate payments” for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.  To the extent any reimbursements or in-kind benefits due to Employee under this Agreement constitute “deferred compensation” under Section 409A of the Code, any such reimbursements or in-kind benefits shall be paid to Employee in a manner consistent with Treas. Reg. Section 1.409A-3(i)(1)(iv).”

5.

Continuation of Employment Agreement in Other Respects .  In all other respects, the Employment Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

6.

Counterparts .  This Amendment may be executed by either of the parties hereto in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original Amendment, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument.





3


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Amendment to the Employment Agreement, effective as of the day and the year first set forth above.



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ S. Lanigan

 

Name:

Susan Lanigan

 

Title:

EVP

 

 

 

 

 

 

EMPLOYEE

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ David M. Tehle

David M. Tehle






AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDMENT TO THE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (this “ Amendment ”) is made December 15, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (the “ Company ”), and Kathleen R. Guion (“ Employee ”).  Capitalized terms used in this Amendment and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Employment Agreement (as defined below).  

WITNESSETH :

WHEREAS , the Company and Employee have previously entered into an Employment Agreement by and between the Company and Employee dated April 1, 2006 (the “ Employment Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the Company and Employee desire to amend the Employment Agreement to ensure compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”).

NOW, THEREFORE , the parties agree to amend the Employment Agreement, effective as of the date hereof, as follows:

1.

Incentive Bonus .  The following sentence shall be added to the end of Section 5(b) of the Employment Agreement as a new last sentence thereof:

“Any bonus payments due hereunder shall be payable to Employee no later than 2½ months after the end of the Company’s taxable year or the calendar year, whichever is later, in which Employee is first vested in such bonus payments for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.”

2.

Release; Timing of Severance Payments .  Section 11(b) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended to delete the first sentence thereof and insert the following sentence in replacement thereof:

“In the event of one of the triggers referenced in Sections 11(a)(i) through (iii) above, then, on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof, and subject to Section 22(n) below, Employee shall be entitled to the following:”

The Company and Employee hereby agree that any severance amounts that would otherwise have been payable during the 60 day period following Employee’s termination of employment shall instead be payable in a single lump sum on the 60 th day after




2


Employee’s termination, with the remaining severance payments paid in the form of salary continuation payments as set forth under Section 11(b).

3.

Effect of Change in Control .  The Company and Employee hereby agree that the special timing of severance payments described under Section 12(a) of the Employment Agreement for certain terminations of employment following a Change in Control shall apply only in the event that the Change in Control constitutes a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code.  In the event that the Change in Control does not constitute a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code, then the timing of any severance payments shall be determined pursuant to Section 11 of the Employment Agreement.  The Company and Employee further agree that any severance amounts which become payable pursuant to Section 12(a) of the Employment Agreement shall become payable on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached to the Employment Agreement.

4.

Section 409A Compliance Generally .  Section 22(n) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended as follows:

a)

Section 22(n)(ii) is hereby amended to delete the sentence therein commencing with the words “Notwithstanding the foregoing” including the immediately following clauses (A) and (B).

b)

Section 22(n)(iv) is hereby deleted in its entirety, and new sentences shall be inserted in lieu thereof to read as follows:

“References under this Agreement to Employee’s termination of employment shall be deemed to refer to the date upon which Employee has experienced a “separation from service” within the meaning of Section 409A of the Code.  All payments made under this Agreement shall constitute “separate payments” for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.  To the extent any reimbursements or in-kind benefits due to Employee under this Agreement constitute “deferred compensation” under Section 409A of the Code, any such reimbursements or in-kind benefits shall be paid to Employee in a manner consistent with Treas. Reg. Section 1.409A-3(i)(1)(iv).”

5.

Continuation of Employment Agreement in Other Respects .  In all other respects, the Employment Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

6.

Counterparts .  This Amendment may be executed by either of the parties hereto in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original Amendment, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument.





3


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Amendment to the Employment Agreement, effective as of the day and the year first set forth above.



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ S. Lanigan

 

Name:

Susan Lanigan

 

Title:

EVP

 

 

 

 

 

 

EMPLOYEE

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Kathleen R. Guion

Kathleen R. Guion





EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (“Agreement”), effective December 1, 2008 (“Effective Date”), is made and entered into by and between DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION (the “Company”), and Todd Vasos (“Employee”).

W I T N E S S E T H:

WHEREAS, Company desires to employ Employee upon the terms and subject to the conditions hereinafter set forth, and Employee desires to accept such employment;

NOW, THEREFORE, for and in consideration of the premises, the mutual promises, covenants and agreements contained herein, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties agree as follows:

Employment Terms

1.

Employment .  Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the Company agrees to employ Employee as Executive Vice President, Division President & Chief Merchandising Officer of Dollar General Corporation.

2.

Term .  The term of this Agreement shall be until the third annual anniversary of the Effective Date (“Term” ) , unless otherwise terminated pursuant to Sections 7, 8, 9, 10 or 11 hereof. The Term shall be automatically extended after the third annual anniversary of the Effective Date from month to month, for up to six (6) months, unless the Company gives written notice to Employee at least one month prior to the expiration of the original or any extended Term that no extension or further extension, as applicable, will occur or unless the Company replaces this Agreement with a new agreement or, in writing, extends or renews the Term of this Agreement for a period that is longer than six months from the expiration of the original Term. Unless otherwise noted, all references to the “Term” shall be deemed to refer to the original Term and any extension or renewal thereof.

3.

Position, Duties and Administrative Support .

a.

Position .  Employee shall perform the duties of the position noted in Section 1 above and shall perform such other duties and responsibilities as Employee’s supervisor or the Company’s CEO may reasonably direct.

b.

Full-Time Efforts .  Employee shall perform and discharge faithfully and diligently such duties and responsibilities and shall devote Employee’s full-time efforts to the



1



business and affairs of Company.  Employee agrees to promote the best interests of the Company and to take no action that is likely to damage the public image or reputation of the Company, its subsidiaries or its affiliates.

c.

Administrative Support .  Employee shall be provided with office space and administrative support.

d.

No Interference With Duties .  Employee shall not devote time to other activities which would inhibit or otherwise interfere with the proper performance of Employee’s duties and shall not be directly or indirectly concerned or interested in any other business occupation, activity or interest other than by reason of holding a non-controlling interest as a shareholder, securities holder or debenture holder in a corporation quoted on a nationally recognized exchange (subject to any limitations in the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics).  Employee may not serve as a member of a board of directors of a for-profit company, other than the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, without the express approval of the CEO and the Compensation Committee of the Board. Under no circumstances may Employee serve on more than one other board of a for-profit company.

4.

Work Standard .  Employee agrees to comply with all terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement, as well as all applicable Company work policies, procedures and rules.  Employee also agrees to comply with all federal, state and local statutes, regulations and public ordinances governing Employee’s performance hereunder.

5.

Compensation .

a.

Base Salary .  Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement, the Company shall pay Employee, and Employee shall accept, an annual base salary (“Base Salary”) of no less than Five Hundred Ninety-Five Thousand Dollars ($595,000).  The Base Salary shall be paid in accordance with Company’s normal payroll practices (but no less frequently than monthly) and may be increased from time to time at the sole discretion of the Company.

b.

Incentive Bonus .  Employee’s incentive compensation for the Term of this Agreement shall be determined under the Company’s annual bonus program for officers at Employee’s grade level, as it may be amended from time to time.  The actual bonus paid pursuant to this Section 5(b), if any, shall be based on criteria established by the Board, its Compensation Committee and/or the CEO, as applicable, in accordance with the terms and



2



conditions of the annual bonus program for officers. Any bonus payments due hereunder shall be payable to the Employee no later than 2 1/2 months after the end of the Company’s taxable year or the calendar year, whichever is later, in which Employee is first vested in such bonus payments for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Internal Revenue Code”) .

c.

Vacation .  Employee shall be entitled to three weeks paid vacation time within the first year of employment. After five years of employment, Employee shall be entitled to four weeks paid vacation. Vacation time is granted on the anniversary of Employee’s hire date each year. Any available but unused vacation as of the annual anniversary of employment date or at Employee’s termination date shall be forfeited.

d.

Business Expenses .  Employee shall be reimbursed for all reasonable business expenses incurred in carrying out the work hereunder.  Employee shall adhere to the Company’s expense reimbursement policies and procedures. In no event will any such reimbursement be made later than the last day of the calendar year following the calendar year in which Employee incurs the reimbursable expense .

e.

Perquisites .  Employee shall be entitled to receive such other executive perquisites, fringe and other benefits as are provided to officers at the same grade level under any of the Company’s plans and/or programs in effect from time to time.

6.

Benefits .  During the Term, Employee (and, where applicable, Employee’s eligible dependents) shall be eligible to participate in those various Company welfare benefit plans, practices and policies in place during the Term (including, without limitation, medical, pharmacy, dental, vision, disability, employee life, accidental death and travel accident insurance plans and other programs, if any) to the extent allowed under and in accordance with the terms of those plans.  In addition, Employee shall be eligible to participate, pursuant to their terms, in any other benefit plans offered by the Company to similarly-situated officers or other employees from time to time during the Term (excluding plans applicable solely to certain officers of the Company in accordance with the express terms of such plans).  Collectively the plans and arrangements described in this Section 6, as they may be amended or modified in accordance with their terms, are hereinafter referred to as the “Benefits Plans.”  Notwithstanding the above, Employee understands and acknowledges that Employee is not eligible for benefits under any other severance plan, program, or policy maintained



3



by the Company, if any exists, and that the only severance benefits Employee is entitled to are set forth in this Agreement.     

7.

Termination for Cause .  This Agreement is not intended to change the at-will nature of Employee’s employment with Company, and it may be terminated at any time by either party, with or without cause. If this Agreement is terminated by Company for “Cause” (Termination for Cause) as that term is defined below, it will be without any liability owing to Employee or Employee’s dependents and beneficiaries under this Agreement, (recognizing, however, that benefits covered by or owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement).  Any one of the following conditions or Employee conduct shall constitute “Cause”:

a.

Any act involving fraud or dishonesty, or any material act of misconduct relating to Employee’s performance of his or her duties hereunder;

b.

Any material breach of any SEC or other law or regulation or any Company policy governing trading or dealing with stocks, securities, public debt instruments, bonds, or investments and the like or with inappropriate disclosure or “tipping” relating to any stock, security, public debt instrument, bond or investment;

c.

Any material violation of the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics (or the equivalent code in place at the time);

d.

Other than as required by law, the carrying out of any activity or the making of any public statement which prejudices or reduces the good name and standing of Company or any of its affiliates or would bring any one of these into public contempt or ridicule;

e.

Attendance at work in a state of intoxication or being found with any drug or substance possession of which would amount to a criminal offense;

f.

Assault or other act of violence;

g.

Conviction of or plea of guilty or nolo contendre to any felony whatsoever or any misdemeanor that would preclude employment under the Company’s hiring policy; or

h.

Willful or repeated refusal or failure substantially to perform Employee’s material obligations and duties hereunder or those reasonably directed by Employee’s supervisor, the CEO and/or the Board (except in connection with a Disability).



4



A termination for Cause shall be effective when the Company has given Employee written notice of its intention to terminate for Cause, describing those acts or omissions that are believed to constitute Cause, and has given Employee ten days to respond.

8.

Termination upon Death .  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, this Agreement shall terminate immediately upon Employee’s death, and the Company shall have no further liability to Employee or Employee’s dependents and beneficiaries under this Agreement, except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.

9.

Disability .  If a Disability (as defined below) of Employee occurs during the Term, unless otherwise prohibited by law, the Company may notify Employee of the Company’s intention to terminate Employee’s employment.  In that event, employment shall terminate effective on the termination date provided in such notice of termination (the “Disability Effective Date”), and this Agreement shall terminate without further liability to Employee, Employee’s dependents and beneficiaries, except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.  In this Agreement, “Disability” means:

a.

A long-term disability, as defined in the Company’s applicable long-term disability plan as then in effect, if any; or

b.

Employee’s inability to perform the duties under this Agreement in accordance with the Company’s expectations because of a medically determinable physical or mental impairment that (i) can reasonably be expected to result in death or (ii) has lasted or can reasonably be expected to last longer than ninety (90) consecutive days.  Under this Section 9(b), unless otherwise required by law, the existence of a Disability shall be determined by the Company, only upon receipt of a written medical opinion from a qualified physician selected by or acceptable to the Company.  In this circumstance, to the extent permitted by law, Employee shall, if reasonably requested by the Company, submit to a physical examination by that qualified physician. Nothing in this Section 9(b) is intended to nor shall it be deemed to broaden or modify the definition of “disability” in the Company’s long-term disability plan.  

10.

Employee’s Termination of Employment .

a.

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, Employee may terminate employment and this Agreement at any time, for no reason, with thirty (30) days written notice



5



to Company (and in the event that Employee is providing notice of termination for Good Reason, Employee must provide such notice within 30 days after the event purported to give rise to Employee’s claim for Good Reason first occurs).  In such event, Employee shall not be entitled to those payments and benefits listed in Sections 11 or 12 below unless Employee terminates employment for Good Reason, as defined below, or unless Section 11(a)(iii) applies.

b.

Upon any termination of employment , Employee shall be entitled to any earned but unpaid Base Salary through the date of termination and such other vested benefits under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, s uch unpaid Base Salary shall be paid to Employee as soon as practicable after the effective date of termination in accordance with the Company’s usual payroll practices (not less frequently than monthly); provided, however, that if payment at such time would result in a prohibited acceleration under Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, then such amount shall be paid at the time the amount would otherwise have been paid absent such prohibited acceleration.

c.

Good Reason shall mean any of the following actions taken by the Company:

(i)

A reduction by the Company in Employee’s Base Salary or target bonus level;

(ii)

The Company shall fail to continue in effect any significant Company-sponsored compensation plan or benefit (without replacing it with a similar plan or with a compensation equivalent), unless such action is in connection with across-the-board plan changes or terminations similarly affecting at least 95 percent of all officers of the Company or 100 percent of officers at the same grade level;

(iii)

The Company’s principal executive offices shall be moved to a location outside the middle-Tennessee area, or Employee is required (absent mutual agreement) to be based anywhere other than the Company’s principal executive offices;

(iv)

Without Employee’s written consent, the assignment to Employee by the Company of duties inconsistent with, or the significant



6



reduction of the title, powers and functions associated with, Employee’s position, title or office as described in Section 3 above, unless such action is the result of a restructuring or realignment of duties and responsibilities by the Company, for business reasons, that leaves Employee at the same rate of Base Salary, annual target bonus opportunity, and officer level (i.e., Executive Vice President, etc.) and with a similar level of responsibility, or unless such action is the result of Employee’s failure to meet pre-established and objective performance criteria;

(v)

Any material breach by the Company of this Agreement; or

(vi)

The failure of any successor (whether direct or indirect, by purchase, merger, assignment, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company to assume expressly and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that the Company would be required to perform it if no such succession had taken place.

Good Reason shall not include Employee’s death, Disability or Termination for Cause or Employee’s termination for any reason other than Good Reason as defined above .

d.

Prior to Employee being entitled to the payments or benefits described in Sections 11 or 12 below, the Company shall have the opportunity to cure any claimed event of Good Reason within thirty (30) days after receiving written notice from Employee specifying the same.

11.

Termination without Cause or by Employee for Good Reason .

a.

The continuation of Base Salary and other payments and benefits described in Section 11(b) shall be triggered only upon one or more of the following circumstances:

(i)

The Company terminates Employee (as it may do at any time) without Cause; it being understood that termination by death or Disability does not constitute termination without Cause;

(ii)

Employee terminates for Good Reason;

(iii)

The Company fails to offer to renew, extend or replace this Agreement before, at, or within six (6) months after, the end of its original three-year Term (or any term provided for in a written renewal or extension of the



7



original Term), and Employee resigns from employment with the Company within sixty (60) days after such failure, unless such failure is accompanied by a mutually agreeable severance arrangement between the Company and Employee or is the result of Employee’s retirement or other termination from the Company other than for Good Reason notwithstanding the Company’s offer to renew, extend or replace this Agreement .

b.

In the event of one of the triggers referenced in Sections 11(a)(i) through (iii) above, then, on the sixtieth (60th) day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof, and subject to Section 22(n) below, Employee shall be entitled to the following:

(i)

Continuation of Employee’s Base Salary as of the date immediately preceding the termination (or, if the termination of employment is for Good Reason due to the reduction of Employee’s Base Salary, then such rate of Base Salary as in effect immediately prior to such reduction) for 24 months, payable in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll cycle and procedures (but not less frequently than monthly ) with a lump sum payment on the sixtieth (60th) day after Employee’s termination of employment of the amounts Employee would otherwise have received during the sixty (60) days after Employee’s termination had the payments begun immediately after Employee’s termination of employment . Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, the amount of any payment or entitlement to payment of the aforesaid Base Salary continuation shall be reduced, offset and subject to recovery by the Company in the event and to the extent of any base salary earned by the Employee as a result of subsequent employment during the 24 months after Employee’s termination of employment.  In no event shall Employee be obligated to seek other employment or take any other action by way of mitigation of such amounts payable to Employee and, except as provided in the preceding sentence, such amounts shall not be reduced whether or not the Employee obtains other employment.

(ii)

A lump sum payment of two times the amount of the average percentage of target bonus paid or to be paid to employees at the same job grade level of Employee (if any) under the annual bonus programs for officers in



8



respect of the Company’s two fiscal years immediately preceding the fiscal year in which the termination date occurs.

(iii)

A lump sum payment in an amount equal to two times the annual contribution that would have been made by the Company in respect of the plan year in which such termination of employment occurs for Employee’s participation in the Company’s medical, pharmacy, dental and vision benefits programs.

(iv)

Reasonable outplacement services, as determined and provided by the Company, for one year or until other employment is secured, whichever comes first.

No such payment or benefit shall be provided to Employee pursuant to this Section 11 if the Release attached hereto is not provided to the Company  no later than forty-five (45) days after Employee’s termination date; and no payment or benefit hereunder shall be provided to Employee prior to the Company’s receipt of the Release and the expiration of the period of revocation provided in the Release.

c.

In the event that there is a material breach by Employee of any continuing obligations under this Agreement or the Release after termination of employment, any unpaid amounts under this Section 11 shall be forfeited and Company shall retain any other rights available to it under law or equity.  Any payments or reimbursements under this Section 11 shall not be deemed the continuation of Employee’s employment for any purpose.  Except as specifically enumerated in the Release, the Company’s payment obligations under this Section 11 will not negate or reduce (i) any amounts otherwise due but not yet paid to Employee by the Company, or (ii) any other amounts payable to Employee outside this Agreement, or (iii) those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.  Subject to any applicable prohibition on acceleration of payment under Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, the Company may, at any time and in its sole discretion, make a lump-sum payment of all amounts, or all remaining amounts, due to Employee under this Section 11.

12.

Effect of 280G .

a.

Subject to Section 22(n) and contingent upon Employee’s timely execution and the effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof as provided in



9



Section 11 hereof, if any payments and benefits by the Company to or for the benefit of Employee (whether paid or payable or distributed or distributable pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise, but determined without regard to any additional payments required under this Section 12 (a “Payment”) constitute “parachute payments” within the meaning of Section 280G of the Internal Revenue Code (“Code Section 280G”) so that Employee would be subject to the excise tax imposed by Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code or any interest or penalties with respect to such tax (collectively referred to as the “Excise Tax”), then Employee shall be entitled to receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment”) in an amount such that, after Employee pays all taxes (including any interest or penalties imposed with respect to such taxes), including, without limitation, any Excise Tax, income tax or other tax (and any interest and penalties imposed with respect thereto), Employee retains an amount of the Gross-Up Payment equal to the Excise Tax imposed upon the Payments.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the Net After-tax Benefit to Employee resulting from receiving the Gross-Up Payment is less than $50,000 greater than the Net After-tax Benefit to Employee resulting from having the Payments reduced to the Reduced Amount, then no Gross-Up Payment shall be made and the Payments shall be reduced to the Reduced Amount. Unless Employee and the Company shall otherwise agree (provided such agreement does not cause any payment or benefit hereunder which is deferred compensation covered by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code to be in non-compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code), in the event the Payments are to be reduced, the Company shall reduce or eliminate the payments or benefits to Employee by first reducing or eliminating those payments or benefits which are not payable in cash and then by reducing or eliminating cash payments, in each case in reverse order beginning with payments or benefits which are to be paid the farthest in time from the date of the “change in ownership or control” (within the meaning of Code Section 280G) (a “Change in Control”).  Any reduction pursuant to the preceding sentence shall take precedence over the provisions of any other plan, arrangement or agreement governing Employee’s rights and entitlements to any benefits or compensation.  For purposes hereof:

(i)

“Net After-tax Benefit” shall mean the Present Value of a Payment net of all taxes (including any Excise Tax imposed on Employee) with respect thereto, determined by applying the highest marginal rate(s) applicable to an individual for Employee’s taxable year in which the Change in Control occurs.



10



(ii)

“Present Value” shall mean such value determined in accordance with Section 280G(d)(4) of the Internal Revenue Code.

(iii)

“Reduced Amount” shall be an amount expressed as a Present Value which maximizes the aggregate Present Value of Payments without causing any Payment to be subject to excise tax under Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code or the deduction limitation of Section 280G of the Internal Revenue Code.

b.

All determinations required to be made under this Section 12, including whether and when a Gross-Up Payment is required and the amount of such Gross-Up Payment and the assumptions to be used in arriving at such determination, shall be made by the tax department of an independent public accounting firm (the “Accounting Firm”) or, at Company’s discretion, by a recognized compensation consulting firm (such as Hewitt Associates) (the “Consulting Firm”) which shall be engaged by the Company prior to the time of the first Payment to Employee.  The Accounting Firm or Consulting Firm selected shall not be serving as accountant or auditor for the individual, entity or group effecting the Change in Control. The Accounting Firm or Consulting Firm shall prepare and provide detailed supporting calculations both to the Company and Employee within fifteen (15) business days of the later of (i) the Accounting Firm’s or Consulting Firm’s engagement to make the required calculations or (ii) the date the Accounting Firm or Consulting Firm obtains all information needed to make the required calculation.  Any determination by the Accounting Firm or Consulting Firm shall be binding upon the Company and Employee.  All fees and expenses of the Accounting Firm or Consulting Firm shall be borne solely by the Company.

c.

Any Gross-Up Payment, as determined pursuant to this Section 12, shall be paid by the Company to Employee within five (5) days of the receipt of the Accounting Firm’s or Consulting Firm’s determination if the Payment is then required to satisfy an assessment or other current demand for payment made of Employee by federal or state taxing authorities.  Gross-Up Payments due at a later date shall be paid to Employee no later than fourteen (14) days prior to the date that Employee’s federal or state payment is due.  If required by law, the Company shall treat all or any portion of the Gross-Up Payment as being subject to income tax withholding for federal or state tax purposes.  Amounts determined by the Company to be subject to federal or state tax withholding will not be paid directly to Employee but shall be timely paid to the respective taxing authority.



11



d.

As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code at the time of the initial determination by the Accounting Firm or Consulting Firm hereunder, it is possible that Gross-Up Payments which will not have been made by the Company should have been made (“Underpayment”), consistent with the calculations required to be made hereunder.  In the event that Employee hereafter is required to make a payment of any Excise Tax, the Firm shall determine the amount of the Underpayment that has occurred and any such Underpayment shall be promptly paid by the Company (or any successor or assign) to or for the benefit of Employee.  Conversely, if it is later determined that the actual required Gross-Up Payment was less than the amount paid to Employee, Employee shall refund the excess portion to the Company but only to the extent that Employee has not yet paid the excess amount to the taxing authorities or is able to obtain a refund from the respective taxing authorities of amounts previously paid.  The Company may pursue at its own expense the refund on behalf of Employee, and, if requested by the Company, Employee shall reasonably cooperate in such refund effort.

e.

All Gross-Up Payments to be made under this Section 12 (other than the Underpayment described in Section 12(e)) must be made no later than the end of the Employee’s taxable year next following the Employee’s taxable year in which the applicable related taxes are remitted.  Any right to reimbursement incurred due to a tax audit or litigation addressing the existence or amount of a tax liability must be made no later than the end of the Employee’s taxable year following the Employee’s taxable year in which the taxes that are the subject of the audit or litigation are remitted to the taxing authorities or, where no such taxes are remitted, the end of the Employee’s taxable year following the year in which the audit is completed or there is a final and non-appealable settlement or the resolution of the litigation.

13.

Publicity; No Disparaging Statement .  Except as otherwise provided in Section 14 hereof, Employee and the Company covenant and agree that they shall not engage in any communi­cations to persons outside the Company which shall disparage one another or interfere with their existing or prospective business relationships.

14.

Confidentiality and Legal Process .  Employee agrees to keep the proprietary terms, of this Agreement confidential and to refrain from disclosing any information concerning this Agreement to any one other than Employee’s immediate family and personal agents or advisors.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing in this Agreement is intended to prohibit Employee or the



12



Company from performing any duty or obligation that shall arise as a matter of law.  Specifically, Employee and the Company shall continue to be under a duty to truthfully respond to any legal and valid subpoena or other legal process.  This Agreement is not intended in any way to proscribe Employee’s or the Company’s right and ability to provide information to any federal, state or local agency in response or adherence to the lawful exercise of such agency’s authority.


15.

Business Protection Provision Definitions .

a.

Preamble .  As a material inducement to the Company to enter into this Agreement, and in recognition of the valuable experience, knowledge and proprietary information Employee has gained or will gain while employed, Employee agrees to abide by and adhere to the business protection provisions in Sections 15, 16, 17, 18 and 19 herein.

b.

Definitions .  For purposes of Sections 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 and 20 herein:

(i)

“Competitive Position” shall mean any employment, consulting, advisory, directorship, agency, promotional or independent contractor arrangement between Employee and (x) any person or Entity engaged wholly or in material part in the business in which the Company is engaged (i.e., the discount consumable basic or general merchandise retail business), including but not limited to such other similar businesses as Wal-Mart, Sam’s, Target, Costco, K-Mart, Big Lots, BJs Wholesale, Walgreen’s, Rite-Aid, CVS, Family Dollar Stores, Fred’s, the 99 Cents Stores and Dollar Tree Stores, or (y) any person or Entity then attempting or planning to enter the discount consumable basics retail business, whereby Employee is required to perform services on behalf of or for the benefit of such person or Entity which are substantially similar to the services Employee provided or directed at any time while employed by the Company or any of its affiliates.

(ii)

“Confidential Information” shall mean the proprietary or confidential data, information, documents or materials (whether oral, written, electronic or otherwise) belonging to or pertaining to the Company, other than “Trade Secrets” (as defined below), which is of tangible or intangible value to the Company and the details of which are not generally known to the competitors of the Company.  Confidential Information shall also include any



13



items marked “CONFIDENTIAL” or some similar designation or which are otherwise identified as being confidential.

(iii)

“Entity” or “Entities” shall mean any business, individual, partnership, joint venture, agency, governmental agency, body or subdivision, association, firm, corporation, limited liability company or other entity of any kind.

(iv)

“Restricted Period” shall mean two (2) years following Employee’s termination date.

(v)

“Territory” shall include individually and as a total area those states in the United States in which the Company maintains stores at Employee’s termination date or those states in which the Company has specific and demonstrable plans to open stores within six months of Employee’s termination date.

(vi)

“Trade Secrets” shall mean information or data of or about the Company, including, but not limited to, technical or non-technical data, formulas, patterns, compilations, programs, devices, methods, techniques, drawings, processes, financial data, financial plans, product plans or lists of actual or potential customers or suppliers that:  (A) derives economic value, actual or potential, from not being generally known to, and not being readily ascertainable by proper means by, other persons who can obtain economic value from its disclosure or use; (B) is the subject of efforts that are reasonable under the circumstances to maintain its secrecy; and (C) any other information which is defined as a “trade secret” under applicable law.

(vii)

“Work Product” shall mean all tangible work product, property, data, documentation, “know-how,” concepts or plans, inventions, improvements, techniques and processes relating to the Company that were conceived, discovered, created, written, revised or developed by Employee while employed by the Company.

16.

Nondisclosure:  Ownership of Proprietary Property .

a.

In recognition of the Company’s need to protect its legitimate business interests, Employee hereby covenants and agrees that, for the Term and thereafter (as



14



described below), Employee shall regard and treat Trade Secrets and Confidential Information as strictly confidential and wholly-owned by the Company and shall not, for any reason, in any fashion, either directly or indirectly, use, sell, lend, lease, distribute, license, give, transfer, assign, show, disclose, disseminate, reproduce, copy, misappropriate or otherwise communicate any Trade Secrets or Confidential Information to any person or Entity for any purpose other than in accordance with Employee’s duties under this Agreement or as required by applicable law. This provision shall apply to each item constituting a Trade Secret at all times it remains a “trade secret” under applicable law and shall apply to any Confidential Information, during employment and for the Restricted Period thereafter.

b.

Employee shall exercise best efforts to ensure the continued confidentiality of all Trade Secrets and Confidential Information and shall immediately notify the Company of any unauthorized disclosure or use of any Trade Secrets or Confidential Information of which Employee becomes aware.  Employee shall assist the Company, to the extent reasonably requested, in the protection or procurement of any intellectual property protection or other rights in any of the Trade Secrets or Confidential Information.

c.

All Work Product shall be owned exclusively by the Company.  To the greatest extent possible, any Work Product shall be deemed to be “work made for hire” (as defined in the Copyright Act, 17 U.S.C.A. § 101 et seq., as amended), and Employee hereby unconditionally and irrevocably transfers and assigns to the Company all right, title and interest Employee currently has or may have by operation of law or otherwise in or to any Work Product, including, without limitation, all patents, copyrights, trademarks (and the goodwill associated therewith), trade secrets, service marks (and the goodwill associated therewith) and other intellectual property rights.  Employee agrees to execute and deliver to the Company any transfers, assignments, documents or other instruments which the Company may deem necessary or appropriate, from time to time, to protect the rights granted herein or to vest complete title and ownership of any and all Work Product, and all associated intellectual property and other rights therein, exclusively in the Company.

17.

Non-Interference with Employees .  Through employment and thereafter through the Restricted Period, Employee will not, either directly or indirectly, alone or in conjunction with any other person or Entity:  actively recruit, solicit, attempt to solicit, induce or attempt to induce any person who is an exempt employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates (or has been within the last 6 months) to leave or cease such employment for any reason whatsoever;



15



18.

Non-Interference with Business Relationships .

a.

Employee acknowledges that, in the course of employment, Employee will learn about Company’s business, services, materials, programs and products and the manner in which they are developed, marketed, serviced and provided.  Employee knows and acknowledges that the Company has invested considerable time and money in developing its product sales and real estate development programs and relationships, vendor and other service provider relationships and agreements, store layouts and fixtures, and marketing techniques and that those things are unique and original.  Employee further acknowledges that the Company has a strong business reason to keep secret information relating to Company’s business concepts, ideas, programs, plans and processes, so as not to aid Company’s competitors.  Accordingly, Employee acknowledges and agrees that the protection outlined in (b) below is necessary and reasonable.

b.

During the Restricted Period, Employee will not, on Employee’s own behalf or on behalf of any other person or Entity, solicit, contact, call upon, or communicate with any person or entity or any representative of any person or entity who has a business relationship with Company and with whom Employee had contact while employed, if such contact or communication would likely interfere with Company’s business relationships or result in an unfair competitive advantage over Company.

19.

Agreement Not to Work in Competitive Position .  Employee covenants and agrees not to accept, obtain or work in a Competitive Position for a company or entity that operates anywhere within the Territory for the Restricted Period.

20.

Acknowledgements Regarding Sections 15 – 19.

a.

Employee and Company expressly covenant and agree that the scope, territorial, time and other restrictions contained in Sections 15 through 19 of this Agreement constitute the most reasonable and equitable restrictions possible to protect the business interests of the Company given: (i) the business of the Company; (ii) the competitive nature of the Company’s industry; and (iii) that Employee’s skills are such that Employee could easily find alternative, commensurate employment or consulting work in Employee’s field which would not violate any of the provisions of this Agreement.

b.

Employee acknowledges that the compensation and benefits described in Sections 5, 11 and 12 are also in consideration of his/her covenants and agreements contained



16



in Sections 15 through 19 hereof and that a breach by Employee of the obligations contained in Sections 15 through 19 hereof shall forfeit Employee’s right to such compensation and benefits.

c.

Employee acknowledges and agrees that a breach by Employee of the obligations set forth in Sections 15 through 19 will likely cause Company irreparable injury and that, in such event, the Company shall be entitled to injunctive relief in addition to such other and further relief as may be proper.

d.

The parties agree that if, at any time, a court of competent jurisdiction determines that any of the provisions of Section 15 through 19 are unreasonable under Tennessee law as to time or area or both, the Company shall be entitled to enforce this Agreement for such period of time or within such area as may be determined reasonable by such court.  

21.

Return of Materials .  Upon Employee’s termination, Employee shall return to the Company all written, electronic, recorded or graphic materials of any kind belonging or relating to the Company or its affiliates, including any originals, copies and abstracts in Employee’s possession or control.

22.

General Provisions .

a.

Amendment .  This Agreement may be amended or modified only by a writing signed by both of the parties hereto.

b.

Binding Agreement .  This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be binding upon Employee, his/her heirs and personal representatives, and the Company and its successors and assigns.

c.

Waiver Of Breach; Specific Performance .  The waiver of a breach of any provision of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any other breach.  Each of the parties to this Agreement will be entitled to enforce this Agreement, specifically, to recover damages by reason of any breach of this Agreement, and to exercise all other rights existing in that party’s favor.  The parties hereto agree and acknowledge that money damages may not be an adequate remedy for any breach of the provisions of this Agreement and that any party may apply to any court of law or equity of competent jurisdiction for specific performance or injunctive relief to enforce or prevent any violations of the provisions of this Agreement.



17



d.

Unsecured General Creditor .  The Company shall neither reserve nor speci­fically set aside funds for the payment of its obligations under this Agreement, and such obligations shall be paid solely from the general assets of the Company.

e.

No Effect On Other Arrangements .  It is expressly understood and agreed that the payments made in accordance with this Agreement are in addition to any other benefits or compensation to which Employee may be entitled or for which Employee may be eligible.

f.

Tax Withholding .  There shall be deducted from each payment under this Agreement the amount of any tax required by any govern­mental authority to be withheld and paid over by the Company to such governmental authority for the account of Employee.

g.

Notices .

(i)

All notices and all other communications provided for herein shall be in writing and delivered personally to the other designated party, or mailed by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, or delivered by a recognized national overnight courier service, or sent by facsimile, as follows:

If to Company to:

Dollar General Corporation

Attn: General Counsel

100 Mission Ridge

Goodlettsville, TN  37072-2171

Facsimile: (615)855-5180

If to Employee to:

(Last address of Employee

known to Company unless

otherwise directed in writing by Employee)


(ii)

All notices sent under this Agreement shall be deemed given twenty-four (24) hours after sent by facsimile or courier, seventy-two (72) hours after sent by certified or registered mail and when delivered if by personal delivery.

(iii)

Either party hereto may change the address to which notice is to be sent hereunder by written notice to the other party in accordance with the provisions of this Section.

h.

Governing Law .  This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Tennessee (without giving effect to conflict of laws).



18



i.

Entire Agreement .  This Agreement contains the full and complete understanding of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter contained herein and, unless specifically provided herein, this Agreement supersedes and replaces any prior agreement, either oral or written, which Employee may have with Company that relates generally to the same subject matter.    

j.

Assignment .  This Agreement may not be assigned by Employee, and any attempted assignment shall be null and void and of no force or effect.

k.

Severability .  If any one or more of the terms, provisions, covenants or restrictions of this Agreement shall be determined by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, void or unenforceable, then the remainder of the terms, provisions, covenants and restrictions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect, and to that end the provisions hereof shall be deemed severable.

l.

Section Headings .  The Section headings set forth herein are for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement whatsoever.

m.

Voluntary Agreement .  Employee and Company represent and agree that each has reviewed all aspects of this Agreement, has carefully read and fully understands all provisions of this Agreement, and is voluntarily entering into this Agreement.  Each party represents and agrees that such party has had the opportunity to review any and all aspects of this Agreement with legal, tax or other adviser(s) of such party’s choice before executing this Agreement.

n.

Deferred Compensation Omnibus Provision .  It is intended that any payment or benefit which is provided pursuant to or in connection with this Agreement which is considered to be deferred compensation subject to Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code shall be paid and provided in a manner, and at such time , including without limitation payment and provision of benefits only in connection with the occurrence of a permissible payment event contained in Section 409A (e.g. death, disability, separation from service from the Company and its affiliates as defined for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code), and in such form, as complies with the applicable requirements of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code to avoid the unfavorable tax consequences provided



19



therein for non-compliance.  In connection with effecting such compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, the following shall apply:

(i)

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the Company is authorized to amend this Agreement, to void or amend any election made by Employee under this Agreement and/or to delay the payment of any monies and/or provision of any benefits in such manner as may be determined by it to be necessary or appropriate to comply, or to evidence or further evidence required compliance, with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (including any transition or grandfather rules thereunder).  

(ii)

Neither Employee nor the Company shall take any action to accelerate or delay the payment of any monies and/or provision of any benefits in any manner which would not be in compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (including any transition or grandfather rules thereunder).

(iii)

If Employee is a specified employee for purposes of Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code, any payment or provision of benefits in connection with a separation from service payment event (as determined for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code) shall not be made until six months after Employee’s separation from service (the “409A Deferral Period”).  In the event such payments are otherwise due to be made in installments or periodically during the 409A Deferral Period, the payments which would otherwise have been made in the 409A Deferral Period shall be accumulated and paid in a lump sum as soon as the 409A Deferral Period ends, and the balance of the payments shall be made as otherwise scheduled.  In the event benefits are required to be deferred, any such benefit may be provided during the 409A Deferral Period at Employee’s expense, with Employee having a right to reimbursement from the Company once the 409A Deferral Period ends, and the balance of the benefits shall be provided as otherwise scheduled.

(iv)

If a Change in Control occurs but the Change in Control does not constitute a change in control within the meaning of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (a “409A Change in Control”), then payment of any



20



amount or provision of any benefit under this Agreement which is considered to be deferred compensation subject to Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code shall be deferred until another permissible payment event contained in Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code occurs (e.g., death, disability, separation from service from the Company and its affiliated companies as defined for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code), including any deferral of payment or provision of benefits for the 409A Deferral Period as provided above .

(v)

For purposes of this Agreement, all rights to payments and benefits hereunder shall be treated as rights to receive a series of separate payments and benefits to the fullest extent allowed by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code.  

(vi)

For purposes of determining time of (but not entitlement to) payment or provision of deferred compensation under this Agreement under Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code in connection with a termination of employment, termination of employment will be read to mean a “separation from service” within the meaning of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code where it is reasonably anticipated that no further services would be performed after that date or that the level of bona fide services Employee would perform after that date (whether as an employee or independent contractor) would permanently decrease to less than 50% of the average level of bona fide services performed over the immediately preceding thirty-six (36) month period.

(vii)

For purposes of this Agreement, a key employee for purposes of Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code shall be determined on the basis of the applicable 12–month period ending on the specified employee identification date designated by the Company consistently for purposes of this Agreement and similar agreements or, if no such designation is made, based on the default rules and regulations under Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code.  



21



(viii)

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the Company shall not be liable to Employee if any payment or benefit which is to be provided pursuant to this Agreement and which is considered deferred compensation subject to Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code otherwise fails to comply with, or be exempt from, the requirements of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code.



IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed, or caused their duly authorized representative to execute this Agreement to be effective as of the Effective Date.



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

/s/ Robert D. Ravener

 

 

Its:

SVP Chief People Officer


Date:

12/03/08


 

 

 

“EMPLOYEE”

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Todd Vasos

 

 

 

Todd Vasos

Date:

12/1/08

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Witnessed By:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Julie L. Filson

 

 

 

 




22



Addendum to Employment Agreement with ___________________


RELEASE AGREEMENT

THIS RELEASE (“Release”) is made and entered into by and between _________________ (“Employee”) and DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION , and its successor or assigns (“Company”).

WHEREAS, Employee and Company have agreed that Employee’s employment with Dollar General Corporation shall terminate on ___________________;

WHEREAS, Employee and the Company have previously entered into that certain Employment Agreement, effective _____________________ (“Agreement”), in which the form of this Release is incorporated by reference;

WHEREAS, Employee and Company desire to delineate their respective rights, duties and obligations attendant to such termination and desire to reach an accord and satisfaction of all claims arising from Employee’s employment, and termination of employment, with appropriate releases, in accordance with the Agreement;

WHEREAS, the Company desires to compensate Employee in accordance with the Agreement for service Employee has provided and/or will provide for the Company;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the agreements of the parties set forth in this Release, and other good and valuable consideration the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, intending to be legally bound, hereby covenant and agree as follows:

1.

Claims Released Under This Agreement .

In exchange for receiving the payments and benefits described in Section 11 and 12 of the Agreement, Employee hereby voluntarily and irrevocably waives, releases, dismisses with prejudice, and withdraws all claims, complaints, suits or demands of any kind whatsoever (whether known or unknown) which Employee ever had, may have, or now has against Company and other current or former subsidiaries or affiliates of the Company and their past, present and future officers, directors, employees, agents, insurers and attorneys (collectively, the “Releasees”), arising from or relating to (directly or indirectly) Employee’s employment or the termination of employment or other events that have occurred as of the date of execution of this Agreement, including but not limited to:



23



a.

claims for violations of Title VII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964, the Age Discrimination in Employment Act, the Fair Labor Standards Act, the Civil Rights Act of 1991, the Americans With Disabilities Act, the Equal Pay Act, the Family and Medical Leave Act, 42 U.S.C. § 1981, the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, the National Labor Relations Act, the Labor Management Relations Act, Executive Order 11246, Executive Order 11141, the Rehabilitation Act of 1973, or the Employee Retirement Income Security Act;

b.

claims for violations of any other federal or state statute or regulation or local ordinance;

c.

claims for lost or unpaid wages, compensation, or benefits, defamation, intentional or negligent infliction of emotional distress, assault, battery, wrongful or constructive discharge, negligent hiring, retention or supervision, fraud, misrepresentation, conversion, tortious interference, breach of contract, or breach of fiduciary duty;

d.

claims to benefits under any bonus, severance, workforce reduction, early retirement, outplacement, or any other similar type plan sponsored by the Company (except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement); or

e.

any other claims under state law arising in tort or contract.

2.

Claims Not Released Under This Agreement .

In signing this Release, Employee is not releasing any claims that may arise under the terms of this Release or which may arise out of events occurring after the date Employee executes this Release.

Employee also is not releasing claims to benefits that Employee is already entitled to receive under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.  However, Employee understands and acknowledges that nothing herein is intended to or shall be construed to require the Company to institute or continue in effect any particular plan or benefit sponsored by the Company, and the Company hereby reserves the right to amend or terminate any of its benefit programs at any time in accordance with the procedures set forth in such plans.

Nothing in this Release shall prohibit Employee from engaging in activities required or protected under applicable law or from communicating, either voluntarily or otherwise, with any governmental agency concerning any potential violation of the law.



24



3.

No Assignment of Claim .  Employee represents that Employee has not assigned or transferred, or purported to assign or transfer, any claims or any portion thereof or interest therein to any party prior to the date of this Release.

4.

Compensation .  In accordance with the Agreement, the Company agrees to pay Employee or, if Employee becomes eligible for payments and benefits under Section 11 and 12 but dies before receipt thereof, Employee’s spouse or estate, as the case may be, the amounts provided in Section 11 and 12 of the Agreement.

5.

Publicity; No Disparaging Statement .  Except as otherwise provided in Section 14 of the Agreement, Section 2 of this Release, and as privileged by law, Employee and the Company covenant and agree that they shall not engage in any communi­cations with persons outside the Company which shall disparage one another or interfere with their existing or prospective business relationships.

6.

No Admission Of Liability .  This Release shall not in any way be construed as an admission by the Company or Employee of any improper actions or liability whatsoever as to one another, and each specifically disclaims any liability to or improper actions against the other or any other person.

7.

Voluntary Execution .  Employee warrants, represents and agrees that Employee has been encouraged in writing to seek advice regarding this Release from an attorney and tax advisor prior to signing it; that this Release represents written notice to do so; that Employee has been given the opportunity and sufficient time to seek such advice; and that Employee fully understands the meaning and contents of this Release. Employee further represents and warrants that Employee was not coerced, threatened or otherwise forced to sign this Release, and that Employee’s signature appearing hereinafter is voluntary and genuine.  EMPLOYEE UNDERSTANDS THAT EMPLOYEE MAY TAKE UP TO TWENTY-ONE (21) DAYS TO CONSIDER WHETHER TO ENTER INTO THIS RELEASE.

8.

Ability to Revoke Agreement .  EMPLOYEE UNDERSTANDS THAT  THIS RELEASE MAY BE REVOKED BY EMPLOYEE BY NOTIFYING THE COMPANY IN WRITING OF SUCH REVOCATION WITHIN SEVEN (7) DAYS OF EMPLOYEE’S EXECUTION OF THIS RELEASE AND THAT THIS RELEASE IS NOT EFFECTIVE UNTIL THE EXPIRATION OF SUCH SEVEN (7) DAY PERIOD.  EMPLOYEE UNDERSTANDS THAT UPON THE EXPIRATION OF SUCH SEVEN (7) DAY PERIOD



25



THIS RELEASE WILL BE BINDING UPON EMPLOYEE AND EMPLOYEE’S HEIRS, ADMINISTRATORS, REPRESENTATIVES, EXECUTORS, SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS AND WILL BE IRREVOCABLE.

Acknowledged and Agreed To:


“COMPANY”

 

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Its:

 


I UNDERSTAND THAT BY SIGNING THIS RELEASE, I AM GIVING UP RIGHTS I MAY HAVE.  I UNDERSTAND THAT I DO NOT HAVE TO SIGN THIS RELEASE.


 

 

 

“EMPLOYEE”

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

WITNESSED BY:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date

 

 

 





26




STOCK OPTION AGREEMENT



THIS AGREEMENT, dated as of the date indicated on Schedule B hereto (the “ Grant Date ”), is made by and between Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (hereinafter referred to as the “ Company ”), and the individual whose name is set forth on the signature page hereof, who is an employee of the Company or a Subsidiary or Affiliate of the Company, hereinafter referred to as the “ Optionee ”.  Any capitalized terms herein not otherwise defined in Article I shall have the meaning set forth in the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of Dollar General Corporation and its Affiliates, as such Plan may be amended from time to time (the “ Plan ”).

WHEREAS, the Company wishes to carry out the Plan, the terms of which are hereby incorporated by reference and made a part of this Agreement; and

WHEREAS, the Compensation Committee of the Board of the Company (or, if no such committee is appointed, the Board) (the “ Committee ”) has determined that it would be to the advantage and best interest of the Company and its shareholders to grant the Option provided for herein to the Optionee as an incentive for increased efforts during his term of office with the Company or its Subsidiaries or Affiliates, and has advised the Company thereof and instructed the undersigned officers to issue said Option;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants herein contained and other good and valuable consideration, receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto do hereby agree as follows:

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

Whenever the following terms are used in this Agreement, they shall have the meaning specified below unless the context clearly indicates to the contrary.

Section 1.1.  

Base Price

“Base Price” shall mean $5.00.


Section 1.2.  

Cause

“Cause” shall mean “Cause” as such term may be defined in any employment agreement or change-in-control agreement in effect at the time of termination of employment between the Optionee and the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or Affiliates, or, if there is no such employment or change-in-control agreement, “Cause” shall mean, with respect to an Optionee: (i) any act of the Optionee involving fraud or dishonesty, or any willful failure to perform reasonable duties assigned to the Optionee which failure is not cured within 10 business days after receipt from the Company of written notice of such failure; (ii) any material breach by the Optionee of any securities or other law or regulation or any Company policy governing trading or dealing with stock, securities, investments or the like, inappropriate disclosure or “tipping” relating to any stock, securities or investments or the like, (iii) other than as required by law, the carrying out by the Optionee of any activity, or the Optionee making any public statement, which prejudices or ridicules the good name and standing of the Company or its affiliates (including any limited partner of Parent) or would bring such persons into public contempt or ridicule; (iv) attendance by the Optionee at work in a state of intoxication or the Optionee otherwise being found in








possession at the Management Stockholder’s place of work of any prohibited drug or substance, possession of which would amount to a criminal office; (v) any assault or other act of violence by the Management Stockholder; or (vi) the Optionee being indicted for any crime constituting (x) any felony whatsoever or (y) any misdemeanor that would preclude employment under the Company’s hiring policy.


Section 1.3.  

Closing Date

“Closing Date” shall mean July 6, 2007.


Section 1.4.  

Disability

“Disability” shall mean “Disability” as such term is defined in any employment agreement between Optionee and the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, or, if there is no such employment agreement, “Disability” as defined in the long-term disability plan of the Company.

Section 1.5.  

Fiscal Year

“Fiscal Year” shall mean each of the fiscal years of the Company set forth on Schedule A attached hereto.

Section 1.6.  

Good Reason

“Good Reason” shall mean “Good Reason” as such term may be defined in any employment agreement or change-in-control agreement in effect at the time of termination of employment between the Optionee and the Company or any of its Subsidiaries or Affiliates, or, if there is no such employment or change-in-control agreement, “Good Reason” shall mean (i) a reduction in the Optionee’s base salary or target bonus level; or (ii) the relocation by the Company of the Optionee’s principal place of employment to a site outside a fifty mile radius from the current site of the Optionee’s principal place of employment.  In each case other than any isolated, insubstantial and inadvertent failure by the Company that is not in bad faith and is cured within ten (10) business days after the Participant gives the Company notice of such event.

Section 1.7.  

Management Stockholder’s Agreement

“Management Stockholder’s Agreement” shall mean that certain Management Stockholder’s Agreement between the Optionee and the Company.

Section 1.8.  

Option

“Option” shall mean the aggregate of the Time Option and the Performance Option granted under Section 2.1 of this Agreement.

Section 1.9.  

Performance Option

“Performance Option” shall mean the right and option to purchase, on the terms and conditions set forth herein, all or any part of an aggregate of the number of shares of Common Stock set forth on Schedule B hereof opposite the term Performance Option.





2



Section 1.10.  

Pro Rata Fraction

“Pro Rata Fraction” shall mean a fraction, the numerator of which equals the number of calendar months in the first Fiscal Year that the Optionee is employed with (in the case of a new employee), or is employed in the promoted position giving rise to the Option grant by (in the event of a promoted employee), the Company or any Service Recipient and the denominator of which is equal to 12; provided, that an Optionee shall only be deemed to have been employed in any given calendar month if the Optionee commences initial employment (in the event of a new employee) or commences employment into the promoted position (in the event of a promoted employee) with the Company or any Service Recipient on or before the fifteenth (15 th ) day of any calendar month occurring in the first Fiscal Year.  In the event an Optionee commences employment (whether initial or promoted) with the Company or any Service Recipient after the fifteenth day of any given calendar month, then the numerator of the foregoing fraction shall only include those calendar months immediately following the calendar month in which the Optionee commences such employment (whether initial or promoted).    


Section 1.11.  

Secretary

“Secretary” shall mean the Secretary of the Company.

Section 1.12.  

Sponsor IRR

 “Sponsor IRR” shall mean, on any given date, a pretax compounded annual internal rate of return of at least 25% realized by the Sponsors or any of their affiliates after the Closing Date on any Shares held by the Sponsors or any of their affiliates, on a per Share, fully diluted basis, based on the amount invested by the Sponsors in the equity securities of the Company.  For the avoidance of doubt, (a) any calculation of Sponsor IRR will for purposes of Section 3.1(c)(ii) and 3.1(d) be calculated solely with respect to Sponsor Shares (as defined herein) actually sold or otherwise disposed of in the applicable transaction, and (b) Sponsor IRR will not be calculated taking into account the receipt by the Sponsor or any of its affiliates of any management, monitoring, transaction or other fees payable to such parties in connection with their separate letter agreement with the Company, and shall only take into account actual distributions paid on the shares of Common Stock indirectly held by such parties.

Section 1.13.  

Sponsor Return

“Sponsor Return” shall mean, on any given date, all cash proceeds actually received by the Sponsors or any of their affiliates after the Closing Date, including the receipt of any cash dividends or other cash distributions thereon, on a per Share, fully diluted basis, in an amount that equals or exceeds the product of 2.5 and the Base Price.   For the avoidance of doubt, (a) any calculation of Sponsor Return will for purposes of Section 3.1(c)(ii) and 3.1(d) be calculated solely with respect to Sponsor Shares actually sold or otherwise disposed of in the applicable transaction, and (b) Sponsor Return will not be calculated taking into account the receipt by the Sponsor or any of its affiliates of any management, monitoring, transaction or other fees payable to such parties in connection with their separate letter agreement with the Company, and shall only take into account actual distributions paid on the shares of Common Stock indirectly held by such parties.

 

Section 1.14.  

Time Option

“Time Option” shall mean the right and option to purchase, on the terms and conditions set forth herein, all or any part of an aggregate of the number of shares of Common Stock set forth on Schedule B hereof opposite the term Time Option.



3



ARTICLE II
GRANT OF OPTIONS

Section 2.1.  

Grant of Options

For good and valuable consideration, on and as of the Grant Date the Company irrevocably grants to the Optionee the following Stock Options:  (a) the Time Option and (b) the Performance Option, in each case on the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement.

Section 2.2.  

Exercise Price

Subject to Section 2.4, the exercise price of the shares of Common Stock covered by the Option (the “Exercise Price”) shall be as set forth on Schedule B hereof, which shall be the Fair Market Value on the Grant Date.

Section 2.3.  

No Guarantee of Employment

Nothing in this Agreement or in the Plan shall confer upon the Optionee any right to continue in the employ of the Company or any Subsidiary or Affiliate or shall interfere with or restrict in any way the rights of the Company and its Subsidiaries or Affiliates, which are hereby expressly reserved, to terminate the employment of the Optionee at any time for any reason whatsoever, with or without cause, subject to the applicable provisions of, if any, the Optionee’s employment agreement with the Company or offer letter provided by the Company to the Optionee.

Section 2.4.  

Adjustments to Option

The Option shall be subject to the adjustment provisions of Sections 8 and 9 of the Plan, provided , however , that in the event of the payment of an extraordinary dividend by the Company to its stockholders, then: the Exercise Prices of the Option shall be reduced by the amount of the dividend paid, but only to the extent the Committee determines it to be permitted under applicable tax laws and not have adverse tax consequences to the Optionee under Section 409A of the Code; and, if such reduction cannot be fully effected due to such tax laws and it will not have adverse tax consequences to the Optionee, then the Company shall pay to the Optionee a cash payment, on a per Share basis, equal to the balance of the amount of the dividend not permitted to be applied to reduce the Exercise Price of the applicable Option as follows: (a) for each Share subject to a vested Option, immediately upon the date of such dividend payment; and (b), for each Share subject to an unvested Option, on the date on which such Option becomes vested and exercisable with respect to such Share.

ARTICLE III
PERIOD OF EXERCISABILITY

Section 3.1.  

Commencement of Exercisability

(a)

So long as the Optionee continues to be employed by the Company or any other Service Recipients, the Option shall become exercisable pursuant to the following schedules:

(i)

Time Option .  The Time Option shall become vested and exercisable with respect to 20% of the Shares subject to such Option on each of the first five anniversaries of the date set forth on Schedule B (the “ Hire or Promotion Date ”).



4



(ii)

Performance Option .  If the Company, on a consolidated basis, achieves its annual EBITDA targets as set forth in Schedule A attached hereto (each an “ EBITDA Target ” or “Annual Performance Target”) for the applicable given Fiscal Year, then the Performance Option shall be eligible to become vested and exercisable as to a percentage of the Shares subject to such Option at the end of each of the six Fiscal Years as follows:

(A)

in respect of the first Fiscal Year, a Pro Rata Fraction of 20% of the Shares subject to the Option (the “Initial Tranche”);

(B)

in respect of each of the second through fifth Fiscal Years, 20% of the Shares subject to the Option; and

(C)

in respect of the sixth Fiscal Year, the portion of the Initial Tranche in excess of the Pro Rata Fraction of the Initial Tranche that did not become vested in respect of the first Fiscal Year.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the event that an EBITDA Target is not achieved in a particular Fiscal Year, then that portion of the Performance Option that was eligible to vest but failed to vest due to the Company’s failure to achieve its EBITDA Target shall nevertheless vest and become exercisable at the end of any subsequent Fiscal Years if the cumulative EBITDA Target (each a “ Cumulative EBITDA Target ”) set forth on Schedule A attached hereto is achieved on a cumulative basis at the end of such Fiscal Year with respect to all then completed Fiscal Years.  In addition, for the avoidance of doubt, except as otherwise provided in Section 3.1(b) below, no portion of the Performance Option shall become vested and exercisable at any time unless the Optionee remains employed with the Company or the applicable Service Recipient through the date on which it is determined that the applicable EBITDA or Cumulative EBITDA Target of the immediately preceding Fiscal Year has been achieved.

(b)

Notwithstanding any of the foregoing, upon a termination of the Optionee’s employment at any time by reason of death or Disability:

(i)

that 20% portion of the Time Option that would have become exercisable on the next anniversary date of the Hire or Promotion Date if the Optionee had remained employed with the Company or the applicable Service Recipient through such date will become vested and exercisable; and

(ii)

that portion of the Performance Option, if any, that would have become exercisable in respect of the Fiscal Year in which the Optionee’s employment terminates if the Optionee had remained employed with the Company or the applicable Service Recipient through such date, shall remain outstanding through the date the Company determines whether the Annual Performance Target or Cumulative EBITDA Target is met for such Fiscal Year, and shall become exercisable on such date if and only if , and only to the extent that, the Annual Performance Target or Cumulative EBITDA Target is met for such Fiscal Year in accordance with Section 3.1(a)(ii) above; provided, however , that if such Annual Performance Target or Cumulative EBITDA Target is not met for such Fiscal Year, that portion of the Performance Option shall remain unvested and shall be forfeited upon such date.


(c)

Notwithstanding any of Section 3.1(a) or (b) above, upon the earlier occurrence of a Change in Control:

(i)

the Time Option shall become immediately exercisable as to 100% of the shares of Common Stock subject to such Option immediately prior to a Change in Control (but only to the extent such Option has not otherwise terminated or become exercisable); and



5



(ii)

the Performance Option shall become immediately exercisable as to 100% of the shares of Common Stock subject to such Option immediately prior to a Change in Control (but only to the extent such Option has not otherwise terminated or become exercisable) if as a result of the Change in Control, (x) the Sponsor achieves the Sponsor IRR on 100% of the Sponsors’ aggregate investment, directly or indirectly, in the equity securities of the Company (the “Sponsor Shares”) and (y) the Sponsor earns an Sponsor Return on 100% of the Sponsor Shares; provided, however, that in the event that there occurs a Change in Control wherein more than 50% but less than 100% of the Common Stock or other voting securities of the Company or Buck Holdings, L.P. is sold or otherwise disposed of, then, the Performance Option will become vested (to the extent not already previously vested pursuant to Section 3.1(a) or (d)) up to the same percentage of Sponsor Shares on which such Sponsor Return and Sponsor IRR has been so achieved.

(d)

Notwithstanding any of Section 3.1(a), (b) or (c) above, if after a Public Offering (as such term is defined in the Management Stockholder’s Agreement), the Sponsor or its affiliates, through one transaction or a series of transactions, sells Shares and achieves the Sponsor Return and the Sponsor IRR on any percentage of Sponsor Shares, so long as the Optionee has remained employed with the Company or the applicable Service Recipient through the relevant sale date, then, the Performance Option will become vested (to the extent not already previously vested pursuant to Section 3.1(a) or (c)) up to the same percentage of Sponsor Shares on which such Sponsor Return and Sponsor IRR has been so achieved.  

(e)

Notwithstanding the foregoing but except as provided in Section 3.1(b), no Option shall become exercisable as to any additional shares of Common Stock following the termination of employment of the Optionee for any reason and any Option, which is unexercisable as of the Optionee’s termination of employment, shall immediately expire without payment therefor.

Section 3.2.  

Expiration of Option

Except as otherwise provided in Section 5 or 6 of the Management Stockholder’s Agreement, the Optionee may not exercise the Option to any extent after the first to occur of the following events:

(a)

The tenth anniversary of the Grant Date so long as the Optionee remains employed with the Company or any Service Recipient through such date;

(b)

The first anniversary of the date of the Optionee’s termination of employment with the Company and all Service Recipients, if the Optionee’s employment is terminated by reason of death or Disability (unless earlier terminated as provided in Section 3.2(h) below);

(c)

Immediately upon the date of the Optionee’s termination of employment by the Company and all Service Recipients for Cause;

(d)

Immediately upon the date of the Optionee’s termination of employment by the Company and all Service Recipients by the Optionee without Good Reason (except due to death or Disability);

(e)

Ninety (90) days after the date of an Optionee’s termination of employment by the Company and all Service Recipients without Cause (for any reason other than as set forth in Section 3.2(b));



6



(f)

Ninety (90) days after the date of an Optionee’s termination of employment with the Company and all Service Recipients by the Optionee for Good Reason;

(g)

The date the Option is terminated pursuant to Section 6 or 7 of the Management Stockholder’s Agreement; or

(h)

At the discretion of the Company, if the Committee so determines pursuant to Section 9 of the Plan.

ARTICLE IV
EXERCISE OF OPTION

Section 4.1.  

Person Eligible to Exercise

During the lifetime of the Optionee, only the Optionee (or his or her duly authorized legal representative) may exercise an Option or any portion thereof.  After the death of the Optionee, any exercisable portion of an Option may, prior to the time when an Option becomes unexercisable under Section 3.2, be exercised by his personal representative or by any person empowered to do so under the Optionee’s will or under the then applicable laws of descent and distribution.

Section 4.2.  

Partial Exercise

Any exercisable portion of an Option or the entire Option, if then wholly exercisable, may be exercised in whole or in part at any time prior to the time when the Option or portion thereof becomes unexercisable under Section 3.2; provided , however , that any partial exercise shall be for whole shares of Common Stock only.

Section 4.3.  

Manner of Exercise

An Option, or any exercisable portion thereof, may be exercised solely by delivering to the Secretary or his or her office or designee all of the following prior to the time when the Option or such portion becomes unexercisable under Section 3.2:

(a)

Notice in writing signed by the Optionee or the other person then entitled to exercise the Option or portion thereof, stating that the Option or portion thereof is thereby exercised, such notice complying with all applicable rules established by the Committee;

(b)

(i) Full payment (in cash or by check or by a combination thereof) for the shares with respect to which such Option or portion thereof is exercised or (ii) indication that the Optionee elects to have the number of Shares that would otherwise be issued to the Optionee reduced by a number of Shares having an equivalent Fair Market Value to the payment that would otherwise be made by Optionee to the Company pursuant to clause (i) of this subsection (b);

(c)

(i) Full payment (in cash or by check or by a combination thereof) to satisfy the minimum withholding tax obligation with respect to which such Option or portion thereof is exercised; or (ii) solely in the event that the Optionee’s employment terminates under circumstances identified in Section 3.2(b), (e) or (f) above, notice in writing that the Optionee elects to have the number of Shares that would otherwise be issued to the Optionee reduced by a number of Shares having an equivalent Fair Market Value to the payment that would otherwise be made by Optionee to the Company pursuant to clause (i) of this subsection (c);



7



(d)

A bona fide written representation and agreement, in a form satisfactory to the Committee, signed by the Optionee or other person then entitled to exercise such Option or portion thereof, stating that the shares of Common Stock are being acquired for his own account, for investment and without any present intention of distributing or reselling said shares or any of them except as may be permitted under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “ Act ”), and then applicable rules and regulations thereunder, and that the Optionee or other person then entitled to exercise such Option or portion thereof will indemnify the Company against and hold it free and harmless from any loss, damage, expense or liability resulting to the Company if any sale or distribution of the shares by such person is contrary to the representation and agreement referred to above; provided , however , that the Committee may, in its reasonable discretion, take whatever additional actions it deems reasonably necessary to ensure the observance and performance of such representation and agreement and to effect compliance with the Act and any other federal or state securities laws or regulations; and

(e)

In the event the Option or portion thereof shall be exercised pursuant to Section 4.1 by any person or persons other than the Optionee, appropriate proof of the right of such person or persons to exercise the option.

Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Committee may require an opinion of counsel acceptable to it to the effect that any subsequent transfer of shares acquired on exercise of an Option does not violate the Act, and may issue stop-transfer orders covering such shares.  Share certificates evidencing stock issued on exercise of this Option shall bear an appropriate legend referring to the provisions of subsection (d) above and the agreements herein. The written representation and agreement referred to in subsection (d) above shall, however, not be required if the shares to be issued pursuant to such exercise have been registered under the Act, and such registration is then effective in respect of such shares.

Section 4.4.  

Conditions to Issuance of Stock Certificates

The shares of stock deliverable upon the exercise of an Option, or any portion thereof, may be either previously authorized but unissued shares or issued shares, which have then been reacquired by the Company.  Such shares shall be fully paid and nonassessable.  The Company shall not be required to issue or deliver any certificate or certificates for shares of stock purchased (if certified, or if not certified, register the issuance of such shares on its books and records) upon the exercise of an Option or portion thereof prior to fulfillment of all of the following conditions:

(a)

The obtaining of approval or other clearance from any state or federal governmental agency which the Committee shall, in its reasonable and good faith discretion, determine to be necessary or advisable;

(b)

The execution by the Optionee of the Management Stockholder’s Agreement and a Sale Participation Agreement; and

(c)

The lapse of such reasonable period of time following the exercise of the Option as the Committee may from time to time establish for reasons of administrative convenience or as may otherwise be required by applicable law.

Section 4.5.  

Rights as Stockholder

Except as otherwise provided in Section 2.4 of this Agreement, the holder of an Option shall not be, nor have any of the rights or privileges of, a stockholder of the Company in respect of any shares purchasable upon the exercise of the Option or any portion thereof unless and until certificates



8



representing such shares shall have been issued by the Company to such holder or the Shares have otherwise been recorded in the records of the Company as owned by such holder.

ARTICLE V
MISCELLANEOUS

Section 5.1.  

Administration

The Committee shall have the power to interpret the Plan and this Agreement and to adopt such rules for the administration, interpretation and application of the Plan as are consistent therewith and to interpret or revoke any such rules.  All actions taken and all interpretations and determinations made by the Committee shall be final and binding upon the Optionee, the Company and all other interested persons.  No member of the Committee shall be personally liable for any action, determination or interpretation made in good faith with respect to the Plan or the Option.  In its absolute discretion, the Board may at any time and from time to time exercise any and all rights and duties of the Committee under the Plan and this Agreement.

Section 5.2.  

Option Not Transferable

Neither the Option nor any interest or right therein or part thereof shall be liable for the debts, contracts or engagements of the Optionee or his successors in interest or shall be subject to disposition by transfer, alienation, anticipation, pledge, encumbrance, assignment or any other means whether such disposition be voluntary or involuntary or by operation of law by judgment, levy, attachment, garnishment or any other legal or equitable proceedings (including bankruptcy), and any attempted disposition thereof shall be null and void and of no effect; provided, however, that this Section 5.2 shall not prevent transfers by will or by the applicable laws of descent and distribution.

Section 5.3.  

Notices

Any notice to be given under the terms of this Agreement to the Company shall be addressed to the Company in care of its Secretary, and any notice to be given to the Optionee shall be addressed to him at the address given beneath his signature hereto.  By a notice given pursuant to this Section 5.3, either party may hereafter designate a different address for notices to be given to him.  Any notice, which is required to be given to the Optionee, shall, if the Optionee is then deceased, be given to the Optionee’s personal representative if such representative has previously informed the Company of his status and address by written notice under this Section 5.3.  Any notice shall have been deemed duly given when (i) delivered in person, (ii) enclosed in a properly sealed envelope or wrapper addressed as aforesaid, deposited (with postage prepaid) in a post office or branch post office regularly maintained by the United States Postal Service, or (iii) enclosed in a properly sealed envelope or wrapper addressed as aforesaid, deposited (with fees prepaid) in an office regularly maintained by FedEx, UPS, or comparable non-public mail carrier.

Section 5.4.  

Titles; Pronouns

Titles are provided herein for convenience only and are not to serve as a basis for interpretation or construction of this Agreement.  The masculine pronoun shall include the feminine and neuter, and the singular the plural, where the context so indicates.



9





Section 5.5.  

Applicability of Plan, Management Stockholder’s Agreement and Sale Participation Agreement

The Option and the shares of Common Stock issued to the Optionee upon exercise of the Option shall be subject to all of the terms and provisions of the Plan, the Management Stockholder’s Agreement and a Sale Participation Agreement, to the extent applicable to the Option and such Shares.  

Section 5.6.  

Amendment

Subject to Section 10 of the Plan, this Agreement may be amended only by a writing executed by the parties hereto, which specifically states that it is amending this Agreement.

Section 5.7.  

Governing Law

The laws of the State of Delaware shall govern the interpretation, validity and performance of the terms of this Agreement regardless of the law that might be applied under principles of conflicts of laws.

Section 5.8.  

Arbitration

In the event of any controversy among the parties hereto arising out of, or relating to, this Agreement which cannot be settled amicably by the parties, such controversy shall be finally, exclusively and conclusively settled by mandatory arbitration conducted expeditiously in accordance with the American Arbitration Association rules, by a single independent arbitrator.  Such arbitration process shall take place within the Nashville, Tennessee metropolitan area.  The decision of the arbitrator shall be final and binding upon all parties hereto and shall be rendered pursuant to a written decision, which contains a detailed recital of the arbitrator’s reasoning.  Judgment upon the award rendered may be entered in any court having jurisdiction thereof.  Each party shall bear its own legal fees and expenses, unless otherwise determined by the arbitrator.  



[ Signatures on next pages .]



10





IN WITNESS WHEREOF, this Agreement has been executed and delivered by the parties hereto.


DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

/s/ Raj Agrawal

 

 

Name:

Raj Agrawal

 

 

Title:

Vice President



ADDRESS:

 

Dollar General Corporation

100 Mission Ridge

Goodlettsville, TN 37072






























[Signature Page of Stock Option Agreement]




11







OPTIONEE:

 

/s/ Todd J. Vasos

Todd J. Vasos



ADDRESS:

 

c/o Dollar General Corporation

100 Mission Ridge

Goodlettsville, TN 37072














[Signature Page of Stock Option Agreement]




12





Schedule A to Stock Option Agreement

Annual and Cumulative Performance Targets

The Annual and Cumulative Performance Targets are based on the Company’s achievement of the following EBITDA targets for the following Fiscal Years:

Fiscal Year

Annual Performance Target

Cumulative Performance Target

2008

[   ]

N/A

2009

[   ]

[   ]

2010

[   ]

[   ]

2011

[   ]

[   ]

2012

[   ]

[   ]

2013

[   ]

[   ]

2014

NA

[   ]


"EBITDA" shall mean earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization plus transaction, management and/or similar fees paid to the Sponsor and/or its Affiliates. The Board shall, fairly and appropriately, adjust the calculation of EBITDA to reflect, to the extent not contemplated in the management plan, the following: acquisitions, divestitures, any change required by GAAP relating to share-based compensation or for other changes in GAAP promulgated by accounting standard setters that, in each case, the Board in good faith determines require adjustment of EBITDA. The Board’s determination of such adjustment shall be based on the Company’s accounting as set forth in its books and records and on the financial plan of the Company pursuant to which the Annual Performance Targets were originally established.

If the Company makes an acquisition in any year, the Annual Performance Target for such year and Cumulative Performance Target for such year and subsequent years will be adjusted, fairly and appropriately, by the amount of EBITDA in the plan for the target presented to the Board at the time the acquisition is approved by the Board. Annual Performance Targets and Cumulative Performance Targets will also be fairly and appropriately adjusted by the Board, in consultation with management, to the extent not contemplated in the plan for the following: any divestitures, major capital investment programs, any change required by GAAP relating to share-based compensation or other changes in GAAP promulgated by accounting standard setters. In the event that any of the foregoing action is taken, such adjustment shall be only the amount deemed reasonably necessary by the Board, in the exercise of its good faith judgment, after consultation of the Company’s accountants, to accurately reflect the direct and measurable effect such event has on such Annual Performance Targets and Cumulative Performance Targets. The intent of such adjustments is to keep the probability of achieving the Annual Performance Targets and Cumulative Performance Targets the same as if the event triggering such adjustment had not



A-1





occurred. The Board’s determination of such necessary adjustment shall be made within 60 days following the completion or closing of such event, and shall be based on the Company’s accounting as set forth in its books and records and on the Company’s financial plan pursuant to which the Annual Performance Targets and Cumulative Performance Targets were originally established.



A-2





Schedule B to Stock Option Agreement

Grant Date :

December 19, 2008

Exercise Price of Options :

[   ]

Option Grants :


Aggregate number of shares of Common Stock

for which the Time Option granted hereunder is

exercisable:

[   ]


Aggregate number of shares of Common Stock

for which the Performance Option

granted hereunder is exercisable:

 

[   ]


Hire or Promotion Date :

December 1, 2008




B-1


MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER’S AGREEMENT

This Management Stockholder’s Agreement (this “ Agreement ”) is entered into as of the date indicated on Schedule I hereto (the “ Effective Date ”) among Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (the “ Company ”), Buck Holdings, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership (“ Parent ”), and the undersigned person (the “ Management Stockholder ”) (the Company, Parent and the Management Stockholder being hereinafter collectively referred to as the “ Parties ”).  All capitalized terms not immediately defined are hereinafter defined in Section 7(b) of this Agreement.

WHEREAS , the Management Stockholder has been selected by the Company (i) to be permitted to transfer to the Company cash in exchange for shares of Common Stock (the “ Purchased Stock ”); and/or (ii) to receive options to purchase shares of Common Stock (the “ Options ”) pursuant to the terms set forth below and the terms of the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of Dollar General Corporation and its Affiliates, as such Plan may be amended from time to time (the “ Option Plan ”), and the Stock Option Agreement dated as of the Effective Date, entered into by and between the Company and the Management Stockholder (the “ Stock Option Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS , this Agreement is one of several other agreements (“ Other Management Stockholders Agreements ”) which have in the past, concurrently with the execution hereof or in the future will be entered into between the Company and other individuals who are or will be key employees of the Company or one of its subsidiaries (collectively, the “ Other Management Stockholders ”).

NOW THEREFORE , to implement the foregoing and in consideration of the mutual agreements contained herein, the Parties agree as follows:

1.

Issuance of Purchased Shares; Options.

(a)    Subject to the terms and conditions hereinafter set forth, the Management Stockholder hereby subscribes for and shall purchase, as of the Effective Date, and the Company shall issue, as of the Effective Date,  and deliver promptly thereafter to the Management Stockholder (if such shares are issued in certificated form) the number of shares of Purchased Stock equal to the investment amount set forth on the Management Stockholder’s signature page hereto divided by the  per share purchase price which shall equal the Fair Market Value on the Effective Date (the “ Base Price ”), payable by the Management Stockholder on the Effective Date by check payable to Dollar General Corporation.

(b)    Subject to the terms and conditions hereinafter set forth and as set forth in the Option Plan, the Company will grant to the Management Stockholder Options to acquire shares of Common Stock, at an initial per share exercise price equal to the Fair Market Value of the Company’s Common Stock on the date the Options are granted (the “ Grant Date ”), and the Parties shall execute and deliver to each other copies of the Stock Option Agreement.

(c)    The Company shall have no obligation to sell any Purchased Stock to any person who (i) is a resident or citizen of a state or other jurisdiction in which the sale of the Common Stock to him or her would constitute a violation of the securities or “blue sky”






2


laws of such jurisdiction or (ii) is not an employee or director of the Company or its subsidiaries as of the date of such sale.

2.

Management Stockholder’s Representations, Warranties and Agreements .

(a)    The Management Stockholder agrees and acknowledges that he will not, directly or indirectly, offer, transfer, sell, assign, pledge, hypothecate or otherwise dispose of (any of the foregoing acts being referred to herein as a “ transfer ”) any shares of Purchased Stock and, at the time of exercise, Common Stock issuable upon exercise of Options (“ Option Stock ”; together with all Purchased Stock and any other Common Stock otherwise acquired and/or held by the Management Stockholder Entities as of or after the date hereof, “ Stock ”), except as otherwise provided for in this Section 2(a) below and Section 3 hereof.  If the Management Stockholder is an Affiliate of the Company, the Management Stockholder also agrees and acknowledges that he or she will not transfer any shares of the Stock unless:

(i)  the transfer is pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations in effect thereunder (the “ Act ”), and in compliance with applicable provisions of state securities laws; or

(ii)  (A) counsel for the Management Stockholder (which counsel shall be reasonably acceptable to the Company) shall have furnished the Company with an opinion or other advice, reasonably satisfactory in form and substance to the Company, that no such registration is required because of the availability of an exemption from registration under the Act and (B) if the Management Stockholder is a citizen or resident of any country other than the United States, or the Management Stockholder desires to effect any transfer in any such country, counsel for the Management Stockholder (which counsel shall be reasonably satisfactory to the Company) shall have furnished the Company with an opinion or other advice reasonably satisfactory in form and substance to the Company to the effect that such transfer will comply with the securities laws of such jurisdiction.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Company acknowledges and agrees that any of the following transfers of Stock are deemed to be in compliance with the Act and this Agreement (including without limitation any restrictions or prohibitions herein) and no opinion of counsel is required in connection therewith: (1) a transfer made pursuant to Sections 3, 4, 5, 6 or 9 hereof, (2) a transfer (x) upon the death or Disability of the Management Stockholder to the Management Stockholder’s Estate or (y) a transfer to the executors, administrators, testamentary trustees, legatees, immediate family members or beneficiaries of a person who has become a holder of Stock in accordance with the terms of this Agreement; provided that it is expressly understood that any such transferee shall be bound by the provisions of this Agreement, (3) a transfer made after the date hereof in compliance with the federal securities laws to a Management Stockholder’s Trust, provided that such transfer is made expressly subject to this Agreement and that the transferee agrees in writing to be bound by the terms and conditions hereof as a “Management Stockholder” with respect to the representations and warranties and other obligations of this Agreement, and provided further that it is expressly understood and agreed that if such Management Stockholder’s Trust at any point includes any person or entity other than the Management Stockholder, his spouse (or ex-spouse) or his lineal descendants (including adopted children) such that it fails to meet the definition thereof as set forth in Section 7(b) hereof, such transfer shall no longer be deemed in compliance with this Agreement and shall be subject to Section 3(d) below, (4) a transfer of Stock made by the Management Stockholder to Other Management Stockholders, provided that it is







3


expressly understood that any such transferee(s) shall be bound by the provisions of this Agreement (in addition to the provisions set forth in any Other Management Stockholders Agreement to which such Other Management Stockholders are a party), and (5) a transfer made by the Management Stockholder, with the Board’s approval, to the Company or any subsidiary of the Company.

(b)    The certificate (or certificates) representing the Stock, if any, shall bear the following legend:

“THE SHARES REPRESENTED BY THIS CERTIFICATE MAY NOT BE TRANSFERRED, SOLD, ASSIGNED, PLEDGED, HYPOTHECATED OR OTHERWISE DISPOSED OF UNLESS SUCH TRANSFER, SALE, ASSIGNMENT, PLEDGE, HYPOTHECATION OR OTHER DISPOSITION COMPLIES WITH THE PROVISIONS OF THE MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER’S AGREEMENT AMONG DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION (THE “COMPANY”), BUCK HOLDINGS, L.P., AND THE MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER NAMED ON THE FACE HEREOF OR THE SALE PARTICIPATION AGREEMENT AMONG SUCH MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER AND BUCK HOLDINGS, L.P., IN EACH CASE DATED AS OF [EFFECTIVE DATE] (COPIES OF WHICH ARE ON FILE WITH THE SECRETARY OF THE COMPANY) AND ALL APPLICABLE FEDERAL AND STATE SECURITIES LAWS.”

(c)    The Management Stockholder acknowledges that he has been advised that (i)  a restrictive legend in the form heretofore set forth shall be placed on the certificates (if any) representing the Stock and (ii) a notation shall be made in the appropriate records of the Company indicating that the Stock is subject to restrictions on transfer and appropriate stop transfer restrictions will be issued to the Company’s transfer agent, if any, with respect to the Stock.  

(d)    If any shares of the Stock are to be disposed of in accordance with Rule 144 under the Act or otherwise, the Management Stockholder shall promptly notify the Company of such intended disposition and shall deliver to the Company at or prior to the time of such disposition such documentation as the Company may reasonably request in connection with such sale and take any actions reasonably requested by the Coordination Committee prior to any such sale (provided that such instructions shall not have a disproportionate adverse impact on the Management Stockholder vis-á-vis any other shareholders of the Company or limited partners of Parent) and, in the case of a disposition pursuant to Rule 144, shall deliver to the Company an executed copy of any notice on Form 144 required to be filed with the SEC.

(e)    The Management Stockholder agrees that, if any shares of the Stock are offered to the public pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Act (other than registration of securities issued on Form S-8, S-4 or any successor or similar form), the Management Stockholder will not effect any public sale or distribution of any shares of the Stock not covered by such registration statement from the time of the receipt of a notice from the Company that the Company has filed or imminently intends to file such registration statement to, or within 180 days (or such shorter period as may be consented to by the managing underwriter or underwriters) in the case of the IPO and 90 days (or in an underwritten offering such shorter period as may be consented to by the managing underwriter or underwriters, if any) in the case of any other Public Offering after, the







4


effective date of such registration statement, unless otherwise agreed to in writing by the Company.

(f)    The Management Stockholder represents and warrants that (i) with respect to the Purchased Stock and Option Stock, the Management Stockholder has received and reviewed the available information relating to such Stock, including having received and reviewed the documents related thereto, certain of which documents set forth the rights, preferences and restrictions relating to the Options and the Stock underlying the Options and the Management Stockholder has relied solely on such information.

(g)    The Management Stockholder further represents and warrants that (i) the Management Stockholder’s financial condition is such that the Management Stockholder can afford to bear the economic risk of holding the Stock for an indefinite period of time and has adequate means for providing for the Management Stockholder’s current needs and personal contingencies, (ii) the Management Stockholder can afford to suffer a complete loss of his or her investment in the Stock, (iii) the Management Stockholder understands and has taken cognizance of all risk factors related to the purchase of the Stock, and (iv) the Management Stockholder’s knowledge and experience in financial and business matters are such that the Management Stockholder is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of the Management Stockholder’s purchase of the Stock as contemplated by this Agreement.

3.

Transferability of Stock .  

(a)    The Management Stockholder agrees that he or she will not transfer any shares of Stock at any time during the period commencing on the date hereof and ending on the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date; provided , however , that during such period, the Management Stockholder may transfer shares of Stock during such time pursuant to one of the following exceptions: (i) transfers permitted by Sections 5 or 6; (ii) transfers permitted by clauses (2), (3) and (4) of Section 2(a); (iii) a sale of shares of Common Stock pursuant to an effective registration statement under the Act filed by the Company upon the proper exercise of registration rights, if any, of such Management Stockholder under Section 9 (excluding any registration on Form S-8, S-4 or any successor or similar form); (iv) transfers permitted pursuant to the Sale Participation Agreement (as defined in Section 7(b));  (v) transfers permitted by the Board or (vi) transfers to Parent or its designee (any such exception, a “ Permitted Transfer ”).  In addition, during the period commencing on the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date through the earlier of a Change of Control or consummation of a Qualified Public Offering, the Management Stockholder may only transfer shares of Stock in compliance with Section 4.

(b)    Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, (i) Section 3(a) shall terminate and be of no further force or effect upon the occurrence of a Change in Control and (ii) upon the occurrence of any sale or other disposition of any percentage of limited partnership units of Parent held by the Sponsors or their Affiliates who are limited partners of Parent, the restrictions on transfer of shares of Common Stock contained in Section 3(a) shall cease to be of any further force or effect with respect to the percentage of shares of Common Stock held by the Management Stockholder Entities equal to the quotient of the number of limited partnership units of Parent sold or disposed of by the Sponsors or such Affiliates in such transaction divided by the aggregate number of Limited Partnership Units owned by the Sponsors or such Affiliates prior to such transaction, and for the avoidance of doubt, such transfer restrictions shall continue to apply to the remaining shares of Common Stock held by the Management Stockholder Entities.







5


(c)    No transfer of any such shares in violation hereof shall be made or recorded on the books of the Company and any such transfer shall be void ab initio and of no effect.

(d)    Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, Parent may, at any time and from time to time, waive the restrictions on transfers contained in Section 3(a), whether such waiver is made prior to or after the transferee has effected or committed to effect the transfer, or has notified Parent of such transfer or commitment to transfer.  Any transfers made pursuant to such waiver or which are later made subject to such a waiver shall, as of the date of the waiver and at all times thereafter, not be deemed to violate any applicable restrictions on transfers contained in this Agreement.

4.

Right of First Refusal .  (a)

If, at any time after the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date and prior to the earlier to occur of a Change of Control or consummation of a Qualified Public Offering, the Management Stockholder proposes to transfer any or all of the Management Stockholder’s Stock to a third party (any such third party, the “ROFR Transferee”) (other than any transfer pursuant to clauses (1), (2), (3), (4) or (5) of Section 2(a), to the extent made to a third party), the Management Stockholder shall notify the Company in writing of the Management Stockholder’s intention to transfer such Stock (such written notice, a “ROFR Notice”).  The ROFR Notice shall include a true and correct description of the number of shares of Stock to be transferred and the material terms of such proposed transfer and a copy of any proposed documentation to be entered into with any ROFR Transferee in respect of such transfer) and shall contain an irrevocable offer to sell such Stock to the Company or its designees (as provided below) (in the manner set forth below) at a purchase price equal to the minimum price at which the Management Stockholder proposes to transfer such Stock to any ROFR Transferee and on substantially the same terms and conditions as the proposed transfer.  At any time within twenty (20) days after the date of the receipt by the Company of the ROFR Notice, the Company shall have the right and option to purchase, or to arrange for a subsidiary, third party or Affiliate to purchase, all (but not less than all) of the shares of Stock proposed to be transferred to a ROFR Transferee, pursuant to Section 4(b).

(b)    The Company shall have the right and option to purchase, or to arrange for a subsidiary, third party or Affiliate to purchase, all of the shares of Stock proposed to be transferred to any ROFR Transferee at a purchase price equal to the minimum price at which the Management Stockholder proposes to transfer such Stock to any ROFR Transferee and otherwise on substantially the same terms and conditions as the proposed transfer (or, if the proposed transfer to any ROFR Transferee includes any consideration other than cash, then at the sole option of the Company, at the equivalent all cash price, determined in good faith by the Board), by delivering (i) a certified bank check or checks in the appropriate amount (or by wire transfer of immediately available funds, if the Management Stockholder Entities provide to the Company wire transfer instructions) and/or (ii) if the proposed transfer to any ROFR Transferee includes any consideration other than cash, any such non-cash consideration to be paid to the Management Stockholder at the principal office of the Company against delivery of certificates or other instruments representing the shares of Stock so purchased, appropriately endorsed by the Management Stockholder.  If at the end of the 20-day period, the Company has not tendered (or caused to be tendered) the purchase price for such shares in the manner set forth above, the Management Stockholder may, during the succeeding 60-day period, sell not less than all of the shares of Stock proposed to be transferred to any ROFR Transferee (subject to compliance with the other terms of this Agreement) on terms no less







6


favorable to the Management Stockholder than those contained in the ROFR Notice.  Promptly after such sale, the Management Stockholder shall notify the Company of the consummation thereof and shall furnish such evidence of the completion and time of completion of such sale and of the terms thereof as may reasonably be requested by the Company.  If, at the end of sixty (60) days following the expiration of the 20-day period during which the Company is entitled hereunder to purchase the Stock, the Management Stockholder has not completed the sale of such shares of the Stock as aforesaid, all of the restrictions on sale, transfer or assignment contained in this Agreement shall again be in effect with respect to such shares of the Stock.

(c)    Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, this Section 4 shall terminate and be of no further force or effect upon the earlier of occurrence of a Change in Control or a Qualified Public Offering.

5.

The Management Stockholder’s Right to Resell Stock and Options to the Company.

(a)    Except as otherwise provided herein, if, prior to the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date, the Management Stockholder’s employment with the Company (or, if applicable, any of its subsidiaries or affiliates) terminates as a result of the death or Disability of the Management Stockholder, then the applicable Management Stockholder Entity, shall, for 365 days (the “ Put Period ”) following the date of such termination for death or Disability, have the right to:

(i)  With respect to Stock, sell to the Company, and the Company shall be required to purchase, on one occasion, all of the shares of Stock then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities at a per share price equal to Fair Market Value on the Repurchase Calculation Date (the “ Section 5 Repurchase Price ”); and

(ii)  With respect to any outstanding vested Options, sell to the Company, and the Company shall be required to purchase, on one occasion, all of the vested Options then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities for an amount equal to the product of (x) the excess, if any, of the Section 5 Repurchase Price over the Option Exercise Price and (y) the number of Exercisable Option Shares, which Options shall be terminated in exchange for such payment.  In the event the Management Stockholder Entity elects to sell under this Section 5(a)(ii) and the foregoing Option Excess Price is zero or a negative number, all outstanding exercisable Options granted to the Management Stockholder shall be automatically terminated without any payment in respect thereof.  In addition, and for the avoidance of doubt, all unvested Options shall be terminated and cancelled without any payment therefor.

(b)    In the event the applicable Management Stockholder Entities intend to exercise their rights pursuant to Section 5(a), such Management Stockholder Entities shall send written notice to the Company, at any time during the Put Period, of their intention to sell shares of Stock in exchange for the payment referred to in Section 5(a)(i) and/or to sell such Options in exchange for the payment referred to in Section 5(a)(ii) and shall indicate the number of shares of Stock to be sold and the number of Options (based on the number of Exercisable Option Shares) to be sold with payment in respect thereof (the “ Redemption Notice ”).   The completion of the purchases shall take place at the principal office of the Company no later than the twentieth (20 th ) business day (such date to be determined by the







7


Company) after the giving of the Redemption Notice.  The applicable Repurchase Price (including any payment with respect to the Options as described above) shall be paid by delivery to the applicable Management Stockholder Entities, at the option of the Company, of a check or checks in the appropriate amount payable to the order of each of the applicable Management Stockholder Entities (or by wire transfer of immediately available funds, if the Management Stockholder Entities provide to the Company wire transfer instructions) against delivery of certificates or other instruments representing the Stock so purchased and appropriate documents cancelling the Options so terminated appropriately endorsed or executed by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities or any duly authorized representative.

(c)    Notwithstanding anything in this Section 5 to the contrary, if there exists and is continuing a default or an event of default on the part of the Company or any subsidiary of the Company under any loan, guarantee or other agreement under which the Company or any subsidiary of the Company has borrowed money or if the repurchase referred to in Section 5(a) (or Section 6 below, as the case may be) would result in a default or an event of default on the part of the Company or any affiliate of the Company under any such agreement or if a repurchase would reasonably be expected to be prohibited by the Tennessee Business Corporation Act (“ TBCA ”) or any federal or state securities laws or regulations (or if the Company reincorporates in another state, the business corporation law of such state) (each such occurrence being an “ Event ”), the Company shall not be obligated to repurchase any of the Stock or the Options from the applicable Management Stockholder Entities to the extent it would cause any such default or would be so prohibited by the Event for cash but instead, with respect to such portion with respect to which cash settlement is prohibited, may satisfy its obligations with respect to the Management Stockholder Entities’ exercise of their rights under Section 5(a) by delivering to the applicable Management Stockholder Entity a note with a principal amount equal to the amount payable under this Section 5 that was not paid in cash, having terms acceptable to the Company’s (and its affiliate’s, as applicable) lenders and permitted under the Company’s (and its affiliate’s, as applicable) debt instruments but which in any event: (i) shall be mandatorily repayable promptly and to the extent that an Event no longer prohibits the payment of cash to the applicable Management Stockholder Entity pursuant to this Agreement; and (ii) shall bear interest at a rate equal to the effective rate of interest in respect of the Company’s U.S. dollar-denominated subordinated public debt securities (including any original issue discount).  Notwithstanding the foregoing and subject to Section 5(d), if an Event exists and is continuing for ninety (90) days after the date of the Redemption Notice, the Management Stockholder Entities shall be permitted by written notice to rescind any Redemption Notice with respect to that portion of the Stock and Options repurchased by the Company from the Management Stockholder Entities pursuant to this Section 5 with the note described in the foregoing sentence, and such repurchase shall be rescinded; provided that, upon such rescission, such note shall be immediately canceled without any action on the part of the Company or the Management Stockholder Entities and, notwithstanding anything herein or in such note to the contrary, the Company shall have no obligation to pay any amounts of principal or interest thereunder.

(d)    Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, except for any payment obligation of the Company which has arisen prior to the occurrence of a Change in Control, this Section 5 shall terminate and be of no further force or effect upon the occurrence of such Change in Control.







8


6.

The Company’s Option to Purchase Stock and Options of the Management Stockholder Upon Certain Terminations of Employment.

(a)     Termination for Cause by the Company and other Call Events .  If, (i) prior to the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date, the Management Stockholder’s active employment with the Company (or, if applicable, its subsidiaries or affiliates) is terminated by the Company (or, if applicable, its subsidiaries or affiliates) for Cause or (ii) the Management Stockholder Entities effect a transfer of Stock (or Options) that is prohibited under this Agreement (or the Stock Option Agreements, as applicable), after notice from the Company of such impermissible transfer and a reasonable opportunity to cure such transfer which is not so cured (each event described above, a “ Section 6(a) Call Event ”), then:

(i)  With respect to Stock, the Company may purchase, on one occasion, all or any portion of the shares of Stock then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities at a per share purchase price equal to the lesser of (x) Base Price (or other applicable price paid by such Management Stockholder Entities for such Stock) and (y) the Fair Market Value on the Repurchase Calculation Date; and

(ii)  with respect to all Options, all Options shall be automatically terminated without any payment in respect thereof upon the occurrence of the Section 6(a) Call Event.

(b)     Termination without Cause by the Company (other than due to his death or Disability), and Termination by the Management Stockholder with Good Reason .  If, prior to the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date, the Management Stockholder’s active employment with the Company (or, if applicable, its subsidiaries or affiliates) is terminated (i) by the Company (or, if applicable, its subsidiaries or affiliates) without Cause (which shall constitute any termination without Cause under any applicable employment agreement) (other than due to his death or Disability), or (ii) by the Management Stockholder with Good Reason (each, a “ Section 6(b) Call Event ”) then:

(i)  With respect to Stock, the Company may purchase all or any portion of the shares of such Stock then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities at a per share purchase price equal to Fair Market Value on the Repurchase Calculation Date;

(ii)  With respect to any vested Options, the Company may purchase, on one occasion, all or any portion of the exercisable vested Options held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities for an amount equal to the product of (x) the excess, if any, of the Fair Market Value on the Repurchase Calculation Date of a share of Stock underlying such Options over the Option Exercise Price and (y) the number of Exercisable Option Shares (solely related to vested Options), which vested Options shall be terminated in exchange for such payment.  In the event the Company elects to repurchase under this Section 6(b)(ii) and the foregoing Option Excess Price is zero or a negative number, all outstanding exercisable vested Options shall be automatically terminated without any payment in respect thereof; and

(iii)  With respect to unvested Options, all outstanding unvested Options shall automatically be terminated without any payment in respect thereof.







9


(c)     Termination for Death or Disability .  if, prior to the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date, the Management Stockholder’s employment with the Company (or, if applicable, its subsidiaries or affiliates) is terminated as a result of the death or Disability of the Management Stockholder (each a “ Section 6(c) Call Event ”), then:

(i)  With respect to Stock, the Company may purchase, on one occasion, all or any portion of the shares of such Stock then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities at a per share purchase price equal to Fair Market Value on the Repurchase Calculation Date;

(ii)  With respect to any vested Options, the Company may purchase, on one occasion, all or any portion of the exercisable vested Options held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities for an amount equal to the product of (x) the excess, if any, of the Fair Market Value on the Repurchase Calculation Date of a share of Stock underlying such Options over the Option Exercise Price and (y) the number of Exercisable Option Shares (solely related to vested Options), which vested Options shall be terminated in exchange for such payment.  In the event the Company elects to repurchase under this Section 6(c)(ii) and the foregoing Option Excess Price is zero or a negative number, all outstanding exercisable vested Options shall be automatically terminated without any payment in respect thereof; and

(iii)  With respect to unvested Options, all outstanding unvested Options shall automatically be terminated without any payment in respect thereof.

(d)     Termination by the Management Stockholder without Good Reason .  If, prior to the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date, the Management Stockholder’s active employment by the Company (and/or, if applicable, its subsidiaries or affiliates) is terminated by the Management Stockholder without Good Reason (a “ Section 6(d) Call Event ”), then:

(i)  With respect to any Purchased Stock, the Company may purchase, on one occasion, all or any portion of the shares of such Purchased Stock then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities at a per share purchase price equal to the lesser of (x) the Fair Market Value and (y) the sum of (A) the Base Price (or other applicable price paid by such Management Stockholder Entities for such Purchased Stock), plus (B) the Applicable Percentage of the excess of the Fair Market Value over the Base Price (or other applicable price paid by such Management Stockholder Entities for such Purchased Stock), as of the Repurchase Calculation Date;

(ii)  With respect to any Option Stock, the Company may purchase, on one occasion, all or any portion of the shares of such Stock then held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities at a per share purchase price equal to the lesser of (x) the Fair Market Value as of the Repurchase Calculation Date and (y) the applicable per share purchase price paid by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities for such Stock; and

(iii)  With respect to the Options, all such Options (whether or not then exercisable) held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities shall automatically be terminated without any payment in respect thereof.

(e)     Call Notice .  The Company shall have a period (the “ Call Period ”) of one hundred eighty (180) days from the date of any Call Event (or, if later, with respect to a







10


Section 6(a) Call Event, the date after discovery of, and the applicable cure period for, an impermissible transfer constituting a Section 6(a) Call Event) in which to give notice in writing to the Management Stockholder of its election to exercise its rights and obligations pursuant to this Section 6 (“ Repurchase Notice ”).  The completion of the purchases pursuant to the foregoing shall take place at the principal office of the Company no later than the fifteenth (15 th ) business day after the giving of the Repurchase Notice.  The applicable Repurchase Price (including any payment with respect to the Options as described in this Section 6) shall be paid by delivery to the applicable Management Stockholder Entities of a check or checks in the appropriate amount payable to the order of each of the applicable Management Stockholder Entities (or by wire transfer of immediately available funds, if the Management Stockholder Entities provide to the Company wire transfer instructions) against delivery of certificates or other instruments representing the Stock so purchased and appropriate documents canceling the Options so terminated, appropriately endorsed or executed by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities or any duly authorized representative.

(f)     Use of Note to Satisfy Call Payment .  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section 6 to the contrary, if there exists and is continuing any Event, the Company will, to the extent it has exercised its rights to purchase Stock or Options pursuant to this Section 6, in order to complete the purchase of any Stock or Options pursuant to this Section 6, deliver to the applicable Management Stockholder Entities (i) a cash payment for any amounts payable pursuant to this Section 6 that would not cause an Event and (ii) a note having the same terms as that provided in Section 5(c) above with a principal amount equal to the amount payable but not paid in cash pursuant to this Section 6 due to the Event.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, if an Event exists and is continuing for ninety (90) days from the date of the Call Event, the Management Stockholder Entities shall be permitted by written notice to cause the Company to rescind any Repurchase Notice with respect to that portion of the Stock and Options repurchased by the Company from the Management Stockholder Entities pursuant to this Section 6 with the note described in the foregoing sentence, provided that, upon such rescission, such repurchase shall be immediately rescinded and such note shall be immediately canceled without any action on the part of the Company or the Management Stockholder Entities and, notwithstanding anything herein or in such note to the contrary, the Company shall have no obligation to pay any amounts of principal or interest thereunder.

(g)     Effect of Change in Control .  Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, except for any payment obligation of the Company which has arisen prior to the occurrence of a Change in Control, this Section 6 shall terminate and be of no further force or effect upon the occurrence of such Change in Control.

7.

Adjustment of Repurchase Price; Definitions.

(a)     Adjustment of Repurchase Price .  In determining the applicable repurchase price of the Stock and Options, as provided for in Sections 5 and 6, above, appropriate adjustments shall be made for any stock dividends, splits, combinations, recapitalizations or any other adjustment in the number of outstanding shares of Stock in order to maintain, as nearly as practicable, the intended operation of the provisions of Sections 5 and 6.







11


(b)     Definitions .  All capitalized terms used in this Agreement and not defined herein shall have such meaning as such terms are defined in the Option Plan.  Terms used herein and as listed below shall be defined as follows:

Act ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(a)(i) hereof.

Affiliate ” means with respect to any Person, any entity directly or indirectly controlling, controlled by or under common control with such Person; provided , however , for purposes of this Agreement, Buck Holdings Co-Invest, LP, shall not be deemed to be an Affiliate of the Sponsor.

Agreement ” shall have the meaning set forth in the introductory paragraph.

Applicable Percentage ” shall mean:  (i) 20% on or after the first anniversary of the Grant Date; (ii) 40% on and after the second anniversary of the Grant Date; (iii) 60% on and after the third anniversary of the Grant Date; (iv) 80% on and after the fourth anniversary of the Grant Date; and (v) 100% on and after the fifth anniversary of the Grant Date.

Base Price ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 1(a) hereof.

Board ” shall mean the board of directors of the Company.

Call Events ” shall mean, collectively, Section 6(a) Call Events, Section 6(b) Call Events, Section 6(c) Call Events and Section 6(d) Call Events.

Call Notice ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6(e) hereof.

Call Period ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6(e) hereof.

Cause ” shall mean “Cause” as such term may be defined in any employment agreement or change in control agreement in effect at the time of termination of employment between the Management Stockholder and the Company or any of its subsidiaries or Affiliates; or, if there is no such employment or change in control agreement, “Cause” shall mean, with respect to the Management Stockholder: (i) any act involving fraud or dishonesty, or any willful failure to perform reasonable duties assigned to him or her which continues beyond ten (10) business days after a written demand for substantial performance is delivered to the Management Stockholder by the Company; (ii) any material breach of any securities or other law or regulation or any Company policy governing trading or dealing with stock, securities, investments or the like or with inappropriate disclosure or “tipping” relating to any stock, securities or investments or the like; (iii) other than as required by law, the carrying out of any activity or making any public statement which prejudices or ridicules the good name and standing of the Company or its Affiliates (including any limited partner of Parent) or would bring such persons into public contempt or ridicule; (iv) attendance at work in a state of intoxication or otherwise being found in possession at the place of work of any prohibited drug or substance, possession of which would amount to a criminal offense; (v) any assault or other act of violence; or (vi) indictment from any crime constituting (x) a felony whatsoever or (y) any misdemeanor that would preclude employment under the Company’s hiring policy.  

Change in Control ” shall mean, in one or a series of related transactions, (i) the sale of all or substantially all of the assets of Buck Holdings, L.P. or the Company and its subsidiaries to any person (or group of persons acting in concert), other than to (x) investment







12


funds affiliated with Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P. (the “ Sponsor ”) or its Affiliates or (y) any employee benefit plan (or trust forming a part thereof) maintained by the Company, the Sponsor or their respective Affiliates or other person of which a majority of its voting power or other equity securities is owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company, the Sponsor or their respective Affiliates; or (ii) a merger, recapitalization or other sale by the Company, the Sponsor (indirectly) or any of their respective Affiliates, to a person (or group of persons acting in concert) of Common Stock or other voting securities of the Company that results in more than 50% of the Common Stock or other voting securities of the Company (or any resulting company after a merger) being held, directly or indirectly,  by a person (or group of persons acting in concert) that is not Controlled by (x) the Sponsor or its Affiliates or (y) an employee benefit plan (or trust forming a part thereof) maintained by the Company, the Sponsor or their respective Affiliates or other person of which a majority of its voting power or other equity securities is owned, directly or indirectly, by the Company, the Sponsor or their respective Affiliates; in any event, which results in the Sponsor and its Affiliates or such employee benefit plan ceasing to hold the ability to elect (or cause to be elected) a majority of the members of the Board.

Closing Date ” shall mean July 6, 2007.

Common Stock ” shall mean the issued and outstanding shares of the Company’s common stock, par value $0.50 per share.

Company ” shall have the meaning set forth in the introductory paragraph.

Confidential Information ” shall mean all non-public information concerning trade secret, know-how, software, developments, inventions, processes, technology, designs, the financial data, strategic business plans or any proprietary or confidential information, documents or materials in any form or media, including any of the foregoing relating to research, operations, finances, current and proposed products and services, vendors, customers, advertising and marketing, and other non-public, proprietary, and confidential information of the Restricted Group.

Controlled by ” with respect to the relationship between or among two or more Persons, means the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the affairs or management of a Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by contract or otherwise, including the ownership, directly or indirectly, of securities having the power to elect a majority of the board of directors or similar body governing the affairs of such Person.

Coordination Committee ” shall have the meaning set forth in the Partnership Agreement.

Disability ” shall mean “Disability” as such term is defined in any employment agreement between the Management Stockholder and the Company or any of its Subsidiaries, or, if there is no such employment agreement, shall mean “Disability” as defined in the Option Plan.

 “ Event ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(c) hereof.

Exchange Act ” shall mean the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (or any successor act or relevant section thereto).







13


Exercisable Option Shares ” shall mean the shares of Common Stock that, at the time that the Redemption Notice or Repurchase Notice is delivered (as applicable), could be purchased by the Management Stockholder upon exercise of his or her outstanding and exercisable Options.

Fair Market Value ” shall mean the fair market value of one share of Common Stock on any given date, as determined reasonably and in good faith by the Board (after consultation with the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer of the Company in the case of put and call rights set forth in Sections 5 and 6 of this Agreement), determined without regard to any discount for minority interest and transfer restrictions imposed on the Common Stock of the Management Stockholder Entities.

Good Reason ” shall mean “Good Reason” as such term may be defined in any employment agreement or change-in-control agreement in effect at the time of termination of employment between the Management Stockholder and the Company or any of its subsidiaries or Affiliates, or, if there is no such employment or change-in-control agreement, “Good Reason” shall mean, with respect to the Management Stockholder: (i) a reduction in base salary or target bonus level; or (ii) the relocation of the Management Stockholder’s principal place of employment to a site outside of a twenty-five mile radius from the site of such Management Stockholder’s principal place of employment prior to such relocation; provided , however , that any isolated, insubstantial and inadvertent failure by the Company that is not in bad faith and is cured within ten (10) business days after the Management Stockholder gives the Company written notice of any such event set forth above, shall not constitute Good Reason.

Group ” shall mean “group,” as such term is used for purposes of Section 13(d) or 14(d) of the Exchange Act.

Investors ” shall mean, collectively, the KKR 2006 Fund L.P. and its affiliated investment funds, KKR PEI Investments, L.P., GS Capital Partners VI Fund, L.P., GS Capital Partners VI Parallel, L.P., GS Capital Partners VI GmbH& Co. KG, GS Capital Partners VI Offshore Fund, L.P. and Goldman Sachs DGC Investors, L.P., Citigroup Capital Partners II Employee Master Fund, L.P., Citigroup Capital Partners II 2007 Citigroup Investment, L.P., Citigroup Capital Partners II Onshore, L.P., Citigroup Capital Partners II Cayman Holdings, L.P. and CPE Co-Investment (Dollar General LLC) and certain other investors in Parent.

Management Stockholder ” shall have the meaning set forth in the introductory paragraph.

Management Stockholder Entities ” shall mean the Management Stockholder’s Trust, the Management Stockholder and the Management Stockholder’s Estate, collectively.

Management Stockholder’s Estate ” shall mean the conservators, guardians, executors, administrators, testamentary trustees, legatees or beneficiaries of the Management Stockholder.

Management Stockholder’s Trust ” shall mean a partnership, limited liability company, corporation, trust, private foundation or custodianship, the beneficiaries of which may include only the Management Stockholder, his or her spouse (or ex-spouse) or his or her lineal descendants (including adopted) or, if at any time after any such transfer there shall be







14


no then living spouse or lineal descendants, then to the ultimate beneficiaries of any such trust or to the estate of a deceased beneficiary.

Options ” shall have the meaning set forth in the first “whereas” paragraph.

Option Excess Price ” shall mean the aggregate amount paid or payable by the Company in respect of Exercisable Option Shares, as determined pursuant to Section 5 or 6 hereof, as applicable.

Option Exercise Price ” shall mean the then-current exercise price of the shares of Common Stock covered by the applicable Option.

Option Plan ” shall have the meaning set forth in the first “whereas” paragraph.

Option Stock ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(a) hereof.

Other Management Stockholders ” shall have the meaning set forth in the second “whereas” paragraph.

Other Management Stockholders Agreements ” shall have the meaning set forth in the second “whereas” paragraph.

Parent ” shall have the meaning set forth in the introductory paragraph.

Parties ” shall have the meaning set forth in the introductory paragraph.

Partnership Agreement ” shall mean the Amended and Restated Partnership Agreement of Buck Holdings, L.P., as it may be amended, modified, restated or supplemented from time to time

Permitted Transfer ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 3(a).

Person ” shall mean “person,” as such term is used for purposes of Section 13(d) or 14(d) of the Exchange Act.

Piggyback Notice ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 9(b) hereof.

Piggyback Registration Rights ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 9(a) hereof.

Proposed Registration ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 9(b) hereof.

Public Offering ” shall mean the sale of shares of Common Stock to the public subsequent to the date hereof pursuant to a registration statement under the Act which has been declared effective by the SEC (other than a registration statement on Form S-4, S-8 or any other similar form).

Purchased Stock ” shall have the meaning set forth in the first “whereas” paragraph.

Put Period ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(a) hereof.

Qualified Public Offering ” shall mean the initial Public Offering (i) for which cash proceeds to be received by the Company (or any successor thereto) from such offering (or







15


series of related offerings) (without deducting underwriter discounts, expenses and commissions) are at least $400,000,000, or (ii) pursuant to which at least 35% of the outstanding shares of Common Stock are sold by the Company (or any successor thereto).

Redemption Notice ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(b) hereof.

Registration Rights Agreement ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 9(a) hereof.

Repurchase Calculation Date ” shall mean (i) prior to the occurrence of a Public Offering, the last day of the month preceding the month in which date of repurchase occurs, and (ii) on and after the occurrence of a Public Offering, the closing trading price on the date immediately preceding the date of repurchase.

Repurchase Notice ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 6(e) hereof.

Repurchase Price ” shall mean the amount to be paid in respect of the Stock and Options to be purchased by the Company pursuant to Section 5 and Section 6, as applicable.

Request ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 9(b) hereof.

Restricted Group ” shall mean, collectively, the Company, its subsidiaries, the Investors and their respective affiliates.

ROFR Notice ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4(a) hereof.

ROFR Transferee ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4(a) hereof.

Sale Participation Agreement ” shall mean that certain sale participation agreement entered into by and between the Management Stockholder and Parent dated as of the date hereof.

SEC ” shall mean the Securities and Exchange Commission.

Senior Management Stockholder ” shall mean any of the Management Stockholders or Other Management Stockholders whose job grade level is Vice President or above and who has been designated as such on Schedule I hereto or the corresponding schedule of the Other Management Stockholders Agreements, as applicable.

Stock ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(a) hereof.

Stock Option Agreements ” shall have the meaning set forth in the first “whereas” paragraph.

TBCA ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 5(c) hereof.

transfer ” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2(a) hereof.

8.

The Company’s Representations and Warranties and Covenants .

(a)    The Company represents and warrants to the Management Stockholder that (i) this Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and delivered by the Company and







16


is enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms and (ii) the Stock, when issued and delivered in accordance with the terms hereof and the other agreements contemplated hereby, will be duly and validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable.

(b)    If the Company is or becomes subject to the reporting requirements of Section 12 of the Exchange Act, the Company will file the reports required to be filed by it under the Act and the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations adopted by the SEC thereunder, to the extent required from time to time to enable the Management Stockholder to sell shares of Stock, subject to compliance with the provisions hereof (including requirements of the Coordination Committee of Parent or the Company) without registration under the Exchange Act within the limitations of the exemptions provided by (A) Rule 144 under the Act, as such Rule may be amended from time to time, or (B) any similar rule or regulation hereafter adopted by the SEC.  Notwithstanding anything contained in this Section 8(b), the Company may de-register under Section 12 of the Exchange Act if it is then permitted to do so pursuant to the Exchange Act and the rules and regulations thereunder and, in such circumstances, shall not be required hereby to file any reports which may be necessary in order for Rule 144 or any similar rule or regulation under the Act to be available.  Nothing in this Section 8(b) shall be deemed to limit in any manner the restrictions on transfers of Stock contained in this Agreement.

(c)

The Company will not agree to any amendment of the terms of the credit agreement entered into on the Closing Date, or to any corresponding provision in any successor or equivalent debt agreement, that imposes any limits on the Company's permission thereunder to repurchase stock, or make payments on any note, in each case under Section 5(c) or 6(e) of this Agreement, that are materially more restrictive than such provision under such credit agreement as in effect on the Closing Date if, at or prior to the time of such agreement, restrictions corresponding and proportionate thereto have not also been imposed thereunder on the payment of cash dividends on the Common Stock.


9.

“Piggyback” Registration Rights .  Effective after the occurrence of an initial Public Offering:

(a)    The Parties agree to be bound, with respect to Senior Management Stockholders or to any other Management Stockholder who are provided such rights pursuant to this Section 9, by all of the terms, conditions and obligations of the Registration Rights Agreement (the “ Registration Rights Agreement ”) as they relate to the exercise of piggyback registration rights as provided in Sections 4, 6, 7, 8 and 11 (but not Section 11(l)) of the Registration Rights Agreement entered into by and among the Company and investors party thereto (the “ Piggyback Registration Rights ”), as in effect on the date hereof (subject, with respect to any such Management Stockholder expressly provided Piggyback Registration Rights, only to any amendments thereto to which such Management Stockholder has agreed in writing to be bound), and, if any of the Investors are selling stock, shall have all of the rights and privileges of the Piggyback Registration Rights (including, without limitation, the right to participate in the initial Public Offering and any rights to indemnification and/or contribution from the Company and/or the Investors), in each case as if the Management Stockholder were an original party (other than the Company) to the Registration Rights Agreement, subject to applicable and customary underwriter restrictions; provided , however , that at no time shall the Management Stockholder have any rights to request registration under Section 3 of the Registration Rights Agreement.  All Stock purchased or held by the







17


applicable Management Stockholder Entities pursuant to this Agreement shall be deemed to be “ Registrable Securities” as defined in the Registration Rights Agreement.

(b)    In the event of a sale of Common Stock by any of the Investors in accordance with the terms of the Registration Rights Agreement, the Company will promptly notify each Senior Management Stockholder or other Management Stockholder to whom the Board, after consultation with the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer of the Company, has decided to extend the Piggyback Registration Rights, in writing (a “ Piggyback Notice ”) of any proposed registration (a “ Proposed Registration ”), which Piggyback Notice shall include: the principal terms and conditions of the proposed registration, including (A) the number of the shares of Common Stock to be sold, (B) the fraction expressed as a percentage, determined by dividing the number of shares of Common Stock to be sold by the holders of Registrable Securities by the total number of shares held by the holders of Registrable Securities selling the shares of Common Stock, (C) the proposed per share purchase price (or an estimate thereof), and (D) the proposed date of sale.  If within fifteen (15) days of the receipt by the Management Stockholder or Management Stockholder, as the case may be, of such Piggyback Notice, the Company receives from the applicable Management Stockholder Entities of the Senior Management Stockholder or Management Stockholder, as the case may be, a written request (a “ Request ”) to register shares of Stock held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities (which Request will be irrevocable unless otherwise mutually agreed to in writing by the Senior Management Stockholder or Management Stockholder, if any, and the Company), shares of Stock will be so registered as provided in this Section 9; provided , however , that for each such registration statement only one Request, which shall be executed by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities, may be submitted for all Registrable Securities held by the applicable Management Stockholder Entities.

(c)    The maximum number of shares of Stock which will be registered pursuant to a Request will be the lowest of (i) the number of shares of Stock then held by the Management Stockholder Entities, including all shares of Stock which the Management Stockholder Entities are then entitled to acquire under an unexercised Option to the extent then exercisable, multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the aggregate number of shares of Stock being sold by holders of Registrable Securities and the denominator of which is the aggregate number of shares of Stock owned by the holders of Registrable Securities or (ii) the maximum number of shares of Stock which the Company can register in connection with such Request in the Proposed Registration without adverse effect on the offering in the view of the managing underwriters (reduced pro rata as more fully described in subsection (d) of this Section 9 or (iii) the maximum number of shares which the Senior Management Stockholder (pro rata based upon the aggregate number of shares of Stock the Senior Management Stockholder and all Other Management Stockholders who are Senior Management Stockholders have requested to be registered) is permitted to register under the Piggyback Registration Rights.

(d)    If a Proposed Registration involves an underwritten offering and the managing underwriter advises the Company in writing that, in its opinion, the number of shares of Stock requested to be included in the Proposed Registration exceeds the number which can be sold in such offering, so as to be likely to have an adverse effect on the price, timing or distribution of the shares of Stock offered in such Public Offering as contemplated by the Company, then, unless the managing underwriter advises that marketing factors require a different allocation, the Company will include in the Proposed Registration (i) first,







18


100% of the shares of Stock the Company proposes to sell and (ii) second, to the extent of the number of shares of Stock requested to be included in such registration which, in the opinion of such managing underwriter, can be sold without having the adverse effect referred to above, the number of shares of Stock which the selling holders of Registrable Securities, the Senior Management Stockholder and all Other Management Stockholders who are Senior Management Stockholders and any other Persons who are entitled to piggyback or incidental registration rights in respect of Stock (together, the “ Holders ”) have requested to be included in the Proposed Registration, such amount to be allocated pro rata among all requesting Holders on the basis of the relative number of shares of Stock then held by each such Holder (including upon exercise of all exercisable Options) ( provided that any shares thereby allocated to any such Holder that exceed such Holder’s request will be reallocated among the remaining requesting Holders in like manner).

(e)    Upon delivering a Request a Senior Management Stockholder or other Management Stockholder having Piggyback Registration Rights pursuant to clause (b) of this Section 9 will, if requested by the Company, execute and deliver a custody agreement and power of attorney having customary terms and in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Company with respect to the shares of Stock to be registered pursuant to this Section 9 (a “ Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney ”).  The Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney will provide, among other things, that the Senior Management Stockholder or Management Stockholder, as the case may be, will deliver to and deposit in custody with the custodian and attorney-in-fact named therein a certificate or certificates (to the extent applicable) representing such shares of Stock (duly endorsed in blank by the registered owner or owners thereof or accompanied by duly executed stock powers in blank) and irrevocably appoint said custodian and attorney-in-fact as the Senior Management Stockholder’s or Management Stockholder’s agent and attorney-in-fact with full power and authority to act under the Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney on the Senior Management Stockholder’s or Management Stockholder’s behalf with respect to the matters specified therein.

(f)    The Management Stockholder agrees that he will execute such other agreements as the Company may reasonably request to further evidence the provisions of this Section 9, including reasonable and customary lock-up agreements; provided that Parent and its Affiliates enter into a similar agreement if requested by the managing underwriter.

(g)    Notwithstanding Section 11(l) of the Registration Rights Agreement, this Section 9 will terminate on the earlier of (i) the occurrence of a Change in Control and (ii) with respect to each Management Stockholder, on the date on which such Management Stockholder ceases to own any Registrable Securities.

10.

Additional Rights of Management Stockholders .  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in the event that the Company receives notice of any event giving rise to any of the tag-along or piggyback registration rights set forth in Section 9 hereof or in the Sale Participation Agreement, in each such case with respect to a Senior Management Stockholder, the Board shall promptly (and in event within such period of time to allow the Management Stockholder to exercise such right, if applicable) after being informed of such notice consult with the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer of the Company to determine whether and to what extent any such rights shall be granted to the Management Stockholder and the Other Management Stockholders who are not Senior Management Stockholders.  Any such grant shall be effective upon, and to the extent set forth in, any applicable resolution passed by the Board, and the Company shall give







19


prompt notice to the Management Stockholder and the Other Management Stockholders of the adoption thereof.

11.

Rights to Negotiate Repurchase Price .  Nothing in this Agreement shall be deemed to restrict or prohibit the Company from purchasing, redeeming or otherwise acquiring for value shares of Stock or Options from the Management Stockholder, at any time, upon such terms and conditions, and for such price, as may be mutually agreed upon in writing between the Parties, whether or not at the time of such purchase, redemption or acquisition circumstances exist which specifically grant the Company the right to purchase, or the Management Stockholder the right to sell, shares of Stock or any Options under the terms of this Agreement; provided that no such purchase, redemption or acquisition shall be consummated, and no agreement with respect to any such purchase, redemption or acquisition shall be entered into, without the prior approval of the Board.

12.

Notice of Change of Beneficiary .  Immediately prior to any transfer of Stock to a Management Stockholder’s Trust, the Management Stockholder shall provide the Company with a copy of the instruments creating the Management Stockholder’s Trust and with the identity of the beneficiaries of the Management Stockholder’s Trust.  The Management Stockholder shall notify the Company as soon as practicable prior to any change in the identity of any beneficiary of the Management Stockholder’s Trust.

13.

Recapitalizations, etc.  The provisions of this Agreement shall apply, to the full extent set forth herein with respect to the Stock or the Options, to any and all shares of capital stock of the Company or any capital stock, partnership units or any other security evidencing ownership interests in any successor or assign of the Company (whether by merger, consolidation, sale of assets or otherwise) which may be issued in respect of, in exchange for, or substitution of the Stock or the Options by reason of any stock dividend, split, reverse split, combination, recapitalization, liquidation, reclassification, merger, consolidation or otherwise.

14.

Management Stockholder’s Employment by the Company .  Nothing contained in this Agreement or in any other agreement entered into by the Company and the Management Stockholder contemporaneously with the execution of this Agreement (i) obligates the Company or any subsidiary of the Company to employ the Management Stockholder in any capacity whatsoever or (ii) prohibits or restricts the Company (or any such subsidiary) from terminating the employment of the Management Stockholder at any time or for any reason whatsoever, with or without Cause, and the Management Stockholder hereby acknowledges and agrees that neither the Company nor any other person has made any representations or promises whatsoever to the Management Stockholder concerning the Management Stockholder’s employment or continued employment by the Company or any subsidiary of the Company.

15.

Binding Effect .  The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and accrue to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective heirs, legal representatives, successors and assigns.  In the case of a transferee permitted under Section 2(a) or Section 3(a) (other than clauses (iii) or (iv) thereof) hereof, such transferee shall be deemed the Management Stockholder hereunder; provided , however , that no transferee (including without limitation, transferees referred to in Section 2(a) or Section 3(a) hereof) shall derive any rights under this Agreement unless and until such transferee has delivered to the Company a valid undertaking and becomes bound by the terms of this Agreement.  No







20


provision of this Agreement is intended to or shall confer upon any Person other than the Parties any rights or remedies hereunder or with respect hereto.

16.

Amendment .  This Agreement may be amended by the Company at any time upon notice to the Management Stockholder thereof; provided that any amendment (i) that materially disadvantages the Management Stockholder shall not be effective unless and until the Management Stockholder has consented thereto in writing and (ii) that disadvantages a class of stockholders in more than a de minimis way but less than a material way shall require the consent of a majority of the equity interests held by such affected class of stockholders.

17.

Closing .  Except as otherwise provided herein, the closing of each purchase and sale of shares of Stock pursuant to this Agreement shall take place at the principal office of the Company on the tenth business day following delivery of the notice by either Party to the other of its exercise of the right to purchase or sell such Stock hereunder.

18.

Applicable Law; Jurisdiction; Arbitration; Legal Fees .

(a)    The laws of the State of Tennessee applicable to contracts executed and to be performed entirely in such state shall govern the interpretation, validity and performance of the terms of this Agreement.

(b)    In the event of any controversy among the parties hereto arising out of, or relating to, this Agreement which cannot be settled amicably by the parties, such controversy shall be finally, exclusively and conclusively settled by mandatory arbitration conducted expeditiously in accordance with the American Arbitration Association rules by a single independent arbitrator.  Such arbitration process shall take place in Nashville, TN.  The decision of the arbitrator shall be final and binding upon all parties hereto and shall be rendered pursuant to a written decision, which contains a detailed recital of the arbitrator’s reasoning.  Judgment upon the award rendered may be entered in any court having jurisdiction thereof.

(c)    Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Management Stockholder acknowledges and agrees that the Company, its subsidiaries, the Investors and any of their respective affiliates shall be entitled to injunctive or other relief in order to enforce the covenant not to compete, covenant not to solicit and/or confidentiality covenants as set forth in Section 22(a) of this Agreement.

(d)    In the event of any arbitration or other disputes with regard to this Agreement or any other document or agreement referred to herein, each Party shall pay its own legal fees and expenses, unless otherwise determined by the arbitrator.    

19.

Assignability of Certain Rights by the Company .  The Company shall have the right to assign any or all of its rights or obligations to purchase shares of Stock pursuant to Sections 4, 5 and 6 hereof; provided , however , that no such assignment shall relieve the Company from its obligations hereunder.

20.

Miscellaneous .

(a)    In this Agreement all references to “dollars” or “$” are to United States dollars and the masculine pronoun shall include the feminine and neuter, and the singular the plural, where the context so indicates.







21


(b)    If any provision of this Agreement shall be declared illegal, void or unenforceable by any court of competent jurisdiction, the other provisions shall not be affected, but shall remain in full force and effect.

21.

Withholding .  The Company or its subsidiaries shall have the right to deduct from any cash payment made under this Agreement to the applicable Management Stockholder Entities any federal, state or local income or other taxes required by law to be withheld with respect to such payment, if applicable.

22.

Notices .  All notices and other communications provided for herein shall be in writing.  Any notice or other communication hereunder shall be deemed duly given (i) upon electronic confirmation of facsimile, (ii) one (1) business day following the date sent when sent by overnight delivery and (iii) five (5) business days following the date mailed when mailed by registered or certified mail return receipt requested and postage prepaid, in each case as follows:

(a)    If to the Company, to it at the following address:

Dollar General Corporation
100 Mission Ridge
Goodlettsville, TN  37072
Attention:  General Counsel
Telecopy:  (615) 855-5180


with copies to:

Kohlberg Kravis Roberts & Co. L.P.

2800 Sand Hill Road, Suite 200

Menlo Park, CA 94025
Attention:  Michael Calbert
Telecopy:  (650) 233-6553


and


Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
425 Lexington Avenue
New York, New York 10017
Attention:  David J. Sorkin, Esq.

                  Marni J. Lerner, Esq.

Telecopy:  (212) 455-2502

(b)    If to the Management Stockholder, to the Management Stockholder at the address set forth below under the Management Stockholder’s signature;

or at such other address as either party shall have specified by notice in writing to the other.

23.

Confidential Information; Covenant Not to Compete; Covenant Not to Solicit .

(a)    In consideration of the Company entering into this Agreement with the Management Stockholder, unless there exists any covenant that pertains to the same subject matter as set forth in this Section 23 in any employment agreement or change in control







22


agreement in effect at the time of termination of employment between the Management Stockholder and the Company or any of its subsidiaries or Affiliates (the “Existing Restrictive Covenants”), in which case such covenants shall supersede the covenants contained in this Section 23; then the Management Stockholder shall be subject to the covenants contained in this Section 23:

(i) 

at any time during or after the Management Stockholder’s employment with the Company or its subsidiaries, disclose any Confidential Information pertaining to the business of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of the Investors or any of their respective Affiliates, except when required to perform his or her duties to the Company or one of its subsidiaries, by law or judicial process;

(ii) 

at any time during the Management Stockholder’s employment with the Company or its subsidiaries and for the lesser period of (a) the period during which the Management Stockholder receives severance payments and benefits pursuant to the Dollar General Corporation Severance Plan and Summary Plan Description, as it may be amended from time to time and (b) six (6) months after the Management Stockholder’s termination of employment , directly or indirectly, act as a proprietor, investor director, officer, employee, substantial stockholder, consultant, or partner in any of the following businesses in any geographic area where the Company or its Affiliates manufactures, produces, sells, leases, rents, licenses or otherwise provides products or services: Wal-Mart, Target, K-Mart, Walgreen’s, Rite-Aid, CVS, Family Dollar Stores, Fred’s, the 99 Cents Stores, and Dollar Tree Stores;

(iii)  

at any time during the Management Stockholder’s employment with the Company or its subsidiaries and for a period of six (6) months thereafter, directly or indirectly (A) solicit customers or clients of the Company, any of its subsidiaries, the Investors or any of their respective Affiliates to terminate their relationship with the Company, any of its subsidiaries, the Investors or any of their respective Affiliates or otherwise solicit such customers or clients to compete with any business of the Company, any of its subsidiaries, the Investors or any of their respective Affiliates or (B) solicit or offer employment to any person who is, or has been at any time during the twelve (12) months immediately preceding the termination of the Management Stockholder’s employment, employed by the Company or any of its Affiliates;

provided that in each of clauses (ii) and (iii) above, such restrictions shall not apply with respect to any Investor or any of their Affiliates that is not engaged in any business that competes, directly or indirectly, with the Company or any of its subsidiaries.  If the Management Stockholder is bound by any other agreement with the Company regarding the use or disclosure of Confidential Information, the provisions of this Agreement shall be read in such a way as to further restrict and not to permit any more extensive use or disclosure of Confidential Information.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, for the purposes of Section 23(a)(ii), the Management Stockholder may, directly or indirectly own, solely as an investment, securities of any Person engaged in the business of the Company or its affiliates which are publicly traded on a national or regional stock exchange or quotation system or on the over the counter market if the Management Stockholder (I) is not a controlling person of, or a member of a group which controls, such person and (II) does not, directly or indirectly, own 5% or more of any class of securities of such Person.

(b)    Notwithstanding clause (a) above, if at any time a court holds that the restrictions stated in such clause (a) are unreasonable or otherwise unenforceable under







23


circumstances then existing, the parties hereto agree that the maximum period, scope or geographic area determined to be reasonable under such circumstances by such court will be substituted for the stated period, scope or area.  Because the Management Stockholder’s services are unique and because the Management Stockholder has had access to Confidential Information, the parties hereto agree that money damages will be an inadequate remedy for any breach of this Agreement.  In the event of a breach or threatened breach of this Agreement, the Company or its successors or assigns may, in addition to other rights and remedies existing in their favor, apply to any court of competent jurisdiction for specific performance and/or injunctive relief in order to enforce, or prevent any violations of, the provisions hereof (without the posting of a bond or other security).

(c)    In the event that the Management Stockholder breaches any of the provisions of Section 23(a), in addition to all other remedies that may be available to the Company, the Management Stockholder shall be required to pay to the Company any amounts actually paid to him or her by the Company in respect of any repurchase by the Company of any Options or Stock held by such Management Stockholder; provided that with respect to Option Stock, the Management Stockholder shall be required to pay to the Company only such amounts, if any, that the Management Stockholder received in excess of the exercise price paid by the Management Stockholder in acquiring such Option Stock, on a net after-tax basis.

24.

Irrevocable Proxy .  In accordance with Tenn. Code Ann. § 48-17-203, each Management Stockholder hereby irrevocably appoints Buck Holdings, L.P. and any authorized representatives and designees thereof as its lawful proxy and attorney-in-fact to exercise with full power in such Management Stockholder’s name and on its behalf such Management Stockholder’s right to vote all of the shares of outstanding Common Stock owned by the Management Stockholder at any regular or special meeting of the stockholders of the Company for the express purpose of electing any one or more members to the Board.  Buck Holdings, L.P. and any authorized representatives and designees thereof shall vote under this proxy on behalf of each such Management Stockholder in the same manner as Buck Holdings, L.P. votes any outstanding shares of Common Stock owned by it at any such regular or special meeting of the stockholders of the Company for the express purpose of electing any one or more members to the Board.    This proxy is irrevocable and is coupled with an interest and shall not be terminable as long as this Agreement remains effective among the parties hereto, their successors, transferees and assigns and, if such Management Stockholder is a natural person, shall not terminate on the disability or incompetence of such Management Stockholder.  The Company is hereby requested and directed to honor this proxy upon its presentation by Buck Holdings, L.P. and any authorized representatives and designees thereof, without any duty of investigation whatsoever on the part of the Company. Each such Management Stockholder agrees that the Company, and the Company’s secretary shall not be liable to such Management Stockholder for so honoring this proxy.

25.

Shareholder Actions by Written Consent .  The Management Stockholder (a) agrees that, in respect of actions undertaken without a meeting pursuant to Article I, Section 6 of the bylaws of the Company and T.C.A. section 48-17-104, unless otherwise provided by the Company's charter or bylaws or applicable law, any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of the shareholders may be taken without a meeting, without prior notice and without a vote if a consent in writing, setting forth the action so taken, is signed in one or more counterparts by shareholders having not less that the minimum number of votes







24


that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which all shares entitled to vote thereon were present and voted and (b) hereby consents to the taking of any such action as set forth in this Section 25 and in Article I, Section 6 of the bylaws of the Company.

26.

Effectiveness .  This Agreement, if duly executed, shall become effective on the Effective Date and prior thereto shall be of no force or effect.  


[ Signatures on next pages .]









IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement on the date(s) set forth below.

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

/s/ Bob Ravener

 

 

Name:

Bob Ravener

 

 

Title:

SVP, Chief People Officer

 

 

Date:

12-19-08



BUCK HOLDINGS, L.P.
By: Buck Holdings, LLC, its General Partner

 

 

By:

/s/ Raj Agrawal

 

 

Name:

Raj Agrawal

 

 

Title:

Vice President

 

 

Date:

12-19-08




[ signature page to Management Stockholder’s Agreement ]







MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER:

 

 

Signature:

/s/ Todd J. Vasos

 

 

Name:

Todd J. Vasos

 

 

Date:

12-02-08



ADDRESS:

 

c/o Dollar General Corporation

100 Mission Ridge

Goodlettsville, TN 37072



PURCHASED STOCK


I hereby elect to invest $ 650,000 in the Company’s Common Stock (NOTE:  the amount you invest, if any, must equal at least $ 650,000 and may not exceed $ 1,300,000 ).



[ signature page to Management Stockholder’s Agreement ]





Schedule I to Management Stockholder’s Agreement



OPTIONS


Number of shares of Common Stock underlying Options (assuming you have satisfied the minimum investment amount):   _________


EFFECTIVE DATE


December 19, 2008


SENIOR MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER?


Yes __ X __

No ____



  



SALE PARTICIPATION AGREEMENT


This Sale Participation Agreement (this “ Agreement ”) is entered into as of the effective date noted on Parent’s signature page hereto (the “ Effective Date”) among Buck Holdings, L.P., a Delaware limited partnership (“ Parent ”), and the undersigned person (the “ Management Stockholder ” or “ you ”).  


WHEREAS, you have entered into a Management Stockholder’s Agreement, as of the Effective Date, between Dollar General Corporation, a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”), Parent and the Management Stockholder (the “ Stockholder’s Agreement ”) relating to (i) the purchase by you of Purchased Stock (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement); and/or (ii) the grant by the Company to you of options (“ Options ”) to purchase shares of common stock, par value $0.50 per share, of the Company (“ Common Stock ”).  

Parent hereby agrees with you as follows, as of the Effective Date:

1.

(a)

In the event that at any time on or after the date hereof Parent or any of its Affiliates (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) proposes to sell directly for cash or any other consideration any shares of Common Stock owned by Parent or any such Affiliate, in any transaction other than a Public Offering (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) or a sale, directly or indirectly, to an Affiliate of Parent, then, unless Parent is entitled to and does exercise the drag-along rights pursuant to Paragraph 7 below and the Drag Transaction is consummated, solely to the extent you are a Senior Management Stockholder (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) or the provisions hereof are otherwise applicable to you pursuant to and in accordance with Section 9 of the Stockholder’s Agreement or as a result of a decision by the Board (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement), after consultation with the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer of the Company, to extend the rights under this Section 1 to you, Parent will notify you or your Management Stockholder’s Estate or Management Stockholder’s Trust (as such terms are defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement, and collectively with you, the “ Management Stockholder Entities ”), as the case may be, in writing (a “ Notice ”) of such proposed sale (a “ Proposed Sale ”) specifying the principal terms and conditions of the Proposed Sale (the “ Material Terms ”) including (A) the amount of Common Stock to be included in the Proposed Sale, (B) the percentage of the outstanding Common Stock at the time the Notice is given that is represented by the number of shares to be included in the Proposed Sale, (C) the price per share of Common Stock subject to the Proposed Sale, including a description of any pricing formulae and of any non-cash consideration sufficiently detailed to permit valuation thereof, (D) the Tag Along Sale Percentage (as defined below) of Parent and (E) the name and address of the Person (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) to whom the offered Common Stock is proposed to be issued.  

(b)

If, within 10 business days after the delivery of Notice under Section 1(a), Parent receives from a Management Stockholder Entity a written request (a “ Request ”) to include Common Stock held by the Management Stockholder Entity in the Proposed Sale (which Request shall be irrevocable except (a) as set forth in clauses (c) and (d) of this Section 1 below or (b) if otherwise mutually agreed to in writing by the Management Stockholder Entity and Parent), the Common Stock held by you (not in any event to exceed the Tag Along Sale Percentage multiplied by the total number of shares of Common Stock held by the Management







2


Stockholder Entities in the aggregate) will be so included as provided herein.  Promptly after the execution of the Sale Agreement, Parent will furnish each Management Stockholder Entity with a copy of the Sale Agreement, if any.  For purposes of this Agreement, the “ Tag Along Sale Percentage ” shall mean the fraction, expressed as a percentage, determined by dividing the number of shares of Common Stock to be purchased from Parent by the total number of shares of Common Stock owned directly or indirectly by Parent.


(c)

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Agreement, if any of the economic terms of the Proposed Sale change, including without limitation if the per share price will be less than the per share price disclosed in the Notice, or any of the other principal terms or conditions will be materially less favorable to the selling Management Stockholder Entities than those described in the Notice, Parent will provide written notice thereof to each such Management Stockholder Entity who has made a Request and each such Management Stockholder Entity will then be given an opportunity to withdraw the offer contained in such holder’s Request (by providing prompt (and in any event within five (5) business days; provided that, notwithstanding the foregoing, if the proposed closing with respect to the Proposed Sale is to occur within five (5) business days or less, no later than three (3) business days prior to such closing) written notice of such withdrawal to Parent), whereupon such withdrawing Management Stockholder Entity will be released from all obligations thereunder.


(d)

If Parent does not complete the Proposed Sale by the end of the 120th day following the date of the effectiveness of the Notice, each selling Management Stockholder Entity may elect to be released from all obligations under the applicable Request by notifying the Parent in writing of its desire to so withdraw.  Upon receipt of that withdrawal notice, the Notice of the relevant Management Stockholder Entity shall be null and void, and it will then be necessary for a separate Notice to be furnished, and the terms and provisions of clauses (a) and (b) of this Section 1 separately complied with, in order to consummate such Proposed Sale pursuant to this Section 1, unless the failure to complete such proposed sale resulted from any failure by any selling Management Stockholder Entity to comply with the terms of this Section 1.


2.

(a)

The number of shares of Common Stock that you will be permitted to include in a Proposed Sale pursuant to a Request will be the lesser of (A) the number of shares of Common Stock that you have offered to sell in the Proposed Sale as set forth in the Request and (B) the number of shares of Common Stock determined by multiplying (i) the number of shares of Common Stock to be included in the Proposed Sale by (ii) a fraction the numerator of which is the number of shares of Common Stock owned by you plus all shares of Common Stock which you are then entitled to acquire under any unexercised portion of Options, to the extent such Option is then exercisable or would become exercisable as a result of the consummation of the Proposed Sale, and the denominator of which is the total number of shares of Common Stock owned by the Management Stockholder Entities and all other Persons participating in such sale as tag-along sellers pursuant to Other Management Stockholder Agreements (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) or other agreements (all such participants, the “ Tag Along Sellers ”) plus all shares of Common Stock which you and such Persons are then entitled to acquire under any unexercised portion of Options, to the extent such Options are then exercisable or would







3


become exercisable as a result of the consummation of the Proposed Sale, plus all shares of Common Stock owned by Parent.      

(b)

If one or more Tag Along Sellers elect not to include the maximum number of shares of Common Stock which such holders would have been permitted to include in a Proposed Sale pursuant to paragraph 2(a) (such non-included shares, the “ Eligible Shares ”), then each of Parent or the remaining Tag Along Sellers, or any of them, will have the right to sell in the Proposed Sale a number of additional shares of their Common Stock equal to their pro rata portion of the number of Eligible Shares, based on the relative number of shares of Common Stock then held by each such holder plus all shares of Common Stock which you are then entitled to acquire under any unexercised portion of the Option, to the extent such Option is then exercisable or would become exercisable as a result of the consummation of the Proposed Sale, and such additional shares of Common Stock which any such holder or holders propose to sell shall not be included in any calculation made pursuant to paragraph 2(a) for the purpose of determining the number of shares of Common Stock which the Management Stockholder Entities will be permitted to include in a Proposed Sale.  Parent will have the right to sell in the Proposed Sale additional shares of Common Stock owned by it equal to the number, if any, of remaining Eligible Shares which will not be included in the Proposed Sale pursuant to the foregoing.  

3.

Except as may otherwise be provided herein, shares of Common Stock subject to a Request will be included in a Proposed Sale pursuant hereto and in any agreements with purchasers relating thereto on the same terms and subject to the same conditions applicable to the shares of Common Stock which Parent proposes to sell in the Proposed Sale.  Such terms and conditions shall include, without limitation: the sale price; the payment of fees, commissions and expenses; the provision of, and customary representations and warranties as to, information reasonably requested by Parent covering matters regarding the Management Stockholder Entities’ ownership of shares; and the provision of requisite indemnification; provided that any indemnification provided by the Management Stockholder Entities shall be pro rata in proportion with the number of shares of Common Stock to be sold; provided , further , that no Management Stockholder Entity shall be required to indemnify any Person for an amount, in the aggregate, in excess of the gross proceeds received in such Proposed Sale.  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing, if the consideration payable for shares of Common Stock is securities and the acquisition of such securities by a Management Stockholder Entity would reasonably be expected to be prohibited under U.S., foreign or state securities laws, such Management Stockholder Entity shall be entitled to receive an amount in cash equal to the value of any such securities such Person would otherwise be entitled to receive.

4.

Upon delivering a Request, the Management Stockholder Entities will, if requested by Parent, execute and deliver a custody agreement and power of attorney in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to Parent with respect to the shares of Common Stock which are to be sold by the Management Stockholder Entities pursuant hereto (a “ Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney ”).  The Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney will contain customary provisions and will provide, among other things, that the Management Stockholder Entities will deliver to and deposit in custody with the custodian and attorney-in-fact named therein a certificate or certificates (if such shares are certificated) representing such shares of Common Stock (duly endorsed in blank by the registered owner or owners thereof) and







4


irrevocably appoint said custodian and attorney-in-fact as the Management Stockholder Entities’ agent and attorney-in-fact with full power and authority to act under the Custody Agreement and Power of Attorney on the Management Stockholder Entities’ behalf with respect to the matters specified therein.

5.

Your right pursuant hereto to participate in a Proposed Sale shall be contingent on your material compliance with each of the provisions hereof and your willingness to execute such documents in connection therewith as may be reasonably requested by Parent.

6.

If the consideration to be paid in exchange for shares of Common Stock in a Proposed Sale pursuant to Section 1 includes any securities, and the receipt thereof by Parent and a Management Shareholder Entity would require under applicable law (a) the registration or qualification of such securities or of any Person as a broker or dealer or agent with respect to such securities or (b) the provision to any selling Management Shareholder Entity of any information regarding the Company, its subsidiaries, such securities or the issuer thereof that would not be required to be delivered in an offering solely to a limited number of “accredited investors” under Regulation D promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations in effect thereunder, Parent and such Management Shareholder Entity shall not, subject to the following sentence, have the right to sell shares of Common Stock in such proposed sale.  In such event, Parent shall have the right to cause to be paid to such selling Management Shareholder Entity in lieu thereof, against surrender of the shares of Common Stock which would have otherwise been sold by such selling Management Shareholder Entity to the prospective buyer in the proposed sale, an amount in cash equal to the Fair Market Value (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) of such shares of Common Stock as of the date such securities would have been issued in exchange for such shares of Common Stock.

7.

(a)  If Parent or any of its Affiliates that directly owns shares of Common Stock proposes to transfer, directly or indirectly, a number of shares of Common Stock equal to 50% or more of the outstanding shares of Common Stock (such Person, the “ Drag-Along Purchaser ”), then if requested by Parent, the Management Stockholder Entities shall be required to sell a number of shares of Common Stock equal to the aggregate number of shares of Common Stock held by the Management Stockholder Entities (including shares of Common Stock underlying exercisable Options) multiplied by the Tag Along Sale Percentage (such transaction, a “ Drag Transaction ”).

(b)

Shares of Common Stock held by the Management Stockholder Entities included in a Drag Transaction will be included in any agreements with the Drag-Along Purchaser relating thereto on the same terms and subject to the same conditions applicable to the shares of Common Stock which Parent proposes to sell in the Drag Transaction.  Such terms and conditions shall include, without limitation:  the pro rata reduction of the number of shares of Common Stock to be sold by Parent and the Management Stockholder Entities to be included in the Drag Transaction if required by the Drag-Along Purchaser; the sale price; the payment of fees, commissions and expenses; the provision of, and representation and warranty as to, information reasonably requested by Parent covering matters regarding the Management Stockholder Entities’ ownership of shares; and the provision of requisite indemnification; provided that any indemnification provided by the Management Stockholder Entities shall be pro rata in proportion with the number of shares of Common Stock to be sold; provided , further , that







5


no Management Stockholder Entity shall be required to indemnify any Person for an amount, in the aggregate, in excess of the gross proceeds received in such Proposed Sale.

(c)

Your pro rata share of any amount to be paid pursuant to Paragraph 3 or 7(b) shall be based upon the number of shares of Common Stock intended to be transferred by the Management Stockholder Entities plus the number of shares of Common Stock you would have the right to acquire under any unexercised portion of the Option which is then vested or would become vested as a result of the Proposed Sale or Drag Transaction, assuming that you receive a payment in respect of such Option.

(d)

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing, if the consideration payable for shares of Common Stock is securities and the acquisition of such securities by a Management Stockholder Entity would reasonably be expected to be prohibited under U.S., foreign or state securities laws, such Management Stockholder Entity shall be entitled to receive an amount in cash equal to the value of any such securities such Person would otherwise be entitled to receive.

8.

The obligations of Parent hereunder shall extend only to you and your transferees (“ Permitted Transferees ”) who (a) are Other Management Stockholders (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement), (b) are party to a Management Stockholder’s Agreement with the Company and (c) have acquired Common Stock pursuant to a Permitted Transfer (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement), and none of the Management Stockholder Entities’ successors or assigns, with the exception of any Permitted Transferee and only with respect to the Common Stock acquired by such Permitted Transferee pursuant to a Permitted Transfer, shall have any rights pursuant hereto.

9.

This Agreement shall terminate and be of no further force and effect on the occurrence of the earlier of the consummation of a Qualified Public Offering (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement) or a Change in Control (as defined in the Stockholder’s Agreement).

10.

All notices and other communications required or permitted hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed effectively given: (a) upon personal delivery to the party to be notified, (b) when sent by confirmed facsimile if sent during normal business hours of the recipient, if not, then on the next business day, (c) five (5) days after having been sent by registered or certified mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid or (d) one (1) business day after deposit with a nationally recognized overnight courier, specifying next day delivery, with written verification of receipt.  All communications shall be sent to such party’s address as set forth below or at such other address or to such other person as the party shall have furnished to each other party in writing in accordance with this provision:

If to Parent, at the following address:

Buck Holdings, L.P.

c/o KKR 2006 Fund, L.P.

2800 Sand Hill Road

Menlo Park, CA 94025







6


Attention:  Michael Calbert
Telecopy:

(650) 233-6553

with a copy to:


Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
425 Lexington Avenue
New York, New York 10017
Attention:  David J. Sorkin, Esq.

      Marni J. Lerner, Esq.

Telecopy:  (212) 455-2502


If to the Company, to the Company at the following address:


Dollar General Corporation
100 Mission Ridge
Goodlettsville, TN  37072
Attention:  General Counsel
Telecopy:  (615) 855-5180


with a copy to:

Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
425 Lexington Avenue
New York, New York 10017
Attention:  David J. Sorkin, Esq.

      Marni J. Lerner, Esq.

Telecopy:  (212) 455-2502


If to you, to you at the address first set forth on the corresponding signature page hereto;

If to your Management Stockholder’s Estate or Management Stockholder’s Trust, to the address provided to the Company by such entity.

11.

The laws of the State of Delaware shall govern the interpretation, validity and performance of the terms of this Agreement.  In the event of any controversy among the parties hereto arising out of, or relating to, this Agreement which cannot be settled amicably by the parties, such controversy shall be finally, exclusively and conclusively settled by mandatory arbitration conducted expeditiously in accordance with the American Arbitration Association rules, by a single independent arbitrator.  Such arbitration process shall take place in Nashville, Tennessee.  The decision of the arbitrator shall be final and binding upon all parties hereto and shall be rendered pursuant to a written decision, which contains a detailed recital of the arbitrator’s reasoning.  Judgment upon the award rendered may be entered in any court having jurisdiction thereof.  Each party shall bear its own legal fees and expenses, unless otherwise determined by the arbitrator; provided that if the Management Stockholder substantially prevails on any of his or her substantive legal claims, then the Investors shall reimburse all legal fees and arbitration fees incurred by the Management Stockholder to arbitrate the dispute.  Each party







7


hereto hereby irrevocably waives any right that it may have had to bring an action in any court, domestic or foreign, or before any similar domestic or foreign authority with respect to this Agreement.

12.

This Agreement may be executed in counterparts, and by different parties on separate counterparts, each of which shall be deemed an original, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument.

13.

It is the understanding of the undersigned that you are aware that no Proposed Sale is contemplated and that such a sale may never occur.

14.

This Agreement may be amended by Parent at any time upon notice to the Management Stockholder thereof; provided that any amendment (i) that materially disadvantages the Management Stockholder shall not be effective unless and until the Management Stockholder has consented thereto in writing and (ii) that disadvantages a class of stockholders in more than a de minimis way but less than a material way shall require the consent of a majority of the equity interests held by such affected class of stockholders.

15.

Capitalized terms used but not defined herein shall have the meaning ascribed to such terms in the Stockholder’s Agreement.

[ Signatures on following pages ]









IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties have executed this Agreement as of the Effective Date.




BUCK HOLDINGS, L.P.

 

 

By:

BUCK HOLDINGS, LLC, its general partner

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ Raj Agrawal

 

 

Name:

Raj Agrawal

 

 

Title:

Vice President


Signature Date:

12-19-08

 

 

Effective Date:

December 19, 2008




[ signature page to Sale Participation Agreement ]









MANAGEMENT STOCKHOLDER:

 

 

Signature:

/s/ Todd J. Vasos

 

 

Printed Name:

Todd J. Vasos

 

 

Signature Date:

12-02-08



ADDRESS:

 

c/o Dollar General Corporation

100 Mission Ridge

Goodlettsville, TN 37072








[ signature page to Sale Participation Agreement ]


EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (“Agreement”), effective April 1, 2006 (“Effective Date”), is made and entered into by and between DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION (the “Company”), and Susan Lanigan (“Employee”).

W I T N E S S E T H:

WHEREAS, Company desires to employ Employee upon the terms and subject to the conditions hereinafter set forth, and Employee desires to accept such employment;

NOW, THEREFORE, for and in consideration of the premises, the mutual promises, covenants and agreements contained herein, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties agree as follows:

Employment Terms

1.

Employment .  Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the Company agrees to employ Employee as EVP, General Counsel of Dollar General Corporation.

2.

Term .  The term of this Agreement shall be until the third annual anniversary of the Effective Date (“Term” ) , unless otherwise terminated pursuant to Sections 7, 8, 9, 10, 11 or 12 hereof.

3.

Position, Duties and Administrative Support .

a.

Position .  Employee shall serve as EVP, General Counsel and shall perform such duties and responsibilities as Employee’s supervisor or the Company’s CEO may direct.

b.

Full-Time Efforts .  Employee shall perform and discharge faithfully and diligently such duties and responsibilities and shall devote Employee’s full-time efforts to the business and affairs of Company.  Employee agrees to promote the best interests of the Company and to take no action that is likely to damage the public image or reputation of the Company, its subsidiaries or its affiliates.

c.

Administrative Support .  Employee shall be provided with office space and administrative support.

d.

No Interference With Duties .  Employee shall not devote time to other activities which would inhibit or otherwise interfere with the proper performance of Employee’s duties and shall not be directly or indirectly concerned or interested in any other



1



business occupation, activity or interest other than by reason of holding a non-controlling interest as a shareholder, securities holder or debenture holder in a corporation quoted on a nationally recognized exchange (subject to any limitations in the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics).  Employee may not serve as a member of a board of directors of a for-profit company, other than the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, without the express approval of the CEO and the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee of the Board. Under no circumstances may Employee serve on more than one other board of a for-profit company.

4.

Work Standard .  Employee agrees to comply with all terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement, as well as all applicable Company work policies, procedures and rules.  Employee also agrees to comply with all federal, state and local statutes, regulations and public ordinances governing Employee’s performance hereunder.

5.

Compensation .

a.

Base Salary .  Subject to the terms and conditions set forth in this Agreement, the Company shall pay Employee, and Employee shall accept an annual base salary (“Base Salary”) of no less than Four Hundred and Ten Thousand Dollars ($410,000).  The Base Salary shall be paid in accordance with Company’s normal payroll practices and may be increased from time to time at the sole discretion of the Company.

b.

Incentive Bonus .  Employee’s incentive compensation for the Term of this Agreement shall be determined under the Company’s bonus program for officers, as it may be amended from time to time.  The actual bonus paid pursuant to this Section 5(b), if any, shall be based on criteria established by the Compensation Committee and/or the CEO, as applicable, in accordance with the terms and conditions of the bonus program for officers.

c.

Stock Based Compensation .  Employee shall be eligible for award grants from time to time consistent with the award grants made to similarly-situated officers of the Company as governed by the terms of the 1998 Employee Stock Incentive Plan, as may be amended, or any successor plan thereof (the “Stock Plan”), as determined in the sole discretion of  the Compensation Committee.

d.

Vacation .  Employee shall be entitled to three weeks paid vacation time within the first year of employment. After five years of employment, Employee shall be entitled to four weeks paid vacation. Vacation time is granted on the anniversary of



2



Employee’s hire date each year. Any available but unused vacation as of the annual anniversary of employment date or at Employee’s termination date shall be forfeited.

e.

Business Expenses .  Employee shall be reimbursed for all reasonable business expenses incurred in carrying out the work hereunder.  Employee shall adhere to the Company’s expense reimbursement policies and procedures.

f.

Perquisites .  Employee shall be entitled to receive such other executive perquisites, fringe and other benefits as are provided to similarly-situated officers and their families under any of the Company’s plans and/or programs in effect from time to time.

6.

Benefits .  During the Term, Employee (and, where applicable, Employee’s eligible dependents) shall be eligible to participate in those various Company welfare benefit plans, practices and policies in place during the Term, if any, (including, without limitation, medical, prescription, dental, vision, disability, employee life, accidental death and travel accident insurance plans and programs, if any) to the extent and in accordance with the terms of those plans.  In addition, Employee shall be eligible to participate, pursuant to their terms, in any other benefit plans offered by the Company to similarly-situated officers or other employees during the Term (excluding plans applicable solely to certain officers of the Company in accordance with the express terms of such plans), including, without limitation, the 401(k) Retirement and Savings Plan and CDP/SERP Plan.  Collectively the plans and arrangements described in this Section 6 and as they may be amended or modified in accordance with their terms are hereinafter referred to as the “Benefits Plans.”  Notwithstanding the above, Employee understands and acknowledges that Employee is not eligible for benefits under the Dollar General Corporation Severance Plan and that the only severance benefits Employee is entitled to are set forth in this Agreement.     

7.

Termination for Cause .  This Agreement may be terminated at any time by either party, with or without cause. If this Agreement is terminated by Company for “Cause” (Termination for Cause) as that term is defined below, it will be without any liability owing to Employee or Employee’s dependents and beneficiaries under this Agreement, except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement. Any one of the following conditions or Employee conduct shall constitute “Cause”:


a.

Any act involving fraud or dishonesty;



3



b.

Any material breach of any SEC or other law or regulation or any Company policy governing  trading or dealing with stocks, securities, investments and the like or with inappropriate disclosure or “tipping” relating to any stock, security or investment;

c.

Other than as required by law, the carrying out of any activity or the making of any public statement which prejudices or reduces the good name and standing of Company or any of its affiliates or would bring any one of these into public contempt or ridicule;

d.

Attendance at work in a state of intoxication or being found with any drug or substance possession of which would amount to a criminal offense;

e.

Assault or other act of violence; or

f.

Conviction of or plea of guilty or nolo contendre to any felony whatsoever or any misdemeanor that would preclude employment under the Company’s hiring policy.

A termination for Cause shall be effective when the Company has given Employee written notice of its intention to terminate for Cause, describing those acts or omissions that are believed to constitute Cause, and has given Employee an opportunity to respond.

8.

Termination upon Death .  Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, this Agreement shall terminate immediately upon Employee’s death, and the Company shall have no further liability to Employee or Employee’s dependents and beneficiaries under this Agreement, except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.

9.

Disability .  If a Disability (as defined below) of Employee occurs during the Term, unless otherwise prohibited by law, the Company may notify Employee of the Company’s intention to terminate Employee’s employment.  In that event, employment shall terminate effective on the termination date provided in such notice of termination (the “Disability Effective Date”), and this Agreement shall terminate without further liability to Employee, Employee’s dependents and beneficiaries, except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.  In this Agreement, “Disability” means:

a.

A long-term disability, as defined in the Company’s applicable long-term disability plan as then in effect, if any; or



4



b.

Employee’s inability to perform the duties under this Agreement in accordance with the Company’s expectations because of a medically determinable physical or mental impairment that (i) can reasonably be expected to result in death or (ii) has lasted or can reasonably be expected to last longer than ninety (90) consecutive days.  Under this provision 9(b), unless otherwise required by law, the existence of a Disability shall be determined by the Company, only upon receipt of a written medical opinion from a qualified physician selected by or acceptable to the Company.  In this circumstance, to the extent permitted by law, Employee shall, if reasonably requested by the Company, submit to a physical examination by that qualified physician. Nothing in this subsection (b) is intended to nor shall it be deemed to broaden or modify the definition of “disability” in the Company’s long-term disability plan.  

10.

Employee’s Termination of Employment .

a.

Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, Employee may terminate employment and this Agreement at any time, for no reason, with thirty (30) days written notice to Company.  Upon such termination, Employee shall be entitled to prorata Base Salary through the date of termination and such other vested benefits under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement. Employee shall not be entitled to those payments and benefits listed in Sections 11 or 12 below, unless Employee terminates employment for Good Reason, as defined below.

b.

Good Reason shall mean any of the following actions taken by the Company:

(i)

A reduction by the Company in Employee’s Base Salary or target bonus level;

(ii)

The Company shall fail to continue in effect any significant Company-sponsored compensation plan or benefit (without replacing it with a similar plan or with a compensation equivalent), unless such action is in connection with across-the-board plan changes or terminations similarly affecting at least ninety-five percent (95%) of all executive employees of the Company;

(iii)

The Company’s principal executive offices shall be moved to a location outside the middle-Tennessee area, or Employee is required to be based anywhere other than the Company’s principal executive offices;



5



(iv)

Without Employee’s written consent, the assignment to Employee by the Company of duties inconsistent with, or the significant reduction of the title, powers and functions associated with, Employee’s position, titles or offices as described in Section 3 above, unless such action is the result of a restructuring or realignment of duties and responsibilities by the Company, for business reasons, that leaves Employee at the same compensation and officer level (i.e., Vice President, Senior Vice President, or Executive Vice President, etc.) and with a similar level of responsibility, or unless such action is the result of Employee’s failure to meet pre-established and objective performance criteria;

(v)

Any material breach by the Company of this Agreement; or

(vi)

The failure of any successor (whether direct or indirect, by purchase, merger, consolidation or otherwise) to all or substantially all of the business and/or assets of the Company to assume expressly and agree to perform this Agreement in the same manner and to the same extent that the Company would be required to perform it if no such succession had taken place.

Good Reason shall not include Employee’s death, Disability or Termination for Cause.  The Company shall have the opportunity to cure any claimed event of Good Reason within thirty (30) days after receiving written notice from Employee specifying the same.

11.

Termination without Cause or by Employee for Good Reason .

a.

The continuation of Base Salary and other payments and benefits described in section 11(b) shall be triggered only upon one or more of the following circumstances:

(i)

The Company terminates Employee (as it may do at any time) without Cause; it being understood that termination by death or Disability does not constitute termination without Cause;

(ii)

Employee terminates for Good Reason;

(iii)

The Company fails to offer to renew, extend or replace this Employment Agreement before, at, or within sixty (60) days after, the end of its Term and Employee resigns from employment with the Company within sixty (60) days after such failure, unless such failure is accompanied by a mutually agreeable



6



severance arrangement between the Company and Employee or is the result of Employee’s voluntary retirement or termination from the Company.

b.

In the event of one of the triggers referenced in subsections 11(a)(i) through (iii) above, then, upon the execution and effective date of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof and in lieu of and not in addition to the payments referenced in Section 12 below, Employee shall be entitled to the following:                                                                       

(i)

Continuation of Employee’s Base Salary as of the date immediately preceding the termination for 24 months, payable in accordance with the Company’s normal payroll cycle and procedures.

(ii)

Lump sum payment of two times Employee’s target incentive bonus then in effect;

(iii)

A lump sum payment in an amount equal to two times the annual contribution made by the Company for Employee’s participation in the Company’s medical, dental and vision benefits program.

(iv)

Outplacement services, provided by the Company, for one year or until other employment is secured, whichever comes first.

Unless otherwise permitted by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Internal Revenue Code”), with regard to any payment or benefit under this Section 11 which is nonqualified deferred compensation covered by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, no such payment or benefit shall be provided to Employee pursuant to this Section if the Release attached hereto is not provided to the Company, without revocation thereof, no later than forty-five (45) days after Employee’s termination date; and no payment or benefit hereunder shall be provided to Employee prior to the Company’s receipt of the Release and the expiration of the period of revocation provided in the Release.

c.

In the event that there is a material breach by Employee of any continuing obligations under this Agreement or the Release after termination of employment, any unpaid amounts under this Section 11 shall be forfeited.  Any payments or reimbursements under this Section 11 shall not be deemed the continuation of Employee’s employment for any purpose.  Except as specifically enumerated in the Release, the Company’s payment obligations under this Section 11 will not negate or reduce (i) any amounts otherwise due but



7



not yet paid to Employee by the Company, or (ii) any other amounts payable to Employee outside this Agreement, or (iii) those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.  Subject to any applicable prohibition on acceleration of payment under Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, the Company may, at any time and in its sole discretion, make a lump-sum payment of all amounts, or all remaining amounts, due to Employee under this Section 11.

12.

Effect of Change in Control .

a.

If within two (2) years following a Change in Control (as hereinafter defined), the Company (or any successor to the Company) terminates Employee’s employment without Cause or Employee terminates for Good Reason, then upon the execution and the effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof, the Company shall pay to Employee (in lieu of the payments referenced in Section 11 above and not in addition to):

(i)

A lump sum payment equal to two times Employee’s Base Salary in effect immediately prior to the Change in Control plus two times the amount of Employee’s target incentive bonus payment in effect immediately prior to the Change in Control;

(ii)

A lump sum payment in an amount equal to two times the annual contribution made by Company for Employee’s participation in the Company’s medical, dental and vision benefits program;

(iii)

Outplacement services, provided by the Company, for one year or until other employment is secured, whichever comes first; and

(iv)

If such Change in Control also constitutes a change in control under the Stock Plan, Employee’s awards, if any, granted pursuant to that plan shall fully vest and shall remain exercisable in accordance with the terms of that plan.

Unless otherwise permitted by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code for any payment or benefit hereunder which is nonqualified deferred compensation covered by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, no such payment or benefit shall be provided to Employee pursuant to this Section if the Release attached hereto is not provided to the Company, without revocation thereof, no later than forty-five (45) days after Employee’s termination



8



date; and no payment or benefit hereunder shall be provided to Employee prior to the Company’s receipt of the Release and the expiration of the period of revocation therefore.

b.

Anything in this Agreement to the contrary notwithstanding and except as set forth below, in the event it shall be determined as provided below that any payment or distribution by the Company to or for the benefit of Employee (whether paid or payable or distributed or distributable pursuant to the terms of this Agreement or otherwise, but determined without regard to any additional payments required under this Section 12(b)) (a “Payment”) would be subject to the excise tax imposed by Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code or any interest or penalties are incurred by Employee with respect to such excise tax (collectively referred to as the “Excise Tax”), then Employee shall be entitled to receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment”) in an amount such that after Employee pays all taxes (including any interest or penalties imposed with respect to such taxes), including, without limitation, any Excise, income or other tax (and any interest and penalties imposed with respect thereto), Employee retains an amount of the Gross-Up Payment equal to the Excise Tax imposed upon the Payments. Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the Net After-tax Benefit to Employee resulting from receiving the Gross-Up Payment is less than $25,000 greater than the Net After-tax Benefit to Employee resulting from having the Payments reduced to the Reduced Amount, then no Gross-Up Payment shall be made and the Payments shall be reduced to the Reduced Amount.  For purposes hereof:

(v)

“Net After-tax Benefit” shall mean the Present Value of a Payment net of all taxes (including any Excise Tax imposed on Employee) with respect thereto, determined by applying the highest marginal rate(s) applicable to an individual for Employee’s taxable year in which the Change in Control occurs.

(vi)

“Present Value” shall mean such value determined in accordance with Section 280G(d)(4) of the Internal Revenue Code.

(vii)

“Reduced Amount” shall be an amount expressed as a Present Value which maximizes the aggregate Present Value of Payments without causing any Payment to be subject to excise tax under Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code or the deduction limitation of Section 280G of the Internal Revenue Code.

Unless Employee and the Company shall otherwise agree (provided such agreement does not cause any payment or benefit hereunder which is nonqualified deferred compensation



9



covered by Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code to be in non-compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code), in the event the Payments are to be reduced, the Company shall reduce or eliminate the Payments to Employee by first reducing or eliminating those payments or benefits which are not payable in cash and then by reducing or eliminating cash payments, in each case in reverse order beginning with payments or benefits which are to be paid the farthest in time from the Change in Control Date.  Any reduction pursuant to the preceding sentence shall take precedence over the provisions of any other plan, arrangement or agreement governing Employee’s rights and entitlements to any benefits or compensation.

c.

All determinations required to be made under this Section 12, including whether and when a Gross-Up Payment is required and the amount of such Gross-Up Payment and the assumptions to be used in arriving at such determination, shall be made by the tax department of an independent public accounting firm (the “Accounting Firm”) which shall be engaged by the Company prior to the time of the first Payment to Employee.  The Accounting Firm selected shall not be serving as accountant or auditor for the individual, entity or group effecting the Change in Control. The Accounting Firm shall prepare and provide detailed supporting calculations both to the Company and Employee within fifteen (15) business days of the later of (i) the Accounting Firm’s engagement to make the required calculations or (ii) the date the Accounting Firm obtains all information needed to make the required calculation.  Any determination by the Accounting Firm shall be binding upon the Company and Employee.  All fees and expenses of the Accounting Firm shall be borne solely by the Company.

d.

Any Gross-Up Payment, as determined pursuant to this Section 12, shall be paid by the Company to Employee within five (5) days of the receipt of the Accounting Firm’s determination if the Payment is then required to satisfy an assessment or other current demand for payment made of Employee by federal or state taxing authorities.  Gross-Up Payments due at a later date shall be paid to Employee no later than fourteen (14) days prior to the date that Employee’s federal or state payment is due.  If required by law, the Company shall treat all or any portion of the Gross-Up Payment as being subject to income tax withholding for federal or state tax purposes.  Amounts determined by the Company to be subject to federal or state tax withholding will not be paid directly to Employee but shall be timely paid to the respective taxing authority.



10



e.

As a result of the uncertainty in the application of Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code at the time of the initial determination by the Accounting Firm hereunder, it is possible that Gross-Up Payments which will not have been made by the Company should have been made (“Underpayment”), consistent with the calculations required to be made hereunder.  In the event that Employee hereafter is required to make a payment of any Excise Tax, the Accounting Firm shall determine the amount of the Underpayment that has occurred and any such Underpayment shall be promptly paid by the Company (or any successor or assign) to or for the benefit of Employee.  Conversely, if it is later determined that the actual required Gross-Up Payment was less than the amount paid to Employee, Employee shall refund the excess portion to the Company but only to the extent that Employee has not yet paid the excess amount to the taxing authorities or is able to obtain a refund from the respective taxing authorities of amounts previously paid.  The Company may pursue at its own expense the refund on behalf of Employee, and, if requested by the Company, Employee shall reasonably cooperate in such refund effort.

f.

“Change in Control” shall mean the date as of which any of the following occurs:  

(i)

Any person or entity, including a “group” as defined in Section 13(d)(3) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”), other than the Company or a wholly-owned subsidiary or affiliate thereof that the Company controls or any employee benefit plan or related trust of or sponsored by the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, becomes the beneficial owner (“Beneficial Owner”), within the meaning of Rule 13d-3 promulgated under the Exchange Act, of the Company’s securities having 35% or more of the combined voting power of the then outstanding securities of the Company that may be cast for the election of directors of the Company (other than as a result of an issuance of securities initiated by the Company in the ordinary course of business); or

(ii)

As the result of, or in connection with, any cash tender or exchange offer, merger or other business combination, sales of assets or contested election, or any combination of the foregoing transactions, less than 65% of the combined voting power of the then outstanding securities of the Company or any successor corporation or entity entitled to vote generally in the election of the directors of the Company or such other corporation or entity after such transaction is held in the aggregate by the



11



holders of the Company’s securities entitled to vote generally in the election of directors of the Company immediately prior to such transaction; or

(iii)

Individuals who at the Effective Date constitute the Board  cease for any reason to constitute at least a majority thereof, unless the election, or the nomination for election, by the Company’s shareholders of a director of the Company subsequent to the Effective Date was approved by a vote of at 75% of the directors of the Company then still in office who were directors of the Company at the Effective Date (those who were members at the Effective Date and those so elected together constituting  the “Incumbent Board”). Notwithstanding the foregoing, no individual who shall become a member of the Board of Directors subsequent to the Effective Date whose initial assumption of office occurs as a result of an actual or threatened election contest (within the meaning of Rule 14a-11 of the regulations promulgated under the Exchange Act) with respect to the election or removal of directors or other actual or threatened solicitation of proxies or consents by or on behalf of an individual, entity or group within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) or 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act other than the Board of Directors shall be deemed a member of the Incumbent Board.

(iv)

The following acquisitions of Voting Securities of the Company shall not constitute a Change in Control:

(A)

any acquisition directly from the Company;

(B)

 any acquisition by Employee or a group within the meaning of Section 14(d) of the Exchange Act that includes Employee

13.

Publicity; No Disparaging Statement .  Except as otherwise provided in Section 14 hereof, Employee and the Company covenant and agree that they shall not engage in any communi­cations to persons outside the Company which shall disparage one another or interfere with their existing or prospective business relationships.

14.

Confidentiality and Legal Process .  Employee agrees to keep the proprietary terms, of this Agreement confidential and to refrain from disclosing any information concerning this Agreement to any one other than Employee’s immediate family and personal agents or advisors.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing in this Agreement is intended to prohibit Employee or the Company from performing any duty or obligation that shall arise as a matter of law.  Specifically,



12



Employee and the Company shall continue to be under a duty to truthfully respond to any legal and valid subpoena or other legal process.  This Agreement is not intended in any way to proscribe Employee’s or the Company’s right and ability to provide information to any federal, state or local agency in response or adherence to the lawful exercise of such agency’s authority.

15.

Business Protection Provision Definitions .

a.

Preamble .  As a material inducement to the Company to enter into this Agreement, and in recognition of the valuable experience, knowledge and proprietary information Employee has gained or will gain while employed, Employee agrees to abide by and adhere to the business protection provisions in Sections 15, 16, 17, 18 and 19 herein.

b.

Definitions .  For purposes of Sections 15, 16, 17, 18, 19 and 20 herein:

(i)

“Competitive Position” shall mean any employment, consulting, advisory, directorship, agency, promotional or independent contractor arrangement between Employee and (x) any person or Entity engaged wholly or in material part in the business in which the Company is engaged (i.e., the deep discount consumable basics retail business), including but not limited to such other similar businesses as Wal-Mart, Target, K-Mart, Walgreen’s, Rite-Aid, CVS, Family Dollar Stores, Fred’s, the 99 Cents Stores and Dollar Tree Stores, or (y) any person or Entity then attempting or planning to enter the deep discount consumable basics retail business, whereby Employee is required to perform services on behalf of or for the benefit of such person or Entity which are substantially similar to the services Employee provided or directed at any time while employed by the Company or any of its affiliates.

(ii)

“Confidential Information” shall mean the proprietary or confidential data, information, documents or materials (whether oral, written, electronic or otherwise) belonging to or pertaining to the Company, other than “Trade Secrets” (as defined below), which is of tangible or intangible value to the Company and the details of which are not generally known to the competitors of the Company.  Confidential Information shall also include any items marked “CONFIDENTIAL” or some similar designation or which are otherwise identified as being confidential.



13



(iii)

“Entity” or “Entities” shall mean any business, individual, partnership, joint venture, agency, governmental agency, body or subdivision, association, firm, corporation, limited liability company or other entity of any kind.

(iv)

“Restricted Period” shall mean two (2) years following Employee’s termination date.

(v)

“Territory” shall include those states in which the Company maintains stores at Employee’s termination date or those states in which the Company has specific and demonstrable plans to open stores within six months of Employee’s termination date.

(vi)

“Trade Secrets” shall mean information or data of or about the Company, including, but not limited to, technical or non-technical data, formulas, patterns, compilations, programs, devices, methods, techniques, drawings, processes, financial data, financial plans, product plans or lists of actual or potential customers or suppliers that:  (A) derives economic value, actual or potential, from not being generally known to, and not being readily ascertainable by proper means by, other persons who can obtain economic value from its disclosure or use; (B) is the subject of efforts that are reasonable under the circumstances to maintain its secrecy; and (C) any other information which is defined as a “trade secret” under applicable law.

(vii)

“Work Product” shall mean all tangible work product, property, data, documentation, “know-how,” concepts or plans, inventions, improvements, techniques and processes relating to the Company that were conceived, discovered, created, written, revised or developed by Employee while employed by the Company.

16.

Nondisclosure:  Ownership of Proprietary Property .

a.

In recognition of the Company’s need to protect its legitimate business interests, Employee hereby covenants and agrees that, for the Term and thereafter (as described below), Employee shall regard and treat Trade Secrets and Confidential Information as strictly confidential and wholly-owned by the Company and shall not, for any reason, in any fashion, either directly or indirectly, use, sell, lend, lease, distribute, license, give, transfer, assign, show, disclose, disseminate, reproduce, copy, misappropriate or otherwise communicate any Trade Secrets or Confidential Information to any person or Entity for any purpose other than in accordance with Employee’s duties under this



14



Agreement or as required by applicable law. This provision shall apply to  each item constituting a Trade Secret at all times it remains a “trade secret” under applicable law and shall apply to any Confidential Information, during employment and for the Restricted Period thereafter.

b.

Employee shall exercise best efforts to ensure the continued confidentiality of all Trade Secrets and Confidential Information and shall immediately notify the Company of any unauthorized disclosure or use of any Trade Secrets or Confidential Information of which Employee becomes aware.  Employee shall assist the Company, to the extent reasonably requested, in the protection or procurement of any intellectual property protection or other rights in any of the Trade Secrets or Confidential Information.

c.

All Work Product shall be owned exclusively by the Company.  To the greatest extent possible, any Work Product shall be deemed to be “work made for hire” (as defined in the Copyright Act, 17 U.S.C.A. § 101 et seq., as amended), and Employee hereby unconditionally and irrevocably transfers and assigns to the Company all right, title and interest Employee currently has or may have by operation of law or otherwise in or to any Work Product, including, without limitation, all patents, copyrights, trademarks (and the goodwill associated therewith), trade secrets, service marks (and the goodwill associated therewith) and other intellectual property rights.  Employee agrees to execute and deliver to the Company any transfers, assignments, documents or other instruments which the Company may deem necessary or appropriate, from time to time, to protect the rights granted herein or to vest complete title and ownership of any and all Work Product, and all associated intellectual property and other rights therein, exclusively in the Company.

17.

Non-Interference with Employees .  Through employment and thereafter through the Restricted Period, Employee will not, either directly or indirectly, alone or in conjunction with any other person or Entity:  actively recruit, solicit, attempt to solicit, induce or attempt to induce any person who is an exempt employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates to leave or cease such employment for any reason whatsoever;

18.

Non-Interference with Business Relationships .

a.

Employee acknowledges that, in the course of employment, Employee will learn about Company’s business, services, materials, programs and products and the manner in which they are developed, marketed, serviced and provided.  Employee knows and



15



acknowledges that the Company has invested considerable time and money in developing its product sales and real estate development programs and relationships, vendor and other service provider relationships and agreements, store layouts and fixtures, and marketing techniques and that those things are unique and original.  Employee further acknowledges that the Company has a strong business reason to keep secret information relating to Company’s business concepts, ideas, programs, plans and processes, so as not to aid Company’s competitors.  Accordingly, Employee acknowledges and agrees that the protection outlined in (b) below is necessary and reasonable.

b.

During the Restricted Period, Employee will not, on Employee’s own behalf or on behalf of any other person or Entity, solicit, contact, call upon, or communicate with any person or entity or any representative of any person or entity who has a business relationship with Company and with whom Employee had contact while employed, if such contact or communication would likely interfere with Company’s business relationships or result in an unfair competitive advantage over Company.

19.

Agreement Not to Work in Competitive Position .  Employee covenants and agrees not to accept, obtain or work in a Competitive Position within the Territory for the Restricted Period.

20.

Acknowledgements Regarding Sections 15 – 19.

a.

Employee and Company expressly covenant and agree that the scope, territorial, time and other restrictions contained in Sections 15 through 19 of this Agreement constitute the most reasonable and equitable restrictions possible to protect the business interests of the Company given: (i) the business of the Company; (ii) the competitive nature of the Company’s industry; and (iii) that Employee’s skills are such that Employee could easily find alternative, commensurate employment or consulting work in Employee’s field which would not violate any of the provisions of this Agreement.

b.

Employee acknowledges that the compensation and benefits described in Sections 5, 11 and 12 are also in consideration of his/her covenants and agreements contained in Sections 15 through 19 hereof.

c.

Employee acknowledges and agrees that a breach by Employee of the obligations set forth in Sections 15 through 19 will likely cause Company irreparable injury and that, in such event, the Company shall be entitled to injunctive relief in addition to such other and further relief as may be proper.



16



d.

The parties agree that if, at any time, a court of competent jurisdiction determines that any of the provisions of Section 15 through 19 are unreasonable under Tennessee law as to time or area or both, the Company shall be entitled to enforce this Agreement for such period of time or within such area as may be determined reasonable by such court.  

21.

Return of Materials .  Upon Employee’s termination, Employee shall return to the Company all written, electronic, recorded or graphic materials of any kind belonging or relating to the Company or its affiliates, including any originals, copies and abstracts in Employee’s possession or control.

22.

General Provisions .

a.

Amendment .  This Agreement may be amended or modified only by a writing signed by both of the parties hereto.

b.

Binding Agreement .  This Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and be binding upon Employee, his/her heirs and personal representatives, and the Company and its successors and assigns.

c.

Waiver Of Breach; Specific Performance .  The waiver of a breach of any provision of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any other breach.  Each of the parties to this Agreement will be entitled to enforce this Agreement, specifically, to recover damages by reason of any breach of this Agreement, and to exercise all other rights existing in that party’s favor.  The parties hereto agree and acknowledge that money damages may not be an adequate remedy for any breach of the provisions of this Agreement and that any party may apply to any court of law or equity of competent jurisdiction for specific performance or injunctive relief to enforce or prevent any violations of the provisions of this Agreement.

d.

Unsecured General Creditor .  The Company shall neither reserve nor speci­fically set aside funds for the payment of its obligations under this Agreement, and such obligations shall be paid solely from the general assets of the Company.

e.

No Effect On Other Arrangements .  It is expressly understood and agreed that the payments made in accordance with this Agreement are in addition to any other benefits or compensation to which Employee may be entitled or for which Employee may be eligible.



17



f.

Tax Withholding .  There shall be deducted from each payment under this Agreement the amount of any tax required by any govern­mental authority to be withheld and paid over by the Company to such governmental authority for the account of Employee.

g.

Notices .

(i)

All notices and all other communications provided for herein shall be in writing and delivered personally to the other designated party, or mailed by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, or delivered by a recognized national overnight courier service, or sent by facsimile, as follows:

If to Company to:

Dollar General Corporation

Attn: General Counsel

100 Mission Ridge

Goodlettsville, TN  37072-2171

Facsimile: (615)855-5180

If to Employee to:

(Last address of Employee

known to Company unless

otherwise directed in writing by Employee)


(ii)

All notices sent under this Agreement shall be deemed given twenty-four (24) hours after sent by facsimile or courier, seventy-two (72) hours after sent by certified or registered mail and when delivered if by personal delivery.

(iii)

Either party hereto may change the address to which notice is to be sent hereunder by written notice to the other party in accordance with the provisions of this Section.

h.

Governing Law .  This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of Tennessee (without giving effect to conflict of laws).

i.

Entire Agreement .  This Agreement contains the full and complete understanding of the parties hereto with respect to the subject matter contained herein and, unless specifically provided herein, this Agreement supersedes and replaces any prior agreement, either oral or written, which Employee may have with Company that relates generally to the same subject matter.    

j.

Assignment .  This Agreement may not be assigned by Employee, and any attempted assignment shall be null and void and of no force or effect.



18



k.

Severability .  If any one or more of the terms, provisions, covenants or restrictions of this Agreement shall be determined by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid, void or unenforceable, then the remainder of the terms, provisions, covenants and restrictions of this Agreement shall remain in full force and effect, and to that end the provisions hereof shall be deemed severable.

l.

Section Headings .  The Section headings set forth herein are for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the meaning or interpretation of this Agreement whatsoever.

m.

Voluntary Agreement .  Employee and Company represent and agree that each has reviewed all aspects of this Agreement, has carefully read and fully understands all provisions of this Agreement, and is voluntarily entering into this Agreement.  Each party represents and agrees that such party has had the opportunity to review any and all aspects of this Agreement with legal, tax or other adviser(s) of such party’s choice before executing this Agreement.

n.

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation Omnibus Provision .  It is intended that any payment or benefit which is provided pursuant to or in connection with this Agreement which is considered to be nonqualified deferred compensation subject to Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code shall be paid and provided in a manner, and at such time and in such form, as complies with the applicable requirements of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code to avoid the unfavorable tax consequences provided therein for non-compliance.  In connection with effecting such compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, the following shall apply:

(i)

Notwithstanding any other provision of this Agreement, the Company is authorized to amend this Agreement, to void or amend any election made by Employee under this Agreement and/or to delay the payment of any monies and/or provision of any benefits in such manner as may be determined by it to be necessary or appropriate to comply, or to evidence or further evidence required compliance, with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (including any transition or grandfather rules thereunder).  

(ii)

Neither Employee nor the Company shall take any action to accelerate or delay the payment of any monies and/or provision of any benefits in any



19



manner which would not be in compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code (including any transition or grandfather rules thereunder).  Notwithstanding the foregoing:

(A)

Payment may be delayed for a reasonable period in the event the payment is not administratively practical due to events beyond the recipient’s control such as where the recipient is not competent to receive the benefit payment, there is a dispute as to amount due or the proper recipient of such benefit payment, additional time is needed to calculate the amount payable, or the payment would jeopardize the solvency of the Company.

(B)

Payments shall be delayed in the following circumstances:  (1) where the Company reasonably anticipates that the payment will violate the terms of a loan agreement to which the Company is a party and that the violation would cause material harm to the Company; or (2) where the Company reasonably anticipates that the payment will violate Federal securities laws or other applicable laws; provided that any payment delayed by operation of this clause (B) will be made at the earliest date at which the Company reasonably anticipates that the payment will not be limited or cause the violations described.

(iii)

If Employee is a specified employee of a publicly traded corporation as required by Section 409A(a)(2)(B)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code, any payment or provision of benefits in connection with a separation from service payment event (as determined for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code) shall not be made until six months after Employee’s separation from service (the “409A Deferral Period”).  In the event such payments are otherwise due to be made in installments or periodically during the 409A Deferral Period, the payments which would otherwise have been made in the 409A Deferral Period shall be accumulated and paid in a lump sum as soon as the 409A Deferral Period ends, and the balance of the payments shall be made as otherwise scheduled.  In the event benefits are required to be deferred, any such benefit may be provided during the 409A Deferral Period at Employee’s expense, with Employee having a right to reimbursement from the Company once the 409A Deferral Period ends, and the balance of the benefits shall be provided as otherwise scheduled.



20



(iv)

If a Change in Control occurs but the Change in Control does not constitute a change in ownership of the Company or in the ownership of a substantial portion of the assets of the Company as provided in Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Internal Revenue Code, then payment of any amount or provision of any benefit under this Agreement which is considered to be nonqualified deferred compensation subject to Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code shall be deferred until another permissible payment event contained in Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code occurs (e.g., death, disability, separation from service from the Company and its affiliated companies as defined for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code), including any deferral of payment or provision of benefits for the 409A Deferral Period as provided above .  

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed, or caused their duly authorized representative to execute this Agreement to be effective as of the Effective Date.


DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

/s/ Challis M. Lowe

 

 

Its:

EVP – Human Resources


Date:

3/30/06

 

“EMPLOYEE”

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ S. Lanigan

 

 

 

Susan Lanigan

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date:

3/30/06

 

Witnessed By:

/s/ Julie Filson

 

 

 

 




21



Addendum to Employment
Agreement with ___________________



RELEASE AGREEMENT

THIS RELEASE (“Release”) is made and entered into by and between _________________ (“Employee”) and DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION , and its successor or assigns (“Company”).

WHEREAS, Employee and Company have agreed that Employee’s employment with Dollar General Corporation shall terminate on ___________________;

WHEREAS, Employee and the Company have previously entered into that certain Employment Agreement, effective _____________________ (“Agreement”), in which the form of this Release is incorporated by reference;

WHEREAS, Employee and Company desire to delineate their respective rights, duties and obligations attendant to such termination and desire to reach an accord and satisfaction of all claims arising from Employee’s employment, and termination of employment, with appropriate releases, in accordance with the Agreement;

WHEREAS, the Company desires to compensate Employee in accordance with the Agreement for service Employee has provided and/or will provide for the Company;

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and the agreements of the parties set forth in this Release, and other good and valuable consideration the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto, intending to be legally bound, hereby covenant and agree as follows:

1.

Claims Released Under This Agreement .

In exchange for receiving the benefits described in Section 11 or 12 of the Agreement, Employee hereby voluntarily and irrevocably waives, releases, dismisses with prejudice, and withdraws all claims, complaints, suits or demands of any kind whatsoever (whether known or unknown) which Employee ever had, may have, or now has against Company and other current or former subsidiaries or affiliates of the Company and their past, present and future officers, directors, employees, agents, insurers and attorneys (collectively, the “Releasees”), arising from or relating to



22



(directly or indirectly) Employee’s employment or the termination of employment or other events that have occurred as of the date of execution of this Agreement, including but not limited to:

a.

claims for violations of Title VII of the Civil Rights Act of 1964, the Age Discrimination in Employment Act, the Fair Labor Standards Act, the Civil Rights Act of 1991, the Americans With Disabilities Act, the Equal Pay Act, the Family and Medical Leave Act, 42 U.S.C. § 1981, the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002, the National Labor Relations Act, the Labor Management Relations Act, Executive Order 11246, Executive Order 11141, the Rehabilitation Act of 1973, or the Employee Retirement Income Security Act;

b.

claims for violations of any other federal or state statute or regulation or local ordinance;

c.

claims for lost or unpaid wages, compensation, or benefits, defamation, intentional or negligent infliction of emotional distress, assault, battery, wrongful or constructive discharge, negligent hiring, retention or supervision, fraud, misrepresentation, conversion, tortious interference, breach of contract, or breach of fiduciary duty;

d.

claims to benefits under any bonus, severance, workforce reduction, early retirement, outplacement, or any other similar type plan sponsored by the Company (except for those benefits owed under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement); or

e.

any other claims under state law arising in tort or contract.

2.

Claims Not Released Under This Agreement .

In signing this Release, Employee is not releasing any claims that may arise under the terms of this Release or which may arise out of events occurring after the date Employee executes this Release.

Employee also is not releasing claims to benefits that Employee is already entitled to receive under any other plan or agreement covering Employee which shall be governed by the terms of such plan or agreement.  However, Employee understands and acknowledges that nothing herein is intended to or shall be construed to require the Company to institute or continue in effect any particular plan or benefit sponsored by the Company, and the Company hereby reserves the right to amend or terminate any of its benefit programs at any time in accordance with the procedures set forth in such plans.



23



Nothing in this Release shall prohibit Employee from engaging in activities required or protected under applicable law or from communicating, either voluntarily or otherwise, with any governmental agency concerning any potential violation of the law.

3.

No Assignment of Claim .  Employee represents that Employee has not assigned or transferred, or purported to assign or transfer, any claims or any portion thereof or interest therein to any party prior to the date of this Release.

4.

Compensation .  In accordance with the Agreement, the Company agrees to pay Employee or, if Employee becomes eligible for payments under Section 11 or 12 but dies before receipt thereof, Employee’s spouse or estate, as the case may be, the amount provided in Section 11 or 12 of the Agreement.

5.

Publicity; No Disparaging Statement .  Except as otherwise provided in Section 14 of the Agreement, Section 2 of this Release, and as privileged by law, Employee and the Company covenant and agree that they shall not engage in any communi­cations with persons outside the Company which shall disparage one another or interfere with their existing or prospective business relationships.

6.

No Admission Of Liability .  This Release shall not in any way be construed as an admission by the Company or Employee of any improper actions or liability whatsoever as to one another, and each specifically disclaims any liability to or improper actions against the other or any other person.

7.

Voluntary Execution .  Employee warrants, represents and agrees that Employee has been encouraged in writing to seek advice regarding this Release from an attorney and tax advisor prior to signing it; that this Release represents written notice to do so; that Employee has been given the opportunity and sufficient time to seek such advice; and that Employee fully understands the meaning and contents of this Release. Employee further represents and warrants that Employee was not coerced, threatened or otherwise forced to sign this Release, and that Employee’s signature appearing hereinafter is voluntary and genuine.  EMPLOYEE UNDERSTANDS THAT EMPLOYEE MAY TAKE UP TO TWENTY-ONE (21) DAYS TO CONSIDER WHETHER TO ENTER INTO THIS RELEASE.

8.

Ability to Revoke Agreement .  EMPLOYEE UNDERSTANDS THAT  THIS RELEASE MAY BE REVOKED BY EMPLOYEE BY NOTIFYING THE COMPANY IN WRITING OF SUCH REVOCATION WITHIN SEVEN (7) DAYS OF EMPLOYEE’S



24



EXECUTION OF THIS RELEASE AND THAT THIS RELEASE IS NOT EFFECTIVE UNTIL THE EXPIRATION OF SUCH SEVEN (7) DAY PERIOD.  EMPLOYEE UNDERSTANDS THAT UPON THE EXPIRATION OF SUCH SEVEN (7) DAY PERIOD THIS RELEASE WILL BE BINDING UPON EMPLOYEE AND EMPLOYEE’S HEIRS, ADMINISTRATORS, REPRESENTATIVES, EXECUTORS, SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS AND WILL BE IRREVOCABLE.

Acknowledged and Agreed To:

“COMPANY”

 

 

DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

 

 

 

Its:

 


I UNDERSTAND THAT BY SIGNING THIS RELEASE, I AM GIVING UP RIGHTS I MAY HAVE.  I UNDERSTAND THAT I DO NOT HAVE TO SIGN THIS RELEASE.


 

 

 

“EMPLOYEE”

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

WITNESSED BY:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Date

 

 

 





25


FIRST AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS FIRST AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (“First Amendment”), which amends that certain Employment Agreement (“Agreement”) effective April 1, 2006 between DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION (the “Company”), and Susan Lanigan (“Employee”), is made and entered into by the Company and Employee as of May 9, 2008 (“First Amendment Effective Date”).


W I T N E S S E T H:


WHEREAS , the change in control severance provisions in Section 12 of the Agreement specifically provide that the Company will pay to Employee, only upon the occurrence of certain events and fulfillment of certain conditions, a severance payment calculated by reference to Employee’s Base Salary (as defined in the Agreement) and target incentive bonus in effect immediately prior to the Change in Control; and

WHEREAS , the intent of such provision was to ensure that the Employee’s potential severance amounts were protected from reductions made after a Change in Control, and the parties desire to amend the Agreement to reflect that intent.


NOW, THEREFORE, for and in consideration of the premises, the mutual promises, covenants and agreements contained herein, and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties agree that the Agreement as follows:


1.

Section 12(a)(i) shall be amended to add the following language to the end of the provision after the words “Change in Control” and  prior to the semi-colon:

“or, if greater, at the date of termination”

2.

Except as expressly provided herein, the Agreement shall otherwise remain in full force and effect.



1




IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed, or caused their duly authorized representative to execute, this First Amendment to be effective as of the First Amendment Effective Date.



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

By:

/s/ David Tehle

 

 

Its:

EVP & CFO


Date:

5/14/08

 

 

 

 

 

“EMPLOYEE”

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ S. Lanigan

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Susan Lanigan

 

 

 

 

Date:

5/14/08

 

 

 

 

 

Witnessed By:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Jeffery R. Rice





2



AMENDMENT TO EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT

THIS AMENDMENT TO THE EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT (this “ Amendment ”) is made December 15, 2008, between Dollar General Corporation, a Tennessee corporation (the “ Company ”), and Susan S. Lanigan (“ Employee ”).  Capitalized terms used in this Amendment and not otherwise defined herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Employment Agreement (as defined below).  

WITNESSETH :

WHEREAS , the Company and Employee have previously entered into an Employment Agreement by and between the Company and Employee dated April 1, 2006 (the “ Employment Agreement ”); and

WHEREAS, the Company and Employee desire to amend the Employment Agreement to ensure compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “ Code ”).

NOW, THEREFORE , the parties agree to amend the Employment Agreement, effective as of the date hereof, as follows:

1.

Incentive Bonus .  The following sentence shall be added to the end of Section 5(b) of the Employment Agreement as a new last sentence thereof:

“Any bonus payments due hereunder shall be payable to Employee no later than 2½ months after the end of the Company’s taxable year or the calendar year, whichever is later, in which Employee is first vested in such bonus payments for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.”

2.

Release; Timing of Severance Payments .  Section 11(b) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended to delete the first sentence thereof and insert the following sentence in replacement thereof:

“In the event of one of the triggers referenced in Sections 11(a)(i) through (iii) above, then, on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached hereto and made a part hereof, and subject to Section 22(n) below, Employee shall be entitled to the following:”

The Company and Employee hereby agree that any severance amounts that would otherwise have been payable during the 60 day period following Employee’s termination of employment shall instead be payable in a single lump sum on the 60 th day after




2


Employee’s termination, with the remaining severance payments paid in the form of salary continuation payments as set forth under Section 11(b).

3.

Effect of Change in Control .  The Company and Employee hereby agree that the special timing of severance payments described under Section 12(a) of the Employment Agreement for certain terminations of employment following a Change in Control shall apply only in the event that the Change in Control constitutes a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code.  In the event that the Change in Control does not constitute a change in ownership or effective control within the meaning of Section 409A(a)(2)(A)(v) of the Code, then the timing of any severance payments shall be determined pursuant to Section 11 of the Employment Agreement.  The Company and Employee further agree that any severance amounts which become payable pursuant to Section 12(a) of the Employment Agreement shall become payable on the 60 th day after Employee’s termination of employment, but contingent upon the execution and effectiveness of the Release attached to the Employment Agreement.

4.

Section 409A Compliance Generally .  Section 22(n) of the Employment Agreement shall be amended as follows:

a)

Section 22(n)(ii) is hereby amended to delete the sentence therein commencing with the words “Notwithstanding the foregoing” including the immediately following clauses (A) and (B).

b)

Section 22(n)(iv) is hereby deleted in its entirety, and new sentences shall be inserted in lieu thereof to read as follows:

“References under this Agreement to Employee’s termination of employment shall be deemed to refer to the date upon which Employee has experienced a “separation from service” within the meaning of Section 409A of the Code.  All payments made under this Agreement shall constitute “separate payments” for purposes of Section 409A of the Code.  To the extent any reimbursements or in-kind benefits due to Employee under this Agreement constitute “deferred compensation” under Section 409A of the Code, any such reimbursements or in-kind benefits shall be paid to Employee in a manner consistent with Treas. Reg. Section 1.409A-3(i)(1)(iv).”

5.

Continuation of Employment Agreement in Other Respects .  In all other respects, the Employment Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

6.

Counterparts .  This Amendment may be executed by either of the parties hereto in counterparts, each of which shall be deemed to be an original Amendment, but all such counterparts shall together constitute one and the same instrument.





3


IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Amendment to the Employment Agreement, effective as of the day and the year first set forth above.



DOLLAR GENERAL CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ David Tehle

 

Name:

David Tehle

 

Title:

EVP, CFO

 

 

 

 

 

 

EMPLOYEE

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ S. Lanigan

Susan S. Lanigan





Dollar General Corporation

Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges

 

Historical

Pro Forma(1)

Historical

 

Predecessor

Successor

 

Fiscal Year Ended

 

 

Fiscal Year Ended

 

January 28, 2005

February 3, 2006(2)

February 2, 2007

February 3,
2007
through
July 6,
2007

March 6,
2007
through
February 1, 2008

February 1,
2008

January 30,
2009

Earnings(3):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

$534.8 

$544.6 

$220.4 

$4.0 

$(6.6)

$(3.4)

$194.4 

Fixed Charges, exclusive of capitalized interest

111.8 

123.1 

140.7 

58.8 

320.7 

380.3 

513.7 

 

$646.6 

$667.7 

$361.1 

$62.8 

$314.1 

$376.9 

$708.1 

Fixed Charges(3):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest charged to expense

$28.8 

$26.2 

$34.9 

$10.3 

$252.9 

$264.0 

$391.9 

Interest factor on rental expense(4)

83.0 

96.9 

105.8 

48.5 

67.8 

116.3 

121.8 

 

111.8 

123.1 

140.7 

58.8 

320.7 

380.3 

513.7 

Interest capitalized

3.6 

3.3 

2.9 

— 

— 

— 

— 

 

$115.4 

$126.4 

$143.6 

$58.8 

$320.7 

$380.3 

$513.7 

Ratio of earnings to fixed charges

5.6x 

5.3x 

2.5x 

1.1x 

 

 

1.4x 

Excess of fixed charges over earnings(5)

 

 

 

 

$(6.6)

$(3.4)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


(1)

To give effect to the increase in interest expense resulting from the portion of the notes proceeds used to retire the $198.3 million of our 8 5 / 8 % unsecured notes due June 10, 2010 as if such transactions had occurred at the beginning of the period presented.

(2)

The fiscal year ended February 3, 2006 was comprised of 53 weeks.

(3)

For purposes of computing the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, (a) earnings consist of income (loss) before income taxes, plus fixed charges less capitalized expenses related to indebtedness (amortization expense for capitalized interest is not significant) and (b) fixed charges consist of interest expense (whether expensed or capitalized), the amortization of debt issuance costs and discounts related to indebtedness, and the interest portion of rent expense.

(4)

The portion of rent expense representative of interest is based on the present value of the future lease payments discounted at 10%.

(5)

For the period from March 6, 2007 through February 1, 2008, fixed charges exceeded earnings by $6.6 million. For the fiscal year ended February 1, 2008, pro forma fixed charges exceeded earnings by $3.4 million.





 

SUBSIDIARIES OF THE REGISTRANT
(as of March 20, 2009)

 

 

 

Name of Entity

Jurisdiction of
Incorporation/Organization

 

DC Financial, LLC

Tennessee

 

Dolgencorp, LLC

Kentucky

 

Dolgencorp of New York, Inc.

Kentucky

 

Dolgencorp of Texas, Inc.

Kentucky

 

Dolgen I, Inc.

Tennessee

 

Dolgen II, Inc.

Tennessee

 

Dolgen III, Inc.

Tennessee

 

DG Strategic I, LLC

Tennessee

 

DG Strategic II, LLC

Tennessee

 

DG Strategic III, LLC

Tennessee

 

DG Transportation, Inc.

Tennessee

 

DG Logistics LLC (1)

Tennessee

 

South Boston Holdings, Inc.

Delaware

 

Sun-Dollar, L.P. (2)

California

 

South Boston FF&E, LLC (3)

Delaware

 

DG Promotions, Inc. [formerly known as Nations Title Company, Inc.]

Tennessee

 

DG Retail, LLC (4)

Tennessee

 

Ashley River Insurance Company, Inc.

South Carolina

 

DGC Holdings, LLC

Delaware

 

Dollar General Global Sourcing Limited (5)

Hong Kong

 

Dollar General Literacy Foundation (6)

Tennessee

 

Dollar General Partners (7)

Kentucky

 

Retail Risk Solutions, LLC

Tennessee

                                                                

 

 

(1)

A limited liability company in which DG Transportation, Inc. is the sole member.

(2)

A limited partnership in which the general partner is South Boston Holdings, Inc. and the limited partner is Dollar General Corporation.

(3)

A limited liability company in which Sun-Dollar, L.P. is the sole member.

(4)

A limited liability company in which DG Promotions, Inc. is the sole member.

(5)

Held 99.9% by Dollar General Corporation and 0.1% by DGC Holdings, LLC.

(6)

A nonprofit, public benefit membership corporation in which Dollar General Corporation is the sole member.

(7)

A general partnership in which the general partners are Dollar General Corporation and DG Promotions, Inc.







Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm


We consent to the incorporation by reference in the following Registration Statements and related prospectuses: (1) the Registration Statement (Form S-8 No. 333-151047) pertaining to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of Dollar General Corporation and its Affiliates, (2) the Registration Statement (Form S-8 No. 333-151049) pertaining to the Dollar General Corporation CDP/SERP Plan, (3) the Registration Statement (Form S-8 No. 333-151655) pertaining to the 2007 Stock Incentive Plan for Key Employees of Dollar General Corporation and its Affiliates, and (4) the Registration Statement (Form S-8 No. 333-151661) pertaining to the Dollar General Corporation 1998 Stock Incentive Plan, of our report dated March 24, 2009, with respect to the consolidated financial statements of Dollar General Corporation included in this Annual Report (Form 10-K) for the year ended January 30, 2009.



/s/ Ernst & Young LLP


Nashville, Tennessee

March 24, 2009



CERTIFICATIONS


I, Richard W. Dreiling, certify that:


1.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Dollar General Corporation;


2.

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;


3.

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;


4.

The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:


(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;


(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;


(c)

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(d)  Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and


5.

The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of  the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):


(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and


(b)  Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.



Date:  March 24, 2009

 

/s/ Richard W. Dreiling

 

 

Richard W. Dreiling

 

 

Chief Executive Officer







I, David M. Tehle, certify that:


1.

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Dollar General Corporation;


2.

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;


3.

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;


4.

The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:


(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;


(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;


(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(d)  Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and


5.

The registrant’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):


(a)  All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and


(b)  Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.



Date: March 24, 2009

 

/s/ David M. Tehle

 

 

David M. Tehle

 

 

Chief Financial Officer




CERTIFICATIONS

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350


Each of the undersigned hereby certifies that to his knowledge the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended January 30, 2009 of Dollar General Corporation (the “Company”) filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof fully complies with the requirements of section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and that the information contained in such report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.



 

/s/ Richard W. Dreiling

 

Name:

Richard W. Dreiling

 

Title:

Chief Executive Officer

 

Date:

March 24, 2009



 

/s/ David M. Tehle

 

Name:

David M. Tehle

 

Title:

Chief Financial Officer

 

Date:

March 24, 2009